gdb/
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996,
3 @c 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009,
4 @c 2010, 2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24 @syncodeindex tp cp
25
26 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
27 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
28 @syncodeindex vr cp
29 @syncodeindex fn cp
30
31 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
32 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
33 @set EDITION Ninth
34
35 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
36 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
37
38 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
39
40 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
41 @c manuals to an info tree.
42 @dircategory Software development
43 @direntry
44 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
45 @end direntry
46
47 @copying
48 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996,
49 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
50 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
51
52 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
53 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
54 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
55 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
56 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
57 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
58
59 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
60 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
61 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
62 @end copying
63
64 @ifnottex
65 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
66
67 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
68 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
69 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
70 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
71 @end ifset
72 Version @value{GDBVN}.
73
74 @insertcopying
75 @end ifnottex
76
77 @titlepage
78 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
79 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
80 @sp 1
81 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
82 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
83 @sp 1
84 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
85 @end ifset
86 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
87 @page
88 @tex
89 {\parskip=0pt
90 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
91 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
92 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
93 }
94 @end tex
95
96 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
97 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
98 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
99 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
100 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
101
102 @insertcopying
103 @page
104 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
105 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
106 software in general. We will miss him.
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2010 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163
164 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
165
166 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
167 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
168 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
169 @end ifset
170 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
171 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
172 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
173 @end ifclear
174 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
175 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
176 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
177 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
178 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
179 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
180 @value{GDBN}
181 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
182 the operating system
183 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
184 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
185 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
186 how you can copy and share GDB
187 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
188 * Index:: Index
189 @end menu
190
191 @end ifnottex
192
193 @contents
194
195 @node Summary
196 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
197
198 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
199 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
200 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
201
202 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
203 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
204
205 @itemize @bullet
206 @item
207 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
208
209 @item
210 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
211
212 @item
213 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
214
215 @item
216 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
217 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
218 @end itemize
219
220 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
221 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
222 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
223
224 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
225 @ref{D,,D}.
226
227 @cindex Modula-2
228 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
229 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
230
231 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
232 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
233
234 @cindex Pascal
235 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
236 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
237 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
238 syntax.
239
240 @cindex Fortran
241 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
242 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
243 underscore.
244
245 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
246 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
247
248 @menu
249 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
250 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
251 @end menu
252
253 @node Free Software
254 @unnumberedsec Free Software
255
256 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
257 General Public License
258 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
259 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
260 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
261 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
262 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
263 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
264
265 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
266 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
267 from anyone else.
268
269 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
270
271 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
272 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
273 include with the free software. Many of our most important
274 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
275 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
276 when an important free software package does not come with a free
277 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
278 gaps today.
279
280 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
281 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
282 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
283 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
284 them from the free software world.
285
286 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
287 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
288 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
289 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
290 contract to make it non-free.
291
292 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
293 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
294 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
295 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
296 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
297 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
298 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
299
300 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
301 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
302 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
303 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
304
305 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
306 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
307 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
308 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
309 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
310 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
311 community.
312
313 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
314 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
315 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
316 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
317 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
318 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
319 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
320 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
321 of the manual.
322
323 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
324 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
325 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
326 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
327 manual to replace it.
328
329 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
330 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
331 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
332 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
333 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
334 the free software community.
335
336 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
337 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
338 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
339 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
340 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
341 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
342 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
343 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
344 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
345
346 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
347 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
348 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
349 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
350 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
351 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
352 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
353 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
354
355 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
356 published by other publishers, at
357 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
358
359 @node Contributors
360 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
361
362 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
363 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
364 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
365 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
366 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
367 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
368 blow-by-blow account.
369
370 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
371
372 @quotation
373 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
374 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
375 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
376 @end quotation
377
378 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
379 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
380 releases:
381 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
382 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
383 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
384 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
385 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
386 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
387 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
388 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
389 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
390
391 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
392 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
393
394 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
395 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
396 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
397 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
398 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
399
400 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
401 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
402 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
403
404 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
405 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
406
407 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
408
409 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
410 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
411 support.
412 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
413 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
414 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
415 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
416 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
417 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
418 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
419 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
420 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
421 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
422 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
423 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
424 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
425 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
426 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
427 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
428
429 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
430
431 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
432 libraries.
433
434 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
435 about several machine instruction sets.
436
437 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
438 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
439 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
440 and RDI targets, respectively.
441
442 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
443 command-line editing and command history.
444
445 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
446 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
447
448 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
449 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
450 symbols.
451
452 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
453 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
454
455 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
456
457 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
458 processors.
459
460 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
461
462 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
463
464 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
465
466 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
467 watchpoints.
468
469 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
470
471 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
472
473 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
474 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
475
476 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
477 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
478 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
479 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
480 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
481 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
482 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
483
484 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
485 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
486
487 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
488 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
489 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
490 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
491 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
492 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
493 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
494 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
495 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
496 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
497 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
498 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
499 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
500 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
501 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
502
503 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
504 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
505
506 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
507 Hat.
508
509 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
510 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
511 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
512 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
513 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
514 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
515
516 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
517 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
518 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
519 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
520 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
521 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
522 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
523 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
524 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
525 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
526 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
527 Weigand.
528
529 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
530 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
531 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
532 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
533
534 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
535 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
536
537 @node Sample Session
538 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
539
540 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
541 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
542 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
543
544 @iftex
545 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
546 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
547 @end iftex
548
549 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
550 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
551
552 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
553 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
554 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
555 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
556 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
557 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
558 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
559 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
560 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
561
562 @smallexample
563 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
564 $ @b{./m4}
565 @b{define(foo,0000)}
566
567 @b{foo}
568 0000
569 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
570
571 @b{bar}
572 0000
573 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
574
575 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
576 @b{baz}
577 @b{Ctrl-d}
578 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
579 @end smallexample
580
581 @noindent
582 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
583
584 @smallexample
585 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
586 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
587 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
588 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
589 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
590 the conditions.
591 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
592 for details.
593
594 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
595 (@value{GDBP})
596 @end smallexample
597
598 @noindent
599 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
600 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
601 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
602 that examples fit in this manual.
603
604 @smallexample
605 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
606 @end smallexample
607
608 @noindent
609 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
610 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
611 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
612 @code{break} command.
613
614 @smallexample
615 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
616 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
617 @end smallexample
618
619 @noindent
620 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
621 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
622 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
623
624 @smallexample
625 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
626 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
627 @b{define(foo,0000)}
628
629 @b{foo}
630 0000
631 @end smallexample
632
633 @noindent
634 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
635 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
636 context where it stops.
637
638 @smallexample
639 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
640
641 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
642 at builtin.c:879
643 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
644 @end smallexample
645
646 @noindent
647 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
648 the next line of the current function.
649
650 @smallexample
651 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
652 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
653 : nil,
654 @end smallexample
655
656 @noindent
657 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
658 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
659 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
660 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
661
662 @smallexample
663 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
664 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
665 at input.c:530
666 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
667 @end smallexample
668
669 @noindent
670 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
671 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
672 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
673 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
674 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
675 stack frame for each active subroutine.
676
677 @smallexample
678 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
679 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
680 at input.c:530
681 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
682 at builtin.c:882
683 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
684 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
685 at macro.c:71
686 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
687 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
688 @end smallexample
689
690 @noindent
691 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
692 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
693 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
694
695 @smallexample
696 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
697 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
698 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
699 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
700 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
702 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
703 : xstrdup(rq);
704 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
705 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
706 @end smallexample
707
708 @noindent
709 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
710 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
711 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
712 (@code{print}) to see their values.
713
714 @smallexample
715 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
716 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
717 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
718 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
719 @end smallexample
720
721 @noindent
722 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
723 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
724 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
725
726 @smallexample
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
728 533 xfree(rquote);
729 534
730 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
731 : xstrdup (lq);
732 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
733 : xstrdup (rq);
734 537
735 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
736 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
737 540 @}
738 541
739 542 void
740 @end smallexample
741
742 @noindent
743 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
744 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
745
746 @smallexample
747 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
748 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
749 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
750 540 @}
751 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
752 $3 = 9
753 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
754 $4 = 7
755 @end smallexample
756
757 @noindent
758 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
759 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
760 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
761 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
762 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
763 assignments.
764
765 @smallexample
766 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
767 $5 = 7
768 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
769 $6 = 9
770 @end smallexample
771
772 @noindent
773 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
774 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
775 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
776 example that caused trouble initially:
777
778 @smallexample
779 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
780 Continuing.
781
782 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
783
784 baz
785 0000
786 @end smallexample
787
788 @noindent
789 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
790 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
791 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
792
793 @smallexample
794 @b{Ctrl-d}
795 Program exited normally.
796 @end smallexample
797
798 @noindent
799 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
800 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
801 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
802
803 @smallexample
804 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
805 @end smallexample
806
807 @node Invocation
808 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
809
810 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
811 The essentials are:
812 @itemize @bullet
813 @item
814 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
815 @item
816 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
817 @end itemize
818
819 @menu
820 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
821 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
822 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
823 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
824 @end menu
825
826 @node Invoking GDB
827 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
828
829 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
830 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
831
832 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
833 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
834
835 The command-line options described here are designed
836 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
837 options may effectively be unavailable.
838
839 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
840 specifying an executable program:
841
842 @smallexample
843 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
844 @end smallexample
845
846 @noindent
847 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
848 specified:
849
850 @smallexample
851 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
852 @end smallexample
853
854 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
855 to debug a running process:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
859 @end smallexample
860
861 @noindent
862 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
863 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
864
865 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
866 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
867 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
868 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
869 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
870
871 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
872 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
873 option processing.
874 @smallexample
875 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
876 @end smallexample
877 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
878 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
879
880 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
881 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
882
883 @smallexample
884 @value{GDBP} -silent
885 @end smallexample
886
887 @noindent
888 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
889 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
890
891 @noindent
892 Type
893
894 @smallexample
895 @value{GDBP} -help
896 @end smallexample
897
898 @noindent
899 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
900 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
901
902 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
903 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
904 @samp{-x} option is used.
905
906
907 @menu
908 * File Options:: Choosing files
909 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
910 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
911 @end menu
912
913 @node File Options
914 @subsection Choosing Files
915
916 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
917 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
918 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
919 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
920 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
921 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
922 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
923 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
924 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
925 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
926 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
927 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
928 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
929
930 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
931 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
932 argument and ignore it.
933
934 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
935 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
936 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
937 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
938 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
939
940 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
941 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
942 @c it.
943
944 @table @code
945 @item -symbols @var{file}
946 @itemx -s @var{file}
947 @cindex @code{--symbols}
948 @cindex @code{-s}
949 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
950
951 @item -exec @var{file}
952 @itemx -e @var{file}
953 @cindex @code{--exec}
954 @cindex @code{-e}
955 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
956 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
957
958 @item -se @var{file}
959 @cindex @code{--se}
960 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
961 file.
962
963 @item -core @var{file}
964 @itemx -c @var{file}
965 @cindex @code{--core}
966 @cindex @code{-c}
967 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
968
969 @item -pid @var{number}
970 @itemx -p @var{number}
971 @cindex @code{--pid}
972 @cindex @code{-p}
973 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
974
975 @item -command @var{file}
976 @itemx -x @var{file}
977 @cindex @code{--command}
978 @cindex @code{-x}
979 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
980 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
981 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
982
983 @item -eval-command @var{command}
984 @itemx -ex @var{command}
985 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
986 @cindex @code{-ex}
987 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
988
989 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
990 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
991
992 @smallexample
993 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
994 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
995 @end smallexample
996
997 @item -directory @var{directory}
998 @itemx -d @var{directory}
999 @cindex @code{--directory}
1000 @cindex @code{-d}
1001 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1002
1003 @item -r
1004 @itemx -readnow
1005 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1006 @cindex @code{-r}
1007 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1008 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1009 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1010
1011 @end table
1012
1013 @node Mode Options
1014 @subsection Choosing Modes
1015
1016 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1017 batch mode or quiet mode.
1018
1019 @table @code
1020 @item -nx
1021 @itemx -n
1022 @cindex @code{--nx}
1023 @cindex @code{-n}
1024 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1025 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1026 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1027 Files}.
1028
1029 @item -quiet
1030 @itemx -silent
1031 @itemx -q
1032 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1033 @cindex @code{--silent}
1034 @cindex @code{-q}
1035 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1036 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1037
1038 @item -batch
1039 @cindex @code{--batch}
1040 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1041 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1042 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1043 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1044 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1045 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1046 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1047
1048 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1049 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1050 make this more useful, the message
1051
1052 @smallexample
1053 Program exited normally.
1054 @end smallexample
1055
1056 @noindent
1057 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1058 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1059 mode.
1060
1061 @item -batch-silent
1062 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1063 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1064 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1065 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1066 for an interactive session.
1067
1068 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1069 messages, for example.
1070
1071 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1072 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1073
1074 @item -return-child-result
1075 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1076 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1077 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1078
1079 @itemize @bullet
1080 @item
1081 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1082 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1083 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1084 @item
1085 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1086 @item
1087 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1088 the exit code will be -1.
1089 @end itemize
1090
1091 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1092 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1093 interface.
1094
1095 @item -nowindows
1096 @itemx -nw
1097 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1098 @cindex @code{-nw}
1099 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1100 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1101 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1102
1103 @item -windows
1104 @itemx -w
1105 @cindex @code{--windows}
1106 @cindex @code{-w}
1107 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1108 used if possible.
1109
1110 @item -cd @var{directory}
1111 @cindex @code{--cd}
1112 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1113 instead of the current directory.
1114
1115 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1116 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1117 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1118 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1119 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1120
1121 @item -fullname
1122 @itemx -f
1123 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1124 @cindex @code{-f}
1125 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1126 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1127 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1128 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1129 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1130 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1131 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1132 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1133 frame.
1134
1135 @item -epoch
1136 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1137 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1138 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1139 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1140 separate window.
1141
1142 @item -annotate @var{level}
1143 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1144 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1145 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1146 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1147 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1148 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1149 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1150 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1151 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1152
1153 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1154 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1155
1156 @item --args
1157 @cindex @code{--args}
1158 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1159 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1160 This option stops option processing.
1161
1162 @item -baud @var{bps}
1163 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1164 @cindex @code{--baud}
1165 @cindex @code{-b}
1166 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1167 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1168
1169 @item -l @var{timeout}
1170 @cindex @code{-l}
1171 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1172 for remote debugging.
1173
1174 @item -tty @var{device}
1175 @itemx -t @var{device}
1176 @cindex @code{--tty}
1177 @cindex @code{-t}
1178 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1179 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1180
1181 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1182 @item -tui
1183 @cindex @code{--tui}
1184 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1185 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1186 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1187 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1188 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1189 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1190 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1191
1192 @c @item -xdb
1193 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1194 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1195 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1196 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1197 @c systems.
1198
1199 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1200 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1201 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1202 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1203 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1204 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1205
1206 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1207 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1208 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1209 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1210 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1211 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1212
1213 @item -write
1214 @cindex @code{--write}
1215 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1216 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1217 (@pxref{Patching}).
1218
1219 @item -statistics
1220 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1221 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1222 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1223
1224 @item -version
1225 @cindex @code{--version}
1226 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1227 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1228
1229 @end table
1230
1231 @node Startup
1232 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1233 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1234
1235 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1236
1237 @enumerate
1238 @item
1239 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1240 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1241
1242 @item
1243 @cindex init file
1244 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1245 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1246 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1247 that file.
1248
1249 @item
1250 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1251 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1252 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1253 that file.
1254
1255 @item
1256 Processes command line options and operands.
1257
1258 @item
1259 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1260 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1261 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1262 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1263 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1264 @value{GDBN}.
1265
1266 @item
1267 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1268 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1269 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1270 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1271
1272 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1273 you must do something like the following:
1274
1275 @smallexample
1276 $ gdb -ex "set auto-load-scripts off" -ex "file myprogram"
1277 @end smallexample
1278
1279 The following does not work because the auto-loading is turned off too late:
1280
1281 @smallexample
1282 $ gdb -ex "set auto-load-scripts off" myprogram
1283 @end smallexample
1284
1285 @item
1286 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1287 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1288
1289 @item
1290 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1291 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1292 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1293 @end enumerate
1294
1295 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1296 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1297 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1298 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1299 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1300 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1301
1302 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1303 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1304
1305 @cindex init file name
1306 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1307 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1308 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1309 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1310 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1311 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1312 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1313 the file to the standard name.
1314
1315
1316 @node Quitting GDB
1317 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1318 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1319 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1320
1321 @table @code
1322 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1323 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1324 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1325 @itemx q
1326 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1327 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1328 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1329 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1330 error code.
1331 @end table
1332
1333 @cindex interrupt
1334 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1335 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1336 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1337 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1338 until a time when it is safe.
1339
1340 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1341 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1342 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1343
1344 @node Shell Commands
1345 @section Shell Commands
1346
1347 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1348 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1349 just use the @code{shell} command.
1350
1351 @table @code
1352 @kindex shell
1353 @cindex shell escape
1354 @item shell @var{command string}
1355 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1356 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1357 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1358 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1359 @end table
1360
1361 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1362 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1363 @value{GDBN}:
1364
1365 @table @code
1366 @kindex make
1367 @cindex calling make
1368 @item make @var{make-args}
1369 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1370 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1371 @end table
1372
1373 @node Logging Output
1374 @section Logging Output
1375 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1376 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1377
1378 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1379 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1380
1381 @table @code
1382 @kindex set logging
1383 @item set logging on
1384 Enable logging.
1385 @item set logging off
1386 Disable logging.
1387 @cindex logging file name
1388 @item set logging file @var{file}
1389 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1390 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1391 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1392 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1393 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1394 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1395 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1396 @kindex show logging
1397 @item show logging
1398 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1399 @end table
1400
1401 @node Commands
1402 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1403
1404 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1405 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1406 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1407 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1408 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1409
1410 @menu
1411 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1412 * Completion:: Command completion
1413 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1414 @end menu
1415
1416 @node Command Syntax
1417 @section Command Syntax
1418
1419 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1420 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1421 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1422 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1423 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1424 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1425
1426 @cindex abbreviation
1427 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1428 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1429 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1430 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1431 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1432 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1433 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1434
1435 @cindex repeating commands
1436 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1437 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1438 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1439 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1440 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1441 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1442 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1443
1444 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1445 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1446 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1447
1448 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1449 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1450 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1451 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1452 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1453
1454 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1455 @cindex comment
1456 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1457 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1458 Files,,Command Files}).
1459
1460 @cindex repeating command sequences
1461 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1462 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1463 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1464 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1465 for editing.
1466
1467 @node Completion
1468 @section Command Completion
1469
1470 @cindex completion
1471 @cindex word completion
1472 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1473 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1474 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1475 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1476
1477 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1478 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1479 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1480 enter it). For example, if you type
1481
1482 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1483 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1484 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1485 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1486 @smallexample
1487 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1488 @end smallexample
1489
1490 @noindent
1491 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1492 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1493
1494 @smallexample
1495 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1496 @end smallexample
1497
1498 @noindent
1499 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1500 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1501 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1502 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1503 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1504 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1505
1506 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1507 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1508 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1509 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1510 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1511 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1512 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1513 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1514 example:
1515
1516 @smallexample
1517 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1518 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1519 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1520 make_abs_section make_function_type
1521 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1522 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1523 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1524 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1525 @end smallexample
1526
1527 @noindent
1528 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1529 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1530 command.
1531
1532 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1533 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1534 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1535 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1536 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1537
1538 @cindex quotes in commands
1539 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1540 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1541 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1542 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1543 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1544 @value{GDBN} commands.
1545
1546 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1547 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1548 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1549 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1550 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1551 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1552 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1553 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1554 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1555 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1556 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1557
1558 @smallexample
1559 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1560 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1561 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1562 @end smallexample
1563
1564 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1565 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1566 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1567 place:
1568
1569 @smallexample
1570 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1571 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1572 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1573 @end smallexample
1574
1575 @noindent
1576 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1577 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1578 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1579
1580 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1581 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1582 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1583 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1584
1585 @cindex completion of structure field names
1586 @cindex structure field name completion
1587 @cindex completion of union field names
1588 @cindex union field name completion
1589 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1590 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1591 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1592 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1593 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1594 left-hand-side:
1595
1596 @smallexample
1597 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1598 magic to_delete to_fputs to_put to_rewind
1599 to_data to_flush to_isatty to_read to_write
1600 @end smallexample
1601
1602 @noindent
1603 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1604 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1605 follows:
1606
1607 @smallexample
1608 struct ui_file
1609 @{
1610 int *magic;
1611 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1612 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1613 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1614 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1615 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1616 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1617 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1618 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1619 void *to_data;
1620 @}
1621 @end smallexample
1622
1623
1624 @node Help
1625 @section Getting Help
1626 @cindex online documentation
1627 @kindex help
1628
1629 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1630 using the command @code{help}.
1631
1632 @table @code
1633 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1634 @item help
1635 @itemx h
1636 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1637 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1638
1639 @smallexample
1640 (@value{GDBP}) help
1641 List of classes of commands:
1642
1643 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1644 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1645 data -- Examining data
1646 files -- Specifying and examining files
1647 internals -- Maintenance commands
1648 obscure -- Obscure features
1649 running -- Running the program
1650 stack -- Examining the stack
1651 status -- Status inquiries
1652 support -- Support facilities
1653 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1654 stopping the program
1655 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1656
1657 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1658 commands in that class.
1659 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1660 documentation.
1661 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1662 (@value{GDBP})
1663 @end smallexample
1664 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1665
1666 @item help @var{class}
1667 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1668 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1669 help display for the class @code{status}:
1670
1671 @smallexample
1672 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1673 Status inquiries.
1674
1675 List of commands:
1676
1677 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1678 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1679 info -- Generic command for showing things
1680 about the program being debugged
1681 show -- Generic command for showing things
1682 about the debugger
1683
1684 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1685 documentation.
1686 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1687 (@value{GDBP})
1688 @end smallexample
1689
1690 @item help @var{command}
1691 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1692 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1693
1694 @kindex apropos
1695 @item apropos @var{args}
1696 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1697 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1698 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1699
1700 @smallexample
1701 apropos reload
1702 @end smallexample
1703
1704 @noindent
1705 results in:
1706
1707 @smallexample
1708 @c @group
1709 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1710 multiple times in one run
1711 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1712 multiple times in one run
1713 @c @end group
1714 @end smallexample
1715
1716 @kindex complete
1717 @item complete @var{args}
1718 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1719 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1720 command you want completed. For example:
1721
1722 @smallexample
1723 complete i
1724 @end smallexample
1725
1726 @noindent results in:
1727
1728 @smallexample
1729 @group
1730 if
1731 ignore
1732 info
1733 inspect
1734 @end group
1735 @end smallexample
1736
1737 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1738 @end table
1739
1740 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1741 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1742 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1743 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1744 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1745 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1746
1747 @c @group
1748 @table @code
1749 @kindex info
1750 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1751 @item info
1752 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1753 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1754 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1755 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1756 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1757 @w{@code{help info}}.
1758
1759 @kindex set
1760 @item set
1761 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1762 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1763 @code{set prompt $}.
1764
1765 @kindex show
1766 @item show
1767 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1768 @value{GDBN} itself.
1769 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1770 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1771 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1772 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1773
1774 @kindex info set
1775 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1776 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1777 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1778 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1779 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1780 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1781 @end table
1782 @c @end group
1783
1784 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1785 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1786
1787 @table @code
1788 @kindex show version
1789 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1790 @item show version
1791 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1792 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1793 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1794 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1795 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1796 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1797 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1798 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1799 @value{GDBN}.
1800
1801 @kindex show copying
1802 @kindex info copying
1803 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1804 @item show copying
1805 @itemx info copying
1806 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1807
1808 @kindex show warranty
1809 @kindex info warranty
1810 @item show warranty
1811 @itemx info warranty
1812 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1813 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1814
1815 @end table
1816
1817 @node Running
1818 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1819
1820 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1821 debugging information when you compile it.
1822
1823 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1824 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1825 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1826 kill a child process.
1827
1828 @menu
1829 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1830 * Starting:: Starting your program
1831 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1832 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1833
1834 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1835 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1836 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1837 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1838
1839 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1840 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1841 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1842 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1843 @end menu
1844
1845 @node Compilation
1846 @section Compiling for Debugging
1847
1848 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1849 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1850 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1851 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1852 and addresses in the executable code.
1853
1854 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1855 the compiler.
1856
1857 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1858 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1859 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1860 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1861 executables containing debugging information.
1862
1863 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1864 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1865 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1866 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1867 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1868
1869 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1870 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1871 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1872
1873 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1874 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1875 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1876 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1877 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1878 provides macro information if you specify the options
1879 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1880 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1881 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1882 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1883 @option{-g} alone.
1884
1885 @need 2000
1886 @node Starting
1887 @section Starting your Program
1888 @cindex starting
1889 @cindex running
1890
1891 @table @code
1892 @kindex run
1893 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1894 @item run
1895 @itemx r
1896 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1897 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1898 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1899 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1900 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1901
1902 @end table
1903
1904 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1905 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1906 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1907 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1908 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1909 message like this one:
1910
1911 @smallexample
1912 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1913 Try "help target" or "continue".
1914 @end smallexample
1915
1916 @noindent
1917 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1918 first (@pxref{load}).
1919
1920 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1921 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1922 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1923 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1924 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1925 divided into four categories:
1926
1927 @table @asis
1928 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1929 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1930 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1931 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1932 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1933 the arguments.
1934 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1935 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1936 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1937
1938 @item The @emph{environment.}
1939 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1940 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1941 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1942 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1943
1944 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1945 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1946 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1947 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1948
1949 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1950 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1951 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1952 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1953 set a different device for your program.
1954 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1955
1956 @cindex pipes
1957 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1958 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1959 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1960 wrong program.
1961 @end table
1962
1963 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1964 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1965 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1966 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1967 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1968
1969 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1970 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1971 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1972 your current breakpoints.
1973
1974 @table @code
1975 @kindex start
1976 @item start
1977 @cindex run to main procedure
1978 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1979 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1980 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1981 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1982 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1983 procedure, depending on the language used.
1984
1985 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1986 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1987 the @samp{run} command.
1988
1989 @cindex elaboration phase
1990 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1991 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1992 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1993 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1994 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1995 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1996 will remain to halt execution.
1997
1998 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1999 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2000 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2001 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2002 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2003
2004 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2005 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2006 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2007 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2008 elaboration code before running your program.
2009
2010 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2011 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2012 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2013 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2014 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2015 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2016 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2017 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2018 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2019 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2020 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2021
2022 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2023 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2024 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2025 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2026
2027 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2028 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2029 environment:
2030
2031 @smallexample
2032 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2033 (@value{GDBP}) run
2034 @end smallexample
2035
2036 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2037 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2038
2039 @kindex set disable-randomization
2040 @item set disable-randomization
2041 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2042 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2043 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2044 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2045 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2046
2047 This feature is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux. You can get the same
2048 behavior using
2049
2050 @smallexample
2051 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2052 @end smallexample
2053
2054 @item set disable-randomization off
2055 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2056 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2057 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2058 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2059 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2060 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2061
2062 The virtual address space randomization is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2063 It protects the programs against some kinds of security attacks. In these
2064 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2065 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2066 a code at its expected addresses.
2067
2068 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2069 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2070 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2071 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2072 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2073 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2074 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2075 a randomly chosen address.
2076
2077 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2078 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2079 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2080 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2081 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2082
2083 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2084 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2085
2086 @item show disable-randomization
2087 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2088 the virtual address space of the started program.
2089
2090 @end table
2091
2092 @node Arguments
2093 @section Your Program's Arguments
2094
2095 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2096 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2097 @code{run} command.
2098 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2099 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2100 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2101 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2102 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2103
2104 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2105 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2106 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2107 the program, not by the shell.
2108
2109 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2110 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2111
2112 @table @code
2113 @kindex set args
2114 @item set args
2115 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2116 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2117 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2118 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2119 it again without arguments.
2120
2121 @kindex show args
2122 @item show args
2123 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2124 @end table
2125
2126 @node Environment
2127 @section Your Program's Environment
2128
2129 @cindex environment (of your program)
2130 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2131 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2132 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2133 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2134 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2135 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2136 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2137
2138 @table @code
2139 @kindex path
2140 @item path @var{directory}
2141 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2142 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2143 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2144 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2145 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2146 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2147 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2148
2149 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2150 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2151 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2152 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2153 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2154 @var{directory} to the search path.
2155 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2156 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2157
2158 @kindex show paths
2159 @item show paths
2160 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2161 environment variable).
2162
2163 @kindex show environment
2164 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2165 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2166 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2167 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2168 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2169
2170 @kindex set environment
2171 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2172 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2173 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2174 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2175 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2176 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2177 null value.
2178 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2179 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2180
2181 For example, this command:
2182
2183 @smallexample
2184 set env USER = foo
2185 @end smallexample
2186
2187 @noindent
2188 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2189 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2190 are not actually required.)
2191
2192 @kindex unset environment
2193 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2194 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2195 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2196 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2197 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2198 @end table
2199
2200 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2201 the shell indicated
2202 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2203 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2204 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2205 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2206 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2207 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2208 @file{.profile}.
2209
2210 @node Working Directory
2211 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2212
2213 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2214 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2215 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2216 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2217 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2218 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2219
2220 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2221 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2222 Specify Files}.
2223
2224 @table @code
2225 @kindex cd
2226 @cindex change working directory
2227 @item cd @var{directory}
2228 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2229
2230 @kindex pwd
2231 @item pwd
2232 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2233 @end table
2234
2235 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2236 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2237 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2238 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2239 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2240 current working directory of the debuggee.
2241
2242 @node Input/Output
2243 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2244
2245 @cindex redirection
2246 @cindex i/o
2247 @cindex terminal
2248 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2249 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2250 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2251 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2252 running your program.
2253
2254 @table @code
2255 @kindex info terminal
2256 @item info terminal
2257 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2258 program is using.
2259 @end table
2260
2261 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2262 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2263
2264 @smallexample
2265 run > outfile
2266 @end smallexample
2267
2268 @noindent
2269 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2270
2271 @kindex tty
2272 @cindex controlling terminal
2273 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2274 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2275 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2276 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2277 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2278
2279 @smallexample
2280 tty /dev/ttyb
2281 @end smallexample
2282
2283 @noindent
2284 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2285 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2286 that as their controlling terminal.
2287
2288 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2289 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2290 terminal.
2291
2292 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2293 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2294 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2295 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2296
2297 @cindex inferior tty
2298 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2299 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2300 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2301 program.
2302
2303 @table @code
2304 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2305 @kindex set inferior-tty
2306 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2307
2308 @item show inferior-tty
2309 @kindex show inferior-tty
2310 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2311 @end table
2312
2313 @node Attach
2314 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2315 @kindex attach
2316 @cindex attach
2317
2318 @table @code
2319 @item attach @var{process-id}
2320 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2321 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2322 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2323 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2324 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2325
2326 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2327 executing the command.
2328 @end table
2329
2330 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2331 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2332 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2333 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2334
2335 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2336 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2337 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2338 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2339 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2340 Specify Files}.
2341
2342 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2343 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2344 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2345 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2346 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2347 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2348 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2349
2350 @table @code
2351 @kindex detach
2352 @item detach
2353 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2354 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2355 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2356 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2357 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2358 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2359 executing the command.
2360 @end table
2361
2362 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2363 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2364 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2365 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2366 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2367 Messages}).
2368
2369 @node Kill Process
2370 @section Killing the Child Process
2371
2372 @table @code
2373 @kindex kill
2374 @item kill
2375 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2376 @end table
2377
2378 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2379 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2380 is running.
2381
2382 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2383 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2384 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2385 outside the debugger.
2386
2387 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2388 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2389 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2390 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2391 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2392 breakpoint settings).
2393
2394 @node Inferiors and Programs
2395 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2396
2397 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2398 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2399 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2400 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2401 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2402 from multiple executables.
2403
2404 @cindex inferior
2405 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2406 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2407 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2408 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2409 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2410 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2411 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2412 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2413 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2414 threads running in it.
2415
2416 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2417 inferiors}}:
2418
2419 @table @code
2420 @kindex info inferiors
2421 @item info inferiors
2422 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2423
2424 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2425
2426 @enumerate
2427 @item
2428 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2429
2430 @item
2431 the target system's inferior identifier
2432
2433 @item
2434 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2435
2436 @end enumerate
2437
2438 @noindent
2439 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2440 indicates the current inferior.
2441
2442 For example,
2443 @end table
2444 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2445
2446 @smallexample
2447 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2448 Num Description Executable
2449 2 process 2307 hello
2450 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2451 @end smallexample
2452
2453 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2454
2455 @table @code
2456 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2457 @item inferior @var{infno}
2458 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2459 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2460 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2461 @end table
2462
2463
2464 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2465 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2466 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2467 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2468 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2469 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2470
2471 @table @code
2472 @kindex add-inferior
2473 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2474 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2475 executable. @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2476 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2477 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2478 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2479
2480 @kindex clone-inferior
2481 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2482 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2483 @var{infno}. @var{n} defaults to 1. @var{infno} defaults to the
2484 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2485 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2486
2487 @smallexample
2488 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2489 Num Description Executable
2490 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2491 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2492 Added inferior 2.
2493 1 inferiors added.
2494 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2495 Num Description Executable
2496 2 <null> helloworld
2497 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2498 @end smallexample
2499
2500 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2501
2502 @kindex remove-inferiors
2503 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2504 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2505 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2506 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2507
2508 @end table
2509
2510 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2511 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2512 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2513 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2514
2515 @table @code
2516 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2517 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2518 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2519 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2520 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2521 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2522
2523 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2524 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2525 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2526 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2527 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2528 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2529 @end table
2530
2531 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2532 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2533 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2534 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2535
2536
2537 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2538 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2539
2540 @table @code
2541 @kindex set print inferior-events
2542 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2543 @item set print inferior-events
2544 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2545 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2546 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2547 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2548 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2549 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2550
2551 @kindex show print inferior-events
2552 @item show print inferior-events
2553 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2554 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2555 @end table
2556
2557 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2558 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2559 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2560
2561
2562 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2563 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2564 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2565 info program-spaces}} command.
2566
2567 @table @code
2568 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2569 @item maint info program-spaces
2570 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2571 @value{GDBN}.
2572
2573 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2574
2575 @enumerate
2576 @item
2577 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2578
2579 @item
2580 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2581 the @code{file} command.
2582
2583 @end enumerate
2584
2585 @noindent
2586 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2587 indicates the current program space.
2588
2589 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2590 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2591 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2592
2593 @smallexample
2594 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2595 Id Executable
2596 2 goodbye
2597 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2598 * 1 hello
2599 @end smallexample
2600
2601 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2602 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2603 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2604 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2605 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2606
2607 @smallexample
2608 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2609 Id Executable
2610 * 1 vfork-test
2611 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2612 @end smallexample
2613
2614 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2615 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2616 @end table
2617
2618 @node Threads
2619 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2620
2621 @cindex threads of execution
2622 @cindex multiple threads
2623 @cindex switching threads
2624 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2625 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2626 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2627 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2628 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2629 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2630 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2631
2632 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2633 programs:
2634
2635 @itemize @bullet
2636 @item automatic notification of new threads
2637 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2638 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2639 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2640 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2641 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2642 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2643 messages on thread start and exit.
2644 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2645 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2646 isn't compatible with the program.
2647 @end itemize
2648
2649 @quotation
2650 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2651 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2652 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2653 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2654 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2655 like this:
2656
2657 @smallexample
2658 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2659 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2660 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2661 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2662 @end smallexample
2663 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2664 @c doesn't support threads"?
2665 @end quotation
2666
2667 @cindex focus of debugging
2668 @cindex current thread
2669 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2670 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2671 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2672 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2673 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2674
2675 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2676 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2677 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2678 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2679 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2680 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2681 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2682 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2683 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2684 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2685
2686 @smallexample
2687 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2688 @end smallexample
2689
2690 @noindent
2691 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2692 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2693 further qualifier.
2694
2695 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2696 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2697 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2698 @c program?
2699 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2700 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2701 @c threads ab initio?
2702
2703 @cindex thread number
2704 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2705 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2706 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2707
2708 @table @code
2709 @kindex info threads
2710 @item info threads @r{[}@var{id}@dots{}@r{]}
2711 Display a summary of all threads currently in your program. Optional
2712 argument @var{id}@dots{} is one or more thread ids separated by spaces, and
2713 means to print information only about the specified thread or threads.
2714 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2715
2716 @enumerate
2717 @item
2718 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2719
2720 @item
2721 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2722
2723 @item
2724 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2725 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2726 program itself.
2727
2728 @item
2729 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2730 @end enumerate
2731
2732 @noindent
2733 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2734 indicates the current thread.
2735
2736 For example,
2737 @end table
2738 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2739
2740 @smallexample
2741 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2742 Id Target Id Frame
2743 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2744 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2745 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2746 at threadtest.c:68
2747 @end smallexample
2748
2749 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2750 Solaris-specific command:
2751
2752 @table @code
2753 @item maint info sol-threads
2754 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2755 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2756 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2757 @end table
2758
2759 @table @code
2760 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2761 @item thread @var{threadno}
2762 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2763 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2764 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2765 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2766 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2767
2768 @smallexample
2769 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2770 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
2771 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
2772 8 printf ("hello\n");
2773 @end smallexample
2774
2775 @noindent
2776 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2777 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2778 threads.
2779
2780 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2781 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2782 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2783 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2784 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2785 information on convenience variables.
2786
2787 @kindex thread apply
2788 @cindex apply command to several threads
2789 @item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all] @var{command}
2790 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2791 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2792 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2793 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2794 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2795 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2796 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2797
2798 @kindex thread name
2799 @cindex name a thread
2800 @item thread name [@var{name}]
2801 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
2802 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
2803 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
2804
2805 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
2806 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
2807 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
2808 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
2809 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
2810
2811 @kindex thread find
2812 @cindex search for a thread
2813 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
2814 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
2815 matches the supplied regular expression.
2816
2817 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
2818 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
2819 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
2820 is the LWP id.
2821
2822 @smallexample
2823 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
2824 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
2825 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
2826 Id Target Id Frame
2827 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
2828 @end smallexample
2829
2830 @kindex set print thread-events
2831 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2832 @item set print thread-events
2833 @itemx set print thread-events on
2834 @itemx set print thread-events off
2835 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2836 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2837 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2838 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2839 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2840
2841 @kindex show print thread-events
2842 @item show print thread-events
2843 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2844 have started and exited.
2845 @end table
2846
2847 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2848 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2849 programs with multiple threads.
2850
2851 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2852 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2853
2854 @table @code
2855 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
2856 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
2857 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
2858 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
2859 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
2860 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
2861 an empty list.
2862
2863 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
2864 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
2865 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2866 to find @code{libthread_db}. If that fails, @value{GDBN} will continue
2867 with default system shared library directories, and finally the directory
2868 from which @code{libpthread} was loaded in the inferior process.
2869
2870 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
2871 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
2872 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
2873 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
2874 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
2875 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
2876 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
2877
2878 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
2879 only on some platforms.
2880
2881 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
2882 @item show libthread-db-search-path
2883 Display current libthread_db search path.
2884
2885 @kindex set debug libthread-db
2886 @kindex show debug libthread-db
2887 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
2888 @item set debug libthread-db
2889 @itemx show debug libthread-db
2890 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
2891 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
2892 @end table
2893
2894 @node Forks
2895 @section Debugging Forks
2896
2897 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2898 @cindex multiple processes
2899 @cindex processes, multiple
2900 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2901 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2902 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2903 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2904 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2905 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2906 will cause it to terminate.
2907
2908 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2909 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2910 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2911 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2912 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2913 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2914 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2915 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2916 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2917 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2918
2919 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2920 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2921 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2922 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2923
2924 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2925 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2926
2927 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2928 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2929
2930 @table @code
2931 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2932 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2933 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2934 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2935 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2936
2937 @table @code
2938 @item parent
2939 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2940 unimpeded. This is the default.
2941
2942 @item child
2943 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2944 unimpeded.
2945
2946 @end table
2947
2948 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2949 @item show follow-fork-mode
2950 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2951 @end table
2952
2953 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2954 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2955 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2956
2957 @table @code
2958 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2959 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2960 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2961 retain debugger control over them both.
2962
2963 @table @code
2964 @item on
2965 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2966 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2967 independently. This is the default.
2968
2969 @item off
2970 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2971 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2972 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2973 is held suspended.
2974
2975 @end table
2976
2977 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2978 @item show detach-on-fork
2979 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2980 @end table
2981
2982 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
2983 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
2984 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
2985 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
2986 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
2987 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
2988
2989 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2990 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
2991 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
2992 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
2993 and Programs}.
2994
2995 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2996 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2997 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2998 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2999 the child process's @code{main}.
3000
3001 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3002 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3003
3004 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3005 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3006 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3007 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3008 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3009 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3010 command.
3011
3012 @table @code
3013 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3014 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3015
3016 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3017 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3018
3019 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3020
3021 @table @code
3022 @item new
3023 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3024 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3025 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3026 original inferior.
3027
3028 For example:
3029
3030 @smallexample
3031 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3032 (gdb) info inferior
3033 Id Description Executable
3034 * 1 <null> prog1
3035 (@value{GDBP}) run
3036 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3037 Program exited normally.
3038 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3039 Id Description Executable
3040 * 2 <null> prog2
3041 1 <null> prog1
3042 @end smallexample
3043
3044 @item same
3045 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3046 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3047 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3048 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3049 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3050
3051 For example:
3052
3053 @smallexample
3054 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3055 Id Description Executable
3056 * 1 <null> prog1
3057 (@value{GDBP}) run
3058 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3059 Program exited normally.
3060 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3061 Id Description Executable
3062 * 1 <null> prog2
3063 @end smallexample
3064
3065 @end table
3066 @end table
3067
3068 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3069 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3070 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3071
3072 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3073 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3074
3075 @cindex checkpoint
3076 @cindex restart
3077 @cindex bookmark
3078 @cindex snapshot of a process
3079 @cindex rewind program state
3080
3081 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3082 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3083 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3084 later.
3085
3086 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3087 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3088 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3089 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3090 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3091
3092 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3093 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3094 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3095 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3096 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3097 start again from there.
3098
3099 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3100 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3101
3102 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3103
3104 @table @code
3105 @kindex checkpoint
3106 @item checkpoint
3107 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3108 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3109 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3110
3111 @kindex info checkpoints
3112 @item info checkpoints
3113 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3114 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3115 listed:
3116
3117 @table @code
3118 @item Checkpoint ID
3119 @item Process ID
3120 @item Code Address
3121 @item Source line, or label
3122 @end table
3123
3124 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3125 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3126 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3127 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3128 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3129 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3130 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3131
3132 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3133 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3134 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3135 the debugger.
3136
3137 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3138 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3139 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3140
3141 @end table
3142
3143 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3144 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3145 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3146 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3147 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3148 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3149 previously read data can be read again.
3150
3151 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3152 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3153 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3154 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3155 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3156 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3157
3158 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3159 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3160 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3161 different execution path this time.
3162
3163 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3164 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3165 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3166 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3167 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3168 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3169 potentially pose a problem.
3170
3171 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3172
3173 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3174 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3175 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3176 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3177 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3178 next.
3179
3180 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3181 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3182 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3183 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3184 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3185
3186 @node Stopping
3187 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3188
3189 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3190 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3191 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3192
3193 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3194 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3195 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3196 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3197 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3198 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3199 explicitly request this information at any time.
3200
3201 @table @code
3202 @kindex info program
3203 @item info program
3204 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3205 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3206 @end table
3207
3208 @menu
3209 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3210 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3211 * Signals:: Signals
3212 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3213 @end menu
3214
3215 @node Breakpoints
3216 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3217
3218 @cindex breakpoints
3219 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3220 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3221 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3222 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3223 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3224 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3225 program.
3226
3227 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3228 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3229 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3230 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3231 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3232 call).
3233
3234 @cindex watchpoints
3235 @cindex data breakpoints
3236 @cindex memory tracing
3237 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3238 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3239 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3240 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3241 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3242 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3243 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3244 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3245 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3246 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3247 same commands.
3248
3249 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3250 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3251 Automatic Display}.
3252
3253 @cindex catchpoints
3254 @cindex breakpoint on events
3255 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3256 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3257 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3258 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3259 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3260 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3261 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3262
3263 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3264 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3265 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3266 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3267 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3268 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3269 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3270 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3271 enable it again.
3272
3273 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3274 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3275 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3276 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3277 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3278 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3279 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3280
3281 @menu
3282 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3283 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3284 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3285 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3286 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3287 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3288 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3289 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3290 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3291 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3292 @end menu
3293
3294 @node Set Breaks
3295 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3296
3297 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3298 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3299 @c
3300 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3301
3302 @kindex break
3303 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3304 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3305 @cindex latest breakpoint
3306 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3307 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3308 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3309 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3310 convenience variables.
3311
3312 @table @code
3313 @item break @var{location}
3314 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3315 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3316 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3317 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3318 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3319
3320 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3321 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3322 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3323 that situation.
3324
3325 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3326 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3327 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3328
3329 @item break
3330 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3331 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3332 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3333 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3334 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3335 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3336 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3337 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3338 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3339 inside loops.
3340
3341 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3342 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3343 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3344 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3345 existed when your program stopped.
3346
3347 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3348 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3349 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3350 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3351 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3352 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3353 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3354
3355 @kindex tbreak
3356 @item tbreak @var{args}
3357 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3358 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3359 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3360 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3361
3362 @kindex hbreak
3363 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3364 @item hbreak @var{args}
3365 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3366 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3367 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3368 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3369 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3370 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3371 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3372 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3373 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3374 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3375 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3376 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3377 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3378 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3379 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3380 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3381 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3382 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3383
3384 @kindex thbreak
3385 @item thbreak @var{args}
3386 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3387 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3388 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3389 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3390 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3391 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3392 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3393 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3394
3395 @kindex rbreak
3396 @cindex regular expression
3397 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3398 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3399 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3400 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3401 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3402 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3403 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3404 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3405 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3406
3407 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3408 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3409 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3410 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3411 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3412 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3413
3414 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3415 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3416 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3417 classes.
3418
3419 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3420 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3421 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3422
3423 @smallexample
3424 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3425 @end smallexample
3426
3427 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3428 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3429 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3430 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3431 every function in a given file:
3432
3433 @smallexample
3434 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3435 @end smallexample
3436
3437 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3438 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3439
3440 @kindex info breakpoints
3441 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3442 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3443 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3444 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3445 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3446 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3447 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3448
3449 @table @emph
3450 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3451 @item Type
3452 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3453 @item Disposition
3454 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3455 @item Enabled or Disabled
3456 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3457 that are not enabled.
3458 @item Address
3459 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3460 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3461 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3462 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3463 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3464 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3465 @item What
3466 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3467 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3468 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3469 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3470 @end table
3471
3472 @noindent
3473 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3474 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3475 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3476 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3477 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3478 valid location.
3479
3480 @noindent
3481 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3482 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3483 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3484 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3485 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3486
3487 @noindent
3488 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3489 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3490 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3491 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3492 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3493 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3494 @end table
3495
3496 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3497 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3498 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3499 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3500
3501 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3502 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3503 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3504 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3505
3506 @itemize @bullet
3507 @item
3508 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3509 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3510
3511 @item
3512 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3513 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3514
3515 @item
3516 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3517 several places where that function is inlined.
3518 @end itemize
3519
3520 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3521 the relevant locations@footnote{
3522 As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's
3523 line number information for all the locations. This means that they
3524 will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug
3525 info with line numbers for them.}.
3526
3527 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3528 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3529 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3530 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3531 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3532 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3533 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3534
3535 For example:
3536
3537 @smallexample
3538 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3539 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3540 stop only if i==1
3541 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3542 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3543 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3544 @end smallexample
3545
3546 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3547 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3548 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3549 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3550 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3551 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3552 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3553 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3554 that belong to that breakpoint.
3555
3556 @cindex pending breakpoints
3557 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3558 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3559 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3560 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3561 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3562 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3563 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3564 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3565 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3566 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3567 is not yet resolved.
3568
3569 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3570 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3571 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3572 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3573 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3574 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3575
3576 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3577 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3578 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3579 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3580
3581 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3582 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3583 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3584
3585 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3586 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3587 address specification to an address:
3588
3589 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3590 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3591 @table @code
3592 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3593 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3594 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3595
3596 @item set breakpoint pending on
3597 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3598 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3599
3600 @item set breakpoint pending off
3601 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3602 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3603 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3604
3605 @item show breakpoint pending
3606 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3607 @end table
3608
3609 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3610 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3611 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3612
3613 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3614 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3615 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3616 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3617 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3618 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3619 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3620 breakpoints.
3621
3622 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3623
3624 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3625 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3626 @table @code
3627 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3628 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3629 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3630 breakpoint must be used.
3631
3632 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3633 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3634 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3635 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3636 @end table
3637
3638 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3639 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3640 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3641 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3642 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3643 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3644 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3645 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3646 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3647
3648 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3649 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3650 @table @code
3651 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3652 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3653 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3654 removed from the target when it stops.
3655
3656 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3657 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3658 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3659 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3660 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3661
3662 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3663 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3664 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3665 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3666 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3667 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3668 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3669 @end table
3670
3671 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3672 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3673 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3674 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3675 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3676 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3677 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3678 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3679
3680
3681 @node Set Watchpoints
3682 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3683
3684 @cindex setting watchpoints
3685 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3686 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3687 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3688 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3689 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3690
3691 @itemize @bullet
3692 @item
3693 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3694
3695 @item
3696 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3697 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3698 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3699
3700 @item
3701 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3702 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3703 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3704 @end itemize
3705
3706 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3707 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3708 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3709 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3710 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3711 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3712 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3713 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3714 the expression changes.
3715
3716 @cindex software watchpoints
3717 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3718 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3719 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3720 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3721 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3722 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3723 culprit.)
3724
3725 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3726 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3727 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3728
3729 @table @code
3730 @kindex watch
3731 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3732 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3733 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3734 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3735 to watch the value of a single variable:
3736
3737 @smallexample
3738 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3739 @end smallexample
3740
3741 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3742 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3743 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3744 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3745 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3746 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3747
3748 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
3749 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
3750 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
3751 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
3752 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
3753 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
3754 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
3755 error.
3756
3757 @kindex rwatch
3758 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3759 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3760 by the program.
3761
3762 @kindex awatch
3763 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3764 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3765 or written into by the program.
3766
3767 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3768 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3769 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
3770 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3771 @end table
3772
3773 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
3774 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
3775 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
3776 a never-changing value:
3777
3778 @smallexample
3779 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
3780 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
3781 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
3782 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
3783 @end smallexample
3784
3785 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3786 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3787 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3788 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3789 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3790 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3791
3792 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3793 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3794 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3795 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3796 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3797 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3798 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3799 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3800
3801 @table @code
3802 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3803 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3804 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3805
3806 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3807 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3808 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3809 @end table
3810
3811 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3812 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3813 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3814
3815 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3816
3817 @smallexample
3818 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3819 @end smallexample
3820
3821 @noindent
3822 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3823
3824 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3825 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3826 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3827 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3828 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3829 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3830 will print a message like this:
3831
3832 @smallexample
3833 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3834 @end smallexample
3835
3836 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3837 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3838 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3839 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3840 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3841 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3842 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3843 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3844
3845 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3846 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3847 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3848 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3849 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3850 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3851
3852 @smallexample
3853 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3854 @end smallexample
3855
3856 @noindent
3857 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3858
3859 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3860 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3861 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3862 expression with separately allocated resources.
3863
3864 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3865 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3866 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3867
3868 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3869 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3870 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3871 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3872 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3873 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3874 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3875 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3876 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3877
3878 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3879 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3880 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3881 watched expression from every thread.
3882
3883 @quotation
3884 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3885 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3886 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3887 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3888 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3889 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3890 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3891 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3892 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3893 @end quotation
3894
3895 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3896
3897 @node Set Catchpoints
3898 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3899 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3900 @cindex exception handlers
3901 @cindex event handling
3902
3903 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3904 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3905 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3906
3907 @table @code
3908 @kindex catch
3909 @item catch @var{event}
3910 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3911 @table @code
3912 @item throw
3913 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3914 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3915
3916 @item catch
3917 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3918
3919 @item exception
3920 @cindex Ada exception catching
3921 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3922 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3923 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3924 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3925 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3926
3927 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
3928 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
3929 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
3930 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
3931 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
3932 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
3933 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
3934 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
3935
3936 @item exception unhandled
3937 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3938
3939 @item assert
3940 A failed Ada assertion.
3941
3942 @item exec
3943 @cindex break on fork/exec
3944 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3945 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3946
3947 @item syscall
3948 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
3949 @cindex break on a system call.
3950 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
3951 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
3952 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
3953 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
3954 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
3955 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
3956 will be caught.
3957
3958 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
3959 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
3960 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
3961 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
3962
3963 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
3964 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
3965 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
3966 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
3967
3968 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
3969 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
3970 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
3971 available choices.
3972
3973 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
3974 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
3975 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
3976 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
3977 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
3978 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
3979 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
3980 behind the OS upgrades).
3981
3982 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
3983 arguments to it:
3984
3985 @smallexample
3986 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
3987 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
3988 (@value{GDBP}) r
3989 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
3990
3991 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
3992 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3993 (@value{GDBP}) c
3994 Continuing.
3995
3996 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
3997 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3998 (@value{GDBP})
3999 @end smallexample
4000
4001 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4002
4003 @smallexample
4004 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4005 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4006 (@value{GDBP}) r
4007 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4008
4009 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4010 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4011 (@value{GDBP}) c
4012 Continuing.
4013
4014 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4015 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4016 (@value{GDBP})
4017 @end smallexample
4018
4019 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4020 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4021 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4022
4023 @smallexample
4024 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4025 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4026 (@value{GDBP}) r
4027 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4028
4029 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4030 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4031 (@value{GDBP}) c
4032 Continuing.
4033
4034 Program exited normally.
4035 (@value{GDBP})
4036 @end smallexample
4037
4038 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4039 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4040 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4041 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4042
4043 @smallexample
4044 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4045 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4046 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4047 (@value{GDBP})
4048 @end smallexample
4049
4050 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4051 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4052 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4053 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4054 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4055 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4056
4057 @smallexample
4058 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4059 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4060 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4061 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4062 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4063 (@value{GDBP})
4064 @end smallexample
4065
4066 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4067
4068 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4069 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4070
4071 @smallexample
4072 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4073 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4074 @end smallexample
4075
4076 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4077
4078 @item fork
4079 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4080 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4081
4082 @item vfork
4083 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4084 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4085
4086 @end table
4087
4088 @item tcatch @var{event}
4089 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4090 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4091
4092 @end table
4093
4094 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4095
4096 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
4097 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
4098
4099 @itemize @bullet
4100 @item
4101 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4102 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4103 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4104 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4105 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4106 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4107 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4108 disabled within interactive calls.
4109
4110 @item
4111 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4112
4113 @item
4114 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4115 @end itemize
4116
4117 @cindex raise exceptions
4118 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
4119 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
4120 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
4121 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
4122 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
4123 out where the exception was raised.
4124
4125 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
4126 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
4127 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
4128 which has the following ANSI C interface:
4129
4130 @smallexample
4131 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
4132 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
4133 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
4134 @end smallexample
4135
4136 @noindent
4137 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
4138 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
4139 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
4140
4141 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
4142 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
4143 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
4144 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
4145 raised.
4146
4147
4148 @node Delete Breaks
4149 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4150
4151 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4152 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4153 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4154 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4155 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4156 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4157
4158 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4159 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4160 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4161 their breakpoint numbers.
4162
4163 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4164 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4165 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4166
4167 @table @code
4168 @kindex clear
4169 @item clear
4170 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4171 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4172 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4173 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4174
4175 @item clear @var{location}
4176 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4177 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4178 most useful ones are listed below:
4179
4180 @table @code
4181 @item clear @var{function}
4182 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4183 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4184
4185 @item clear @var{linenum}
4186 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4187 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4188 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4189 @end table
4190
4191 @cindex delete breakpoints
4192 @kindex delete
4193 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4194 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4195 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4196 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4197 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4198 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4199 @end table
4200
4201 @node Disabling
4202 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4203
4204 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4205 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4206 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4207 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4208 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4209
4210 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4211 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4212 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4213 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4214 do not know which numbers to use.
4215
4216 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4217 affects all of its locations.
4218
4219 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
4220 states of enablement:
4221
4222 @itemize @bullet
4223 @item
4224 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4225 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4226 @item
4227 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4228 @item
4229 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4230 disabled.
4231 @item
4232 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4233 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4234 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4235 @end itemize
4236
4237 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4238 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4239
4240 @table @code
4241 @kindex disable
4242 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4243 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4244 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4245 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4246 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4247 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4248 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4249
4250 @kindex enable
4251 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4252 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4253 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4254
4255 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4256 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4257 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4258
4259 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4260 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4261 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4262 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4263 @end table
4264
4265 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4266 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4267 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4268 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4269 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4270 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4271 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4272 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4273 Stepping}.)
4274
4275 @node Conditions
4276 @subsection Break Conditions
4277 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4278 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4279
4280 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4281 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4282 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4283 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4284 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4285 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4286 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4287 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4288
4289 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4290 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4291 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4292 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4293 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4294
4295 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4296 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4297 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4298 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4299 one.
4300
4301 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4302 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4303 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4304 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4305 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4306 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4307 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4308 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4309 conditions for the
4310 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4311 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4312
4313 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4314 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4315 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4316 with the @code{condition} command.
4317
4318 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4319 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4320 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4321 catchpoint.
4322
4323 @table @code
4324 @kindex condition
4325 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4326 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4327 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4328 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4329 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4330 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4331 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4332 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4333 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4334 prints an error message:
4335
4336 @smallexample
4337 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4338 @end smallexample
4339
4340 @noindent
4341 @value{GDBN} does
4342 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4343 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4344 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4345
4346 @item condition @var{bnum}
4347 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4348 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4349 @end table
4350
4351 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4352 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4353 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4354 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4355 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4356 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4357 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4358 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4359 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4360 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4361 your program reaches it.
4362
4363 @table @code
4364 @kindex ignore
4365 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4366 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4367 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4368 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4369 takes no action.
4370
4371 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4372 a count of zero.
4373
4374 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4375 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4376 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4377 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4378
4379 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4380 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4381 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4382
4383 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4384 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4385 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4386 Variables}.
4387 @end table
4388
4389 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4390
4391
4392 @node Break Commands
4393 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4394
4395 @cindex breakpoint commands
4396 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4397 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4398 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4399 enable other breakpoints.
4400
4401 @table @code
4402 @kindex commands
4403 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4404 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4405 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4406 @itemx end
4407 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4408 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4409 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4410
4411 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4412 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4413
4414 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4415 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4416 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4417 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4418 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4419 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4420 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4421 Expressions}).
4422 @end table
4423
4424 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4425 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4426
4427 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4428 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4429 that resumes execution.
4430
4431 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4432 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4433 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4434 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4435 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4436
4437 @kindex silent
4438 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4439 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4440 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4441 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4442 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4443 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4444
4445 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4446 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4447 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4448
4449 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4450 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4451
4452 @smallexample
4453 break foo if x>0
4454 commands
4455 silent
4456 printf "x is %d\n",x
4457 cont
4458 end
4459 @end smallexample
4460
4461 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4462 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4463 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4464 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4465 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4466 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4467 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4468
4469 @smallexample
4470 break 403
4471 commands
4472 silent
4473 set x = y + 4
4474 cont
4475 end
4476 @end smallexample
4477
4478 @node Save Breakpoints
4479 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4480
4481 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4482 breakpoints}} command.
4483
4484 @table @code
4485 @kindex save breakpoints
4486 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4487 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4488 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4489 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4490 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4491 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4492 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4493 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4494 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4495 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4496 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4497 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4498 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4499 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4500 that can no longer be recreated.
4501 @end table
4502
4503 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4504 @node Error in Breakpoints
4505 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4506
4507 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4508 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
4509
4510 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4511 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4512 @smallexample
4513 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4514 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4515 @end smallexample
4516
4517 @noindent
4518 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4519 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4520 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4521
4522 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4523 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4524
4525 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4526 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4527 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4528
4529 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4530 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4531 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4532 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4533
4534 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4535 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4536 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4537 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4538 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4539 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4540 first in the bundle.
4541
4542 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4543 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4544 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4545 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4546 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4547 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4548 is hit.
4549
4550 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4551 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4552
4553 @smallexample
4554 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
4555 @end smallexample
4556
4557 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
4558 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
4559 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
4560 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
4561 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
4562 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
4563 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
4564 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
4565
4566 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
4567 adjusted breakpoints:
4568
4569 @smallexample
4570 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
4571 to 0x00010410.
4572 @end smallexample
4573
4574 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
4575 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
4576 frequently than expected.
4577
4578 @node Continuing and Stepping
4579 @section Continuing and Stepping
4580
4581 @cindex stepping
4582 @cindex continuing
4583 @cindex resuming execution
4584 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4585 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4586 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4587 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4588 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4589 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4590 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4591 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4592
4593 @table @code
4594 @kindex continue
4595 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4596 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4597 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4598 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4599 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4600 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4601 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4602 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4603 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4604 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4605
4606 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4607 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4608 @code{continue} is ignored.
4609
4610 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4611 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4612 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4613 @code{continue}.
4614 @end table
4615
4616 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4617 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4618 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4619 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4620
4621 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4622 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4623 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4624 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4625 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4626 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4627
4628 @table @code
4629 @kindex step
4630 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4631 @item step
4632 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4633 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4634 abbreviated @code{s}.
4635
4636 @quotation
4637 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4638 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4639 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4640 @c distinction here.
4641 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4642 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4643 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4644 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4645 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4646 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4647 below.
4648 @end quotation
4649
4650 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4651 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4652 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4653 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4654 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4655 called within the line.
4656
4657 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4658 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4659 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4660 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4661 was any debugging information about the routine.
4662
4663 @item step @var{count}
4664 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4665 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4666 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4667
4668 @kindex next
4669 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4670 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4671 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4672 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4673 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4674 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4675 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4676 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4677
4678 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4679
4680
4681 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4682 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4683 @c
4684 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4685 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4686 @c function are executed without stopping.
4687
4688 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4689 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4690 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4691
4692 @kindex set step-mode
4693 @item set step-mode
4694 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4695 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4696 @itemx set step-mode on
4697 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4698 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4699 information rather than stepping over it.
4700
4701 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4702 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4703 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4704
4705 @item set step-mode off
4706 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4707 debug information. This is the default.
4708
4709 @item show step-mode
4710 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4711 source line debug information.
4712
4713 @kindex finish
4714 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
4715 @item finish
4716 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4717 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
4718 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
4719
4720 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4721 ,Returning from a Function}).
4722
4723 @kindex until
4724 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4725 @cindex run until specified location
4726 @item until
4727 @itemx u
4728 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4729 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4730 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4731 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4732 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4733 than the address of the jump.
4734
4735 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4736 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4737 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4738 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4739 through the next iteration.
4740
4741 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4742 stack frame.
4743
4744 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4745 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4746 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4747 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4748 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4749
4750 @smallexample
4751 (@value{GDBP}) f
4752 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4753 206 expand_input();
4754 (@value{GDBP}) until
4755 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4756 @end smallexample
4757
4758 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4759 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4760 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4761 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4762 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4763 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4764 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4765
4766 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4767 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4768 argument.
4769
4770 @item until @var{location}
4771 @itemx u @var{location}
4772 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4773 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4774 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4775 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4776 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4777 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4778 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4779 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4780 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4781 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4782 invocations have returned.
4783
4784 @smallexample
4785 94 int factorial (int value)
4786 95 @{
4787 96 if (value > 1) @{
4788 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4789 98 @}
4790 99 return (value);
4791 100 @}
4792 @end smallexample
4793
4794
4795 @kindex advance @var{location}
4796 @itemx advance @var{location}
4797 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4798 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4799 @ref{Specify Location}.
4800 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4801 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4802 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4803 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4804
4805
4806 @kindex stepi
4807 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4808 @item stepi
4809 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4810 @itemx si
4811 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4812
4813 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4814 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4815 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4816 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4817
4818 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4819
4820 @need 750
4821 @kindex nexti
4822 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4823 @item nexti
4824 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4825 @itemx ni
4826 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4827 proceed until the function returns.
4828
4829 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4830 @end table
4831
4832 @node Signals
4833 @section Signals
4834 @cindex signals
4835
4836 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4837 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4838 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4839 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4840 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4841 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4842 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4843 requested an alarm).
4844
4845 @cindex fatal signals
4846 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4847 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4848 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4849 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4850 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4851 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4852
4853 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4854 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4855 signal.
4856
4857 @cindex handling signals
4858 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4859 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4860 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4861 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4862 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4863
4864 @table @code
4865 @kindex info signals
4866 @kindex info handle
4867 @item info signals
4868 @itemx info handle
4869 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4870 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4871 the defined types of signals.
4872
4873 @item info signals @var{sig}
4874 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4875
4876 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4877
4878 @kindex handle
4879 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4880 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4881 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4882 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4883 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4884 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4885 say what change to make.
4886 @end table
4887
4888 @c @group
4889 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4890 Their full names are:
4891
4892 @table @code
4893 @item nostop
4894 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4895 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4896
4897 @item stop
4898 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4899 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4900
4901 @item print
4902 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4903
4904 @item noprint
4905 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4906 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4907
4908 @item pass
4909 @itemx noignore
4910 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4911 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4912 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4913
4914 @item nopass
4915 @itemx ignore
4916 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4917 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4918 @end table
4919 @c @end group
4920
4921 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4922 program until you
4923 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4924 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4925 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4926 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4927 program sees that signal when you continue.
4928
4929 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4930 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4931 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4932 erroneous signals.
4933
4934 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4935 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4936 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4937 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4938 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4939 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4940 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4941 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4942 Program a Signal}.
4943
4944 @cindex extra signal information
4945 @anchor{extra signal information}
4946
4947 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
4948 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
4949 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
4950 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
4951 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
4952 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
4953 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
4954 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
4955 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
4956 system header.
4957
4958 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
4959 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
4960
4961 @smallexample
4962 @group
4963 (@value{GDBP}) continue
4964 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
4965 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
4966 69 *(int *)p = 0;
4967 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
4968 type = struct @{
4969 int si_signo;
4970 int si_errno;
4971 int si_code;
4972 union @{
4973 int _pad[28];
4974 struct @{...@} _kill;
4975 struct @{...@} _timer;
4976 struct @{...@} _rt;
4977 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
4978 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
4979 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
4980 @} _sifields;
4981 @}
4982 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
4983 type = struct @{
4984 void *si_addr;
4985 @}
4986 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
4987 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
4988 @end group
4989 @end smallexample
4990
4991 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
4992
4993 @node Thread Stops
4994 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4995
4996 @cindex stopped threads
4997 @cindex threads, stopped
4998
4999 @cindex continuing threads
5000 @cindex threads, continuing
5001
5002 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5003 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5004 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5005 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5006 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5007 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5008 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5009 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5010 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5011
5012 @menu
5013 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5014 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5015 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5016 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5017 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5018 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5019 @end menu
5020
5021 @node All-Stop Mode
5022 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5023
5024 @cindex all-stop mode
5025
5026 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5027 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5028 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5029 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5030 underfoot.
5031
5032 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5033 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5034 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5035
5036 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5037 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5038 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5039 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5040 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5041 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5042 stops.
5043
5044 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5045 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5046 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5047 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5048
5049 @cindex automatic thread selection
5050 @cindex switching threads automatically
5051 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5052 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5053 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5054 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5055 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5056 thread.
5057
5058 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5059 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5060
5061 @table @code
5062 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5063 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5064 @cindex lock scheduler
5065 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5066 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5067 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5068 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5069 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5070 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5071 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
5072 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
5073 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
5074 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5075 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5076 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5077
5078 @item show scheduler-locking
5079 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5080 @end table
5081
5082 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5083 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5084 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5085 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5086 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5087 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5088 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5089 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5090 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5091 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5092 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5093 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5094 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5095 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5096
5097 @table @code
5098 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5099 @item set schedule-multiple
5100 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5101 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5102 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5103 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5104 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5105 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5106
5107 @item show schedule-multiple
5108 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5109 multiple processes.
5110 @end table
5111
5112 @node Non-Stop Mode
5113 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5114
5115 @cindex non-stop mode
5116
5117 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5118 @c with more details.
5119
5120 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5121 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5122 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5123 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5124 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5125 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5126
5127 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5128 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5129 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5130 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5131 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5132 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5133 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5134 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5135 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5136 independently and simultaneously.
5137
5138 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5139 or attach to your program:
5140
5141 @smallexample
5142 # Enable the async interface.
5143 set target-async 1
5144
5145 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5146 set pagination off
5147
5148 # Finally, turn it on!
5149 set non-stop on
5150 @end smallexample
5151
5152 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5153
5154 @table @code
5155 @kindex set non-stop
5156 @item set non-stop on
5157 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5158 @item set non-stop off
5159 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5160 @kindex show non-stop
5161 @item show non-stop
5162 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5163 @end table
5164
5165 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5166 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5167 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5168 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5169 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5170 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5171 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5172 default.
5173
5174 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5175 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5176 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5177
5178 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5179 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5180 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5181 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5182 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5183
5184 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5185 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5186 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5187 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5188 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5189
5190 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5191
5192 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5193 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5194 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5195 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5196 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5197 previously current thread.
5198
5199 @node Background Execution
5200 @subsection Background Execution
5201
5202 @cindex foreground execution
5203 @cindex background execution
5204 @cindex asynchronous execution
5205 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5206
5207 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5208 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5209 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5210 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5211 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5212 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5213
5214 You need to explicitly enable asynchronous mode before you can use
5215 background execution commands. You can use these commands to
5216 manipulate the asynchronous mode setting:
5217
5218 @table @code
5219 @kindex set target-async
5220 @item set target-async on
5221 Enable asynchronous mode.
5222 @item set target-async off
5223 Disable asynchronous mode.
5224 @kindex show target-async
5225 @item show target-async
5226 Show the current target-async setting.
5227 @end table
5228
5229 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5230 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5231
5232 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5233 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5234 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5235 are:
5236
5237 @table @code
5238 @kindex run&
5239 @item run
5240 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5241
5242 @item attach
5243 @kindex attach&
5244 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5245
5246 @item step
5247 @kindex step&
5248 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
5249
5250 @item stepi
5251 @kindex stepi&
5252 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
5253
5254 @item next
5255 @kindex next&
5256 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
5257
5258 @item nexti
5259 @kindex nexti&
5260 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
5261
5262 @item continue
5263 @kindex continue&
5264 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
5265
5266 @item finish
5267 @kindex finish&
5268 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
5269
5270 @item until
5271 @kindex until&
5272 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
5273
5274 @end table
5275
5276 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
5277 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
5278 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
5279 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
5280 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
5281 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
5282
5283 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
5284 using the @code{interrupt} command.
5285
5286 @table @code
5287 @kindex interrupt
5288 @item interrupt
5289 @itemx interrupt -a
5290
5291 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
5292 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
5293 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
5294 use @code{interrupt -a}.
5295 @end table
5296
5297 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5298 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5299
5300 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
5301 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
5302 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
5303
5304 @table @code
5305 @cindex breakpoints and threads
5306 @cindex thread breakpoints
5307 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
5308 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
5309 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
5310 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
5311 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
5312 specify some source line.
5313
5314 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
5315 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
5316 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
5317 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
5318 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
5319
5320 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
5321 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
5322 program.
5323
5324 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
5325 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
5326 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
5327
5328 @smallexample
5329 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
5330 @end smallexample
5331
5332 @end table
5333
5334 @node Interrupted System Calls
5335 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
5336
5337 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
5338 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
5339 @cindex premature return from system calls
5340 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
5341 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
5342 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
5343 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
5344 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
5345 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
5346 stop execution.
5347
5348 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
5349 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
5350 style anyways.
5351
5352 For example, do not write code like this:
5353
5354 @smallexample
5355 sleep (10);
5356 @end smallexample
5357
5358 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
5359 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
5360
5361 Instead, write this:
5362
5363 @smallexample
5364 int unslept = 10;
5365 while (unslept > 0)
5366 unslept = sleep (unslept);
5367 @end smallexample
5368
5369 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
5370 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
5371 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
5372 @value{GDBN}.
5373
5374 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
5375 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
5376 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
5377 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
5378
5379 @node Observer Mode
5380 @subsection Observer Mode
5381
5382 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
5383 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
5384 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
5385 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
5386 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
5387
5388 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
5389 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
5390 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
5391 mode.
5392
5393 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
5394 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
5395 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
5396 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
5397 stream will still not be able to be placed.
5398
5399 @table @code
5400
5401 @kindex observer
5402 @item set observer on
5403 @itemx set observer off
5404 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
5405 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
5406 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
5407 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
5408
5409 @item show observer
5410 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
5411
5412 @kindex may-write-registers
5413 @item set may-write-registers on
5414 @itemx set may-write-registers off
5415 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
5416 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
5417 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
5418
5419 @item show may-write-registers
5420 Show the current permission to write registers.
5421
5422 @kindex may-write-memory
5423 @item set may-write-memory on
5424 @itemx set may-write-memory off
5425 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
5426 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
5427 defaults to @code{on}.
5428
5429 @item show may-write-memory
5430 Show the current permission to write memory.
5431
5432 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
5433 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
5434 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
5435 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
5436 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
5437 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5438
5439 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
5440 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
5441
5442 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
5443 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
5444 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
5445 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
5446 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
5447 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
5448 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5449
5450 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
5451 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
5452
5453 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
5454 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
5455 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
5456 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
5457 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
5458 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
5459 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5460
5461 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
5462 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
5463
5464 @kindex may-interrupt
5465 @item set may-interrupt on
5466 @itemx set may-interrupt off
5467 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
5468 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
5469 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
5470 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5471
5472 @item show may-interrupt
5473 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
5474
5475 @end table
5476
5477 @node Reverse Execution
5478 @chapter Running programs backward
5479 @cindex reverse execution
5480 @cindex running programs backward
5481
5482 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
5483 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
5484 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
5485 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
5486
5487 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
5488 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
5489 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
5490 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
5491 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
5492 all target environments can support reverse execution.
5493
5494 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
5495 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
5496 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
5497 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
5498 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
5499 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
5500 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
5501 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
5502 prior values@footnote{
5503 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
5504 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
5505 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
5506
5507 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
5508 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
5509 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
5510 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
5511 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
5512 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
5513 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
5514 }.
5515
5516 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
5517 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
5518
5519 @table @code
5520 @kindex reverse-continue
5521 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
5522 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5523 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5524 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
5525 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
5526 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
5527 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
5528
5529 @kindex reverse-step
5530 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
5531 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5532 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
5533 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
5534
5535 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
5536 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
5537 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
5538 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
5539 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
5540 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
5541
5542 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
5543 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
5544
5545 @kindex reverse-stepi
5546 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
5547 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5548 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
5549 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
5550 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
5551 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
5552 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
5553
5554 @kindex reverse-next
5555 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
5556 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5557 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
5558 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
5559 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
5560 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
5561 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
5562 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
5563 line of a function back to its return to its caller
5564 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
5565
5566 @kindex reverse-nexti
5567 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
5568 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5569 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
5570 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
5571 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
5572 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
5573 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
5574 frame) is reached.
5575
5576 @kindex reverse-finish
5577 @item reverse-finish
5578 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
5579 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
5580 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
5581 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
5582
5583 @kindex set exec-direction
5584 @item set exec-direction
5585 Set the direction of target execution.
5586 @itemx set exec-direction reverse
5587 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
5588 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
5589 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
5590 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
5591 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
5592 @item set exec-direction forward
5593 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
5594 This is the default.
5595 @end table
5596
5597
5598 @node Process Record and Replay
5599 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
5600 @cindex process record and replay
5601 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
5602
5603 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
5604 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
5605 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
5606
5607 @cindex replay mode
5608 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
5609 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
5610 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
5611 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
5612 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
5613 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
5614 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
5615 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
5616 execution log.
5617
5618 @cindex record mode
5619 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
5620 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
5621 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
5622 for future replay.
5623
5624 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
5625 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
5626 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
5627 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
5628 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
5629 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
5630
5631 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
5632 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
5633 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
5634 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
5635
5636 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
5637 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
5638
5639 @table @code
5640 @kindex target record
5641 @kindex record
5642 @kindex rec
5643 @item target record
5644 This command starts the process record and replay target. The process
5645 record and replay target can only debug a process that is already
5646 running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with the
5647 @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording with
5648 the @kbd{target record} command.
5649
5650 Both @code{record} and @code{rec} are aliases of @code{target record}.
5651
5652 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
5653 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
5654 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
5655 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
5656 doesn't support displaced stepping.
5657
5658 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
5659 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
5660 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
5661 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), the
5662 process record and replay target cannot be started because it doesn't
5663 support these two modes.
5664
5665 @kindex record stop
5666 @kindex rec s
5667 @item record stop
5668 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
5669 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
5670 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
5671
5672 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
5673 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
5674 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
5675 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
5676 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
5677
5678 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
5679 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
5680 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
5681 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
5682 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
5683
5684 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
5685 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
5686
5687 @kindex record save
5688 @item record save @var{filename}
5689 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
5690 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
5691 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
5692
5693 @kindex record restore
5694 @item record restore @var{filename}
5695 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
5696 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
5697
5698 @kindex set record insn-number-max
5699 @item set record insn-number-max @var{limit}
5700 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded. Default value is 200000.
5701
5702 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
5703 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
5704 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
5705 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
5706 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
5707 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
5708 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
5709 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
5710
5711 If @var{limit} is zero, @value{GDBN} will never delete recorded
5712 instructions from the execution log. The number of recorded
5713 instructions is unlimited in this case.
5714
5715 @kindex show record insn-number-max
5716 @item show record insn-number-max
5717 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded.
5718
5719 @kindex set record stop-at-limit
5720 @item set record stop-at-limit
5721 Control the behavior when the number of recorded instructions reaches
5722 the limit. If ON (the default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit
5723 is reached for the first time and ask you whether you want to stop the
5724 inferior or continue running it and recording the execution log. If
5725 you decide to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will
5726 cause the oldest one to be deleted.
5727
5728 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
5729 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
5730
5731 @kindex show record stop-at-limit
5732 @item show record stop-at-limit
5733 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
5734
5735 @kindex set record memory-query
5736 @item set record memory-query
5737 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
5738 changes caused by an instruction. If ON, @value{GDBN} will query
5739 whether to stop the inferior in that case.
5740
5741 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
5742 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
5743 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
5744 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
5745 results.
5746
5747 @kindex show record memory-query
5748 @item show record memory-query
5749 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
5750
5751 @kindex info record
5752 @item info record
5753 Show various statistics about the state of process record and its
5754 in-memory execution log buffer, including:
5755
5756 @itemize @bullet
5757 @item
5758 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
5759 @item
5760 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
5761 @item
5762 Highest recorded instruction number.
5763 @item
5764 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
5765 @item
5766 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
5767 @item
5768 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
5769 @end itemize
5770
5771 @kindex record delete
5772 @kindex rec del
5773 @item record delete
5774 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
5775 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
5776 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
5777 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
5778 @end table
5779
5780
5781 @node Stack
5782 @chapter Examining the Stack
5783
5784 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
5785 stopped and how it got there.
5786
5787 @cindex call stack
5788 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
5789 is generated.
5790 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
5791 the arguments of the call,
5792 and the local variables of the function being called.
5793 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
5794 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
5795 stack}.
5796
5797 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
5798 stack allow you to see all of this information.
5799
5800 @cindex selected frame
5801 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
5802 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
5803 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
5804 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
5805 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
5806 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5807
5808 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5809 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
5810 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
5811
5812 @menu
5813 * Frames:: Stack frames
5814 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
5815 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
5816 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
5817
5818 @end menu
5819
5820 @node Frames
5821 @section Stack Frames
5822
5823 @cindex frame, definition
5824 @cindex stack frame
5825 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
5826 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
5827 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
5828 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
5829 which the function is executing.
5830
5831 @cindex initial frame
5832 @cindex outermost frame
5833 @cindex innermost frame
5834 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
5835 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
5836 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
5837 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
5838 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
5839 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
5840 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
5841 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
5842
5843 @cindex frame pointer
5844 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
5845 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
5846 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
5847 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
5848 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
5849 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
5850
5851 @cindex frame number
5852 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
5853 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
5854 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
5855 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
5856 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
5857
5858 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
5859 @c underflow problems.
5860 @cindex frameless execution
5861 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
5862 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
5863 @smallexample
5864 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
5865 @end smallexample
5866 generates functions without a frame.)
5867 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
5868 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
5869 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
5870 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
5871 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
5872 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
5873 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
5874
5875 @table @code
5876 @kindex frame@r{, command}
5877 @cindex current stack frame
5878 @item frame @var{args}
5879 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
5880 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5881 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
5882 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
5883
5884 @kindex select-frame
5885 @cindex selecting frame silently
5886 @item select-frame
5887 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
5888 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
5889 @code{frame}.
5890 @end table
5891
5892 @node Backtrace
5893 @section Backtraces
5894
5895 @cindex traceback
5896 @cindex call stack traces
5897 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
5898 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
5899 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
5900 stack.
5901
5902 @table @code
5903 @kindex backtrace
5904 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
5905 @item backtrace
5906 @itemx bt
5907 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
5908 frames in the stack.
5909
5910 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
5911 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
5912
5913 @item backtrace @var{n}
5914 @itemx bt @var{n}
5915 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
5916
5917 @item backtrace -@var{n}
5918 @itemx bt -@var{n}
5919 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
5920
5921 @item backtrace full
5922 @itemx bt full
5923 @itemx bt full @var{n}
5924 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
5925 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
5926 number of frames to print, as described above.
5927 @end table
5928
5929 @kindex where
5930 @kindex info stack
5931 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
5932 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
5933
5934 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
5935 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
5936 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
5937 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
5938 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
5939 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
5940 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
5941 multi-threaded program.
5942
5943 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
5944 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
5945 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
5946 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
5947 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
5948 line number.
5949
5950 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
5951 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
5952
5953 @smallexample
5954 @group
5955 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5956 at builtin.c:993
5957 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
5958 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
5959 at macro.c:71
5960 (More stack frames follow...)
5961 @end group
5962 @end smallexample
5963
5964 @noindent
5965 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
5966 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
5967 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
5968
5969 @noindent
5970 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
5971 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
5972 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
5973 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
5974 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
5975
5976 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
5977 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
5978 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
5979 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
5980 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
5981 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
5982 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
5983 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
5984 such a backtrace might look like:
5985
5986 @smallexample
5987 @group
5988 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5989 at builtin.c:993
5990 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
5991 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
5992 at macro.c:71
5993 (More stack frames follow...)
5994 @end group
5995 @end smallexample
5996
5997 @noindent
5998 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
5999 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
6000
6001 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
6002 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
6003 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
6004
6005 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
6006 @cindex program entry point
6007 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
6008 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
6009 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
6010 @code{main}@footnote{
6011 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
6012 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
6013 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
6014 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
6015 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
6016 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
6017
6018 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
6019 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
6020
6021 @table @code
6022 @item set backtrace past-main
6023 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
6024 @kindex set backtrace
6025 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
6026
6027 @item set backtrace past-main off
6028 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
6029 default.
6030
6031 @item show backtrace past-main
6032 @kindex show backtrace
6033 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
6034
6035 @item set backtrace past-entry
6036 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
6037 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
6038 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
6039 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
6040
6041 @item set backtrace past-entry off
6042 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
6043 application. This is the default.
6044
6045 @item show backtrace past-entry
6046 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
6047
6048 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
6049 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
6050 @cindex backtrace limit
6051 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
6052 unlimited.
6053
6054 @item show backtrace limit
6055 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
6056 @end table
6057
6058 @node Selection
6059 @section Selecting a Frame
6060
6061 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
6062 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
6063 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
6064 of the stack frame just selected.
6065
6066 @table @code
6067 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
6068 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
6069 @item frame @var{n}
6070 @itemx f @var{n}
6071 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
6072 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
6073 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
6074 @code{main}.
6075
6076 @item frame @var{addr}
6077 @itemx f @var{addr}
6078 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
6079 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
6080 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
6081 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
6082 switches between them.
6083
6084 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
6085 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
6086
6087 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
6088 pointer and a program counter.
6089
6090 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
6091 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
6092
6093 @kindex up
6094 @item up @var{n}
6095 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
6096 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
6097 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
6098
6099 @kindex down
6100 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
6101 @item down @var{n}
6102 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
6103 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
6104 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
6105 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
6106 @end table
6107
6108 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
6109 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
6110 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
6111 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
6112
6113 @need 1000
6114 For example:
6115
6116 @smallexample
6117 @group
6118 (@value{GDBP}) up
6119 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
6120 at env.c:10
6121 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
6122 @end group
6123 @end smallexample
6124
6125 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
6126 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
6127 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
6128 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
6129 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
6130 for details.
6131
6132 @table @code
6133 @kindex down-silently
6134 @kindex up-silently
6135 @item up-silently @var{n}
6136 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
6137 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
6138 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
6139 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
6140 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
6141 distracting.
6142 @end table
6143
6144 @node Frame Info
6145 @section Information About a Frame
6146
6147 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
6148 stack frame.
6149
6150 @table @code
6151 @item frame
6152 @itemx f
6153 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
6154 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
6155 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
6156 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
6157 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6158
6159 @kindex info frame
6160 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
6161 @item info frame
6162 @itemx info f
6163 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
6164 including:
6165
6166 @itemize @bullet
6167 @item
6168 the address of the frame
6169 @item
6170 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
6171 @item
6172 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
6173 @item
6174 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
6175 @item
6176 the address of the frame's arguments
6177 @item
6178 the address of the frame's local variables
6179 @item
6180 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
6181 @item
6182 which registers were saved in the frame
6183 @end itemize
6184
6185 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
6186 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
6187 the usual conventions.
6188
6189 @item info frame @var{addr}
6190 @itemx info f @var{addr}
6191 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
6192 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
6193 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
6194 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
6195 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6196
6197 @kindex info args
6198 @item info args
6199 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
6200
6201 @item info locals
6202 @kindex info locals
6203 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
6204 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
6205 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
6206
6207 @kindex info catch
6208 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
6209 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
6210 @item info catch
6211 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
6212 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
6213 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
6214 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
6215 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
6216
6217 @end table
6218
6219
6220 @node Source
6221 @chapter Examining Source Files
6222
6223 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
6224 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
6225 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
6226 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
6227 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
6228 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
6229 source files by explicit command.
6230
6231 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
6232 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
6233 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
6234
6235 @menu
6236 * List:: Printing source lines
6237 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
6238 * Edit:: Editing source files
6239 * Search:: Searching source files
6240 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
6241 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
6242 @end menu
6243
6244 @node List
6245 @section Printing Source Lines
6246
6247 @kindex list
6248 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
6249 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
6250 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
6251 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
6252 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
6253
6254 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
6255
6256 @table @code
6257 @item list @var{linenum}
6258 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
6259 current source file.
6260
6261 @item list @var{function}
6262 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
6263 @var{function}.
6264
6265 @item list
6266 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
6267 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
6268 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
6269 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
6270 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
6271
6272 @item list -
6273 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
6274 @end table
6275
6276 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
6277 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
6278 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
6279
6280 @table @code
6281 @kindex set listsize
6282 @item set listsize @var{count}
6283 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
6284 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
6285
6286 @kindex show listsize
6287 @item show listsize
6288 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
6289 @end table
6290
6291 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
6292 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
6293 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
6294 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
6295 each repetition moves up in the source file.
6296
6297 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
6298 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
6299 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
6300 to specify some source line.
6301
6302 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
6303
6304 @table @code
6305 @item list @var{linespec}
6306 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
6307
6308 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
6309 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
6310 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
6311 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
6312 the same source file as the first linespec.
6313
6314 @item list ,@var{last}
6315 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
6316
6317 @item list @var{first},
6318 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
6319
6320 @item list +
6321 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
6322
6323 @item list -
6324 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
6325
6326 @item list
6327 As described in the preceding table.
6328 @end table
6329
6330 @node Specify Location
6331 @section Specifying a Location
6332 @cindex specifying location
6333 @cindex linespec
6334
6335 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
6336 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
6337 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
6338 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
6339
6340 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
6341 @value{GDBN} understands:
6342
6343 @table @code
6344 @item @var{linenum}
6345 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
6346
6347 @item -@var{offset}
6348 @itemx +@var{offset}
6349 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
6350 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
6351 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
6352 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
6353 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
6354 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
6355 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
6356 linespec.
6357
6358 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
6359 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
6360
6361 @item @var{function}
6362 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
6363 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
6364
6365 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
6366 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
6367
6368 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
6369 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
6370 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
6371 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
6372 functions in different source files.
6373
6374 @item @var{label}
6375 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears.
6376 @value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to
6377 the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
6378 stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then
6379 @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
6380
6381 @item *@var{address}
6382 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
6383 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
6384 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
6385 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
6386 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
6387 source files.
6388
6389 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
6390 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
6391 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
6392 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
6393 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
6394 of @var{address}:
6395
6396 @table @code
6397 @item @var{expression}
6398 Any expression valid in the current working language.
6399
6400 @item @var{funcaddr}
6401 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
6402 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
6403 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
6404 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
6405 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
6406 (although the Pascal form also works).
6407
6408 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
6409 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
6410
6411 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
6412 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
6413 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
6414 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
6415 functions with identical names in different source files.
6416 @end table
6417
6418 @end table
6419
6420
6421 @node Edit
6422 @section Editing Source Files
6423 @cindex editing source files
6424
6425 @kindex edit
6426 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
6427 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
6428 The editing program of your choice
6429 is invoked with the current line set to
6430 the active line in the program.
6431 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
6432 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
6433
6434 @table @code
6435 @item edit @var{location}
6436 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
6437 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
6438 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
6439 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
6440 command most commonly used:
6441
6442 @table @code
6443 @item edit @var{number}
6444 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
6445
6446 @item edit @var{function}
6447 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
6448 @end table
6449
6450 @end table
6451
6452 @subsection Choosing your Editor
6453 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
6454 @footnote{
6455 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
6456 following command-line syntax:
6457 @smallexample
6458 ex +@var{number} file
6459 @end smallexample
6460 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
6461 the file where to start editing.}.
6462 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
6463 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
6464 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
6465 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
6466 @smallexample
6467 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
6468 export EDITOR
6469 gdb @dots{}
6470 @end smallexample
6471 or in the @code{csh} shell,
6472 @smallexample
6473 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
6474 gdb @dots{}
6475 @end smallexample
6476
6477 @node Search
6478 @section Searching Source Files
6479 @cindex searching source files
6480
6481 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
6482 regular expression.
6483
6484 @table @code
6485 @kindex search
6486 @kindex forward-search
6487 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
6488 @itemx search @var{regexp}
6489 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
6490 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
6491 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
6492 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
6493 @code{fo}.
6494
6495 @kindex reverse-search
6496 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
6497 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
6498 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
6499 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
6500 this command as @code{rev}.
6501 @end table
6502
6503 @node Source Path
6504 @section Specifying Source Directories
6505
6506 @cindex source path
6507 @cindex directories for source files
6508 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
6509 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
6510 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
6511 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
6512 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
6513 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
6514 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
6515
6516 For example, suppose an executable references the file
6517 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
6518 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
6519 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
6520 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
6521 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
6522 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
6523 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
6524 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
6525 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
6526 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
6527
6528 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
6529 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
6530 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
6531 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
6532 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
6533 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
6534
6535 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
6536 source files.
6537
6538 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
6539 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
6540 each line is in the file.
6541
6542 @kindex directory
6543 @kindex dir
6544 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
6545 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
6546 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
6547
6548 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
6549 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
6550
6551 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
6552 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
6553 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
6554 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
6555 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
6556 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
6557 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
6558 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
6559 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
6560 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
6561 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
6562 name to look up the sources.
6563
6564 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
6565 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
6566 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
6567 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
6568 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
6569 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
6570 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
6571 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
6572
6573 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
6574 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
6575 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
6576 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
6577 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
6578 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
6579 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
6580
6581 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
6582 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
6583 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
6584 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
6585 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
6586 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
6587 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
6588 command.
6589
6590 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
6591 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
6592 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
6593 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
6594 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
6595 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
6596 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
6597
6598 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
6599 @cindex default source path substitution
6600 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
6601 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
6602 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
6603 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
6604 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
6605 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
6606 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
6607 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
6608 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
6609 together.
6610
6611 @table @code
6612 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
6613 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
6614 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
6615 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
6616 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
6617 part of absolute file names) or
6618 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
6619 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
6620
6621 @kindex cdir
6622 @kindex cwd
6623 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
6624 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
6625 @cindex compilation directory
6626 @cindex current directory
6627 @cindex working directory
6628 @cindex directory, current
6629 @cindex directory, compilation
6630 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
6631 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
6632 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
6633 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
6634 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
6635 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
6636
6637 @item directory
6638 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
6639
6640 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
6641 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
6642
6643 @item set directories @var{path-list}
6644 @kindex set directories
6645 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
6646 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
6647
6648 @item show directories
6649 @kindex show directories
6650 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
6651
6652 @anchor{set substitute-path}
6653 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
6654 @kindex set substitute-path
6655 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
6656 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
6657 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
6658
6659 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
6660 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
6661
6662 @smallexample
6663 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
6664 @end smallexample
6665
6666 @noindent
6667 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
6668 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
6669 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
6670
6671 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
6672 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
6673 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
6674 the substitution.
6675
6676 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
6677
6678 @smallexample
6679 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
6680 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
6681 @end smallexample
6682
6683 @noindent
6684 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
6685 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
6686 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
6687 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
6688
6689
6690 @item unset substitute-path [path]
6691 @kindex unset substitute-path
6692 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
6693 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
6694 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
6695
6696 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
6697
6698 @item show substitute-path [path]
6699 @kindex show substitute-path
6700 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
6701 which would rewrite that path, if any.
6702
6703 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
6704 rules.
6705
6706 @end table
6707
6708 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
6709 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
6710 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
6711
6712 @enumerate
6713 @item
6714 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
6715
6716 @item
6717 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
6718 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
6719 directories in one command.
6720 @end enumerate
6721
6722 @node Machine Code
6723 @section Source and Machine Code
6724 @cindex source line and its code address
6725
6726 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
6727 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
6728 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
6729 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
6730 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6731 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
6732 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
6733 well as hex.
6734
6735 @table @code
6736 @kindex info line
6737 @item info line @var{linespec}
6738 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
6739 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
6740 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
6741 @end table
6742
6743 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
6744 the object code for the first line of function
6745 @code{m4_changequote}:
6746
6747 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
6748 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
6749 @smallexample
6750 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
6751 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
6752 @end smallexample
6753
6754 @noindent
6755 @cindex code address and its source line
6756 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
6757 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
6758 @smallexample
6759 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
6760 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
6761 @end smallexample
6762
6763 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
6764 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
6765 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
6766 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
6767 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
6768 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
6769 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
6770 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
6771 Variables}).
6772
6773 @table @code
6774 @kindex disassemble
6775 @cindex assembly instructions
6776 @cindex instructions, assembly
6777 @cindex machine instructions
6778 @cindex listing machine instructions
6779 @item disassemble
6780 @itemx disassemble /m
6781 @itemx disassemble /r
6782 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
6783 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
6784 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
6785 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
6786 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
6787 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
6788 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
6789 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
6790 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
6791 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
6792
6793 @table @code
6794 @item @var{start},@var{end}
6795 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
6796 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
6797 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
6798 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
6799 @end table
6800
6801 @noindent
6802 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
6803 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
6804
6805 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
6806 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
6807
6808 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
6809 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
6810 @end table
6811
6812 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
6813 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
6814
6815 @smallexample
6816 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
6817 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
6818 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
6819 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
6820 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6821 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
6822 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
6823 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
6824 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
6825 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6826 End of assembler dump.
6827 @end smallexample
6828
6829 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
6830 program is stopped just after function prologue:
6831
6832 @smallexample
6833 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
6834 Dump of assembler code for function main:
6835 5 @{
6836 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
6837 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
6838 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
6839 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
6840 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
6841
6842 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
6843 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
6844 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
6845
6846 7 return 0;
6847 8 @}
6848 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
6849 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
6850 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
6851
6852 End of assembler dump.
6853 @end smallexample
6854
6855 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
6856
6857 @smallexample
6858 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
6859 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
6860 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
6861 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
6862 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
6863 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
6864 End of assembler dump.
6865 @end smallexample
6866
6867 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
6868 mnemonics or other syntax.
6869
6870 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
6871 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
6872 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
6873 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
6874 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
6875
6876 @table @code
6877 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
6878 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
6879 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
6880 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
6881 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
6882 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
6883
6884 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
6885 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
6886 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
6887 assemblers for x86-based targets.
6888
6889 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
6890 @item show disassembly-flavor
6891 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
6892 @end table
6893
6894 @table @code
6895 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
6896 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
6897 @item set disassemble-next-line
6898 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
6899 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
6900 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
6901 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
6902 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
6903 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
6904 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
6905 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
6906 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
6907 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
6908 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
6909 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
6910 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
6911 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
6912 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
6913 instruction.
6914 @end table
6915
6916
6917 @node Data
6918 @chapter Examining Data
6919
6920 @cindex printing data
6921 @cindex examining data
6922 @kindex print
6923 @kindex inspect
6924 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
6925 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
6926 @c different window or something like that.
6927 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
6928 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
6929 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
6930 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
6931 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
6932 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
6933
6934 @table @code
6935 @item print @var{expr}
6936 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
6937 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
6938 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
6939 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
6940 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
6941 Formats}.
6942
6943 @item print
6944 @itemx print /@var{f}
6945 @cindex reprint the last value
6946 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
6947 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
6948 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
6949 @end table
6950
6951 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
6952 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
6953 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6954
6955 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
6956 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
6957 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
6958 Table}.
6959
6960 @menu
6961 * Expressions:: Expressions
6962 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
6963 * Variables:: Program variables
6964 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
6965 * Output Formats:: Output formats
6966 * Memory:: Examining memory
6967 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
6968 * Print Settings:: Print settings
6969 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
6970 * Value History:: Value history
6971 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
6972 * Registers:: Registers
6973 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
6974 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
6975 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
6976 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
6977 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
6978 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
6979 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
6980 character set than GDB does
6981 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
6982 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
6983 @end menu
6984
6985 @node Expressions
6986 @section Expressions
6987
6988 @cindex expressions
6989 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
6990 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
6991 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
6992 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
6993 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
6994 you compiled your program to include this information; see
6995 @ref{Compilation}.
6996
6997 @cindex arrays in expressions
6998 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
6999 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
7000 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
7001 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
7002 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
7003 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
7004
7005 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
7006 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
7007 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
7008 languages.
7009
7010 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
7011 expressions regardless of your programming language.
7012
7013 @cindex casts, in expressions
7014 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
7015 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
7016 at that address in memory.
7017 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
7018
7019 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
7020 to programming languages:
7021
7022 @table @code
7023 @item @@
7024 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
7025 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
7026
7027 @item ::
7028 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
7029 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
7030
7031 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
7032 @cindex type casting memory
7033 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
7034 @cindex casts, to view memory
7035 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
7036 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
7037 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
7038 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
7039 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
7040 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
7041 @end table
7042
7043 @node Ambiguous Expressions
7044 @section Ambiguous Expressions
7045 @cindex ambiguous expressions
7046
7047 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
7048 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
7049 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
7050 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
7051 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
7052 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
7053 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
7054
7055 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
7056 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
7057 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
7058 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
7059 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
7060 as well.
7061
7062 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
7063 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
7064 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
7065 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
7066 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
7067 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
7068 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
7069 choices.
7070
7071 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
7072 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
7073 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
7074
7075 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
7076 @smallexample
7077 @group
7078 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
7079 [0] cancel
7080 [1] all
7081 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
7082 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
7083 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
7084 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
7085 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
7086 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
7087 > 2 4 6
7088 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
7089 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
7090 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
7091 Multiple breakpoints were set.
7092 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
7093 breakpoints.
7094 (@value{GDBP})
7095 @end group
7096 @end smallexample
7097
7098 @table @code
7099 @kindex set multiple-symbols
7100 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
7101 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
7102
7103 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
7104 is ambiguous.
7105
7106 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
7107 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
7108 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
7109 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
7110 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
7111 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
7112 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
7113 in the use of the menu.
7114
7115 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
7116 when an ambiguity is detected.
7117
7118 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
7119 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
7120
7121 @kindex show multiple-symbols
7122 @item show multiple-symbols
7123 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
7124 @end table
7125
7126 @node Variables
7127 @section Program Variables
7128
7129 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
7130 in your program.
7131
7132 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
7133 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
7134
7135 @itemize @bullet
7136 @item
7137 global (or file-static)
7138 @end itemize
7139
7140 @noindent or
7141
7142 @itemize @bullet
7143 @item
7144 visible according to the scope rules of the
7145 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
7146 @end itemize
7147
7148 @noindent This means that in the function
7149
7150 @smallexample
7151 foo (a)
7152 int a;
7153 @{
7154 bar (a);
7155 @{
7156 int b = test ();
7157 bar (b);
7158 @}
7159 @}
7160 @end smallexample
7161
7162 @noindent
7163 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
7164 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
7165 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
7166 the block where @code{b} is declared.
7167
7168 @cindex variable name conflict
7169 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
7170 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
7171 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
7172 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
7173 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
7174 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
7175 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
7176
7177 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
7178 @ifnotinfo
7179 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
7180 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
7181 @end ifnotinfo
7182 @smallexample
7183 @var{file}::@var{variable}
7184 @var{function}::@var{variable}
7185 @end smallexample
7186
7187 @noindent
7188 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
7189 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
7190 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
7191 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
7192
7193 @smallexample
7194 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
7195 @end smallexample
7196
7197 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
7198 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
7199 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
7200 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
7201 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
7202 @c conflict?? --mew
7203
7204 @cindex wrong values
7205 @cindex variable values, wrong
7206 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
7207 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
7208 @quotation
7209 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
7210 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
7211 scope, and just before exit.
7212 @end quotation
7213 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
7214 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
7215 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
7216 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
7217 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
7218 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
7219 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
7220 variable definitions may be gone.
7221
7222 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
7223 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
7224 when compiling.
7225
7226 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
7227 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
7228 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
7229 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
7230 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
7231 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
7232 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
7233
7234 @smallexample
7235 No symbol "foo" in current context.
7236 @end smallexample
7237
7238 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
7239 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
7240 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
7241 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
7242 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
7243 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
7244 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
7245 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
7246 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
7247 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
7248 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
7249
7250 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
7251 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
7252 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
7253 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
7254
7255 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
7256 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
7257 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
7258 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
7259 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
7260 For program code
7261
7262 @smallexample
7263 char var0[] = "A";
7264 signed char var1[] = "A";
7265 @end smallexample
7266
7267 You get during debugging
7268 @smallexample
7269 (gdb) print var0
7270 $1 = "A"
7271 (gdb) print var1
7272 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
7273 @end smallexample
7274
7275 @node Arrays
7276 @section Artificial Arrays
7277
7278 @cindex artificial array
7279 @cindex arrays
7280 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
7281 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
7282 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
7283 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
7284 program.
7285
7286 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
7287 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
7288 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
7289 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
7290 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
7291 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
7292 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
7293 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
7294 example. If a program says
7295
7296 @smallexample
7297 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
7298 @end smallexample
7299
7300 @noindent
7301 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
7302
7303 @smallexample
7304 p *array@@len
7305 @end smallexample
7306
7307 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
7308 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
7309 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
7310 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
7311 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
7312
7313 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
7314 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
7315 The value need not be in memory:
7316 @smallexample
7317 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
7318 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
7319 @end smallexample
7320
7321 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
7322 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
7323 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
7324 @smallexample
7325 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
7326 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
7327 @end smallexample
7328
7329 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
7330 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
7331 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
7332 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
7333 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7334 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
7335 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
7336 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
7337 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
7338 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
7339
7340 @smallexample
7341 set $i = 0
7342 p dtab[$i++]->fv
7343 @key{RET}
7344 @key{RET}
7345 @dots{}
7346 @end smallexample
7347
7348 @node Output Formats
7349 @section Output Formats
7350
7351 @cindex formatted output
7352 @cindex output formats
7353 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
7354 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
7355 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
7356 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
7357 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
7358
7359 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
7360 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
7361 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
7362 letters supported are:
7363
7364 @table @code
7365 @item x
7366 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
7367 hexadecimal.
7368
7369 @item d
7370 Print as integer in signed decimal.
7371
7372 @item u
7373 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
7374
7375 @item o
7376 Print as integer in octal.
7377
7378 @item t
7379 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
7380 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
7381 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
7382 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
7383
7384 @item a
7385 @cindex unknown address, locating
7386 @cindex locate address
7387 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
7388 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
7389 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
7390
7391 @smallexample
7392 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
7393 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
7394 @end smallexample
7395
7396 @noindent
7397 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
7398 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
7399
7400 @item c
7401 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
7402 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
7403 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
7404 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
7405
7406 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
7407 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
7408 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
7409 data.
7410
7411 @item f
7412 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
7413 using typical floating point syntax.
7414
7415 @item s
7416 @cindex printing strings
7417 @cindex printing byte arrays
7418 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
7419 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
7420 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
7421 natural types.
7422
7423 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
7424 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
7425 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
7426 array.
7427
7428 @item r
7429 @cindex raw printing
7430 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
7431 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
7432 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
7433 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
7434 pretty-printer which might exist.
7435 @end table
7436
7437 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
7438
7439 @smallexample
7440 p/x $pc
7441 @end smallexample
7442
7443 @noindent
7444 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
7445 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
7446
7447 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
7448 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
7449 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
7450
7451 @node Memory
7452 @section Examining Memory
7453
7454 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
7455 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
7456
7457 @cindex examining memory
7458 @table @code
7459 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
7460 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
7461 @itemx x @var{addr}
7462 @itemx x
7463 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
7464 @end table
7465
7466 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
7467 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
7468 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
7469 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
7470 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
7471
7472 @table @r
7473 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
7474 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
7475 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
7476 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
7477 @c 4.1.2.
7478
7479 @item @var{f}, the display format
7480 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
7481 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
7482 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
7483 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
7484 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
7485
7486 @item @var{u}, the unit size
7487 The unit size is any of
7488
7489 @table @code
7490 @item b
7491 Bytes.
7492 @item h
7493 Halfwords (two bytes).
7494 @item w
7495 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
7496 @item g
7497 Giant words (eight bytes).
7498 @end table
7499
7500 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
7501 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
7502 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
7503 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
7504 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
7505 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
7506 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
7507 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
7508 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
7509 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
7510 be altered.
7511
7512 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
7513 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
7514 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
7515 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
7516 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
7517 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
7518 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
7519 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
7520 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
7521 a value from memory).
7522 @end table
7523
7524 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
7525 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
7526 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
7527 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
7528 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
7529
7530 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
7531 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
7532 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
7533 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
7534 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
7535
7536 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
7537 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
7538 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
7539 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
7540 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
7541 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
7542 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
7543 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
7544 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
7545
7546 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
7547 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
7548 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
7549 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
7550 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
7551 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
7552 for successive uses of @code{x}.
7553
7554 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
7555 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
7556
7557 @smallexample
7558 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
7559 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
7560 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
7561 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
7562 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
7563 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
7564 @end smallexample
7565
7566 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
7567 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
7568 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
7569 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
7570 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
7571 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
7572 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
7573 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
7574 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
7575
7576 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
7577 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
7578 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
7579
7580 @cindex remote memory comparison
7581 @cindex verify remote memory image
7582 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
7583 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
7584 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
7585 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
7586 situations.
7587
7588 @table @code
7589 @kindex compare-sections
7590 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
7591 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
7592 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
7593 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
7594 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
7595 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
7596 remote request.
7597 @end table
7598
7599 @node Auto Display
7600 @section Automatic Display
7601 @cindex automatic display
7602 @cindex display of expressions
7603
7604 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
7605 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
7606 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
7607 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
7608 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
7609 The automatic display looks like this:
7610
7611 @smallexample
7612 2: foo = 38
7613 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
7614 @end smallexample
7615
7616 @noindent
7617 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
7618 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
7619 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
7620 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
7621 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
7622 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
7623
7624 @table @code
7625 @kindex display
7626 @item display @var{expr}
7627 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
7628 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
7629
7630 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
7631
7632 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
7633 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
7634 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
7635 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
7636 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
7637
7638 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
7639 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
7640 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
7641 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
7642 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
7643 @end table
7644
7645 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
7646 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
7647 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
7648
7649 @table @code
7650 @kindex delete display
7651 @kindex undisplay
7652 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
7653 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7654 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
7655 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
7656 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
7657 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
7658 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
7659
7660 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
7661 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
7662
7663 @kindex disable display
7664 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7665 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
7666 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
7667 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
7668 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
7669 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
7670 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
7671 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
7672
7673 @kindex enable display
7674 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7675 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
7676 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
7677 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
7678 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
7679 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
7680 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
7681
7682 @item display
7683 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
7684 done when your program stops.
7685
7686 @kindex info display
7687 @item info display
7688 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
7689 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
7690 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
7691 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
7692 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
7693 @end table
7694
7695 @cindex display disabled out of scope
7696 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
7697 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
7698 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
7699 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
7700 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
7701 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
7702 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
7703 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
7704 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
7705 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
7706
7707 @node Print Settings
7708 @section Print Settings
7709
7710 @cindex format options
7711 @cindex print settings
7712 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
7713 and symbols are printed.
7714
7715 @noindent
7716 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
7717
7718 @table @code
7719 @kindex set print
7720 @item set print address
7721 @itemx set print address on
7722 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
7723 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
7724 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
7725 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
7726 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
7727 @code{set print address on}:
7728
7729 @smallexample
7730 @group
7731 (@value{GDBP}) f
7732 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
7733 at input.c:530
7734 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7735 @end group
7736 @end smallexample
7737
7738 @item set print address off
7739 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
7740 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
7741
7742 @smallexample
7743 @group
7744 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
7745 (@value{GDBP}) f
7746 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
7747 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7748 @end group
7749 @end smallexample
7750
7751 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
7752 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
7753 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
7754 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
7755
7756 @kindex show print
7757 @item show print address
7758 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
7759 @end table
7760
7761 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
7762 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
7763 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
7764 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
7765 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
7766 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
7767 it prints a symbolic address:
7768
7769 @table @code
7770 @item set print symbol-filename on
7771 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
7772 @cindex symbol, source file and line
7773 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
7774 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7775
7776 @item set print symbol-filename off
7777 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
7778 default.
7779
7780 @item show print symbol-filename
7781 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
7782 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7783 @end table
7784
7785 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
7786 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
7787 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
7788
7789 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
7790 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
7791
7792 @table @code
7793 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
7794 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
7795 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
7796 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
7797 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
7798 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
7799
7800 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
7801 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
7802 symbolic address.
7803 @end table
7804
7805 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
7806 @cindex pointer, finding referent
7807 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
7808 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
7809 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
7810 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
7811 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
7812 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
7813
7814 @smallexample
7815 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
7816 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
7817 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
7818 @end smallexample
7819
7820 @quotation
7821 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
7822 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
7823 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
7824 @end quotation
7825
7826 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
7827
7828 @table @code
7829 @item set print array
7830 @itemx set print array on
7831 @cindex pretty print arrays
7832 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
7833 but uses more space. The default is off.
7834
7835 @item set print array off
7836 Return to compressed format for arrays.
7837
7838 @item show print array
7839 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
7840 arrays.
7841
7842 @cindex print array indexes
7843 @item set print array-indexes
7844 @itemx set print array-indexes on
7845 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
7846 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
7847 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
7848
7849 @item set print array-indexes off
7850 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
7851
7852 @item show print array-indexes
7853 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
7854 arrays.
7855
7856 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
7857 @cindex number of array elements to print
7858 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
7859 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
7860 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
7861 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
7862 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
7863 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
7864 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
7865
7866 @item show print elements
7867 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
7868 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
7869
7870 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
7871 @kindex set print frame-arguments
7872 @cindex printing frame argument values
7873 @cindex print all frame argument values
7874 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
7875 @cindex do not print frame argument values
7876 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
7877 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
7878 values are:
7879
7880 @table @code
7881 @item all
7882 The values of all arguments are printed.
7883
7884 @item scalars
7885 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
7886 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
7887 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
7888 only scalar arguments are shown:
7889
7890 @smallexample
7891 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
7892 at frame-args.c:23
7893 @end smallexample
7894
7895 @item none
7896 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
7897 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
7898
7899 @smallexample
7900 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
7901 at frame-args.c:23
7902 @end smallexample
7903 @end table
7904
7905 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
7906 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
7907 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
7908 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
7909 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
7910 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
7911 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
7912 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
7913 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
7914 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
7915
7916 @item show print frame-arguments
7917 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
7918
7919 @item set print repeats
7920 @cindex repeated array elements
7921 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
7922 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
7923 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
7924 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
7925 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
7926 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
7927 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
7928
7929 @item show print repeats
7930 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
7931 elements.
7932
7933 @item set print null-stop
7934 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
7935 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
7936 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
7937 contain only short strings.
7938 The default is off.
7939
7940 @item show print null-stop
7941 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
7942 @sc{null} character.
7943
7944 @item set print pretty on
7945 @cindex print structures in indented form
7946 @cindex indentation in structure display
7947 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
7948 per line, like this:
7949
7950 @smallexample
7951 @group
7952 $1 = @{
7953 next = 0x0,
7954 flags = @{
7955 sweet = 1,
7956 sour = 1
7957 @},
7958 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
7959 @}
7960 @end group
7961 @end smallexample
7962
7963 @item set print pretty off
7964 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
7965
7966 @smallexample
7967 @group
7968 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
7969 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
7970 @end group
7971 @end smallexample
7972
7973 @noindent
7974 This is the default format.
7975
7976 @item show print pretty
7977 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
7978
7979 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
7980 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
7981 @cindex octal escapes in strings
7982 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
7983 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
7984 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
7985 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
7986 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
7987
7988 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
7989 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
7990 international character sets, and is the default.
7991
7992 @item show print sevenbit-strings
7993 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
7994
7995 @item set print union on
7996 @cindex unions in structures, printing
7997 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
7998 and other unions. This is the default setting.
7999
8000 @item set print union off
8001 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
8002 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
8003 instead.
8004
8005 @item show print union
8006 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
8007 structures and other unions.
8008
8009 For example, given the declarations
8010
8011 @smallexample
8012 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
8013 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
8014 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
8015 Bug_forms;
8016
8017 struct thing @{
8018 Species it;
8019 union @{
8020 Tree_forms tree;
8021 Bug_forms bug;
8022 @} form;
8023 @};
8024
8025 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
8026 @end smallexample
8027
8028 @noindent
8029 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
8030
8031 @smallexample
8032 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
8033 @end smallexample
8034
8035 @noindent
8036 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
8037
8038 @smallexample
8039 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
8040 @end smallexample
8041
8042 @noindent
8043 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
8044 and in Pascal.
8045 @end table
8046
8047 @need 1000
8048 @noindent
8049 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
8050
8051 @table @code
8052 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
8053 @item set print demangle
8054 @itemx set print demangle on
8055 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
8056 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
8057 linkage. The default is on.
8058
8059 @item show print demangle
8060 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
8061
8062 @item set print asm-demangle
8063 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
8064 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
8065 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
8066 The default is off.
8067
8068 @item show print asm-demangle
8069 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
8070 or demangled form.
8071
8072 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
8073 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
8074 @kindex set demangle-style
8075 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
8076 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
8077 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
8078
8079 @table @code
8080 @item auto
8081 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
8082
8083 @item gnu
8084 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
8085 This is the default.
8086
8087 @item hp
8088 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
8089
8090 @item lucid
8091 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
8092
8093 @item arm
8094 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
8095 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
8096 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
8097 require further enhancement to permit that.
8098
8099 @end table
8100 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
8101
8102 @item show demangle-style
8103 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
8104
8105 @item set print object
8106 @itemx set print object on
8107 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
8108 @cindex display derived types
8109 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
8110 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
8111 the virtual function table.
8112
8113 @item set print object off
8114 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
8115 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
8116
8117 @item show print object
8118 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
8119
8120 @item set print static-members
8121 @itemx set print static-members on
8122 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
8123 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
8124
8125 @item set print static-members off
8126 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
8127
8128 @item show print static-members
8129 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
8130
8131 @item set print pascal_static-members
8132 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
8133 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
8134 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
8135 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
8136
8137 @item set print pascal_static-members off
8138 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
8139
8140 @item show print pascal_static-members
8141 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
8142
8143 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
8144 @item set print vtbl
8145 @itemx set print vtbl on
8146 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
8147 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
8148 @cindex VTBL display
8149 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
8150 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
8151 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
8152
8153 @item set print vtbl off
8154 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
8155
8156 @item show print vtbl
8157 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
8158 @end table
8159
8160 @node Pretty Printing
8161 @section Pretty Printing
8162
8163 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
8164 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
8165 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
8166
8167 @menu
8168 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
8169 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
8170 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
8171 @end menu
8172
8173 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
8174 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
8175
8176 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
8177 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
8178 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
8179
8180 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
8181 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
8182 pretty-printers with their names.
8183 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
8184 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
8185 Each such subprinter has its own name.
8186 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
8187
8188 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
8189 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
8190 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
8191 do anything special.
8192
8193 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
8194
8195 @itemize @bullet
8196 @item
8197 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
8198 all inferiors.
8199
8200 @item
8201 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
8202 when debugging that program.
8203 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
8204
8205 @item
8206 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
8207 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
8208 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
8209 @end itemize
8210
8211 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
8212 pretty-printers are selected,
8213
8214 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
8215 for new types.
8216
8217 @node Pretty-Printer Example
8218 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
8219
8220 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
8221
8222 @smallexample
8223 (@value{GDBP}) print s
8224 $1 = @{
8225 static npos = 4294967295,
8226 _M_dataplus = @{
8227 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
8228 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
8229 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
8230 @},
8231 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
8232 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
8233 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
8234 @}
8235 @}
8236 @end smallexample
8237
8238 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
8239
8240 @smallexample
8241 (@value{GDBP}) print s
8242 $2 = "abcd"
8243 @end smallexample
8244
8245 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
8246 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
8247 @cindex pretty-printer commands
8248
8249 @table @code
8250 @kindex info pretty-printer
8251 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
8252 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
8253 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
8254
8255 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
8256 whose pretty-printers to list.
8257 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
8258 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
8259 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
8260 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
8261 looks up a printer from these three objects.
8262
8263 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
8264 to list.
8265
8266 @kindex disable pretty-printer
8267 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
8268 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
8269 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
8270
8271 @kindex enable pretty-printer
8272 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
8273 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
8274 @end table
8275
8276 Example:
8277
8278 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
8279 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
8280 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
8281 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
8282
8283 @smallexample
8284 (gdb) info pretty-printer
8285 library1.so:
8286 foo
8287 library2.so:
8288 bar
8289 bar1
8290 bar2
8291 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
8292 library2.so:
8293 bar
8294 bar1
8295 bar2
8296 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
8297 1 printer disabled
8298 2 of 3 printers enabled
8299 (gdb) info pretty-printer
8300 library1.so:
8301 foo [disabled]
8302 library2.so:
8303 bar
8304 bar1
8305 bar2
8306 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
8307 1 printer disabled
8308 1 of 3 printers enabled
8309 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
8310 library1.so:
8311 foo [disabled]
8312 library2.so:
8313 bar
8314 bar1 [disabled]
8315 bar2
8316 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
8317 1 printer disabled
8318 0 of 3 printers enabled
8319 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
8320 library1.so:
8321 foo [disabled]
8322 library2.so:
8323 bar [disabled]
8324 bar1 [disabled]
8325 bar2
8326 @end smallexample
8327
8328 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
8329 as can each individual subprinter.
8330
8331 @node Value History
8332 @section Value History
8333
8334 @cindex value history
8335 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
8336 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
8337 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
8338 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
8339 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
8340 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
8341 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
8342 symbol table.
8343
8344 @cindex @code{$}
8345 @cindex @code{$$}
8346 @cindex history number
8347 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
8348 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
8349 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
8350 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
8351 history number.
8352
8353 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
8354 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
8355 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
8356 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
8357 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
8358 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
8359 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
8360
8361 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
8362 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
8363
8364 @smallexample
8365 p *$
8366 @end smallexample
8367
8368 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
8369 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
8370
8371 @smallexample
8372 p *$.next
8373 @end smallexample
8374
8375 @noindent
8376 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
8377 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
8378
8379 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
8380 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
8381
8382 @smallexample
8383 print x
8384 set x=5
8385 @end smallexample
8386
8387 @noindent
8388 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
8389 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
8390
8391 @table @code
8392 @kindex show values
8393 @item show values
8394 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
8395 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
8396 values} does not change the history.
8397
8398 @item show values @var{n}
8399 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
8400
8401 @item show values +
8402 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
8403 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
8404 @end table
8405
8406 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
8407 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
8408
8409 @node Convenience Vars
8410 @section Convenience Variables
8411
8412 @cindex convenience variables
8413 @cindex user-defined variables
8414 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
8415 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
8416 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
8417 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
8418 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
8419
8420 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
8421 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
8422 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
8423 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
8424 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
8425
8426 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
8427 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
8428 For example:
8429
8430 @smallexample
8431 set $foo = *object_ptr
8432 @end smallexample
8433
8434 @noindent
8435 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
8436 @code{object_ptr}.
8437
8438 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
8439 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
8440 value with another assignment at any time.
8441
8442 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
8443 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
8444 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
8445 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
8446
8447 @table @code
8448 @kindex show convenience
8449 @cindex show all user variables
8450 @item show convenience
8451 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
8452 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
8453
8454 @kindex init-if-undefined
8455 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
8456 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
8457 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
8458 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
8459 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
8460 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
8461 override default values used in a command script.
8462
8463 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
8464 any side-effects do not occur.
8465 @end table
8466
8467 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
8468 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
8469 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
8470
8471 @smallexample
8472 set $i = 0
8473 print bar[$i++]->contents
8474 @end smallexample
8475
8476 @noindent
8477 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
8478
8479 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
8480 values likely to be useful.
8481
8482 @table @code
8483 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
8484 @item $_
8485 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
8486 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
8487 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
8488 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
8489 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
8490 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
8491 to the type of @code{$__}.
8492
8493 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
8494 @item $__
8495 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
8496 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
8497 to match the format in which the data was printed.
8498
8499 @item $_exitcode
8500 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
8501 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
8502 the program being debugged terminates.
8503
8504 @item $_sdata
8505 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
8506 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
8507 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
8508 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
8509 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
8510
8511 @item $_siginfo
8512 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
8513 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
8514 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
8515 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
8516 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
8517
8518 @item $_tlb
8519 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
8520 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
8521 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
8522 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
8523 @xref{General Query Packets}.
8524 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
8525
8526 @end table
8527
8528 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
8529 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
8530 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
8531
8532 @cindex convenience functions
8533 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
8534 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
8535 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
8536 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
8537 @value{GDBN}.
8538
8539 @table @code
8540 @item help function
8541 @kindex help function
8542 @cindex show all convenience functions
8543 Print a list of all convenience functions.
8544 @end table
8545
8546 @node Registers
8547 @section Registers
8548
8549 @cindex registers
8550 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
8551 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
8552 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
8553 your machine.
8554
8555 @table @code
8556 @kindex info registers
8557 @item info registers
8558 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
8559 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
8560
8561 @kindex info all-registers
8562 @cindex floating point registers
8563 @item info all-registers
8564 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
8565 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
8566
8567 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
8568 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
8569 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
8570 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
8571 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
8572 @end table
8573
8574 @cindex stack pointer register
8575 @cindex program counter register
8576 @cindex process status register
8577 @cindex frame pointer register
8578 @cindex standard registers
8579 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
8580 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
8581 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
8582 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
8583 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
8584 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
8585 register that contains the processor status. For example,
8586 you could print the program counter in hex with
8587
8588 @smallexample
8589 p/x $pc
8590 @end smallexample
8591
8592 @noindent
8593 or print the instruction to be executed next with
8594
8595 @smallexample
8596 x/i $pc
8597 @end smallexample
8598
8599 @noindent
8600 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
8601 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
8602 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
8603 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
8604 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
8605 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
8606 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
8607
8608 @smallexample
8609 set $sp += 4
8610 @end smallexample
8611
8612 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
8613 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
8614 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
8615 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
8616 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
8617 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
8618 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
8619
8620 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
8621 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
8622 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
8623 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
8624 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
8625 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
8626 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
8627
8628 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
8629 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
8630 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
8631 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
8632 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
8633 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
8634 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
8635 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
8636 prints the data in both formats.
8637
8638 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
8639 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
8640 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
8641 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
8642 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
8643 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
8644 registers in @code{struct} notation:
8645
8646 @smallexample
8647 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
8648 $1 = @{
8649 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
8650 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
8651 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
8652 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
8653 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
8654 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
8655 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
8656 @}
8657 @end smallexample
8658
8659 @noindent
8660 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
8661 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
8662 value to a @code{struct} member:
8663
8664 @smallexample
8665 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
8666 @end smallexample
8667
8668 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
8669 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
8670 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
8671 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
8672 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
8673 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
8674
8675 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
8676 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
8677 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
8678 frame makes no difference.
8679
8680 @node Floating Point Hardware
8681 @section Floating Point Hardware
8682 @cindex floating point
8683
8684 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
8685 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
8686
8687 @table @code
8688 @kindex info float
8689 @item info float
8690 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
8691 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
8692 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
8693 the ARM and x86 machines.
8694 @end table
8695
8696 @node Vector Unit
8697 @section Vector Unit
8698 @cindex vector unit
8699
8700 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
8701 more information about the status of the vector unit.
8702
8703 @table @code
8704 @kindex info vector
8705 @item info vector
8706 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
8707 layout vary depending on the hardware.
8708 @end table
8709
8710 @node OS Information
8711 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
8712 @cindex OS information
8713
8714 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
8715 you debug your program.
8716
8717 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
8718 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
8719 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
8720 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
8721 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
8722 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
8723 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
8724 structure.
8725
8726 @table @code
8727 @item info udot
8728 @kindex info udot
8729 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
8730 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
8731 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
8732 the @code{examine} command.
8733 @end table
8734
8735 @cindex auxiliary vector
8736 @cindex vector, auxiliary
8737 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
8738 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
8739 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
8740 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
8741 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
8742 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
8743 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
8744 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
8745 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
8746 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
8747 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
8748
8749 @table @code
8750 @kindex info auxv
8751 @item info auxv
8752 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
8753 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
8754 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
8755 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
8756 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
8757 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
8758 an unrecognized tag.
8759 @end table
8760
8761 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating-system-specific information
8762 and display it to user, without interpretation. For remote targets,
8763 this functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
8764 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
8765
8766 @table @code
8767 @kindex info os
8768 @item info os
8769 List the types of OS information available for the target. If the
8770 target does not return a list of possible types, this command will
8771 report an error.
8772
8773 @kindex info os processes
8774 @item info os processes
8775 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
8776 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, and
8777 the command corresponding to the process.
8778 @end table
8779
8780 @node Memory Region Attributes
8781 @section Memory Region Attributes
8782 @cindex memory region attributes
8783
8784 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
8785 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
8786 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
8787 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
8788 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
8789 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
8790 user can override the fetched regions.
8791
8792 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
8793 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
8794 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
8795 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
8796 all memory.
8797
8798 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
8799 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
8800
8801 @table @code
8802 @kindex mem
8803 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
8804 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
8805 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
8806 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
8807 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
8808 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
8809
8810 @item mem auto
8811 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
8812 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
8813
8814 @kindex delete mem
8815 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8816 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
8817 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
8818
8819 @kindex disable mem
8820 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8821 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
8822 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
8823 It may be enabled again later.
8824
8825 @kindex enable mem
8826 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8827 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
8828
8829 @kindex info mem
8830 @item info mem
8831 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
8832 for each region:
8833
8834 @table @emph
8835 @item Memory Region Number
8836 @item Enabled or Disabled.
8837 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
8838 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
8839
8840 @item Lo Address
8841 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
8842
8843 @item Hi Address
8844 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
8845
8846 @item Attributes
8847 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
8848 @end table
8849 @end table
8850
8851
8852 @subsection Attributes
8853
8854 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
8855 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
8856 write accesses to a memory region.
8857
8858 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
8859 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
8860 etc.@: from accessing memory.
8861
8862 @table @code
8863 @item ro
8864 Memory is read only.
8865 @item wo
8866 Memory is write only.
8867 @item rw
8868 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
8869 @end table
8870
8871 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
8872 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
8873 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
8874 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
8875 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
8876
8877 @table @code
8878 @item 8
8879 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
8880 @item 16
8881 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
8882 @item 32
8883 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
8884 @item 64
8885 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
8886 @end table
8887
8888 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
8889 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
8890 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
8891 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
8892 @c
8893 @c @table @code
8894 @c @item hwbreak
8895 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
8896 @c @item swbreak (default)
8897 @c @end table
8898
8899 @subsubsection Data Cache
8900 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
8901 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
8902 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
8903 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
8904 registers.
8905
8906 @table @code
8907 @item cache
8908 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
8909 @item nocache
8910 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
8911 @end table
8912
8913 @subsection Memory Access Checking
8914 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
8915 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
8916 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
8917 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
8918
8919 @table @code
8920 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
8921 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
8922 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
8923 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
8924 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
8925 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
8926 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
8927 The default value is @code{on}.
8928 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
8929 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
8930 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
8931 @end table
8932
8933
8934 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
8935 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
8936 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
8937 @c
8938 @c @table @code
8939 @c @item verify
8940 @c @item noverify (default)
8941 @c @end table
8942
8943 @node Dump/Restore Files
8944 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
8945 @cindex dump/restore files
8946 @cindex append data to a file
8947 @cindex dump data to a file
8948 @cindex restore data from a file
8949
8950 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
8951 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
8952 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
8953 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
8954 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
8955 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
8956 files.
8957
8958 @table @code
8959
8960 @kindex dump
8961 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
8962 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
8963 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
8964 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
8965
8966 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
8967 @table @code
8968 @item binary
8969 Raw binary form.
8970 @item ihex
8971 Intel hex format.
8972 @item srec
8973 Motorola S-record format.
8974 @item tekhex
8975 Tektronix Hex format.
8976 @end table
8977
8978 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
8979 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
8980 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
8981 form.
8982
8983 @kindex append
8984 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
8985 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
8986 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
8987 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
8988 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
8989
8990 @kindex restore
8991 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
8992 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
8993 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
8994 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
8995 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
8996
8997 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
8998 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
8999 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
9000 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
9001 from that location.
9002
9003 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
9004 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
9005 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
9006 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
9007
9008 @end table
9009
9010 @node Core File Generation
9011 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
9012 @cindex dump core from inferior
9013
9014 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
9015 image of a running process and its process status (register values
9016 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
9017 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
9018 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
9019 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
9020 the post-mortem debugging mode.
9021
9022 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
9023 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
9024 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
9025
9026 @table @code
9027 @kindex gcore
9028 @kindex generate-core-file
9029 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
9030 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
9031 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
9032 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
9033 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
9034 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
9035
9036 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
9037 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
9038 @end table
9039
9040 @node Character Sets
9041 @section Character Sets
9042 @cindex character sets
9043 @cindex charset
9044 @cindex translating between character sets
9045 @cindex host character set
9046 @cindex target character set
9047
9048 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
9049 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
9050 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
9051 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
9052 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
9053 @dfn{target character set}.
9054
9055 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
9056 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
9057 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
9058 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
9059 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
9060 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
9061 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
9062 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
9063 character and string literals in expressions.
9064
9065 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
9066 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
9067 target-charset} command, described below.
9068
9069 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
9070 support:
9071
9072 @table @code
9073 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
9074 @kindex set target-charset
9075 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
9076 list of supported target character sets, type
9077 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
9078
9079 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
9080 @kindex set host-charset
9081 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
9082
9083 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
9084 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
9085 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
9086 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
9087 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
9088
9089 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
9090 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
9091 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
9092
9093 @item set charset @var{charset}
9094 @kindex set charset
9095 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
9096 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
9097 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
9098 for both host and target.
9099
9100 @item show charset
9101 @kindex show charset
9102 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
9103
9104 @item show host-charset
9105 @kindex show host-charset
9106 Show the name of the current host character set.
9107
9108 @item show target-charset
9109 @kindex show target-charset
9110 Show the name of the current target character set.
9111
9112 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
9113 @kindex set target-wide-charset
9114 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
9115 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
9116 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
9117 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
9118
9119 @item show target-wide-charset
9120 @kindex show target-wide-charset
9121 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
9122 @end table
9123
9124 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
9125 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
9126 @file{charset-test.c}:
9127
9128 @smallexample
9129 #include <stdio.h>
9130
9131 char ascii_hello[]
9132 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
9133 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
9134 char ibm1047_hello[]
9135 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
9136 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
9137
9138 main ()
9139 @{
9140 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9141 @}
9142 @end smallexample
9143
9144 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
9145 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
9146 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
9147
9148 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
9149
9150 @smallexample
9151 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
9152 $ gdb -nw charset-test
9153 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
9154 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
9155 @dots{}
9156 (@value{GDBP})
9157 @end smallexample
9158
9159 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
9160 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
9161 strings:
9162
9163 @smallexample
9164 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
9165 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
9166 (@value{GDBP})
9167 @end smallexample
9168
9169 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
9170 initial character set:
9171 @smallexample
9172 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
9173 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
9174 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
9175 (@value{GDBP})
9176 @end smallexample
9177
9178 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
9179 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
9180 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
9181 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
9182 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
9183
9184 @smallexample
9185 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
9186 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
9187 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
9188 $2 = 72 'H'
9189 (@value{GDBP})
9190 @end smallexample
9191
9192 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
9193 literals you use in expressions:
9194
9195 @smallexample
9196 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
9197 $3 = 43 '+'
9198 (@value{GDBP})
9199 @end smallexample
9200
9201 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
9202 character.
9203
9204 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
9205 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
9206 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
9207
9208 @smallexample
9209 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
9210 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
9211 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
9212 $5 = 200 '\310'
9213 (@value{GDBP})
9214 @end smallexample
9215
9216 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
9217 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
9218
9219 @smallexample
9220 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
9221 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
9222 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
9223 @end smallexample
9224
9225 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
9226 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
9227 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
9228 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
9229 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
9230
9231 @smallexample
9232 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
9233 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
9234 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
9235 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
9236 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
9237 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
9238 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
9239 $7 = 72 '\110'
9240 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
9241 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
9242 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
9243 $9 = 200 'H'
9244 (@value{GDBP})
9245 @end smallexample
9246
9247 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
9248 string literals you use in expressions:
9249
9250 @smallexample
9251 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
9252 $10 = 78 '+'
9253 (@value{GDBP})
9254 @end smallexample
9255
9256 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
9257 character.
9258
9259 @node Caching Remote Data
9260 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
9261 @cindex caching data of remote targets
9262
9263 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a
9264 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
9265 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
9266 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately, simply
9267 caching everything would lead to incorrect results, since @value{GDBN}
9268 does not necessarily know anything about volatile values, memory-mapped I/O
9269 addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode})
9270 memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command is executing.
9271 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
9272 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
9273 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
9274 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
9275 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.}.
9276 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
9277 cacheable; see @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
9278
9279 @table @code
9280 @kindex set remotecache
9281 @item set remotecache on
9282 @itemx set remotecache off
9283 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
9284 with old scripts.
9285
9286 @kindex show remotecache
9287 @item show remotecache
9288 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
9289
9290 @kindex set stack-cache
9291 @item set stack-cache on
9292 @itemx set stack-cache off
9293 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{ON}, use
9294 caching. By default, this option is @code{ON}.
9295
9296 @kindex show stack-cache
9297 @item show stack-cache
9298 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
9299
9300 @kindex info dcache
9301 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
9302 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
9303 information displayed includes the dcache width and depth, and for
9304 each cache line, its number, address, and how many times it was
9305 referenced. This command is useful for debugging the data cache
9306 operation.
9307
9308 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
9309 printed in hex.
9310 @end table
9311
9312 @node Searching Memory
9313 @section Search Memory
9314 @cindex searching memory
9315
9316 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
9317 @code{find} command.
9318
9319 @table @code
9320 @kindex find
9321 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
9322 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
9323 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
9324 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
9325 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
9326 @end table
9327
9328 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
9329 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
9330
9331 @table @r
9332 @item @var{s}, search query size
9333 The size of each search query value.
9334
9335 @table @code
9336 @item b
9337 bytes
9338 @item h
9339 halfwords (two bytes)
9340 @item w
9341 words (four bytes)
9342 @item g
9343 giant words (eight bytes)
9344 @end table
9345
9346 All values are interpreted in the current language.
9347 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
9348 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
9349
9350 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
9351 value's type in the current language.
9352 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
9353 pattern as a mixture of types.
9354 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
9355 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
9356 which is typically four bytes.
9357
9358 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
9359 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
9360 @end table
9361
9362 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
9363 (@code{"}).
9364 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
9365 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
9366
9367 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
9368 number of matches found.
9369
9370 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
9371 @samp{$_}.
9372 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
9373
9374 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
9375
9376 @smallexample
9377 void
9378 hello ()
9379 @{
9380 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
9381 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
9382 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
9383 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
9384 printf ("%s\n", hello);
9385 @}
9386 @end smallexample
9387
9388 @noindent
9389 you get during debugging:
9390
9391 @smallexample
9392 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
9393 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
9394 1 pattern found
9395 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
9396 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
9397 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
9398 2 patterns found
9399 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
9400 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
9401 1 pattern found
9402 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
9403 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
9404 1 pattern found
9405 (gdb) print $numfound
9406 $1 = 1
9407 (gdb) print $_
9408 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
9409 @end smallexample
9410
9411 @node Optimized Code
9412 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
9413 @cindex optimized code, debugging
9414 @cindex debugging optimized code
9415
9416 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
9417 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
9418 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
9419 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
9420 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
9421 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
9422 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
9423
9424 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
9425 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
9426 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
9427 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
9428
9429 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
9430 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
9431 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
9432 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
9433 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
9434 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
9435
9436 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
9437 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
9438 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
9439 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
9440 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
9441
9442 @menu
9443 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
9444 @end menu
9445
9446 @node Inline Functions
9447 @section Inline Functions
9448 @cindex inline functions, debugging
9449
9450 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
9451 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
9452 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
9453 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
9454 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
9455 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
9456 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
9457 @code{info frame} command.
9458
9459 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
9460 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
9461 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
9462 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
9463 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
9464 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
9465 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
9466 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
9467 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
9468 local variables in the caller.
9469
9470 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
9471 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
9472 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
9473 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
9474 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
9475 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
9476 instructions are executed.
9477
9478 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
9479 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
9480 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
9481 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
9482
9483 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
9484 function calls are the same as normal calls:
9485
9486 @itemize @bullet
9487 @item
9488 You cannot set breakpoints on inlined functions. @value{GDBN}
9489 either reports that there is no symbol with that name, or else sets the
9490 breakpoint only on non-inlined copies of the function. This limitation
9491 will be removed in a future version of @value{GDBN}; until then,
9492 set a breakpoint by line number on the first line of the inlined
9493 function instead.
9494
9495 @item
9496 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
9497 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
9498 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
9499 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
9500 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
9501 or inside the inlined function instead.
9502
9503 @item
9504 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
9505 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
9506 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
9507 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
9508
9509 @end itemize
9510
9511
9512 @node Macros
9513 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
9514
9515 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
9516 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
9517 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
9518 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
9519 where it was defined.
9520
9521 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
9522 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
9523 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
9524 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
9525
9526 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
9527 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
9528 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
9529 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
9530 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
9531 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
9532 see @ref{List}.
9533
9534 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
9535 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
9536 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
9537
9538 @table @code
9539
9540 @kindex macro expand
9541 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
9542 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
9543 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
9544 @item macro expand @var{expression}
9545 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
9546 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
9547 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
9548 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
9549 it can be any string of tokens.
9550
9551 @kindex macro exp1
9552 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
9553 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
9554 @cindex expand macro once
9555 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
9556 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
9557 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
9558 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
9559 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
9560 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
9561 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
9562 can be any string of tokens.
9563
9564 @kindex info macro
9565 @cindex macro definition, showing
9566 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
9567 @item info macro @var{macro}
9568 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
9569 source location or compiler command-line where that definition was established.
9570
9571 @kindex macro define
9572 @cindex user-defined macros
9573 @cindex defining macros interactively
9574 @cindex macros, user-defined
9575 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
9576 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
9577 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
9578 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
9579 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
9580 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
9581 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
9582 @var{arglist}.
9583
9584 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
9585 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
9586 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
9587 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
9588 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
9589
9590 @kindex macro undef
9591 @item macro undef @var{macro}
9592 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
9593 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
9594 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
9595 in the program being debugged.
9596
9597 @kindex macro list
9598 @item macro list
9599 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
9600 @end table
9601
9602 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
9603 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
9604 show our source files:
9605
9606 @smallexample
9607 $ cat sample.c
9608 #include <stdio.h>
9609 #include "sample.h"
9610
9611 #define M 42
9612 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
9613
9614 main ()
9615 @{
9616 #define N 28
9617 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9618 #undef N
9619 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9620 #define N 1729
9621 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
9622 @}
9623 $ cat sample.h
9624 #define Q <
9625 $
9626 @end smallexample
9627
9628 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
9629 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
9630 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
9631 information.
9632
9633 @smallexample
9634 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
9635 $
9636 @end smallexample
9637
9638 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
9639
9640 @smallexample
9641 $ gdb -nw sample
9642 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
9643 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
9644 GDB is free software, @dots{}
9645 (@value{GDBP})
9646 @end smallexample
9647
9648 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
9649 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
9650 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
9651
9652 @smallexample
9653 (@value{GDBP}) list main
9654 3
9655 4 #define M 42
9656 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
9657 6
9658 7 main ()
9659 8 @{
9660 9 #define N 28
9661 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9662 11 #undef N
9663 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9664 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
9665 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
9666 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
9667 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
9668 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
9669 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
9670 #define Q <
9671 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
9672 expands to: (42 + 1)
9673 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
9674 expands to: once (M + 1)
9675 (@value{GDBP})
9676 @end smallexample
9677
9678 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
9679 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
9680 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
9681 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
9682
9683 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
9684 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
9685
9686 @smallexample
9687 (@value{GDBP}) break main
9688 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
9689 (@value{GDBP}) run
9690 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
9691
9692 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
9693 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9694 (@value{GDBP})
9695 @end smallexample
9696
9697 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
9698
9699 @smallexample
9700 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9701 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
9702 #define N 28
9703 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
9704 expands to: 28 < 42
9705 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
9706 $1 = 1
9707 (@value{GDBP})
9708 @end smallexample
9709
9710 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
9711 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
9712 thereof) in force at each point:
9713
9714 @smallexample
9715 (@value{GDBP}) next
9716 Hello, world!
9717 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9718 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9719 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
9720 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
9721 (@value{GDBP}) next
9722 We're so creative.
9723 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
9724 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9725 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
9726 #define N 1729
9727 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
9728 expands to: 1729 < 42
9729 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
9730 $2 = 0
9731 (@value{GDBP})
9732 @end smallexample
9733
9734 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
9735 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
9736 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
9737 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
9738
9739 @smallexample
9740 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
9741 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
9742 -D__STDC__=1
9743 (@value{GDBP})
9744 @end smallexample
9745
9746
9747 @node Tracepoints
9748 @chapter Tracepoints
9749 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
9750 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
9751
9752 @cindex tracepoints
9753 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
9754 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
9755 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
9756 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
9757 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
9758 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
9759 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
9760
9761 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
9762 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
9763 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
9764 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
9765 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
9766 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
9767 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
9768 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
9769 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
9770 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
9771 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
9772
9773 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
9774 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
9775 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
9776 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
9777 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
9778 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
9779 Packets}.
9780
9781 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
9782 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
9783 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
9784
9785 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
9786
9787 @menu
9788 * Set Tracepoints::
9789 * Analyze Collected Data::
9790 * Tracepoint Variables::
9791 * Trace Files::
9792 @end menu
9793
9794 @node Set Tracepoints
9795 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
9796
9797 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
9798 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
9799 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
9800 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
9801 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
9802 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
9803 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
9804
9805 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
9806 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
9807 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
9808 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
9809 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
9810 tracepoint was hit.
9811
9812 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
9813 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
9814 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
9815 either.
9816
9817 @cindex fast tracepoints
9818 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
9819 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
9820 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
9821
9822 @cindex static tracepoints
9823 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
9824 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
9825 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
9826 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
9827 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
9828 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
9829 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
9830 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
9831 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
9832 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
9833 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
9834 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
9835 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
9836 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
9837 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
9838 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
9839 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
9840 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
9841 static tracepoint marker.
9842
9843 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
9844 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
9845
9846 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
9847 conditions and actions.
9848
9849 @menu
9850 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
9851 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
9852 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
9853 * Tracepoint Conditions::
9854 * Trace State Variables::
9855 * Tracepoint Actions::
9856 * Listing Tracepoints::
9857 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
9858 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
9859 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
9860 @end menu
9861
9862 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
9863 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
9864
9865 @table @code
9866 @cindex set tracepoint
9867 @kindex trace
9868 @item trace @var{location}
9869 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
9870 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
9871 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
9872 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
9873 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
9874 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
9875 changing its actions doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
9876 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
9877 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts.
9878
9879 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
9880
9881 @smallexample
9882 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
9883
9884 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
9885
9886 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
9887
9888 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
9889
9890 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
9891 @end smallexample
9892
9893 @noindent
9894 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
9895
9896 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
9897 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
9898 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
9899 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
9900 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
9901 information on tracepoint conditions.
9902
9903 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
9904 @cindex set fast tracepoint
9905 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
9906 @kindex ftrace
9907 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
9908 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
9909 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
9910 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
9911 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
9912 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
9913 message.
9914
9915 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
9916 @code{trace}.
9917
9918 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
9919 @cindex set static tracepoint
9920 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
9921 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
9922 @kindex strace
9923 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
9924 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
9925 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
9926 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
9927 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
9928
9929 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
9930 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
9931 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
9932 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
9933 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
9934 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
9935 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
9936 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
9937 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
9938 tracing engine:
9939
9940 @smallexample
9941 main ()
9942 @{
9943 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
9944 @}
9945 @end smallexample
9946
9947 @noindent
9948 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
9949 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
9950
9951 @smallexample
9952 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
9953 Cnt Enb ID Address What
9954 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
9955 Data: "str %s"
9956 [etc...]
9957 @end smallexample
9958
9959 @noindent
9960 so you may probe the marker above with:
9961
9962 @smallexample
9963 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
9964 @end smallexample
9965
9966 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
9967 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
9968 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
9969 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
9970 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
9971 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
9972 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
9973 the @samp{Data:} field.
9974
9975 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
9976 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
9977 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
9978
9979 @vindex $tpnum
9980 @cindex last tracepoint number
9981 @cindex recent tracepoint number
9982 @cindex tracepoint number
9983 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
9984 of the most recently set tracepoint.
9985
9986 @kindex delete tracepoint
9987 @cindex tracepoint deletion
9988 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9989 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
9990 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
9991 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
9992
9993 Examples:
9994
9995 @smallexample
9996 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
9997
9998 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
9999 @end smallexample
10000
10001 @noindent
10002 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
10003 @end table
10004
10005 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
10006 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
10007
10008 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
10009
10010 @table @code
10011 @kindex disable tracepoint
10012 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
10013 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
10014 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
10015 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
10016 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
10017
10018 @kindex enable tracepoint
10019 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
10020 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
10021 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
10022 run.
10023 @end table
10024
10025 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
10026 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
10027
10028 @table @code
10029 @kindex passcount
10030 @cindex tracepoint pass count
10031 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
10032 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
10033 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
10034 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
10035 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
10036 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
10037 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
10038 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
10039 user.
10040
10041 Examples:
10042
10043 @smallexample
10044 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
10045 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
10046
10047 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
10048 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
10049 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
10050 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
10051 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
10052 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
10053 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
10054 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
10055 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
10056 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
10057 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
10058 @end smallexample
10059 @end table
10060
10061 @node Tracepoint Conditions
10062 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
10063 @cindex conditional tracepoints
10064 @cindex tracepoint conditions
10065
10066 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
10067 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
10068 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
10069 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
10070 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
10071 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
10072 is true.
10073
10074 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
10075 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
10076 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
10077 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
10078 just as with breakpoints.
10079
10080 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
10081 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
10082 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
10083 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
10084 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
10085 accesses, and so forth.
10086
10087 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
10088 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
10089 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
10090 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
10091 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
10092 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
10093 search through.
10094
10095 @smallexample
10096 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
10097 @end smallexample
10098
10099 @node Trace State Variables
10100 @subsection Trace State Variables
10101 @cindex trace state variables
10102
10103 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
10104 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
10105 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
10106 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
10107 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
10108 integers.
10109
10110 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
10111 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
10112 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
10113 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
10114
10115 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
10116 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
10117 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
10118 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
10119 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
10120 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
10121 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
10122 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
10123 variable with the same name.
10124
10125 @table @code
10126
10127 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
10128 @kindex tvariable
10129 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
10130 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
10131 @var{expression}. @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
10132 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
10133 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
10134 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
10135 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
10136 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
10137 value. The default initial value is 0.
10138
10139 @item info tvariables
10140 @kindex info tvariables
10141 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
10142 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
10143 currently running.
10144
10145 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
10146 @kindex delete tvariable
10147 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
10148 are specified.
10149
10150 @end table
10151
10152 @node Tracepoint Actions
10153 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
10154
10155 @table @code
10156 @kindex actions
10157 @cindex tracepoint actions
10158 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
10159 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
10160 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
10161 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
10162 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
10163 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
10164 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
10165 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
10166 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
10167 @code{while-stepping}.
10168
10169 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
10170 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
10171 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
10172
10173 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
10174 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
10175 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
10176
10177 @smallexample
10178 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
10179
10180 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
10181
10182 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
10183 @end smallexample
10184
10185 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
10186 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
10187 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
10188 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
10189 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
10190 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
10191 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
10192 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
10193
10194 @smallexample
10195 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
10196 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
10197 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
10198 > collect bar,baz
10199 > collect $regs
10200 > while-stepping 12
10201 > collect $pc, arr[i]
10202 > end
10203 end
10204 @end smallexample
10205
10206 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
10207 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
10208 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
10209 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
10210 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
10211 special arguments are supported:
10212
10213 @table @code
10214 @item $regs
10215 Collect all registers.
10216
10217 @item $args
10218 Collect all function arguments.
10219
10220 @item $locals
10221 Collect all local variables.
10222
10223 @item $_sdata
10224 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
10225 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
10226 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
10227 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
10228 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
10229 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
10230 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
10231 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
10232 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
10233
10234 @smallexample
10235 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
10236 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
10237 @end smallexample
10238
10239 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
10240 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
10241 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
10242 @value{GDBN}.
10243 @end table
10244
10245 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
10246 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
10247 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
10248
10249 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
10250 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
10251
10252 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
10253 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
10254 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
10255 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
10256 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
10257 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
10258 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
10259 action were used.
10260
10261 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
10262 @item while-stepping @var{n}
10263 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
10264 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
10265 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
10266 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
10267
10268 @smallexample
10269 > while-stepping 12
10270 > collect $regs, myglobal
10271 > end
10272 >
10273 @end smallexample
10274
10275 @noindent
10276 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
10277 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
10278 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
10279 @code{stepping}.
10280
10281 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
10282 @kindex set default-collect
10283 @cindex default collection action
10284 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
10285 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
10286 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
10287 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
10288 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
10289 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
10290
10291 @item show default-collect
10292 @kindex show default-collect
10293 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
10294 tracepoint hit.
10295
10296 @end table
10297
10298 @node Listing Tracepoints
10299 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
10300
10301 @table @code
10302 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
10303 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
10304 @cindex information about tracepoints
10305 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
10306 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
10307 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
10308 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
10309 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
10310 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
10311
10312 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
10313 tracing:
10314
10315 @itemize @bullet
10316 @item
10317 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
10318 @end itemize
10319
10320 @smallexample
10321 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
10322 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
10323 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
10324 while-stepping 20
10325 collect globfoo, $regs
10326 end
10327 collect globfoo2
10328 end
10329 pass count 1200
10330 (@value{GDBP})
10331 @end smallexample
10332
10333 @noindent
10334 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
10335 @end table
10336
10337 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
10338 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
10339
10340 @table @code
10341 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
10342 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
10343 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
10344 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
10345 program.
10346
10347 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
10348
10349 @table @emph
10350 @item Count
10351 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
10352 stable identifier.
10353 @item ID
10354 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
10355 @item Enabled or Disabled
10356 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
10357 that are not enabled.
10358 @item Address
10359 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
10360 @item What
10361 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
10362 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
10363 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
10364 will be left blank.
10365 @end table
10366
10367 @noindent
10368 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
10369
10370 @table @emph
10371 @item Data
10372 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
10373 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
10374 marker call.
10375 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
10376 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
10377 @end table
10378
10379 @smallexample
10380 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
10381 Cnt ID Enb Address What
10382 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
10383 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
10384 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
10385 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
10386 Data: str %s
10387 (@value{GDBP})
10388 @end smallexample
10389 @end table
10390
10391 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
10392 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
10393
10394 @table @code
10395 @kindex tstart
10396 @cindex start a new trace experiment
10397 @cindex collected data discarded
10398 @item tstart
10399 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
10400 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
10401 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
10402 experiment.
10403
10404 @kindex tstop
10405 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
10406 @item tstop
10407 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
10408 stops collecting data.
10409
10410 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
10411 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
10412 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
10413
10414 @kindex tstatus
10415 @cindex status of trace data collection
10416 @cindex trace experiment, status of
10417 @item tstatus
10418 This command displays the status of the current trace data
10419 collection.
10420 @end table
10421
10422 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
10423
10424 @smallexample
10425 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
10426 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
10427 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
10428 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
10429 > while-stepping 11
10430 > collect $regs
10431 > end
10432 > end
10433 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
10434 [time passes @dots{}]
10435 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
10436 @end smallexample
10437
10438 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
10439 @cindex disconnected tracing
10440 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
10441 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
10442 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
10443 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
10444 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
10445 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
10446 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
10447 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
10448
10449 @table @code
10450 @item set disconnected-tracing on
10451 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
10452 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
10453 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
10454 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
10455 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
10456 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
10457 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
10458
10459 @item show disconnected-tracing
10460 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
10461 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
10462
10463 @end table
10464
10465 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
10466 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
10467 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
10468 it will continue after reconnection.
10469
10470 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
10471 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
10472 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
10473 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
10474 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
10475 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
10476 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
10477 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
10478 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
10479 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
10480
10481 @cindex circular trace buffer
10482 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
10483 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
10484 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
10485 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
10486 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
10487 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
10488 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
10489 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
10490 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
10491 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
10492 the next run.
10493
10494 @table @code
10495 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
10496 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
10497 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
10498 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
10499 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
10500 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
10501 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
10502
10503 @item show circular-trace-buffer
10504 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
10505 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
10506 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
10507 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
10508 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
10509
10510 @end table
10511
10512 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
10513 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
10514
10515 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
10516 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
10517 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
10518 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
10519 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
10520 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
10521 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
10522 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
10523 mentioned here.
10524
10525 @itemize @bullet
10526
10527 @item
10528 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
10529 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
10530 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
10531 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
10532 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
10533 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
10534 cannot be collected either.
10535
10536 @item
10537 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
10538 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
10539 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
10540 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
10541 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
10542 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
10543 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
10544 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
10545 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
10546 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
10547
10548 @item
10549 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
10550 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
10551 in a misleading way.
10552
10553 @item
10554 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
10555 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
10556 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
10557 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
10558 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
10559 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
10560 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
10561 by @code{ptr}.
10562
10563 @item
10564 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
10565 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
10566 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*$esp@@300}
10567 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
10568 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
10569 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
10570 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
10571 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
10572 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
10573 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
10574 invalid address.
10575
10576 @item
10577 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
10578 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
10579 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
10580 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
10581 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
10582 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
10583 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
10584 it to zero.
10585
10586 @end itemize
10587
10588 @node Analyze Collected Data
10589 @section Using the Collected Data
10590
10591 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
10592 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
10593 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
10594 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
10595 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
10596 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
10597 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
10598 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
10599 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
10600 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
10601 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
10602 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
10603 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
10604 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
10605 the buffer will fail.
10606
10607 @menu
10608 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
10609 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
10610 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
10611 @end menu
10612
10613 @node tfind
10614 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
10615
10616 @kindex tfind
10617 @cindex select trace snapshot
10618 @cindex find trace snapshot
10619 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
10620 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
10621 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
10622 snapshot is selected.
10623
10624 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
10625
10626 @table @code
10627 @item tfind start
10628 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
10629 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
10630
10631 @item tfind none
10632 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
10633
10634 @item tfind end
10635 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
10636
10637 @item tfind
10638 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
10639
10640 @item tfind -
10641 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
10642 retracing earlier steps.
10643
10644 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
10645 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
10646 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
10647 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
10648 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
10649
10650 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
10651 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
10652 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
10653 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
10654 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
10655
10656 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
10657 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
10658 addresses (exclusive).
10659
10660 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
10661 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
10662 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
10663
10664 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
10665 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
10666 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
10667 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
10668 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
10669 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
10670 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
10671 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
10672 @end table
10673
10674 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
10675 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
10676 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
10677 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
10678 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
10679 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
10680 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
10681 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
10682 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
10683 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
10684 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
10685 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
10686 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
10687 tracepoint as the current one.
10688
10689 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
10690 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
10691 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
10692 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
10693 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
10694
10695 @smallexample
10696 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
10697 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
10698 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
10699 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
10700 > tfind
10701 > end
10702
10703 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
10704 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
10705 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
10706 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
10707 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
10708 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
10709 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
10710 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
10711 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
10712 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
10713 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
10714 @end smallexample
10715
10716 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
10717 the buffer:
10718
10719 @smallexample
10720 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
10721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
10722 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
10723 > tfind line
10724 > end
10725
10726 Frame 0, X = 1
10727 Frame 7, X = 2
10728 Frame 13, X = 255
10729 @end smallexample
10730
10731 @node tdump
10732 @subsection @code{tdump}
10733 @kindex tdump
10734 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
10735 @cindex tracepoint data, display
10736
10737 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
10738 the current trace snapshot.
10739
10740 @smallexample
10741 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
10742 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
10743 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
10744 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
10745 > end
10746
10747 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
10748
10749 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
10750 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
10751 at gdb_test.c:444
10752 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
10753
10754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
10755 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
10756 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
10757 d1 0x18 24
10758 d2 0x80 128
10759 d3 0x33 51
10760 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
10761 d5 0x22 34
10762 d6 0xe0 224
10763 d7 0x380035 3670069
10764 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
10765 a1 0x3000668 50333288
10766 a2 0x100 256
10767 a3 0x322000 3284992
10768 a4 0x3000698 50333336
10769 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
10770 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
10771 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
10772 ps 0x0 0
10773 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
10774 fpcontrol 0x0 0
10775 fpstatus 0x0 0
10776 fpiaddr 0x0 0
10777 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
10778 p1 = (void *) 0x11
10779 p2 = (void *) 0x22
10780 p3 = (void *) 0x33
10781 p4 = (void *) 0x44
10782 p5 = (void *) 0x55
10783 p6 = (void *) 0x66
10784 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
10785
10786 (@value{GDBP})
10787 @end smallexample
10788
10789 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
10790 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
10791 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
10792 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
10793
10794 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
10795 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
10796 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
10797 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
10798 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
10799 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
10800 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
10801 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
10802 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
10803 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
10804
10805 @node save tracepoints
10806 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
10807 @kindex save tracepoints
10808 @kindex save-tracepoints
10809 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
10810
10811 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
10812 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
10813 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
10814 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
10815 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
10816 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
10817
10818 @node Tracepoint Variables
10819 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
10820 @cindex tracepoint variables
10821 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
10822
10823 @table @code
10824 @vindex $trace_frame
10825 @item (int) $trace_frame
10826 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
10827 snapshot is selected.
10828
10829 @vindex $tracepoint
10830 @item (int) $tracepoint
10831 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
10832
10833 @vindex $trace_line
10834 @item (int) $trace_line
10835 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
10836
10837 @vindex $trace_file
10838 @item (char []) $trace_file
10839 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
10840
10841 @vindex $trace_func
10842 @item (char []) $trace_func
10843 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
10844 @end table
10845
10846 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
10847 use @code{output} instead.
10848
10849 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
10850 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
10851 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
10852 which are managed by the target.
10853
10854 @smallexample
10855 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
10856
10857 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
10858 > output $trace_file
10859 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
10860 > tfind
10861 > end
10862 @end smallexample
10863
10864 @node Trace Files
10865 @section Using Trace Files
10866 @cindex trace files
10867
10868 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
10869 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
10870 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
10871 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
10872 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
10873
10874 @table @code
10875
10876 @kindex tsave
10877 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
10878 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
10879 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
10880 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
10881 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
10882 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
10883 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
10884 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
10885 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
10886
10887 @kindex target tfile
10888 @kindex tfile
10889 @item target tfile @var{filename}
10890 Use the file named @var{filename} as a source of trace data. Commands
10891 that examine data work as they do with a live target, but it is not
10892 possible to run any new trace experiments. @code{tstatus} will report
10893 the state of the trace run at the moment the data was saved, as well
10894 as the current trace frame you are examining. @var{filename} must be
10895 on a filesystem accessible to the host.
10896
10897 @end table
10898
10899 @node Overlays
10900 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
10901 @cindex overlays
10902
10903 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
10904 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
10905 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
10906 use overlays.
10907
10908 @menu
10909 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
10910 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
10911 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
10912 mapped by asking the inferior.
10913 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
10914 @end menu
10915
10916 @node How Overlays Work
10917 @section How Overlays Work
10918 @cindex mapped overlays
10919 @cindex unmapped overlays
10920 @cindex load address, overlay's
10921 @cindex mapped address
10922 @cindex overlay area
10923
10924 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
10925 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
10926 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
10927 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
10928 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
10929
10930 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
10931 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
10932 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
10933 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
10934 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
10935 largest overlay as well.
10936
10937 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
10938 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
10939 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
10940 there.
10941
10942 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
10943 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
10944 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
10945
10946 @smallexample
10947 @group
10948 Data Instruction Larger
10949 Address Space Address Space Address Space
10950 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
10951 | | | | | |
10952 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
10953 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
10954 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
10955 | and heap | | | | | |
10956 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
10957 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
10958 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
10959 | | | | | |
10960 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
10961 address | | | | | |
10962 | overlay | <-' | | |
10963 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
10964 | | <---. | | load address
10965 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
10966 | | | |
10967 +-----------+ | |
10968 +-----------+
10969 | |
10970 +-----------+
10971
10972 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
10973 @end group
10974 @end smallexample
10975
10976 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
10977 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
10978 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
10979 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
10980 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
10981 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
10982 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
10983 program and the overlay area.
10984
10985 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
10986 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
10987 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
10988 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
10989 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
10990 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
10991 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
10992
10993 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
10994 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
10995 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
10996
10997 @itemize @bullet
10998
10999 @item
11000 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
11001 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
11002 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
11003 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
11004
11005 @item
11006 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
11007 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
11008 your program's performance.
11009
11010 @item
11011 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
11012 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
11013 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
11014 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
11015 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
11016 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
11017 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
11018
11019 @item
11020 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
11021 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
11022 instruction and data spaces.
11023
11024 @end itemize
11025
11026 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
11027 improved in many ways:
11028
11029 @itemize @bullet
11030
11031 @item
11032 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
11033 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
11034 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
11035 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
11036 area in the usual way.
11037
11038 @item
11039 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
11040 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
11041
11042 @item
11043 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
11044 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
11045 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
11046 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
11047 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
11048 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
11049 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
11050
11051 @end itemize
11052
11053
11054 @node Overlay Commands
11055 @section Overlay Commands
11056
11057 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
11058 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
11059 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
11060 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
11061 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
11062 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
11063
11064 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
11065 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
11066
11067 @table @code
11068 @item overlay off
11069 @kindex overlay
11070 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
11071 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
11072 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
11073 overlay support is disabled.
11074
11075 @item overlay manual
11076 @cindex manual overlay debugging
11077 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
11078 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
11079 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
11080 commands described below.
11081
11082 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
11083 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
11084 @cindex map an overlay
11085 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
11086 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
11087 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
11088 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
11089 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
11090 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
11091
11092 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
11093 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
11094 @cindex unmap an overlay
11095 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
11096 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
11097 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
11098 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
11099
11100 @item overlay auto
11101 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
11102 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
11103 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
11104 Overlay Debugging}.
11105
11106 @item overlay load-target
11107 @itemx overlay load
11108 @cindex reloading the overlay table
11109 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
11110 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
11111 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
11112 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
11113 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
11114
11115 @item overlay list-overlays
11116 @itemx overlay list
11117 @cindex listing mapped overlays
11118 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
11119 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
11120
11121 @end table
11122
11123 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
11124 of the function the address falls in:
11125
11126 @smallexample
11127 (@value{GDBP}) print main
11128 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
11129 @end smallexample
11130 @noindent
11131 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
11132 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
11133 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
11134 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
11135
11136 @smallexample
11137 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
11138 No sections are mapped.
11139 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
11140 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
11141 @end smallexample
11142 @noindent
11143 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
11144 name normally:
11145
11146 @smallexample
11147 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
11148 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
11149 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
11150 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
11151 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
11152 @end smallexample
11153
11154 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
11155 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
11156 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
11157 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
11158 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
11159
11160 @itemize @bullet
11161 @item
11162 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
11163 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
11164 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
11165 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
11166 @item
11167 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
11168 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
11169 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
11170 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
11171 breakpoints properly.
11172 @end itemize
11173
11174
11175 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
11176 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
11177 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
11178
11179 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
11180 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
11181 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
11182 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
11183 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
11184 current state of the overlays.
11185
11186 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
11187 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
11188
11189 @table @asis
11190
11191 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
11192 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
11193
11194 @smallexample
11195 struct
11196 @{
11197 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
11198 unsigned long vma;
11199
11200 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
11201 unsigned long size;
11202
11203 /* The overlay's load address. */
11204 unsigned long lma;
11205
11206 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
11207 zero otherwise. */
11208 unsigned long mapped;
11209 @}
11210 @end smallexample
11211
11212 @item @code{_novlys}:
11213 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
11214 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
11215
11216 @end table
11217
11218 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
11219 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
11220 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
11221 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
11222 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
11223 currently mapped.
11224
11225 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
11226 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
11227 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
11228 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
11229 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
11230 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
11231 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
11232 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
11233 are not being executed.
11234
11235 @node Overlay Sample Program
11236 @section Overlay Sample Program
11237 @cindex overlay example program
11238
11239 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
11240 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
11241 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
11242 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
11243 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
11244 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
11245 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
11246
11247 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
11248 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
11249 suite. The program consists of the following files from
11250 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
11251
11252 @table @file
11253 @item overlays.c
11254 The main program file.
11255 @item ovlymgr.c
11256 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
11257 @item foo.c
11258 @itemx bar.c
11259 @itemx baz.c
11260 @itemx grbx.c
11261 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
11262 @item d10v.ld
11263 @itemx m32r.ld
11264 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
11265 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
11266 @end table
11267
11268 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
11269 cross-compiler like this:
11270
11271 @smallexample
11272 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
11273 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
11274 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
11275 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
11276 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
11277 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
11278 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
11279 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
11280 @end smallexample
11281
11282 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
11283 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
11284 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
11285
11286
11287 @node Languages
11288 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
11289 @cindex languages
11290
11291 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
11292 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
11293 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
11294 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
11295 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
11296 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
11297
11298 @cindex working language
11299 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
11300 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
11301 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
11302 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
11303 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
11304 language}.
11305
11306 @menu
11307 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
11308 * Show:: Displaying the language
11309 * Checks:: Type and range checks
11310 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
11311 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
11312 @end menu
11313
11314 @node Setting
11315 @section Switching Between Source Languages
11316
11317 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
11318 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
11319 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
11320 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
11321 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
11322 are printed, etc.
11323
11324 In addition to the working language, every source file that
11325 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
11326 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
11327 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
11328 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
11329 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
11330 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
11331 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
11332 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
11333 Displaying the Language}.
11334
11335 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
11336 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
11337 another language. In that case, make the
11338 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
11339 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
11340 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
11341
11342 @menu
11343 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
11344 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
11345 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
11346 @end menu
11347
11348 @node Filenames
11349 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
11350
11351 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
11352 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
11353
11354 @table @file
11355 @item .ada
11356 @itemx .ads
11357 @itemx .adb
11358 @itemx .a
11359 Ada source file.
11360
11361 @item .c
11362 C source file
11363
11364 @item .C
11365 @itemx .cc
11366 @itemx .cp
11367 @itemx .cpp
11368 @itemx .cxx
11369 @itemx .c++
11370 C@t{++} source file
11371
11372 @item .d
11373 D source file
11374
11375 @item .m
11376 Objective-C source file
11377
11378 @item .f
11379 @itemx .F
11380 Fortran source file
11381
11382 @item .mod
11383 Modula-2 source file
11384
11385 @item .s
11386 @itemx .S
11387 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
11388 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
11389 @end table
11390
11391 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
11392 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
11393
11394 @node Manually
11395 @subsection Setting the Working Language
11396
11397 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
11398 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
11399 your program.
11400
11401 @kindex set language
11402 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
11403 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
11404 a language, such as
11405 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
11406 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
11407
11408 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
11409 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
11410 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
11411 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
11412 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
11413 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
11414 command such as:
11415
11416 @smallexample
11417 print a = b + c
11418 @end smallexample
11419
11420 @noindent
11421 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
11422 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
11423 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
11424 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
11425
11426 @node Automatically
11427 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
11428
11429 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
11430 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
11431 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
11432 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
11433 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
11434 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
11435 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
11436 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
11437 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
11438
11439 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
11440 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
11441 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
11442 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
11443 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
11444
11445 @node Show
11446 @section Displaying the Language
11447
11448 The following commands help you find out which language is the
11449 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
11450
11451 @table @code
11452 @item show language
11453 @kindex show language
11454 Display the current working language. This is the
11455 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
11456 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
11457
11458 @item info frame
11459 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
11460 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
11461 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
11462 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
11463 information listed here.
11464
11465 @item info source
11466 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
11467 Display the source language of this source file.
11468 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
11469 information listed here.
11470 @end table
11471
11472 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
11473 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
11474 with a language explicitly:
11475
11476 @table @code
11477 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
11478 @kindex set extension-language
11479 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
11480 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
11481
11482 @item info extensions
11483 @kindex info extensions
11484 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
11485 @end table
11486
11487 @node Checks
11488 @section Type and Range Checking
11489
11490 @quotation
11491 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
11492 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
11493 section documents the intended facilities.
11494 @end quotation
11495 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
11496
11497 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
11498 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
11499 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
11500 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
11501 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
11502 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
11503 errors when your program is running.
11504
11505 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
11506 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
11507 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
11508 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
11509 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
11510 automatically based on your program's source language.
11511 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
11512 settings of supported languages.
11513
11514 @menu
11515 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
11516 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
11517 @end menu
11518
11519 @cindex type checking
11520 @cindex checks, type
11521 @node Type Checking
11522 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
11523
11524 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
11525 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
11526 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
11527 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
11528
11529 @smallexample
11530 1 + 2 @result{} 3
11531 @exdent but
11532 @error{} 1 + 2.3
11533 @end smallexample
11534
11535 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
11536 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
11537
11538 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
11539 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
11540 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
11541 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
11542 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
11543 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
11544 also issues a warning.
11545
11546 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
11547 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
11548 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
11549 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
11550 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
11551 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
11552
11553 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
11554 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
11555 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
11556 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
11557 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
11558 details on specific languages.
11559
11560 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
11561
11562 @kindex set check type
11563 @kindex show check type
11564 @table @code
11565 @item set check type auto
11566 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
11567 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
11568 each language.
11569
11570 @item set check type on
11571 @itemx set check type off
11572 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
11573 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
11574 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
11575 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
11576 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
11577
11578 @item set check type warn
11579 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
11580 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
11581 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
11582 numbers and structures.
11583
11584 @item show type
11585 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
11586 is setting it automatically.
11587 @end table
11588
11589 @cindex range checking
11590 @cindex checks, range
11591 @node Range Checking
11592 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
11593
11594 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
11595 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
11596 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
11597 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
11598 not exceed the bounds of the array.
11599
11600 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
11601 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
11602 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
11603 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
11604
11605 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
11606 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
11607 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
11608 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
11609 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
11610 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
11611
11612 @smallexample
11613 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
11614 @end smallexample
11615
11616 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
11617 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
11618 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
11619
11620 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
11621
11622 @kindex set check range
11623 @kindex show check range
11624 @table @code
11625 @item set check range auto
11626 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
11627 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
11628 each language.
11629
11630 @item set check range on
11631 @itemx set check range off
11632 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
11633 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
11634 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
11635 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
11636
11637 @item set check range warn
11638 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
11639 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
11640 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
11641 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
11642 systems).
11643
11644 @item show range
11645 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
11646 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
11647 @end table
11648
11649 @node Supported Languages
11650 @section Supported Languages
11651
11652 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, OpenCL C, Pascal,
11653 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
11654 @c This is false ...
11655 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
11656 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
11657 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
11658 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
11659 language.
11660
11661 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
11662 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
11663 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
11664 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
11665 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
11666 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
11667 language reference or tutorial.
11668
11669 @menu
11670 * C:: C and C@t{++}
11671 * D:: D
11672 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
11673 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
11674 * Fortran:: Fortran
11675 * Pascal:: Pascal
11676 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
11677 * Ada:: Ada
11678 @end menu
11679
11680 @node C
11681 @subsection C and C@t{++}
11682
11683 @cindex C and C@t{++}
11684 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
11685
11686 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
11687 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
11688 together.
11689
11690 @cindex C@t{++}
11691 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
11692 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
11693 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
11694 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
11695 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
11696 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
11697 compiler (@code{aCC}).
11698
11699 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
11700 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
11701 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
11702 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
11703 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
11704 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
11705
11706 @menu
11707 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
11708 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
11709 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
11710 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
11711 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
11712 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
11713 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
11714 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
11715 @end menu
11716
11717 @node C Operators
11718 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
11719
11720 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
11721
11722 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
11723 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
11724 often defined on groups of types.
11725
11726 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
11727
11728 @itemize @bullet
11729
11730 @item
11731 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
11732 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
11733
11734 @item
11735 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
11736 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
11737
11738 @item
11739 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
11740
11741 @item
11742 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
11743
11744 @end itemize
11745
11746 @noindent
11747 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
11748 in order of increasing precedence:
11749
11750 @table @code
11751 @item ,
11752 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
11753 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
11754 expression being the last expression evaluated.
11755
11756 @item =
11757 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
11758 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
11759
11760 @item @var{op}=
11761 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
11762 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
11763 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
11764 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
11765 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
11766
11767 @item ?:
11768 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
11769 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
11770 integral type.
11771
11772 @item ||
11773 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
11774
11775 @item &&
11776 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
11777
11778 @item |
11779 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
11780
11781 @item ^
11782 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
11783
11784 @item &
11785 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
11786
11787 @item ==@r{, }!=
11788 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
11789 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
11790
11791 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
11792 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
11793 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
11794 and non-zero for true.
11795
11796 @item <<@r{, }>>
11797 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
11798
11799 @item @@
11800 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
11801
11802 @item +@r{, }-
11803 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
11804 pointer types.
11805
11806 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
11807 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
11808 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
11809 integral types.
11810
11811 @item ++@r{, }--
11812 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
11813 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
11814 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
11815 operation takes place.
11816
11817 @item *
11818 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
11819 @code{++}.
11820
11821 @item &
11822 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
11823
11824 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
11825 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
11826 to examine the address
11827 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
11828 stored.
11829
11830 @item -
11831 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
11832 precedence as @code{++}.
11833
11834 @item !
11835 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
11836 @code{++}.
11837
11838 @item ~
11839 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
11840 @code{++}.
11841
11842
11843 @item .@r{, }->
11844 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
11845 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
11846 pointer based on the stored type information.
11847 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
11848
11849 @item .*@r{, }->*
11850 Dereferences of pointers to members.
11851
11852 @item []
11853 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
11854 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
11855
11856 @item ()
11857 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
11858
11859 @item ::
11860 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
11861 and @code{class} types.
11862
11863 @item ::
11864 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
11865 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
11866 above.
11867 @end table
11868
11869 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
11870 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
11871 predefined meaning.
11872
11873 @node C Constants
11874 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
11875
11876 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
11877
11878 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
11879 following ways:
11880
11881 @itemize @bullet
11882 @item
11883 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
11884 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
11885 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
11886 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
11887 @code{long} value.
11888
11889 @item
11890 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
11891 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
11892 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
11893 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
11894 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
11895 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
11896 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
11897 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
11898 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
11899 constant.
11900
11901 @item
11902 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
11903 integral equivalents.
11904
11905 @item
11906 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
11907 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
11908 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
11909 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
11910 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
11911 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
11912 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
11913 @samp{\n} for newline.
11914
11915 @item
11916 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
11917 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
11918 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
11919 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
11920 characters.
11921
11922 @item
11923 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
11924 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
11925
11926 @item
11927 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
11928 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
11929 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
11930 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
11931 @end itemize
11932
11933 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
11934 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
11935
11936 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
11937 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
11938
11939 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
11940 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
11941 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
11942 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
11943 @quotation
11944 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
11945 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
11946 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
11947 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
11948 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
11949 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
11950 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
11951 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
11952 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
11953 C@t{++} code.
11954 @end quotation
11955
11956 @enumerate
11957
11958 @cindex member functions
11959 @item
11960 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
11961
11962 @smallexample
11963 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
11964 @end smallexample
11965
11966 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
11967 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
11968 @item
11969 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
11970 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
11971 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
11972 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
11973
11974 @cindex call overloaded functions
11975 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
11976 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
11977 @item
11978 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
11979 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
11980 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
11981 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
11982 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
11983 default arguments.
11984
11985 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
11986 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
11987 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
11988 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
11989 number of function arguments.
11990
11991 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
11992 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
11993 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
11994
11995 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
11996 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
11997 @smallexample
11998 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
11999 @end smallexample
12000
12001 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
12002 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
12003
12004 @cindex reference declarations
12005 @item
12006 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
12007 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
12008 dereferenced.
12009
12010 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
12011 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
12012 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
12013 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
12014 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
12015
12016 @item
12017 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
12018 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
12019 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
12020 necessary, for example in an expression like
12021 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
12022 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
12023 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
12024 @end enumerate
12025
12026 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
12027 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
12028 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
12029 invoking user-defined operators.
12030
12031 @node C Defaults
12032 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
12033
12034 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
12035
12036 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
12037 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
12038 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
12039 selects the working language.
12040
12041 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
12042 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
12043 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
12044 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
12045 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
12046 for further details.
12047
12048 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
12049 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
12050 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
12051
12052 @node C Checks
12053 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
12054
12055 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
12056
12057 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
12058 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
12059 considers two variables type equivalent if:
12060
12061 @itemize @bullet
12062 @item
12063 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
12064 enumerated tag.
12065
12066 @item
12067 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
12068 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
12069
12070 @ignore
12071 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
12072 @c FIXME--beers?
12073 @item
12074 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
12075 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
12076 compilers.)
12077 @end ignore
12078 @end itemize
12079
12080 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
12081 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
12082 that is not itself an array.
12083
12084 @node Debugging C
12085 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
12086
12087 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
12088 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
12089 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
12090 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
12091
12092 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
12093 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
12094 ,Expressions}.
12095
12096 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
12097 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
12098
12099 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
12100
12101 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
12102 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
12103
12104 @table @code
12105 @cindex break in overloaded functions
12106 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
12107 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
12108 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
12109 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
12110 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
12111
12112 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
12113 @item rbreak @var{regex}
12114 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
12115 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
12116 classes.
12117 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
12118
12119 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
12120 @item catch throw
12121 @itemx catch catch
12122 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
12123 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
12124
12125 @cindex inheritance
12126 @item ptype @var{typename}
12127 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
12128 @var{typename}.
12129 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
12130
12131 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
12132 @item set print demangle
12133 @itemx show print demangle
12134 @itemx set print asm-demangle
12135 @itemx show print asm-demangle
12136 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
12137 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
12138 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
12139
12140 @item set print object
12141 @itemx show print object
12142 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
12143 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
12144
12145 @item set print vtbl
12146 @itemx show print vtbl
12147 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
12148 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
12149 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
12150 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
12151
12152 @kindex set overload-resolution
12153 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
12154 @item set overload-resolution on
12155 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
12156 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
12157 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
12158 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
12159 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
12160 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
12161
12162 @item set overload-resolution off
12163 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
12164 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
12165 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
12166 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
12167 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
12168 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
12169 argument types.
12170
12171 @kindex show overload-resolution
12172 @item show overload-resolution
12173 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
12174
12175 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
12176 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
12177 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
12178 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
12179 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
12180 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
12181 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
12182 @end table
12183
12184 @node Decimal Floating Point
12185 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
12186 @cindex decimal floating point format
12187
12188 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
12189 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
12190 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
12191 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
12192
12193 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
12194 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
12195 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
12196 target.
12197
12198 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
12199 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
12200 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
12201
12202 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
12203 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
12204 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
12205
12206 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
12207 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
12208 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
12209
12210 @node D
12211 @subsection D
12212
12213 @cindex D
12214 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
12215 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
12216 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
12217
12218 @node Objective-C
12219 @subsection Objective-C
12220
12221 @cindex Objective-C
12222 This section provides information about some commands and command
12223 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
12224 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
12225 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
12226
12227 @menu
12228 * Method Names in Commands::
12229 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
12230 @end menu
12231
12232 @node Method Names in Commands
12233 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
12234
12235 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
12236 names as line specifications:
12237
12238 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
12239 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
12240 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
12241 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
12242 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
12243 @itemize
12244 @item @code{clear}
12245 @item @code{break}
12246 @item @code{info line}
12247 @item @code{jump}
12248 @item @code{list}
12249 @end itemize
12250
12251 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
12252
12253 @smallexample
12254 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
12255 @end smallexample
12256
12257 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
12258 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
12259 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
12260 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
12261 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
12262 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
12263 debugged, enter:
12264
12265 @smallexample
12266 break -[Fruit create]
12267 @end smallexample
12268
12269 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
12270 enter:
12271
12272 @smallexample
12273 list +[NSText initialize]
12274 @end smallexample
12275
12276 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
12277 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
12278 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
12279 is also possible to specify just a method name:
12280
12281 @smallexample
12282 break create
12283 @end smallexample
12284
12285 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
12286 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
12287 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
12288 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
12289 none apply.
12290
12291 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
12292 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
12293
12294 @smallexample
12295 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
12296 @end smallexample
12297
12298 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
12299 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
12300 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
12301 @kindex print-object
12302 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
12303
12304 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
12305
12306 @smallexample
12307 print -[@var{object} hash]
12308 @end smallexample
12309
12310 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
12311 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
12312 @noindent
12313 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
12314 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
12315 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
12316 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
12317 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
12318 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
12319
12320 @node OpenCL C
12321 @subsection OpenCL C
12322
12323 @cindex OpenCL C
12324 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
12325
12326 @menu
12327 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
12328 * OpenCL C Expressions::
12329 * OpenCL C Operators::
12330 @end menu
12331
12332 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
12333 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
12334
12335 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
12336 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
12337 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
12338 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
12339 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
12340
12341 @node OpenCL C Expressions
12342 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
12343
12344 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
12345 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
12346 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
12347 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
12348
12349 @node OpenCL C Operators
12350 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
12351
12352 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
12353 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
12354 vector data types.
12355
12356 @node Fortran
12357 @subsection Fortran
12358 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
12359
12360 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
12361 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
12362
12363 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
12364 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
12365 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
12366 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
12367 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
12368 underscore.
12369
12370 @menu
12371 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
12372 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
12373 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
12374 @end menu
12375
12376 @node Fortran Operators
12377 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
12378
12379 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
12380
12381 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
12382 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
12383 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
12384
12385 @table @code
12386 @item **
12387 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
12388 of the second one.
12389
12390 @item :
12391 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
12392 represent a section of array.
12393
12394 @item %
12395 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
12396 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
12397 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
12398 union type.
12399 @end table
12400
12401 @node Fortran Defaults
12402 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
12403
12404 @cindex Fortran Defaults
12405
12406 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
12407 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
12408 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
12409 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
12410
12411 @node Special Fortran Commands
12412 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
12413
12414 @cindex Special Fortran commands
12415
12416 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
12417 such as displaying common blocks.
12418
12419 @table @code
12420 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
12421 @kindex info common
12422 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
12423 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
12424 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
12425 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
12426 printed.
12427 @end table
12428
12429 @node Pascal
12430 @subsection Pascal
12431
12432 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
12433 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
12434 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
12435 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
12436 syntax.
12437
12438 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
12439 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
12440 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
12441
12442 @node Modula-2
12443 @subsection Modula-2
12444
12445 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
12446
12447 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
12448 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
12449 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
12450 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
12451 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
12452 table.
12453
12454 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
12455 @menu
12456 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
12457 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
12458 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
12459 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
12460 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
12461 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
12462 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
12463 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
12464 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
12465 @end menu
12466
12467 @node M2 Operators
12468 @subsubsection Operators
12469 @cindex Modula-2 operators
12470
12471 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
12472 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
12473 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
12474 following definitions hold:
12475
12476 @itemize @bullet
12477
12478 @item
12479 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
12480 their subranges.
12481
12482 @item
12483 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
12484
12485 @item
12486 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
12487
12488 @item
12489 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
12490 @var{type}}.
12491
12492 @item
12493 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
12494
12495 @item
12496 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
12497
12498 @item
12499 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
12500 @end itemize
12501
12502 @noindent
12503 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
12504 increasing precedence:
12505
12506 @table @code
12507 @item ,
12508 Function argument or array index separator.
12509
12510 @item :=
12511 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
12512 @var{value}.
12513
12514 @item <@r{, }>
12515 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
12516 types.
12517
12518 @item <=@r{, }>=
12519 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
12520 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
12521 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
12522
12523 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
12524 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
12525 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
12526 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
12527 comment character.
12528
12529 @item IN
12530 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
12531 Same precedence as @code{<}.
12532
12533 @item OR
12534 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
12535
12536 @item AND@r{, }&
12537 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
12538
12539 @item @@
12540 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
12541
12542 @item +@r{, }-
12543 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
12544 and difference on set types.
12545
12546 @item *
12547 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
12548 on set types.
12549
12550 @item /
12551 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
12552 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
12553
12554 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
12555 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
12556 precedence as @code{*}.
12557
12558 @item -
12559 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
12560
12561 @item ^
12562 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
12563
12564 @item NOT
12565 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
12566 @code{^}.
12567
12568 @item .
12569 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
12570 precedence as @code{^}.
12571
12572 @item []
12573 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
12574
12575 @item ()
12576 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
12577 as @code{^}.
12578
12579 @item ::@r{, }.
12580 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
12581 @end table
12582
12583 @quotation
12584 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
12585 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
12586 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
12587 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
12588 @end quotation
12589
12590
12591 @node Built-In Func/Proc
12592 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
12593 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
12594
12595 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
12596 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
12597
12598 @table @var
12599
12600 @item a
12601 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
12602
12603 @item c
12604 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
12605
12606 @item i
12607 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
12608
12609 @item m
12610 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
12611 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
12612 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
12613
12614 @item n
12615 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
12616
12617 @item r
12618 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
12619
12620 @item t
12621 represents a type.
12622
12623 @item v
12624 represents a variable.
12625
12626 @item x
12627 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
12628 explanation of the function for details.
12629 @end table
12630
12631 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
12632
12633 @table @code
12634 @item ABS(@var{n})
12635 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
12636
12637 @item CAP(@var{c})
12638 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
12639 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
12640
12641 @item CHR(@var{i})
12642 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
12643
12644 @item DEC(@var{v})
12645 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
12646
12647 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
12648 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
12649 new value.
12650
12651 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
12652 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
12653 set.
12654
12655 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
12656 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
12657
12658 @item HIGH(@var{a})
12659 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
12660
12661 @item INC(@var{v})
12662 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
12663
12664 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
12665 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
12666 new value.
12667
12668 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
12669 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
12670 there. Returns the new set.
12671
12672 @item MAX(@var{t})
12673 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
12674
12675 @item MIN(@var{t})
12676 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
12677
12678 @item ODD(@var{i})
12679 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
12680
12681 @item ORD(@var{x})
12682 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
12683 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
12684 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
12685 integral, character and enumerated types.
12686
12687 @item SIZE(@var{x})
12688 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
12689
12690 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
12691 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
12692
12693 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
12694 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
12695
12696 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
12697 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
12698 @end table
12699
12700 @quotation
12701 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
12702 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
12703 an error.
12704 @end quotation
12705
12706 @cindex Modula-2 constants
12707 @node M2 Constants
12708 @subsubsection Constants
12709
12710 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
12711 ways:
12712
12713 @itemize @bullet
12714
12715 @item
12716 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
12717 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
12718 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
12719 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
12720
12721 @item
12722 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
12723 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
12724 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
12725 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
12726 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
12727 digits.
12728
12729 @item
12730 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
12731 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
12732 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
12733 followed by a @samp{C}.
12734
12735 @item
12736 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
12737 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
12738 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
12739 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
12740 sequences.
12741
12742 @item
12743 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
12744
12745 @item
12746 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
12747 @code{FALSE}.
12748
12749 @item
12750 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
12751
12752 @item
12753 Set constants are not yet supported.
12754 @end itemize
12755
12756 @node M2 Types
12757 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
12758 @cindex Modula-2 types
12759
12760 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
12761 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
12762 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
12763 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
12764 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
12765 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
12766
12767 The first example contains the following section of code:
12768
12769 @smallexample
12770 VAR
12771 s: SET OF CHAR ;
12772 r: [20..40] ;
12773 @end smallexample
12774
12775 @noindent
12776 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
12777 @code{r} and @code{s}.
12778
12779 @smallexample
12780 (@value{GDBP}) print s
12781 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
12782 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12783 SET OF CHAR
12784 (@value{GDBP}) print r
12785 21
12786 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
12787 [20..40]
12788 @end smallexample
12789
12790 @noindent
12791 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
12792
12793 @smallexample
12794 VAR
12795 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
12796 @end smallexample
12797
12798 @noindent
12799 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
12800
12801 @smallexample
12802 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12803 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
12804 @end smallexample
12805
12806 @noindent
12807 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
12808 expressions using the debugger.
12809
12810 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
12811 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
12812
12813 @smallexample
12814 VAR
12815 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
12816 @end smallexample
12817
12818 @smallexample
12819 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12820 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
12821 @end smallexample
12822
12823 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
12824 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
12825 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
12826 above.
12827
12828 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
12829
12830 @smallexample
12831 TYPE
12832 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
12833 t = [blue..yellow] ;
12834 VAR
12835 s: t ;
12836 BEGIN
12837 s := blue ;
12838 @end smallexample
12839
12840 @noindent
12841 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
12842 and value of a variable.
12843
12844 @smallexample
12845 (@value{GDBP}) print s
12846 $1 = blue
12847 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
12848 type = [blue..yellow]
12849 @end smallexample
12850
12851 @noindent
12852 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
12853 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
12854 their @code{C} counterparts.
12855
12856 @smallexample
12857 VAR
12858 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
12859 BEGIN
12860 s[1] := 1 ;
12861 @end smallexample
12862
12863 @smallexample
12864 (@value{GDBP}) print s
12865 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
12866 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12867 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
12868 @end smallexample
12869
12870 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
12871 pointer types as shown in this example:
12872
12873 @smallexample
12874 VAR
12875 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
12876 BEGIN
12877 NEW(s) ;
12878 s^[1] := 1 ;
12879 @end smallexample
12880
12881 @noindent
12882 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
12883
12884 @smallexample
12885 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12886 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
12887 @end smallexample
12888
12889 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
12890 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
12891 types:
12892
12893 @smallexample
12894 TYPE
12895 foo = RECORD
12896 f1: CARDINAL ;
12897 f2: CHAR ;
12898 f3: myarray ;
12899 END ;
12900
12901 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
12902 myrange = [-2..2] ;
12903 VAR
12904 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
12905 @end smallexample
12906
12907 @noindent
12908 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
12909 below.
12910
12911 @smallexample
12912 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12913 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
12914 f1 : CARDINAL;
12915 f2 : CHAR;
12916 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
12917 END
12918 @end smallexample
12919
12920 @node M2 Defaults
12921 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
12922 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
12923
12924 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
12925 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
12926 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
12927 selected the working language.
12928
12929 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
12930 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
12931 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
12932 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
12933
12934 @node Deviations
12935 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
12936 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
12937
12938 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
12939 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
12940
12941 @itemize @bullet
12942 @item
12943 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
12944 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
12945 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
12946 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
12947 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
12948 returned a pointer.)
12949
12950 @item
12951 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
12952 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
12953 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
12954 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
12955
12956 @item
12957 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
12958 argument.
12959
12960 @item
12961 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
12962 @end itemize
12963
12964 @node M2 Checks
12965 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
12966 @cindex Modula-2 checks
12967
12968 @quotation
12969 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
12970 range checking.
12971 @end quotation
12972 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
12973
12974 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
12975
12976 @itemize @bullet
12977 @item
12978 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
12979 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
12980
12981 @item
12982 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
12983 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
12984 @end itemize
12985
12986 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
12987 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
12988
12989 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
12990 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
12991
12992 @node M2 Scope
12993 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
12994 @cindex scope
12995 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
12996 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
12997 @ifinfo
12998 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
12999 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
13000 @end ifinfo
13001 @ifnotinfo
13002 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
13003 @end ifnotinfo
13004
13005 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
13006 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
13007 similar syntax:
13008
13009 @smallexample
13010
13011 @var{module} . @var{id}
13012 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
13013 @end smallexample
13014
13015 @noindent
13016 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
13017 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
13018 identifier within your program, except another module.
13019
13020 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
13021 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
13022 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
13023 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
13024
13025 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
13026 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
13027 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
13028 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
13029 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
13030 @var{module}.
13031
13032 @node GDB/M2
13033 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
13034
13035 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
13036 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
13037 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
13038 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
13039 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
13040 analogue in Modula-2.
13041
13042 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
13043 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
13044 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
13045 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
13046 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
13047 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
13048
13049 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
13050 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
13051 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
13052
13053 @node Ada
13054 @subsection Ada
13055 @cindex Ada
13056
13057 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
13058 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
13059 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
13060 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
13061 to be difficult.
13062
13063
13064 @cindex expressions in Ada
13065 @menu
13066 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
13067 and semantics supported by Ada mode
13068 in @value{GDBN}.
13069 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
13070 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
13071 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
13072 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
13073 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
13074 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
13075 Profile
13076 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
13077 @end menu
13078
13079 @node Ada Mode Intro
13080 @subsubsection Introduction
13081 @cindex Ada mode, general
13082
13083 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
13084 syntax, with some extensions.
13085 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
13086
13087 @itemize @bullet
13088 @item
13089 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
13090 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
13091 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
13092 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
13093
13094 @item
13095 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
13096 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
13097
13098 @item
13099 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
13100 @end itemize
13101
13102 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
13103 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
13104 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
13105 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
13106 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
13107
13108 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
13109 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
13110 was translated from an Ada source file.
13111
13112 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
13113 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
13114 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
13115 middle (to allow based literals).
13116
13117 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
13118 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
13119 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
13120 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
13121 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
13122 functions to procedures elsewhere.
13123
13124 @node Omissions from Ada
13125 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
13126 @cindex Ada, omissions from
13127
13128 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
13129
13130 @itemize @bullet
13131 @item
13132 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
13133
13134 @itemize @minus
13135 @item
13136 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
13137 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
13138
13139 @item
13140 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
13141
13142 @item
13143 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
13144
13145 @item
13146 @t{'Tag}.
13147
13148 @item
13149 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
13150 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
13151
13152 @item
13153 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
13154 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
13155
13156 @item
13157 @t{'Address}.
13158 @end itemize
13159
13160 @item
13161 The names in
13162 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
13163 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
13164 not currently available.
13165
13166 @item
13167 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
13168 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
13169 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
13170 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
13171 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
13172 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
13173 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
13174 indeterminate values.
13175
13176 @item
13177 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
13178 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
13179 are not implemented.
13180
13181 @item
13182 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
13183 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
13184 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
13185 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
13186 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
13187
13188 @smallexample
13189 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
13190 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
13191 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
13192 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
13193 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
13194 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
13195 @end smallexample
13196
13197 Changing a
13198 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
13199 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
13200 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
13201 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
13202 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
13203 declared to have a type such as:
13204
13205 @smallexample
13206 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
13207 Id : Integer;
13208 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
13209 end record;
13210 @end smallexample
13211
13212 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
13213 assignments:
13214
13215 @smallexample
13216 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
13217 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
13218 @end smallexample
13219
13220 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
13221 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
13222 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
13223 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
13224 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
13225 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
13226 redundant component associations, although which component values are
13227 assigned in such cases is not defined.
13228
13229 @item
13230 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
13231
13232 @item
13233 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
13234 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
13235 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
13236 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
13237 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
13238 the proper resolution.
13239
13240 @item
13241 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
13242
13243 @item
13244 Entry calls are not implemented.
13245
13246 @item
13247 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
13248 formats are not supported.
13249
13250 @item
13251 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
13252
13253 @item
13254 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
13255 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
13256 context.
13257 Should your program
13258 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
13259 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
13260 @end itemize
13261
13262 @node Additions to Ada
13263 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
13264 @cindex Ada, deviations from
13265
13266 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
13267 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
13268
13269 @itemize @bullet
13270 @item
13271 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
13272 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
13273 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
13274 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
13275 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
13276 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
13277 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
13278 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
13279
13280 @item
13281 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
13282 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
13283 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
13284
13285 @item
13286 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
13287 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
13288
13289 @item
13290 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
13291 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
13292 @end itemize
13293
13294 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
13295 additions specific to Ada:
13296
13297 @itemize @bullet
13298 @item
13299 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
13300 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
13301
13302 @smallexample
13303 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
13304 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
13305 @end smallexample
13306
13307 @item
13308 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
13309 the value of its right-hand operand.
13310 This allows, for example,
13311 complex conditional breaks:
13312
13313 @smallexample
13314 (@value{GDBP}) break f
13315 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
13316 @end smallexample
13317
13318 @item
13319 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
13320 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
13321 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
13322 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
13323 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
13324 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
13325 in strings. For example,
13326 @smallexample
13327 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
13328 @end smallexample
13329 @noindent
13330 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
13331 after each period.
13332
13333 @item
13334 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
13335 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
13336 to write
13337
13338 @smallexample
13339 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
13340 @end smallexample
13341
13342 @item
13343 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
13344 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
13345 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
13346 of 3 might print as
13347
13348 @smallexample
13349 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
13350 @end smallexample
13351
13352 @noindent
13353 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
13354 clause.
13355
13356 @item
13357 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
13358 multi-character subsequence of
13359 their names (an exact match gets preference).
13360 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
13361 in place of @t{a'length}.
13362
13363 @item
13364 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
13365 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
13366 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
13367 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
13368 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
13369 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
13370 For example,
13371 @smallexample
13372 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
13373 @end smallexample
13374
13375 @item
13376 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
13377 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
13378 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
13379 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
13380 object.
13381
13382 @end itemize
13383
13384 @node Stopping Before Main Program
13385 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
13386
13387 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
13388 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
13389 before reaching the main procedure.
13390 As defined in the Ada Reference
13391 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
13392 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
13393 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
13394 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
13395
13396 @node Ada Tasks
13397 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
13398 @cindex Ada, tasking
13399
13400 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
13401 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
13402
13403 @table @code
13404 @kindex info tasks
13405 @item info tasks
13406 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
13407
13408
13409 @smallexample
13410 @iftex
13411 @leftskip=0.5cm
13412 @end iftex
13413 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13414 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13415 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13416 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
13417 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
13418 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
13419
13420 @end smallexample
13421
13422 @noindent
13423 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
13424 task currently being inspected.
13425
13426 @table @asis
13427 @item ID
13428 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
13429
13430 @item TID
13431 The Ada task ID.
13432
13433 @item P-ID
13434 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
13435
13436 @item Pri
13437 The base priority of the task.
13438
13439 @item State
13440 Current state of the task.
13441
13442 @table @code
13443 @item Unactivated
13444 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
13445 executing.
13446
13447 @item Runnable
13448 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
13449 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
13450
13451 @item Terminated
13452 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
13453 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
13454 terminated themselves.
13455
13456 @item Child Activation Wait
13457 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
13458
13459 @item Accept Statement
13460 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
13461
13462 @item Waiting on entry call
13463 The task is waiting on an entry call.
13464
13465 @item Async Select Wait
13466 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
13467 select statement.
13468
13469 @item Delay Sleep
13470 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
13471 alternative open.
13472
13473 @item Child Termination Wait
13474 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
13475 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
13476 waiting on a terminate Phase.
13477
13478 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
13479 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
13480 finish terminating.
13481
13482 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
13483 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
13484 @end table
13485
13486 @item Name
13487 Name of the task in the program.
13488
13489 @end table
13490
13491 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
13492 @item info task @var{taskno}
13493 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
13494 the following example:
13495 @smallexample
13496 @iftex
13497 @leftskip=0.5cm
13498 @end iftex
13499 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13500 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13501 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13502 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
13503 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
13504 Ada Task: 0x807c468
13505 Name: task_1
13506 Thread: 0x807f378
13507 Parent: 1 (main_task)
13508 Base Priority: 15
13509 State: Runnable
13510 @end smallexample
13511
13512 @item task
13513 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
13514 @cindex current Ada task ID
13515 This command prints the ID of the current task.
13516
13517 @smallexample
13518 @iftex
13519 @leftskip=0.5cm
13520 @end iftex
13521 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13522 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13523 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13524 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
13525 (@value{GDBP}) task
13526 [Current task is 2]
13527 @end smallexample
13528
13529 @item task @var{taskno}
13530 @cindex Ada task switching
13531 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
13532 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
13533 from the current task to the given task.
13534
13535 @smallexample
13536 @iftex
13537 @leftskip=0.5cm
13538 @end iftex
13539 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13540 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13541 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13542 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
13543 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
13544 [Switching to task 1]
13545 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
13546 (@value{GDBP}) bt
13547 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
13548 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
13549 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
13550 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
13551 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
13552 @end smallexample
13553
13554 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
13555 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
13556 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
13557 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
13558 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
13559 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
13560 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}).
13561 @var{linespec} specifies source lines, as described
13562 in @ref{Specify Location}.
13563
13564 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
13565 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
13566 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. @var{taskno} is one of the
13567 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
13568 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
13569
13570 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
13571 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
13572 program.
13573
13574 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
13575 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
13576 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
13577
13578 For example,
13579
13580 @smallexample
13581 @iftex
13582 @leftskip=0.5cm
13583 @end iftex
13584 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13585 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13586 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13587 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
13588 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
13589 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
13590 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
13591 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
13592 (@value{GDBP}) cont
13593 Continuing.
13594 task # 1 running
13595 task # 2 running
13596
13597 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
13598 15 flush;
13599 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13600 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13601 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13602 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
13603 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
13604 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
13605 @end smallexample
13606 @end table
13607
13608 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
13609 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
13610 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
13611
13612 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
13613 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
13614 the platform being used.
13615 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
13616 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
13617 as usual.
13618
13619 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
13620 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
13621 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
13622 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
13623 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
13624 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
13625
13626 @node Ravenscar Profile
13627 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
13628 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
13629
13630 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
13631 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
13632 requirements.
13633
13634 @table @code
13635 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
13636 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
13637 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
13638 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
13639 Profile. This is the default.
13640
13641 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
13642 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
13643 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
13644 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
13645 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
13646 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
13647 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
13648
13649 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
13650 @item show ravenscar task-switching
13651 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
13652 using the Ravenscar Profile.
13653
13654 @end table
13655
13656 @node Ada Glitches
13657 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
13658 @cindex Ada, problems
13659
13660 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
13661 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
13662 @value{GDBN},
13663 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
13664 and the GNU Ada compiler.
13665
13666 @itemize @bullet
13667 @item
13668 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
13669 storage are invisible to the debugger.
13670
13671 @item
13672 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
13673 argument lists are treated as positional).
13674
13675 @item
13676 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
13677
13678 @item
13679 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
13680 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
13681 the host machine.
13682
13683 @item
13684 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
13685 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
13686 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
13687 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
13688 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
13689 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
13690 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
13691 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
13692 you can usually resolve the confusion
13693 by qualifying the problematic names with package
13694 @code{Standard} explicitly.
13695 @end itemize
13696
13697 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
13698 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
13699 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
13700 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
13701 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
13702 enabled.
13703
13704 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
13705 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
13706 @table @code
13707
13708 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
13709 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
13710 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
13711 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
13712 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
13713 This is the default.
13714
13715 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
13716 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
13717 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
13718 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
13719 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
13720 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
13721 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
13722
13723 @end table
13724
13725 @node Unsupported Languages
13726 @section Unsupported Languages
13727
13728 @cindex unsupported languages
13729 @cindex minimal language
13730 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
13731 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
13732 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
13733 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
13734 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
13735 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
13736
13737 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
13738 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
13739 language.
13740
13741 @node Symbols
13742 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
13743
13744 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
13745 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
13746 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
13747 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
13748 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
13749 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
13750 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
13751
13752 @cindex symbol names
13753 @cindex names of symbols
13754 @cindex quoting names
13755 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
13756 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
13757 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
13758 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
13759 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
13760 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
13761 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
13762 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
13763
13764 @smallexample
13765 p 'foo.c'::x
13766 @end smallexample
13767
13768 @noindent
13769 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
13770
13771 @table @code
13772 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
13773 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
13774 @kindex set case-sensitive
13775 @item set case-sensitive on
13776 @itemx set case-sensitive off
13777 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
13778 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
13779 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
13780 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
13781 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
13782 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
13783 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
13784 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
13785 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
13786 case-insensitive matches.
13787
13788 @kindex show case-sensitive
13789 @item show case-sensitive
13790 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
13791 lookups.
13792
13793 @kindex info address
13794 @cindex address of a symbol
13795 @item info address @var{symbol}
13796 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
13797 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
13798 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
13799 is always stored.
13800
13801 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
13802 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
13803 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
13804
13805 @kindex info symbol
13806 @cindex symbol from address
13807 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
13808 @item info symbol @var{addr}
13809 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
13810 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
13811 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
13812
13813 @smallexample
13814 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
13815 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
13816 @end smallexample
13817
13818 @noindent
13819 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
13820 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
13821
13822 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
13823 library containing the symbol is also printed:
13824
13825 @smallexample
13826 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
13827 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
13828 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
13829 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
13830 @end smallexample
13831
13832 @kindex whatis
13833 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
13834 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
13835 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
13836 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
13837 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
13838 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
13839 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
13840 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
13841 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
13842 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
13843 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
13844
13845 @kindex ptype
13846 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
13847 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
13848 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
13849 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
13850
13851 For example, for this variable declaration:
13852
13853 @smallexample
13854 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
13855 @end smallexample
13856
13857 @noindent
13858 the two commands give this output:
13859
13860 @smallexample
13861 @group
13862 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
13863 type = struct complex
13864 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
13865 type = struct complex @{
13866 double real;
13867 double imag;
13868 @}
13869 @end group
13870 @end smallexample
13871
13872 @noindent
13873 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
13874 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
13875
13876 @cindex incomplete type
13877 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
13878 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
13879 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
13880 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
13881 given these declarations:
13882
13883 @smallexample
13884 struct foo;
13885 struct foo *fooptr;
13886 @end smallexample
13887
13888 @noindent
13889 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
13890
13891 @smallexample
13892 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
13893 $1 = <incomplete type>
13894 @end smallexample
13895
13896 @noindent
13897 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
13898 completely specified.
13899
13900 @kindex info types
13901 @item info types @var{regexp}
13902 @itemx info types
13903 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
13904 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
13905 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
13906 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
13907 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
13908 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
13909 name is @code{value}.
13910
13911 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
13912 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
13913 lists all source files where a type is defined.
13914
13915 @kindex info scope
13916 @cindex local variables
13917 @item info scope @var{location}
13918 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
13919 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
13920 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
13921 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
13922 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
13923
13924 @smallexample
13925 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
13926 Scope for command_line_handler:
13927 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
13928 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
13929 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
13930 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
13931 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
13932 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
13933 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
13934 @end smallexample
13935
13936 @noindent
13937 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
13938 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
13939 collect}.
13940
13941 @kindex info source
13942 @item info source
13943 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
13944 the function containing the current point of execution:
13945 @itemize @bullet
13946 @item
13947 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
13948 @item
13949 the directory it was compiled in,
13950 @item
13951 its length, in lines,
13952 @item
13953 which programming language it is written in,
13954 @item
13955 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
13956 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
13957 @item
13958 whether the debugging information includes information about
13959 preprocessor macros.
13960 @end itemize
13961
13962
13963 @kindex info sources
13964 @item info sources
13965 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
13966 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
13967 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
13968
13969 @kindex info functions
13970 @item info functions
13971 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
13972
13973 @item info functions @var{regexp}
13974 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
13975 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
13976 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
13977 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
13978 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
13979 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
13980 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
13981
13982 @kindex info variables
13983 @item info variables
13984 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
13985 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
13986
13987 @item info variables @var{regexp}
13988 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
13989 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
13990 @var{regexp}.
13991
13992 @kindex info classes
13993 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
13994 @item info classes
13995 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
13996 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
13997 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
13998 expression.
13999
14000 @kindex info selectors
14001 @item info selectors
14002 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
14003 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
14004 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
14005 expression.
14006
14007 @ignore
14008 This was never implemented.
14009 @kindex info methods
14010 @item info methods
14011 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
14012 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
14013 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
14014 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
14015 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
14016 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
14017 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
14018 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
14019 @end ignore
14020
14021 @cindex reloading symbols
14022 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
14023 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
14024 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
14025 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
14026 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
14027
14028 @table @code
14029 @kindex set symbol-reloading
14030 @item set symbol-reloading on
14031 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
14032 object file with a particular name is seen again.
14033
14034 @item set symbol-reloading off
14035 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
14036 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
14037 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
14038 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
14039 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
14040 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
14041 name.
14042
14043 @kindex show symbol-reloading
14044 @item show symbol-reloading
14045 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
14046 @end table
14047
14048 @cindex opaque data types
14049 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
14050 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
14051 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
14052 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
14053 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
14054 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
14055 another source file. The default is on.
14056
14057 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
14058 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
14059
14060 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
14061 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
14062 is printed as follows:
14063 @smallexample
14064 @{<no data fields>@}
14065 @end smallexample
14066
14067 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
14068 @item show opaque-type-resolution
14069 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
14070
14071 @kindex maint print symbols
14072 @cindex symbol dump
14073 @kindex maint print psymbols
14074 @cindex partial symbol dump
14075 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
14076 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
14077 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
14078 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
14079 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
14080 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
14081 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
14082 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
14083 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
14084 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
14085 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
14086 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
14087 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
14088 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
14089 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
14090 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
14091 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
14092
14093 @kindex maint info symtabs
14094 @kindex maint info psymtabs
14095 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
14096 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
14097 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
14098 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
14099 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
14100 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
14101
14102 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
14103 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
14104 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
14105 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
14106 structure in more detail. For example:
14107
14108 @smallexample
14109 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
14110 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
14111 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
14112 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
14113 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
14114 readin no
14115 fullname (null)
14116 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
14117 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
14118 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
14119 dependencies (none)
14120 @}
14121 @}
14122 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
14123 (@value{GDBP})
14124 @end smallexample
14125 @noindent
14126 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
14127 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
14128 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
14129 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
14130 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
14131
14132 @smallexample
14133 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
14134 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
14135 line 1574.
14136 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
14137 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
14138 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
14139 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
14140 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
14141 dirname (null)
14142 fullname (null)
14143 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
14144 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
14145 debugformat DWARF 2
14146 @}
14147 @}
14148 (@value{GDBP})
14149 @end smallexample
14150 @end table
14151
14152
14153 @node Altering
14154 @chapter Altering Execution
14155
14156 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
14157 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
14158 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
14159 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
14160 program.
14161
14162 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
14163 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
14164 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
14165
14166 @menu
14167 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
14168 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
14169 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
14170 * Returning:: Returning from a function
14171 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
14172 * Patching:: Patching your program
14173 @end menu
14174
14175 @node Assignment
14176 @section Assignment to Variables
14177
14178 @cindex assignment
14179 @cindex setting variables
14180 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
14181 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
14182
14183 @smallexample
14184 print x=4
14185 @end smallexample
14186
14187 @noindent
14188 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
14189 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
14190 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
14191 information on operators in supported languages.
14192
14193 @kindex set variable
14194 @cindex variables, setting
14195 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
14196 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
14197 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
14198 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
14199 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
14200
14201 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
14202 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
14203 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
14204 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
14205 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
14206 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
14207 command @code{set width}:
14208
14209 @smallexample
14210 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
14211 type = double
14212 (@value{GDBP}) p width
14213 $4 = 13
14214 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
14215 Invalid syntax in expression.
14216 @end smallexample
14217
14218 @noindent
14219 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
14220 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
14221
14222 @smallexample
14223 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
14224 @end smallexample
14225
14226 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
14227 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
14228 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
14229 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
14230 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
14231 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
14232
14233 @smallexample
14234 @group
14235 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
14236 type = double
14237 (@value{GDBP}) p g
14238 $1 = 1
14239 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
14240 (@value{GDBP}) p g
14241 $2 = 1
14242 (@value{GDBP}) r
14243 The program being debugged has been started already.
14244 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
14245 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
14246 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
14247 Invalid bfd target.
14248 (@value{GDBP}) show g
14249 The current BFD target is "=4".
14250 @end group
14251 @end smallexample
14252
14253 @noindent
14254 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
14255 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
14256 @code{g}, use
14257
14258 @smallexample
14259 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
14260 @end smallexample
14261
14262 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
14263 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
14264 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
14265 same length or shorter.
14266 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
14267 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
14268
14269 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
14270 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
14271 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
14272 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
14273 and representation in memory), and
14274
14275 @smallexample
14276 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
14277 @end smallexample
14278
14279 @noindent
14280 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
14281
14282 @node Jumping
14283 @section Continuing at a Different Address
14284
14285 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
14286 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
14287 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
14288
14289 @table @code
14290 @kindex jump
14291 @item jump @var{linespec}
14292 @itemx jump @var{location}
14293 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
14294 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
14295 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
14296 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
14297 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
14298 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14299
14300 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
14301 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
14302 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
14303 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
14304 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
14305 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
14306 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
14307 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
14308 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
14309 @end table
14310
14311 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
14312 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
14313 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
14314 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
14315 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
14316 example,
14317
14318 @smallexample
14319 set $pc = 0x485
14320 @end smallexample
14321
14322 @noindent
14323 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
14324 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
14325 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
14326
14327 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
14328 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
14329 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
14330 detail.
14331
14332 @c @group
14333 @node Signaling
14334 @section Giving your Program a Signal
14335 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
14336
14337 @table @code
14338 @kindex signal
14339 @item signal @var{signal}
14340 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
14341 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
14342 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
14343 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
14344
14345 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
14346 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
14347 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
14348 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
14349 signal.
14350
14351 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
14352 after executing the command.
14353 @end table
14354 @c @end group
14355
14356 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
14357 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
14358 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
14359 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
14360 passes the signal directly to your program.
14361
14362
14363 @node Returning
14364 @section Returning from a Function
14365
14366 @table @code
14367 @cindex returning from a function
14368 @kindex return
14369 @item return
14370 @itemx return @var{expression}
14371 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
14372 command. If you give an
14373 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
14374 value.
14375 @end table
14376
14377 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
14378 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
14379 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
14380 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
14381
14382 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
14383 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
14384 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
14385 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
14386 of functions.
14387
14388 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
14389 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
14390 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
14391 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
14392 selected stack frame returns naturally.
14393
14394 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
14395 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
14396 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
14397 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
14398 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
14399 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
14400 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
14401 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
14402 assignment into the right register(s).
14403
14404 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
14405 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
14406 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
14407 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
14408 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
14409 into a @code{long long int}:
14410
14411 @smallexample
14412 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
14413 29 return 31;
14414 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
14415 Make func return now? (y or n) y
14416 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
14417 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
14418 (@value{GDBP})
14419 @end smallexample
14420
14421 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
14422 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
14423 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
14424 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
14425 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
14426 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
14427 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
14428 an appropriate cast explicitly:
14429
14430 @smallexample
14431 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
14432 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
14433 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
14434 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
14435 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
14436 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
14437 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
14438 (@value{GDBP})
14439 @end smallexample
14440
14441 @node Calling
14442 @section Calling Program Functions
14443
14444 @table @code
14445 @cindex calling functions
14446 @cindex inferior functions, calling
14447 @item print @var{expr}
14448 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
14449 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
14450 debugged.
14451
14452 @kindex call
14453 @item call @var{expr}
14454 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
14455 returned values.
14456
14457 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
14458 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
14459 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
14460 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
14461 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
14462 value history.
14463 @end table
14464
14465 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
14466 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
14467 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
14468 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
14469
14470 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
14471 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
14472 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
14473 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
14474 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
14475 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
14476 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
14477 in that case is controlled by the
14478 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
14479
14480 @table @code
14481 @item set unwindonsignal
14482 @kindex set unwindonsignal
14483 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
14484 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
14485 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
14486 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
14487 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
14488 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
14489 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
14490 received.
14491
14492 @item show unwindonsignal
14493 @kindex show unwindonsignal
14494 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
14495 @value{GDBN}.
14496
14497 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
14498 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
14499 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
14500 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
14501 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
14502 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
14503 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
14504 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
14505 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
14506 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
14507
14508 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
14509 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
14510 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
14511 @value{GDBN}.
14512
14513 @end table
14514
14515 @cindex weak alias functions
14516 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
14517 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
14518 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
14519 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
14520 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
14521 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
14522 function instead.
14523
14524 @node Patching
14525 @section Patching Programs
14526
14527 @cindex patching binaries
14528 @cindex writing into executables
14529 @cindex writing into corefiles
14530
14531 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
14532 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
14533 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
14534 patching your program's binary.
14535
14536 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
14537 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
14538 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
14539 repairs.
14540
14541 @table @code
14542 @kindex set write
14543 @item set write on
14544 @itemx set write off
14545 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
14546 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
14547 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
14548
14549 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
14550 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
14551 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
14552
14553 @item show write
14554 @kindex show write
14555 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
14556 as well as reading.
14557 @end table
14558
14559 @node GDB Files
14560 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
14561
14562 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
14563 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
14564 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
14565 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
14566
14567 @menu
14568 * Files:: Commands to specify files
14569 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
14570 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
14571 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
14572 * Data Files:: GDB data files
14573 @end menu
14574
14575 @node Files
14576 @section Commands to Specify Files
14577
14578 @cindex symbol table
14579 @cindex core dump file
14580
14581 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
14582 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
14583 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
14584 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
14585
14586 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
14587 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
14588 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
14589 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
14590 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
14591 new files are useful.
14592
14593 @table @code
14594 @cindex executable file
14595 @kindex file
14596 @item file @var{filename}
14597 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
14598 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
14599 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
14600 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
14601 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
14602 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
14603 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
14604 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
14605
14606 @cindex unlinked object files
14607 @cindex patching object files
14608 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
14609 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
14610 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
14611 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
14612 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
14613 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
14614 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
14615 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
14616
14617 @item file
14618 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
14619 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
14620
14621 @kindex exec-file
14622 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
14623 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
14624 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
14625 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
14626 discard information on the executable file.
14627
14628 @kindex symbol-file
14629 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
14630 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
14631 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
14632 table and program to run from the same file.
14633
14634 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
14635 program's symbol table.
14636
14637 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
14638 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
14639 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
14640 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
14641 @value{GDBN}.
14642
14643 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
14644 executing it once.
14645
14646 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
14647 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
14648 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
14649 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
14650 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
14651 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
14652 optimized code.
14653
14654 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
14655 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
14656 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
14657 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
14658 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
14659
14660 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
14661 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
14662 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
14663 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
14664 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
14665 Warnings and Messages}.)
14666
14667 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
14668 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
14669 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
14670 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
14671 in stabs format.
14672
14673 @kindex readnow
14674 @cindex reading symbols immediately
14675 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
14676 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
14677 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
14678 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
14679 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
14680 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
14681 entire symbol table available.
14682
14683 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
14684 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
14685 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
14686 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
14687 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
14688 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
14689 @c files.
14690
14691 @kindex core-file
14692 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
14693 @itemx core
14694 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
14695 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
14696 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
14697 executable file itself for other parts.
14698
14699 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
14700 to be used.
14701
14702 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
14703 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
14704 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
14705 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
14706 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
14707
14708 @kindex add-symbol-file
14709 @cindex dynamic linking
14710 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
14711 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
14712 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
14713 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
14714 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
14715 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
14716 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
14717 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
14718 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
14719 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
14720 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
14721 @var{address} as an expression.
14722
14723 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
14724 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
14725 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
14726 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
14727 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
14728
14729 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
14730 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
14731 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
14732 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
14733 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
14734 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
14735 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
14736 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
14737 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
14738
14739 @itemize @bullet
14740 @item
14741 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
14742 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
14743 @item
14744 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
14745 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
14746 @item
14747 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
14748 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
14749 @end itemize
14750
14751 @noindent
14752 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
14753 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
14754 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
14755 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
14756 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
14757 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
14758 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
14759 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
14760 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
14761 way.
14762
14763 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
14764
14765 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
14766 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
14767 @cindex load symbols from memory
14768 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
14769 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
14770 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
14771 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
14772 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
14773 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
14774 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
14775 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
14776 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
14777
14778 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
14779 @kindex assf
14780 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
14781 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
14782 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
14783 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
14784 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
14785 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
14786 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
14787 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
14788 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
14789 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
14790
14791 @kindex section
14792 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
14793 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
14794 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
14795 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
14796 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
14797 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
14798 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
14799 their addresses.
14800
14801 @kindex info files
14802 @kindex info target
14803 @item info files
14804 @itemx info target
14805 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
14806 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
14807 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
14808 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
14809 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
14810 current ones.
14811
14812 @kindex maint info sections
14813 @item maint info sections
14814 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
14815 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
14816 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
14817 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
14818 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
14819 may be arbitrarily combined):
14820
14821 @table @code
14822 @item ALLOBJ
14823 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
14824 @item @var{sections}
14825 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
14826 @item @var{section-flags}
14827 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
14828 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
14829 @table @code
14830 @item ALLOC
14831 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
14832 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
14833 @item LOAD
14834 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
14835 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
14836 @item RELOC
14837 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
14838 @item READONLY
14839 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
14840 @item CODE
14841 Section contains executable code only.
14842 @item DATA
14843 Section contains data only (no executable code).
14844 @item ROM
14845 Section will reside in ROM.
14846 @item CONSTRUCTOR
14847 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
14848 @item HAS_CONTENTS
14849 Section is not empty.
14850 @item NEVER_LOAD
14851 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
14852 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
14853 A notification to the linker that the section contains
14854 COFF shared library information.
14855 @item IS_COMMON
14856 Section contains common symbols.
14857 @end table
14858 @end table
14859 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
14860 @cindex read-only sections
14861 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
14862 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
14863 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
14864 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
14865 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
14866 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
14867 enhancement to debugging performance.
14868
14869 The default is off.
14870
14871 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
14872 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
14873 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
14874 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
14875
14876 @item show trust-readonly-sections
14877 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
14878 @end table
14879
14880 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
14881 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
14882 name and remembers it that way.
14883
14884 @cindex shared libraries
14885 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
14886 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
14887 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
14888
14889 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
14890 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
14891
14892 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
14893 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
14894 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
14895 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
14896 debugging a core file).
14897
14898 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
14899 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
14900
14901 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
14902 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
14903 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
14904
14905 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
14906 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
14907 particularly large or there are many of them.
14908
14909 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
14910 commands:
14911
14912 @table @code
14913 @kindex set auto-solib-add
14914 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
14915 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
14916 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
14917 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
14918 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
14919 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
14920 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
14921
14922 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
14923 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
14924 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
14925 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
14926 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
14927 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
14928 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
14929 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
14930 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
14931
14932 @kindex show auto-solib-add
14933 @item show auto-solib-add
14934 Display the current autoloading mode.
14935 @end table
14936
14937 @cindex load shared library
14938 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
14939 command:
14940
14941 @table @code
14942 @kindex info sharedlibrary
14943 @kindex info share
14944 @item info share @var{regex}
14945 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
14946 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
14947 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
14948 all shared libraries that are loaded.
14949
14950 @kindex sharedlibrary
14951 @kindex share
14952 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
14953 @itemx share @var{regex}
14954 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
14955 Unix regular expression.
14956 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
14957 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
14958 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
14959 loaded.
14960
14961 @item nosharedlibrary
14962 @kindex nosharedlibrary
14963 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
14964 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
14965 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
14966 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
14967 discarded.
14968 @end table
14969
14970 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
14971 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
14972 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
14973
14974 @table @code
14975 @item set stop-on-solib-events
14976 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
14977 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
14978 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
14979 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
14980 shared library.
14981
14982 @item show stop-on-solib-events
14983 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
14984 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
14985 library events happen.
14986 @end table
14987
14988 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
14989 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
14990 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
14991 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
14992 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
14993 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
14994 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
14995 not.
14996
14997 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
14998 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
14999 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
15000 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
15001 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
15002
15003 @table @code
15004 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
15005 @cindex system root, alternate
15006 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
15007 @kindex set sysroot
15008 @item set sysroot @var{path}
15009 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
15010 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
15011 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
15012 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
15013 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
15014 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
15015 under @var{path}.
15016
15017 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
15018 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
15019 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
15020 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
15021 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
15022 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
15023 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
15024 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
15025 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
15026
15027 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
15028 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
15029 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
15030 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
15031 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
15032
15033 @smallexample
15034 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
15035 @end smallexample
15036
15037 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
15038 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
15039 system:
15040
15041 @smallexample
15042 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
15043 @end smallexample
15044
15045 If that does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries removing
15046 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
15047 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
15048 colons:
15049
15050 @smallexample
15051 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
15052 @end smallexample
15053
15054 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
15055 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
15056 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
15057 @samp{z}):
15058
15059 @smallexample
15060 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
15061 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
15062 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
15063 @end smallexample
15064
15065 @noindent
15066 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
15067 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
15068 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
15069
15070 If that still does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries
15071 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
15072
15073 @smallexample
15074 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
15075 @end smallexample
15076
15077 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
15078 if you don't want or need to.
15079
15080 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
15081 sysroot}.
15082
15083 @cindex default system root
15084 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
15085 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
15086 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
15087 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
15088 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
15089 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
15090 location.
15091
15092 @kindex show sysroot
15093 @item show sysroot
15094 Display the current shared library prefix.
15095
15096 @kindex set solib-search-path
15097 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
15098 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
15099 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
15100 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
15101 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
15102 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
15103 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
15104 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
15105 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
15106 of shared library symbols.
15107
15108 @kindex show solib-search-path
15109 @item show solib-search-path
15110 Display the current shared library search path.
15111
15112 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
15113 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
15114 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
15115 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
15116 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
15117
15118 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
15119 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
15120 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
15121 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
15122 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
15123 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
15124 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
15125 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
15126 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
15127 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
15128 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
15129 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
15130 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
15131 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
15132 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
15133 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
15134 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
15135 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
15136 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
15137 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
15138 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
15139 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
15140
15141 @table @code
15142 @item unix
15143 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
15144 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
15145 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
15146 the forward slash.
15147
15148 @item dos-based
15149 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
15150 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
15151 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
15152 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
15153 considered directory separators.
15154
15155 @item auto
15156 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
15157 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
15158 This is the default.
15159 @end table
15160 @end table
15161
15162
15163 @node Separate Debug Files
15164 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
15165 @cindex separate debugging information files
15166 @cindex debugging information in separate files
15167 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
15168 @cindex debugging information directory, global
15169 @cindex global debugging information directory
15170 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
15171 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
15172
15173 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
15174 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
15175 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
15176 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
15177 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
15178 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
15179 install only when they need to debug a problem.
15180
15181 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
15182 file:
15183
15184 @itemize @bullet
15185 @item
15186 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
15187 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
15188 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
15189 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
15190 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
15191 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
15192 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
15193 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
15194
15195 @item
15196 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
15197 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
15198 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
15199 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
15200 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
15201 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
15202 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
15203 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
15204 below.
15205 @end itemize
15206
15207 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
15208 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
15209
15210 @itemize @bullet
15211 @item
15212 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
15213 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
15214 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
15215 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
15216 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
15217
15218 @item
15219 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
15220 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
15221 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
15222 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
15223 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
15224 hex characters, not 10.)
15225 @end itemize
15226
15227 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
15228 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
15229 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
15230 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
15231 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
15232 debug information files, in the indicated order:
15233
15234 @itemize @minus
15235 @item
15236 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
15237 @item
15238 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
15239 @item
15240 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
15241 @item
15242 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
15243 @end itemize
15244
15245 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
15246 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
15247
15248 @table @code
15249
15250 @kindex set debug-file-directory
15251 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
15252 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
15253 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple directory components can be set
15254 concatenating them by a directory separator.
15255
15256 @kindex show debug-file-directory
15257 @item show debug-file-directory
15258 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
15259 information files.
15260
15261 @end table
15262
15263 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
15264 @cindex debug link sections
15265 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
15266 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
15267
15268 @itemize
15269 @item
15270 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
15271 a zero byte,
15272 @item
15273 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
15274 boundary within the section, and
15275 @item
15276 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
15277 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
15278 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
15279 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
15280 @end itemize
15281
15282 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
15283 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
15284 described above.
15285
15286 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
15287 @cindex build ID sections
15288 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
15289 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
15290 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
15291 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
15292 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
15293 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
15294 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
15295 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
15296 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
15297
15298 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
15299 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
15300 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
15301 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
15302 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
15303 in an ordinary executable.
15304
15305 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
15306 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
15307 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
15308 following commands:
15309
15310 @smallexample
15311 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
15312 @kbd{strip -g foo}
15313 @end smallexample
15314
15315 @noindent
15316 These commands remove the debugging
15317 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
15318 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
15319 two files:
15320
15321 @itemize @bullet
15322 @item
15323 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
15324 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
15325
15326 @smallexample
15327 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
15328 @end smallexample
15329
15330 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
15331 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
15332 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
15333 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
15334
15335 @item
15336 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
15337 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
15338 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
15339 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
15340 @end itemize
15341
15342 @noindent
15343
15344 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
15345 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
15346 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
15347
15348 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
15349 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
15350 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
15351 @c different ways!
15352 @ifhtml
15353 @display
15354 @html
15355 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
15356 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
15357 @end html
15358 @end display
15359 @end ifhtml
15360 @ifnothtml
15361 @display
15362 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
15363 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
15364 @end display
15365 @end ifnothtml
15366
15367 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
15368 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
15369 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
15370 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
15371 CRC.
15372
15373 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
15374 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{Remote Protocol,
15375 , @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol}). However in the
15376 case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed @emph{most}
15377 significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so trailing
15378 zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
15379
15380 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
15381 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
15382 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
15383 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
15384 @code{0xffffffff}.
15385
15386 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
15387 @smallexample
15388 unsigned long
15389 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
15390 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
15391 @{
15392 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
15393 @{
15394 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
15395 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
15396 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
15397 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
15398 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
15399 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
15400 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
15401 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
15402 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
15403 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
15404 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
15405 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
15406 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
15407 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
15408 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
15409 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
15410 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
15411 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
15412 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
15413 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
15414 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
15415 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
15416 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
15417 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
15418 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
15419 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
15420 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
15421 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
15422 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
15423 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
15424 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
15425 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
15426 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
15427 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
15428 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
15429 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
15430 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
15431 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
15432 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
15433 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
15434 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
15435 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
15436 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
15437 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
15438 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
15439 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
15440 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
15441 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
15442 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
15443 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
15444 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
15445 0x2d02ef8d
15446 @};
15447 unsigned char *end;
15448
15449 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
15450 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
15451 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
15452 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
15453 @}
15454 @end smallexample
15455
15456 @noindent
15457 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
15458
15459
15460 @node Index Files
15461 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
15462 @cindex index files
15463 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
15464
15465 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
15466 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
15467 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
15468 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
15469 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
15470 startup.
15471
15472 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
15473 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
15474 using @command{objcopy}.
15475
15476 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
15477
15478 @table @code
15479 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
15480 @kindex save gdb-index
15481 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
15482 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
15483 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
15484 @var{directory}.
15485 @end table
15486
15487 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
15488 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
15489
15490 @smallexample
15491 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
15492 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
15493 @end smallexample
15494
15495 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
15496 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
15497 currently work for programs using Ada.
15498
15499 @node Symbol Errors
15500 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
15501
15502 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
15503 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
15504 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
15505 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
15506 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
15507 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
15508 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
15509 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
15510 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
15511 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
15512 Messages}).
15513
15514 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
15515
15516 @table @code
15517 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
15518
15519 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
15520 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
15521 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
15522 in its outer scope blocks.
15523
15524 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
15525 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
15526 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
15527 function.
15528
15529 @item block at @var{address} out of order
15530
15531 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
15532 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
15533 do so.
15534
15535 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
15536 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
15537 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
15538 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
15539 Messages}.)
15540
15541 @item bad block start address patched
15542
15543 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
15544 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
15545 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
15546
15547 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
15548 starting on the previous source line.
15549
15550 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
15551
15552 @cindex foo
15553 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
15554 larger than the size of the string table.
15555
15556 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
15557 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
15558 with this name.
15559
15560 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
15561
15562 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
15563 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
15564 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
15565
15566 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
15567 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
15568 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
15569 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
15570 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
15571 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
15572
15573 @item stub type has NULL name
15574
15575 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
15576
15577 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
15578 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
15579 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
15580 it.
15581
15582 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
15583
15584 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
15585
15586 @end table
15587
15588 @node Data Files
15589 @section GDB Data Files
15590
15591 @cindex prefix for data files
15592 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
15593 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
15594
15595 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
15596 is currently using.
15597
15598 @table @code
15599 @kindex set data-directory
15600 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
15601 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
15602 to @var{directory}.
15603
15604 @kindex show data-directory
15605 @item show data-directory
15606 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
15607 @end table
15608
15609 @cindex default data directory
15610 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
15611 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
15612 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
15613 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
15614 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
15615 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
15616 location.
15617
15618 The data directory may also be specified with the
15619 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
15620 @xref{Mode Options}.
15621
15622 @node Targets
15623 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
15624
15625 @cindex debugging target
15626 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
15627
15628 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
15629 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
15630 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
15631 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
15632 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
15633 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
15634 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
15635 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
15636
15637 @cindex target architecture
15638 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
15639 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
15640 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
15641 command.
15642
15643 @table @code
15644 @kindex set architecture
15645 @kindex show architecture
15646 @item set architecture @var{arch}
15647 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
15648 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
15649 supported architectures.
15650
15651 @item show architecture
15652 Show the current target architecture.
15653
15654 @item set processor
15655 @itemx processor
15656 @kindex set processor
15657 @kindex show processor
15658 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
15659 and @code{show architecture}.
15660 @end table
15661
15662 @menu
15663 * Active Targets:: Active targets
15664 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
15665 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
15666 @end menu
15667
15668 @node Active Targets
15669 @section Active Targets
15670
15671 @cindex stacking targets
15672 @cindex active targets
15673 @cindex multiple targets
15674
15675 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
15676 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
15677 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
15678 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
15679 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
15680 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
15681 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
15682 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
15683 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
15684
15685 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
15686 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
15687 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
15688 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
15689
15690 @node Target Commands
15691 @section Commands for Managing Targets
15692
15693 @table @code
15694 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
15695 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
15696 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
15697 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
15698 protocol of the target machine.
15699
15700 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
15701 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
15702 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
15703
15704 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
15705 after executing the command.
15706
15707 @kindex help target
15708 @item help target
15709 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
15710 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
15711 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
15712
15713 @item help target @var{name}
15714 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
15715 select it.
15716
15717 @kindex set gnutarget
15718 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
15719 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
15720 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
15721 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
15722 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
15723 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
15724
15725 @quotation
15726 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
15727 you must know the actual BFD name.
15728 @end quotation
15729
15730 @noindent
15731 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
15732
15733 @kindex show gnutarget
15734 @item show gnutarget
15735 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
15736 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
15737 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
15738 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
15739 @end table
15740
15741 @cindex common targets
15742 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
15743 configuration):
15744
15745 @table @code
15746 @kindex target
15747 @item target exec @var{program}
15748 @cindex executable file target
15749 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
15750 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
15751
15752 @item target core @var{filename}
15753 @cindex core dump file target
15754 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
15755 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
15756
15757 @item target remote @var{medium}
15758 @cindex remote target
15759 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
15760 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
15761 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
15762
15763 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
15764 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
15765
15766 @smallexample
15767 target remote /dev/ttya
15768 @end smallexample
15769
15770 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
15771 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
15772 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
15773 clobbered by the download.
15774
15775 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
15776 @cindex built-in simulator target
15777 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
15778 In general,
15779 @smallexample
15780 target sim
15781 load
15782 run
15783 @end smallexample
15784 @noindent
15785 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
15786 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
15787 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
15788 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
15789 Processors}.
15790
15791 @end table
15792
15793 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
15794
15795 @table @code
15796
15797 @item target nrom @var{dev}
15798 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
15799 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
15800
15801 @end table
15802
15803 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
15804 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
15805
15806 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
15807 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
15808 various aspects of this process.
15809
15810 @table @code
15811
15812 @item set hash
15813 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
15814 @cindex hash mark while downloading
15815 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
15816 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
15817 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
15818 monitor.
15819
15820 @item show hash
15821 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
15822 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
15823
15824 @item set debug monitor
15825 @kindex set debug monitor
15826 @cindex display remote monitor communications
15827 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
15828 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
15829
15830 @item show debug monitor
15831 @kindex show debug monitor
15832 Show the current status of displaying communications between
15833 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
15834 @end table
15835
15836 @table @code
15837
15838 @kindex load @var{filename}
15839 @item load @var{filename}
15840 @anchor{load}
15841 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
15842 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
15843 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
15844 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
15845 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
15846 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
15847
15848 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
15849 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
15850 target is @dots{}}''
15851
15852 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
15853 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
15854 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
15855 specifies a fixed address.
15856 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
15857
15858 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
15859 load programs into flash memory.
15860
15861 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
15862 @end table
15863
15864 @node Byte Order
15865 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
15866
15867 @cindex choosing target byte order
15868 @cindex target byte order
15869
15870 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
15871 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
15872 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
15873 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
15874 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
15875 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
15876
15877 @table @code
15878 @kindex set endian
15879 @item set endian big
15880 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
15881
15882 @item set endian little
15883 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
15884
15885 @item set endian auto
15886 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
15887 executable.
15888
15889 @item show endian
15890 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
15891
15892 @end table
15893
15894 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
15895 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
15896 target system.
15897
15898
15899 @node Remote Debugging
15900 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
15901 @cindex remote debugging
15902
15903 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
15904 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
15905 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
15906 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
15907 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
15908
15909 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
15910 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
15911 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
15912 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
15913 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
15914 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
15915
15916 Other remote targets may be available in your
15917 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
15918
15919 @menu
15920 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
15921 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
15922 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
15923 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
15924 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
15925 @end menu
15926
15927 @node Connecting
15928 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
15929
15930 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
15931 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
15932 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
15933 program as the first argument.
15934
15935 @cindex @code{target remote}
15936 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
15937 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
15938 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
15939 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
15940 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
15941 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
15942
15943 @table @code
15944
15945 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
15946 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
15947 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
15948 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
15949
15950 @smallexample
15951 target remote /dev/ttyb
15952 @end smallexample
15953
15954 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
15955 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
15956 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
15957 @code{target} command.
15958
15959 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
15960 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
15961 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
15962 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
15963 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
15964 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
15965 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
15966 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
15967 target.
15968
15969 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
15970 @code{manyfarms}:
15971
15972 @smallexample
15973 target remote manyfarms:2828
15974 @end smallexample
15975
15976 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
15977 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
15978 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
15979 port 1234 on your local machine:
15980
15981 @smallexample
15982 target remote :1234
15983 @end smallexample
15984 @noindent
15985
15986 Note that the colon is still required here.
15987
15988 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
15989 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
15990 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
15991 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
15992
15993 @smallexample
15994 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
15995 @end smallexample
15996
15997 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
15998 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
15999 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
16000 cause havoc with your debugging session.
16001
16002 @item target remote | @var{command}
16003 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
16004 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
16005 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
16006 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
16007 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
16008 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
16009 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
16010 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
16011
16012 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
16013 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
16014 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
16015
16016 @end table
16017
16018 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
16019 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
16020 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
16021 need to use @kbd{run}.
16022
16023 @cindex interrupting remote programs
16024 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
16025 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
16026 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
16027 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
16028 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
16029 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
16030
16031 @smallexample
16032 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
16033 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
16034 @end smallexample
16035
16036 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
16037 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
16038 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
16039 goes back to waiting.
16040
16041 @table @code
16042 @kindex detach (remote)
16043 @item detach
16044 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
16045 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
16046 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
16047 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
16048 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
16049
16050 @kindex disconnect
16051 @item disconnect
16052 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
16053 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
16054 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
16055 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
16056 another target.
16057
16058 @cindex send command to remote monitor
16059 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
16060 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
16061 @kindex monitor
16062 @item monitor @var{cmd}
16063 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
16064 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
16065 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
16066 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
16067 and implement.
16068 @end table
16069
16070 @node File Transfer
16071 @section Sending files to a remote system
16072 @cindex remote target, file transfer
16073 @cindex file transfer
16074 @cindex sending files to remote systems
16075
16076 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
16077 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
16078 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
16079 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
16080 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
16081 the only way to upload or download files.
16082
16083 Not all remote targets support these commands.
16084
16085 @table @code
16086 @kindex remote put
16087 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
16088 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
16089 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
16090
16091 @kindex remote get
16092 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
16093 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
16094 on the host system.
16095
16096 @kindex remote delete
16097 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
16098 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
16099
16100 @end table
16101
16102 @node Server
16103 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
16104
16105 @kindex gdbserver
16106 @cindex remote connection without stubs
16107 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
16108 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
16109 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
16110
16111 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
16112 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
16113 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
16114 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
16115 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
16116 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
16117 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
16118 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
16119 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
16120 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
16121 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
16122 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
16123 choice for debugging.
16124
16125 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
16126 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
16127 protocol.
16128
16129 @quotation
16130 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
16131 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
16132 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
16133 target system with the same privileges as the user running
16134 @code{gdbserver}.
16135 @end quotation
16136
16137 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
16138 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
16139 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
16140
16141 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
16142 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
16143 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
16144 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
16145 system does all the symbol handling.
16146
16147 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
16148 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
16149 syntax is:
16150
16151 @smallexample
16152 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
16153 @end smallexample
16154
16155 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
16156 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
16157 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
16158 @file{/dev/com1}:
16159
16160 @smallexample
16161 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
16162 @end smallexample
16163
16164 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
16165 with it.
16166
16167 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
16168
16169 @smallexample
16170 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
16171 @end smallexample
16172
16173 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
16174 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
16175 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
16176 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
16177 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
16178 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
16179 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
16180 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
16181 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
16182 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
16183 @code{target remote} command.
16184
16185 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
16186 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
16187 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
16188
16189 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
16190 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
16191
16192 @smallexample
16193 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
16194 @end smallexample
16195
16196 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
16197 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
16198
16199 @pindex pidof
16200 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
16201 @code{pidof} utility:
16202
16203 @smallexample
16204 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
16205 @end smallexample
16206
16207 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
16208 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
16209 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
16210
16211 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
16212 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, multiple processes
16213 @cindex multiple processes with @code{gdbserver}
16214
16215 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
16216 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
16217 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
16218 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
16219
16220 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
16221 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
16222 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
16223 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
16224 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
16225 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
16226 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
16227 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
16228 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
16229
16230 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
16231 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
16232 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
16233 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
16234 the program you want to debug.
16235
16236 In multi-process mode @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit unless you
16237 use the option @option{--once}. You can terminate it by using
16238 @code{monitor exit} (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). Note that the
16239 conditions under which @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN}
16240 connects to it (@kbd{target remote} or @kbd{target extended-remote}). The
16241 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
16242
16243 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
16244
16245 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP port.
16246
16247 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
16248 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
16249 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
16250 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
16251 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
16252 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
16253 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
16254 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
16255
16256 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
16257 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
16258 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
16259
16260 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
16261 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
16262 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
16263 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
16264 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
16265 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
16266 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
16267 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
16268 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
16269 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
16270 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
16271 instance closes its port after the first connection.
16272
16273 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
16274
16275 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
16276 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
16277 status information about the debugging process.
16278 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
16279 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
16280 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
16281 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
16282
16283 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
16284 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
16285 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
16286 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
16287 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
16288
16289 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
16290 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
16291 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
16292 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
16293
16294 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
16295 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
16296 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
16297 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
16298
16299 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
16300 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
16301 environment:
16302
16303 @smallexample
16304 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
16305 @end smallexample
16306
16307 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
16308
16309 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
16310
16311 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
16312 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
16313 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
16314 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
16315
16316 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
16317 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
16318 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
16319 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
16320 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
16321 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
16322 programs.
16323
16324 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
16325 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
16326 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
16327 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
16328 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
16329 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
16330 already on the target.
16331
16332 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
16333 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
16334 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
16335
16336 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
16337 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
16338 Here are the available commands.
16339
16340 @table @code
16341 @item monitor help
16342 List the available monitor commands.
16343
16344 @item monitor set debug 0
16345 @itemx monitor set debug 1
16346 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
16347
16348 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
16349 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
16350 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
16351 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
16352
16353 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
16354 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
16355 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
16356 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
16357 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
16358 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to an empty list.
16359
16360 @item monitor exit
16361 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
16362 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
16363 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
16364 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
16365 of a multi-process mode debug session.
16366
16367 @end table
16368
16369 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
16370 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
16371
16372 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
16373 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
16374
16375 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
16376 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
16377 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
16378 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
16379 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
16380 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
16381 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
16382 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
16383 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
16384 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
16385 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
16386 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
16387
16388 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
16389
16390 @table @code
16391 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
16392
16393 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
16394 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
16395 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
16396
16397 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
16398
16399 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
16400 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
16401 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
16402 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
16403 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
16404 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
16405
16406 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
16407
16408 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
16409 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
16410 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
16411 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
16412 command for that. For example:
16413
16414 @smallexample
16415 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
16416 @end smallexample
16417
16418 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
16419 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
16420 @end table
16421
16422 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
16423 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
16424 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
16425 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
16426 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
16427 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
16428 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
16429 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
16430 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
16431 @code{gdbserver} like so:
16432
16433 @smallexample
16434 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
16435 @end smallexample
16436
16437 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
16438
16439 @smallexample
16440 $ gdb myprogram
16441 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
16442 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
16443 (@value{GDBP}) b main
16444 (@value{GDBP}) continue
16445 @end smallexample
16446
16447 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
16448 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
16449 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
16450 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
16451 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
16452 tracing.
16453
16454 @node Remote Configuration
16455 @section Remote Configuration
16456
16457 @kindex set remote
16458 @kindex show remote
16459 This section documents the configuration options available when
16460 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
16461 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
16462 system-call-allowed}.
16463
16464 @table @code
16465 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
16466 @cindex address size for remote targets
16467 @cindex bits in remote address
16468 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
16469 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
16470 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
16471 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
16472
16473 @item show remoteaddresssize
16474 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
16475
16476 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
16477 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
16478 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
16479 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
16480 remote targets.
16481
16482 @item show remotebaud
16483 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
16484
16485 @item set remotebreak
16486 @cindex interrupt remote programs
16487 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
16488 @anchor{set remotebreak}
16489 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
16490 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
16491 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
16492 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
16493 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
16494
16495 @item show remotebreak
16496 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
16497 interrupt the remote program.
16498
16499 @item set remoteflow on
16500 @itemx set remoteflow off
16501 @kindex set remoteflow
16502 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
16503 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
16504
16505 @item show remoteflow
16506 @kindex show remoteflow
16507 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
16508
16509 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
16510 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
16511 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
16512 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
16513 @code{ascii}.
16514
16515 @item show remotelogbase
16516 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
16517 protocol.
16518
16519 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
16520 @cindex record serial communications on file
16521 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
16522 default is not to record at all.
16523
16524 @item show remotelogfile.
16525 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
16526 serial communications.
16527
16528 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
16529 @cindex timeout for serial communications
16530 @cindex remote timeout
16531 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
16532 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
16533
16534 @item show remotetimeout
16535 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
16536 responses.
16537
16538 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
16539 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
16540 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
16541 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
16542 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
16543 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
16544 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
16545 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
16546
16547 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
16548 @itemx show remote exec-file
16549 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
16550 @cindex executable file, for remote target
16551 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
16552 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
16553 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
16554 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
16555
16556 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
16557 @cindex interrupt remote programs
16558 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
16559 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
16560 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
16561 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
16562 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
16563 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
16564 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
16565 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
16566
16567 @item show interrupt-sequence
16568 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
16569 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
16570 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
16571 also known as Magic SysRq g.
16572
16573 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
16574 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
16575 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
16576 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
16577 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
16578 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
16579
16580 @item show interrupt-on-connect
16581 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
16582 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
16583
16584 @kindex set tcp
16585 @kindex show tcp
16586 @item set tcp auto-retry on
16587 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
16588 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
16589 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
16590 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
16591 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
16592 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
16593 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
16594 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
16595
16596 @item set tcp auto-retry off
16597 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
16598
16599 @item show tcp auto-retry
16600 Show the current auto-retry setting.
16601
16602 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
16603 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
16604 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
16605 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
16606 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
16607 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
16608 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
16609 value.
16610
16611 @item show tcp connect-timeout
16612 Show the current connection timeout setting.
16613 @end table
16614
16615 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
16616 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
16617 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
16618 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
16619 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
16620 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
16621 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
16622 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
16623 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
16624
16625 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
16626 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
16627 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
16628 @value{GDBN} developers.
16629
16630 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
16631 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
16632 are:
16633
16634 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
16635 @item Command Name
16636 @tab Remote Packet
16637 @tab Related Features
16638
16639 @item @code{fetch-register}
16640 @tab @code{p}
16641 @tab @code{info registers}
16642
16643 @item @code{set-register}
16644 @tab @code{P}
16645 @tab @code{set}
16646
16647 @item @code{binary-download}
16648 @tab @code{X}
16649 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
16650
16651 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
16652 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
16653 @tab @code{info auxv}
16654
16655 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
16656 @tab @code{qSymbol}
16657 @tab Detecting multiple threads
16658
16659 @item @code{attach}
16660 @tab @code{vAttach}
16661 @tab @code{attach}
16662
16663 @item @code{verbose-resume}
16664 @tab @code{vCont}
16665 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
16666
16667 @item @code{run}
16668 @tab @code{vRun}
16669 @tab @code{run}
16670
16671 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
16672 @tab @code{Z0}
16673 @tab @code{break}
16674
16675 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
16676 @tab @code{Z1}
16677 @tab @code{hbreak}
16678
16679 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
16680 @tab @code{Z2}
16681 @tab @code{watch}
16682
16683 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
16684 @tab @code{Z3}
16685 @tab @code{rwatch}
16686
16687 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
16688 @tab @code{Z4}
16689 @tab @code{awatch}
16690
16691 @item @code{target-features}
16692 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
16693 @tab @code{set architecture}
16694
16695 @item @code{library-info}
16696 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
16697 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
16698
16699 @item @code{memory-map}
16700 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
16701 @tab @code{info mem}
16702
16703 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
16704 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
16705 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
16706
16707 @item @code{read-spu-object}
16708 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
16709 @tab @code{info spu}
16710
16711 @item @code{write-spu-object}
16712 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
16713 @tab @code{info spu}
16714
16715 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
16716 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
16717 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
16718
16719 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
16720 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
16721 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
16722
16723 @item @code{threads}
16724 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
16725 @tab @code{info threads}
16726
16727 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
16728 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
16729 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
16730
16731 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
16732 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
16733 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
16734
16735 @item @code{search-memory}
16736 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
16737 @tab @code{find}
16738
16739 @item @code{supported-packets}
16740 @tab @code{qSupported}
16741 @tab Remote communications parameters
16742
16743 @item @code{pass-signals}
16744 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
16745 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
16746
16747 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
16748 @tab @code{vFile:close}
16749 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
16750
16751 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
16752 @tab @code{vFile:open}
16753 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
16754
16755 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
16756 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
16757 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
16758
16759 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
16760 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
16761 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
16762
16763 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
16764 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
16765 @tab @code{remote delete}
16766
16767 @item @code{noack-packet}
16768 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
16769 @tab Packet acknowledgment
16770
16771 @item @code{osdata}
16772 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
16773 @tab @code{info os}
16774
16775 @item @code{query-attached}
16776 @tab @code{qAttached}
16777 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
16778
16779 @item @code{traceframe-info}
16780 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
16781 @tab Traceframe info
16782 @end multitable
16783
16784 @node Remote Stub
16785 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
16786
16787 @cindex debugging stub, example
16788 @cindex remote stub, example
16789 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
16790 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
16791 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
16792 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
16793 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
16794 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
16795 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
16796 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
16797
16798 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
16799 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
16800 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
16801 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
16802 program, you need:
16803
16804 @enumerate
16805 @item
16806 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
16807 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
16808 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
16809
16810 @item
16811 A C subroutine library to support your program's
16812 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
16813
16814 @item
16815 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
16816 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
16817 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
16818 documentation.
16819 @end enumerate
16820
16821 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
16822 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
16823 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
16824
16825 @table @emph
16826 @item On the host,
16827 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
16828 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
16829 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16830
16831 @item On the target,
16832 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
16833 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
16834 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
16835
16836 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
16837 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
16838 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
16839 @end table
16840
16841 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
16842 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
16843 @sc{sparc} boards.
16844
16845 @cindex remote serial stub list
16846 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
16847
16848 @table @code
16849
16850 @item i386-stub.c
16851 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
16852 @cindex Intel
16853 @cindex i386
16854 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
16855
16856 @item m68k-stub.c
16857 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
16858 @cindex Motorola 680x0
16859 @cindex m680x0
16860 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
16861
16862 @item sh-stub.c
16863 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
16864 @cindex Renesas
16865 @cindex SH
16866 For Renesas SH architectures.
16867
16868 @item sparc-stub.c
16869 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
16870 @cindex Sparc
16871 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
16872
16873 @item sparcl-stub.c
16874 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
16875 @cindex Fujitsu
16876 @cindex SparcLite
16877 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
16878
16879 @end table
16880
16881 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
16882 recently added stubs.
16883
16884 @menu
16885 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
16886 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
16887 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
16888 @end menu
16889
16890 @node Stub Contents
16891 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
16892
16893 @cindex remote serial stub
16894 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
16895 subroutines:
16896
16897 @table @code
16898 @item set_debug_traps
16899 @findex set_debug_traps
16900 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
16901 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
16902 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
16903 beginning of your program.
16904
16905 @item handle_exception
16906 @findex handle_exception
16907 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
16908 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
16909 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
16910 run when a trap is triggered.
16911
16912 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
16913 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
16914 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
16915 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
16916 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
16917 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
16918 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
16919 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
16920 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
16921 machine.
16922
16923 @item breakpoint
16924 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
16925 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
16926 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
16927 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
16928 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
16929 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
16930 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
16931 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
16932 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
16933 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
16934 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
16935
16936 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
16937 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
16938 start of your debugging session.
16939 @end table
16940
16941 @node Bootstrapping
16942 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
16943
16944 @cindex remote stub, support routines
16945 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
16946 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
16947 debugging target machine.
16948
16949 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
16950 serial port.
16951
16952 @table @code
16953 @item int getDebugChar()
16954 @findex getDebugChar
16955 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
16956 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
16957 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
16958
16959 @item void putDebugChar(int)
16960 @findex putDebugChar
16961 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
16962 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
16963 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
16964 @end table
16965
16966 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
16967 @cindex interrupting remote targets
16968 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
16969 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
16970 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
16971 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
16972 remote system to stop.
16973
16974 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
16975 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
16976 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
16977 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
16978
16979 Other routines you need to supply are:
16980
16981 @table @code
16982 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
16983 @findex exceptionHandler
16984 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
16985 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
16986 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
16987 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
16988 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
16989 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
16990 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
16991 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
16992 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
16993 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
16994 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
16995 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
16996 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
16997
16998 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
16999 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
17000 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
17001 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
17002 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
17003
17004 @item void flush_i_cache()
17005 @findex flush_i_cache
17006 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
17007 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
17008 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
17009
17010 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
17011 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
17012 @end table
17013
17014 @noindent
17015 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
17016
17017 @table @code
17018 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
17019 @findex memset
17020 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
17021 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
17022 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
17023 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
17024 @end table
17025
17026 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
17027 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
17028 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
17029 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
17030
17031
17032 @node Debug Session
17033 @subsection Putting it All Together
17034
17035 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
17036 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
17037 steps.
17038
17039 @enumerate
17040 @item
17041 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
17042 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
17043 @display
17044 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
17045 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
17046 @end display
17047
17048 @item
17049 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
17050
17051 @smallexample
17052 set_debug_traps();
17053 breakpoint();
17054 @end smallexample
17055
17056 @item
17057 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
17058 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
17059
17060 @smallexample
17061 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
17062 @end smallexample
17063
17064 @noindent
17065 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
17066 function in your program, that function is called when
17067 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
17068 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
17069 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
17070
17071 @item
17072 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
17073 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
17074
17075 @item
17076 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
17077 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
17078
17079 @item
17080 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
17081 @c document that. FIXME.
17082 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
17083 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
17084
17085 @item
17086 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
17087 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
17088
17089 @end enumerate
17090
17091 @node Configurations
17092 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
17093
17094 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
17095 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
17096 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
17097
17098 There are three major categories of configurations: native
17099 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
17100 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
17101 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
17102 are quite different from each other.
17103
17104 @menu
17105 * Native::
17106 * Embedded OS::
17107 * Embedded Processors::
17108 * Architectures::
17109 @end menu
17110
17111 @node Native
17112 @section Native
17113
17114 This section describes details specific to particular native
17115 configurations.
17116
17117 @menu
17118 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
17119 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
17120 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
17121 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
17122 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
17123 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
17124 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
17125 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
17126 @end menu
17127
17128 @node HP-UX
17129 @subsection HP-UX
17130
17131 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
17132 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
17133 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
17134
17135
17136 @node BSD libkvm Interface
17137 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
17138
17139 @cindex libkvm
17140 @cindex kernel memory image
17141 @cindex kernel crash dump
17142
17143 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
17144 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
17145 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
17146 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
17147 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
17148 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
17149 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
17150 @code{kvm} target:
17151
17152 @smallexample
17153 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
17154 @end smallexample
17155
17156 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
17157 argument:
17158
17159 @smallexample
17160 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
17161 @end smallexample
17162
17163 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
17164 available:
17165
17166 @table @code
17167 @kindex kvm
17168 @item kvm pcb
17169 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
17170
17171 @item kvm proc
17172 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
17173 modern FreeBSD systems.
17174 @end table
17175
17176 @node SVR4 Process Information
17177 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
17178 @cindex /proc
17179 @cindex examine process image
17180 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
17181
17182 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
17183 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
17184 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
17185 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
17186 proc} is available to report information about the process running
17187 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
17188 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
17189 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
17190 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
17191
17192 @table @code
17193 @kindex info proc
17194 @cindex process ID
17195 @item info proc
17196 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
17197 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
17198 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
17199 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
17200 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
17201 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
17202 executable file's absolute file name.
17203
17204 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
17205 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
17206 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
17207 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
17208 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
17209 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
17210
17211 @item info proc mappings
17212 @cindex memory address space mappings
17213 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
17214 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
17215 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
17216 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
17217 memory access rights to that range.
17218
17219 @item info proc stat
17220 @itemx info proc status
17221 @cindex process detailed status information
17222 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
17223 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
17224 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
17225 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
17226 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
17227 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
17228 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
17229
17230 @item info proc all
17231 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
17232 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
17233
17234 @ignore
17235 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
17236 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
17237 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
17238 @kindex info proc times
17239 @item info proc times
17240 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
17241 its children.
17242
17243 @kindex info proc id
17244 @item info proc id
17245 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
17246 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
17247 @end ignore
17248
17249 @item set procfs-trace
17250 @kindex set procfs-trace
17251 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
17252 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
17253
17254 @item show procfs-trace
17255 @kindex show procfs-trace
17256 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
17257
17258 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
17259 @kindex set procfs-file
17260 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
17261 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
17262 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
17263 standard output.
17264
17265 @item show procfs-file
17266 @kindex show procfs-file
17267 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
17268
17269 @item proc-trace-entry
17270 @itemx proc-trace-exit
17271 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
17272 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
17273 @kindex proc-trace-entry
17274 @kindex proc-trace-exit
17275 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
17276 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
17277 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
17278 from the @code{syscall} interface.
17279
17280 @item info pidlist
17281 @kindex info pidlist
17282 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
17283 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
17284 processes and all the threads within each process.
17285
17286 @item info meminfo
17287 @kindex info meminfo
17288 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
17289 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
17290 @end table
17291
17292 @node DJGPP Native
17293 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
17294 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
17295 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
17296 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
17297
17298 @cindex DPMI
17299 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
17300 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
17301 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
17302 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
17303
17304 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
17305 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
17306 subsection describes those commands.
17307
17308 @table @code
17309 @kindex info dos
17310 @item info dos
17311 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
17312 information about the target system and important OS structures.
17313
17314 @kindex sysinfo
17315 @cindex MS-DOS system info
17316 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
17317 @item info dos sysinfo
17318 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
17319 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
17320 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
17321
17322 @cindex GDT
17323 @cindex LDT
17324 @cindex IDT
17325 @cindex segment descriptor tables
17326 @cindex descriptor tables display
17327 @item info dos gdt
17328 @itemx info dos ldt
17329 @itemx info dos idt
17330 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
17331 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
17332 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
17333 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
17334 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
17335 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
17336 rights.
17337
17338 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
17339 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
17340 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
17341 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
17342 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
17343
17344 @cindex garbled pointers
17345 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
17346 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
17347 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
17348 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
17349 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
17350 debugged program's data segment:
17351
17352 @smallexample
17353 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
17354 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
17355 @end smallexample
17356
17357 @noindent
17358 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
17359 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
17360
17361 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
17362 @item info dos pde
17363 @itemx info dos pte
17364 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
17365 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
17366 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
17367 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
17368 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
17369 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
17370 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
17371 that is currently in use.
17372
17373 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
17374 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
17375 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
17376 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
17377 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
17378 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
17379 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
17380
17381 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
17382 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
17383 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
17384 controller.
17385
17386 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
17387
17388 @cindex physical address from linear address
17389 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
17390 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
17391 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
17392 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
17393 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
17394 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
17395 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
17396
17397 @smallexample
17398 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
17399 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
17400 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
17401 @end smallexample
17402
17403 @noindent
17404 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
17405 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
17406 attributes of that page.
17407
17408 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
17409 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
17410 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
17411 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
17412 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
17413 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
17414
17415 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
17416 transfer buffer:
17417
17418 @smallexample
17419 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
17420 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
17421 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
17422 @end smallexample
17423
17424 @noindent
17425 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
17426 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
17427 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
17428 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
17429 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
17430
17431 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
17432 @end table
17433
17434 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
17435 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
17436 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
17437 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
17438
17439 @table @code
17440 @kindex set com1base
17441 @kindex set com1irq
17442 @kindex set com2base
17443 @kindex set com2irq
17444 @kindex set com3base
17445 @kindex set com3irq
17446 @kindex set com4base
17447 @kindex set com4irq
17448 @item set com1base @var{addr}
17449 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
17450 port.
17451
17452 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
17453 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
17454 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
17455
17456 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
17457 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
17458 other 3 COM ports.
17459
17460 @kindex show com1base
17461 @kindex show com1irq
17462 @kindex show com2base
17463 @kindex show com2irq
17464 @kindex show com3base
17465 @kindex show com3irq
17466 @kindex show com4base
17467 @kindex show com4irq
17468 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
17469 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
17470 lines used by the COM ports.
17471
17472 @item info serial
17473 @kindex info serial
17474 @cindex DOS serial port status
17475 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
17476 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
17477 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
17478 counts of various errors encountered so far.
17479 @end table
17480
17481
17482 @node Cygwin Native
17483 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
17484 @cindex MS Windows debugging
17485 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
17486 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
17487
17488 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
17489 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
17490
17491 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
17492 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
17493 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
17494 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
17495 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
17496 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
17497 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
17498 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
17499
17500 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
17501 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
17502 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
17503
17504 @table @code
17505 @kindex info w32
17506 @item info w32
17507 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
17508 information about the target system and important OS structures.
17509
17510 @item info w32 selector
17511 This command displays information returned by
17512 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
17513 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
17514 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
17515 Without argument, this command displays information
17516 about the six segment registers.
17517
17518 @item info w32 thread-information-block
17519 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
17520 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
17521 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
17522
17523 @kindex info dll
17524 @item info dll
17525 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
17526
17527 @kindex dll-symbols
17528 @item dll-symbols
17529 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
17530 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
17531
17532 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
17533 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
17534 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
17535 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
17536 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
17537 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
17538 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
17539 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
17540 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
17541 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
17542 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
17543
17544 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
17545 @item show cygwin-exceptions
17546 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
17547 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
17548
17549 @kindex set new-console
17550 @item set new-console @var{mode}
17551 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
17552 be started in a new console on next start.
17553 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
17554 be started in the same console as the debugger.
17555
17556 @kindex show new-console
17557 @item show new-console
17558 Displays whether a new console is used
17559 when the debuggee is started.
17560
17561 @kindex set new-group
17562 @item set new-group @var{mode}
17563 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
17564 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
17565 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
17566 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
17567
17568 @kindex show new-group
17569 @item show new-group
17570 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
17571
17572 @kindex set debugevents
17573 @item set debugevents
17574 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
17575 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
17576 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
17577 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
17578 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
17579
17580 @kindex set debugexec
17581 @item set debugexec
17582 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
17583 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
17584
17585 @kindex set debugexceptions
17586 @item set debugexceptions
17587 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
17588 debuggee seen by the debugger.
17589
17590 @kindex set debugmemory
17591 @item set debugmemory
17592 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
17593 and writes by the debugger.
17594
17595 @kindex set shell
17596 @item set shell
17597 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
17598 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
17599
17600 @kindex show shell
17601 @item show shell
17602 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
17603
17604 @end table
17605
17606 @menu
17607 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
17608 @end menu
17609
17610 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
17611 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
17612 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
17613 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
17614
17615 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
17616 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
17617 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
17618 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
17619 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
17620 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
17621 ``minimal symbols''.
17622
17623 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
17624 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
17625 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
17626 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
17627 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
17628 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
17629 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
17630 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
17631 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
17632 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
17633
17634 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
17635
17636 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
17637 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
17638 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
17639 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
17640 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
17641 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
17642 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
17643 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
17644 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
17645
17646 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
17647 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
17648 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
17649 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
17650 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
17651 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
17652
17653 @smallexample
17654 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
17655 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
17656
17657 Non-debugging symbols:
17658 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
17659 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
17660 @end smallexample
17661
17662 @smallexample
17663 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
17664 All functions matching regular expression "!":
17665
17666 Non-debugging symbols:
17667 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
17668 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
17669 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
17670 [etc...]
17671 @end smallexample
17672
17673 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
17674
17675 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
17676 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
17677 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
17678 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
17679 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
17680 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
17681 a function within a DLL without a running program.
17682
17683 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
17684 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
17685 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
17686 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
17687 problem:
17688
17689 @smallexample
17690 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
17691 $1 = 268572168
17692 @end smallexample
17693
17694 @smallexample
17695 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
17696 0x10021610: "\230y\""
17697 @end smallexample
17698
17699 And two possible solutions:
17700
17701 @smallexample
17702 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
17703 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
17704 @end smallexample
17705
17706 @smallexample
17707 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
17708 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
17709 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
17710 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
17711 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
17712 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
17713 @end smallexample
17714
17715 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
17716 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
17717 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
17718 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
17719 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
17720
17721 @smallexample
17722 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
17723 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
17724 @end smallexample
17725
17726 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
17727 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
17728 safe.
17729
17730 @node Hurd Native
17731 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
17732 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
17733
17734 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
17735 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
17736
17737 @table @code
17738 @item set signals
17739 @itemx set sigs
17740 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
17741 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
17742 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
17743 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
17744 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
17745 @code{signals}.
17746
17747 @item show signals
17748 @itemx show sigs
17749 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
17750 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
17751 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
17752
17753 @item set signal-thread
17754 @itemx set sigthread
17755 @kindex set signal-thread
17756 @kindex set sigthread
17757 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
17758 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
17759 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
17760 signal-thread}.
17761
17762 @item show signal-thread
17763 @itemx show sigthread
17764 @kindex show signal-thread
17765 @kindex show sigthread
17766 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
17767 delivered a signal.
17768
17769 @item set stopped
17770 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
17771 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
17772 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
17773 continued by delivering a signal to it.
17774
17775 @item show stopped
17776 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
17777 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
17778 stopped.
17779
17780 @item set exceptions
17781 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
17782 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
17783 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
17784 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
17785 trapping on.
17786
17787 @item show exceptions
17788 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
17789 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
17790
17791 @item set task pause
17792 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
17793 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
17794 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
17795 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
17796 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
17797 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
17798 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
17799 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
17800 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
17801
17802 @item show task pause
17803 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
17804 Show the current state of task suspension.
17805
17806 @item set task detach-suspend-count
17807 @cindex task suspend count
17808 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17809 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
17810 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
17811
17812 @item show task detach-suspend-count
17813 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
17814
17815 @item set task exception-port
17816 @itemx set task excp
17817 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17818 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
17819 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
17820 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
17821
17822 @item set noninvasive
17823 @cindex noninvasive task options
17824 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
17825 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
17826 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
17827 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
17828
17829 @item info send-rights
17830 @itemx info receive-rights
17831 @itemx info port-rights
17832 @itemx info port-sets
17833 @itemx info dead-names
17834 @itemx info ports
17835 @itemx info psets
17836 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17837 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17838 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17839 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17840 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17841 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
17842 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
17843 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
17844 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
17845
17846 @item set thread pause
17847 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
17848 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17849 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
17850 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
17851 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
17852 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
17853 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
17854 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
17855 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
17856 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
17857 only the current thread.
17858
17859 @item show thread pause
17860 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
17861 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
17862
17863 @item set thread run
17864 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
17865
17866 @item show thread run
17867 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
17868
17869 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
17870 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17871 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17872 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
17873 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
17874 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
17875 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
17876
17877 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
17878 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
17879 detaching.
17880
17881 @item set thread exception-port
17882 @itemx set thread excp
17883 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
17884 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
17885 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
17886
17887 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
17888 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
17889 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
17890 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
17891
17892 @item set thread default
17893 @itemx show thread default
17894 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17895 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
17896 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
17897 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
17898 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
17899 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
17900 the non-default commands.
17901 @end table
17902
17903
17904 @node Neutrino
17905 @subsection QNX Neutrino
17906 @cindex QNX Neutrino
17907
17908 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
17909 Neutrino target:
17910
17911 @table @code
17912 @item set debug nto-debug
17913 @kindex set debug nto-debug
17914 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
17915 Neutrino support.
17916
17917 @item show debug nto-debug
17918 @kindex show debug nto-debug
17919 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
17920 @end table
17921
17922 @node Darwin
17923 @subsection Darwin
17924 @cindex Darwin
17925
17926 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
17927
17928 @table @code
17929 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
17930 @kindex set debug darwin
17931 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
17932 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
17933
17934 @item show debug darwin
17935 @kindex show debug darwin
17936 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
17937
17938 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
17939 @kindex set debug mach-o
17940 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
17941 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
17942 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
17943 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
17944 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
17945 usage.
17946
17947 @item show debug mach-o
17948 @kindex show debug mach-o
17949 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
17950
17951 @item set mach-exceptions on
17952 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
17953 @kindex set mach-exceptions
17954 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
17955 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
17956 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
17957 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
17958
17959 @item show mach-exceptions
17960 @kindex show mach-exceptions
17961 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
17962 @end table
17963
17964
17965 @node Embedded OS
17966 @section Embedded Operating Systems
17967
17968 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
17969 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
17970 architectures.
17971
17972 @menu
17973 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
17974 @end menu
17975
17976 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
17977 various real-time operating systems.
17978
17979 @node VxWorks
17980 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
17981
17982 @cindex VxWorks
17983
17984 @table @code
17985
17986 @kindex target vxworks
17987 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
17988 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
17989 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
17990
17991 @end table
17992
17993 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
17994 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
17995
17996 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
17997 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
17998 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
17999 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
18000 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
18001 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
18002 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
18003
18004 @table @code
18005 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
18006 @kindex vxworks-timeout
18007 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
18008 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
18009 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
18010 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
18011 of a thin network line.
18012 @end table
18013
18014 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
18015 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
18016 procedures.
18017
18018 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
18019 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
18020 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
18021 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
18022 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
18023 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
18024 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
18025 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
18026 manual.
18027 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
18028
18029 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
18030 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
18031 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
18032 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
18033
18034 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
18035
18036 @smallexample
18037 (vxgdb)
18038 @end smallexample
18039
18040 @menu
18041 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
18042 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
18043 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
18044 @end menu
18045
18046 @node VxWorks Connection
18047 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
18048
18049 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
18050 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
18051
18052 @smallexample
18053 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
18054 @end smallexample
18055
18056 @need 750
18057 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
18058
18059 @smallexample
18060 Attaching remote machine across net...
18061 Connected to tt.
18062 @end smallexample
18063
18064 @need 1000
18065 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
18066 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
18067 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
18068 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
18069 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
18070
18071 @smallexample
18072 prog.o: No such file or directory.
18073 @end smallexample
18074
18075 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
18076 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
18077 command again.
18078
18079 @node VxWorks Download
18080 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
18081
18082 @cindex download to VxWorks
18083 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
18084 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
18085 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
18086 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
18087 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
18088 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
18089 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
18090 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
18091 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
18092 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
18093 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
18094 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
18095 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
18096 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
18097 program, type this on VxWorks:
18098
18099 @smallexample
18100 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
18101 @end smallexample
18102
18103 @noindent
18104 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
18105
18106 @smallexample
18107 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
18108 (vxgdb) load prog.o
18109 @end smallexample
18110
18111 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
18112
18113 @smallexample
18114 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
18115 @end smallexample
18116
18117 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
18118 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
18119 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
18120 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
18121 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
18122 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
18123 table.)
18124
18125 @node VxWorks Attach
18126 @subsubsection Running Tasks
18127
18128 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
18129 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
18130 follows:
18131
18132 @smallexample
18133 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
18134 @end smallexample
18135
18136 @noindent
18137 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
18138 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
18139 the time of attachment.
18140
18141 @node Embedded Processors
18142 @section Embedded Processors
18143
18144 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
18145 configurations.
18146
18147 @cindex send command to simulator
18148 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
18149 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
18150
18151 @table @code
18152 @item sim @var{command}
18153 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
18154 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
18155 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
18156 acceptable commands.
18157 @end table
18158
18159
18160 @menu
18161 * ARM:: ARM RDI
18162 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
18163 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
18164 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
18165 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
18166 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
18167 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
18168 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
18169 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
18170 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
18171 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
18172 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
18173 * CRIS:: CRIS
18174 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
18175 @end menu
18176
18177 @node ARM
18178 @subsection ARM
18179 @cindex ARM RDI
18180
18181 @table @code
18182 @kindex target rdi
18183 @item target rdi @var{dev}
18184 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
18185 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
18186 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
18187
18188 @kindex target rdp
18189 @item target rdp @var{dev}
18190 ARM Demon monitor.
18191
18192 @end table
18193
18194 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
18195
18196 @table @code
18197 @item set arm disassembler
18198 @kindex set arm
18199 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
18200 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
18201
18202 @item show arm disassembler
18203 @kindex show arm
18204 Show the current disassembly style.
18205
18206 @item set arm apcs32
18207 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
18208 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
18209
18210 @item show arm apcs32
18211 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
18212
18213 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
18214 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
18215 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
18216
18217 @table @code
18218 @item auto
18219 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
18220 @item softfpa
18221 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
18222 processors.
18223 @item fpa
18224 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
18225 @item softvfp
18226 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
18227 @item vfp
18228 VFP co-processor.
18229 @end table
18230
18231 @item show arm fpu
18232 Show the current type of the FPU.
18233
18234 @item set arm abi
18235 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
18236
18237 @item show arm abi
18238 Show the currently used ABI.
18239
18240 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
18241 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
18242 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
18243 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
18244 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
18245 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
18246 register).
18247
18248 @item show arm fallback-mode
18249 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
18250
18251 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
18252 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
18253 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
18254 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
18255 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
18256
18257 @item show arm force-mode
18258 Show the current forced instruction mode.
18259
18260 @item set debug arm
18261 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
18262 target support subsystem.
18263
18264 @item show debug arm
18265 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
18266 @end table
18267
18268 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
18269 using the RDI interface:
18270
18271 @table @code
18272 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
18273 @kindex rdilogfile
18274 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
18275 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
18276 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
18277 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
18278 @file{rdi.log}.
18279
18280 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
18281 @kindex rdilogenable
18282 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
18283 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
18284 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
18285 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
18286 are logged to a file.
18287
18288 @item set rdiromatzero
18289 @kindex set rdiromatzero
18290 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
18291 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
18292 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
18293 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
18294 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
18295
18296 @item show rdiromatzero
18297 @kindex show rdiromatzero
18298 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
18299
18300 @item set rdiheartbeat
18301 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
18302 @cindex RDI heartbeat
18303 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
18304 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
18305 well as the Angel monitor.
18306
18307 @item show rdiheartbeat
18308 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
18309 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
18310 @end table
18311
18312 @table @code
18313 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
18314 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
18315
18316 @table @code
18317 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
18318 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support.
18319 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
18320 The default value is @code{all}.
18321
18322 @table @code
18323 @item none
18324 @item demon
18325 @item angel
18326 @item redboot
18327 @item all
18328 @end table
18329 @end table
18330 @end table
18331
18332 @node M32R/D
18333 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
18334
18335 @table @code
18336 @kindex target m32r
18337 @item target m32r @var{dev}
18338 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
18339
18340 @kindex target m32rsdi
18341 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
18342 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
18343 @end table
18344
18345 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
18346
18347 @table @code
18348 @item set download-path @var{path}
18349 @kindex set download-path
18350 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
18351 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
18352
18353 @item show download-path
18354 @kindex show download-path
18355 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
18356
18357 @item set board-address @var{addr}
18358 @kindex set board-address
18359 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
18360 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
18361
18362 @item show board-address
18363 @kindex show board-address
18364 Show the current IP address of the target board.
18365
18366 @item set server-address @var{addr}
18367 @kindex set server-address
18368 @cindex download server address (M32R)
18369 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
18370 host machine.
18371
18372 @item show server-address
18373 @kindex show server-address
18374 Display the IP address of the download server.
18375
18376 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
18377 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
18378 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
18379 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
18380 executable file is uploaded.
18381
18382 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
18383 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
18384 Test the @code{upload} command.
18385 @end table
18386
18387 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
18388
18389 @table @code
18390 @item sdireset
18391 @kindex sdireset
18392 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
18393 This command resets the SDI connection.
18394
18395 @item sdistatus
18396 @kindex sdistatus
18397 This command shows the SDI connection status.
18398
18399 @item debug_chaos
18400 @kindex debug_chaos
18401 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
18402 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
18403
18404 @item use_debug_dma
18405 @kindex use_debug_dma
18406 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
18407
18408 @item use_mon_code
18409 @kindex use_mon_code
18410 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
18411
18412 @item use_ib_break
18413 @kindex use_ib_break
18414 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
18415
18416 @item use_dbt_break
18417 @kindex use_dbt_break
18418 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
18419 @end table
18420
18421 @node M68K
18422 @subsection M68k
18423
18424 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
18425 target command for the following ROM monitor.
18426
18427 @table @code
18428
18429 @kindex target dbug
18430 @item target dbug @var{dev}
18431 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
18432
18433 @end table
18434
18435 @node MicroBlaze
18436 @subsection MicroBlaze
18437 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
18438 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
18439
18440 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
18441 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
18442 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
18443 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
18444 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
18445 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
18446 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
18447 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
18448 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
18449 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
18450 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
18451
18452 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
18453
18454 @table @code
18455 @item target remote :1234
18456 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
18457 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
18458
18459 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
18460 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
18461 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
18462
18463 @item load
18464 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
18465
18466 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
18467 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
18468
18469 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
18470 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
18471 @end table
18472
18473 @node MIPS Embedded
18474 @subsection MIPS Embedded
18475
18476 @cindex MIPS boards
18477 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
18478 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
18479 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
18480
18481 @need 1000
18482 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
18483
18484 @table @code
18485 @item target mips @var{port}
18486 @kindex target mips @var{port}
18487 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
18488 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
18489 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
18490 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
18491 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
18492 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
18493
18494 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
18495 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
18496 debugger:
18497
18498 @smallexample
18499 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
18500 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
18501 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
18502 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
18503 (@value{GDBP}) run
18504 @end smallexample
18505
18506 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
18507 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
18508 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
18509 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
18510 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
18511
18512 @item target pmon @var{port}
18513 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
18514 PMON ROM monitor.
18515
18516 @item target ddb @var{port}
18517 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
18518 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
18519
18520 @item target lsi @var{port}
18521 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
18522 LSI variant of PMON.
18523
18524 @kindex target r3900
18525 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
18526 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
18527
18528 @kindex target array
18529 @item target array @var{dev}
18530 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
18531
18532 @end table
18533
18534
18535 @noindent
18536 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
18537
18538 @table @code
18539 @item set mipsfpu double
18540 @itemx set mipsfpu single
18541 @itemx set mipsfpu none
18542 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
18543 @itemx show mipsfpu
18544 @kindex set mipsfpu
18545 @kindex show mipsfpu
18546 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
18547 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
18548 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
18549 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
18550 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
18551 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
18552 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
18553 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
18554 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
18555 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
18556 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
18557 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
18558 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
18559
18560 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
18561 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
18562 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
18563
18564 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
18565 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
18566
18567 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
18568 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
18569 @itemx show timeout
18570 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
18571 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
18572 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
18573 @kindex set timeout
18574 @kindex show timeout
18575 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
18576 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
18577 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
18578 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
18579 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
18580 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
18581 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
18582 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
18583 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
18584 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
18585
18586 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
18587 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
18588 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
18589 to run before stopping.
18590
18591 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
18592 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
18593 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
18594 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
18595 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
18596 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
18597
18598 @item show syn-garbage-limit
18599 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
18600 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
18601 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
18602
18603 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
18604 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
18605 @cindex remote monitor prompt
18606 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
18607 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
18608 @table @asis
18609 @item pmon target
18610 @samp{PMON}
18611 @item ddb target
18612 @samp{NEC010}
18613 @item lsi target
18614 @samp{PMON>}
18615 @end table
18616
18617 @item show monitor-prompt
18618 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
18619 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
18620 remote monitor.
18621
18622 @item set monitor-warnings
18623 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
18624 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
18625 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
18626 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
18627 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
18628
18629 @item show monitor-warnings
18630 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
18631 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
18632
18633 @item pmon @var{command}
18634 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
18635 @cindex send PMON command
18636 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
18637 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
18638 @end table
18639
18640 @node OpenRISC 1000
18641 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
18642 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
18643
18644 @cindex or1k boards
18645 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
18646 about platform and commands.
18647
18648 @table @code
18649
18650 @kindex target jtag
18651 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
18652
18653 Connects to remote JTAG server.
18654 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
18655 connected via parallel port to the board.
18656
18657 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
18658
18659 @kindex or1ksim
18660 @item or1ksim @var{command}
18661 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
18662 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
18663
18664 @kindex info or1k spr
18665 @item info or1k spr
18666 Displays spr groups.
18667
18668 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
18669 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
18670 Displays register names in selected group.
18671
18672 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
18673 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
18674 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
18675 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
18676 Shows information about specified spr register.
18677
18678 @kindex spr
18679 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
18680 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
18681 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
18682 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
18683 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
18684 @end table
18685
18686 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
18687 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
18688 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
18689 triggers can be set using:
18690 @table @code
18691 @item $LEA/$LDATA
18692 Load effective address/data
18693 @item $SEA/$SDATA
18694 Store effective address/data
18695 @item $AEA/$ADATA
18696 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
18697 @item $FETCH
18698 Fetch data
18699 @end table
18700
18701 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
18702 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
18703
18704 @code{htrace} commands:
18705 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
18706 @table @code
18707 @kindex hwatch
18708 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
18709 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
18710 or Data. For example:
18711
18712 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
18713
18714 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
18715
18716 @kindex htrace
18717 @item htrace info
18718 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
18719
18720 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
18721 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
18722
18723 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
18724 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
18725
18726 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
18727 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
18728
18729 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
18730 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
18731 triggered.
18732
18733 @item htrace enable
18734 @itemx htrace disable
18735 Enables/disables the HW trace.
18736
18737 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
18738 Clears currently recorded trace data.
18739
18740 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
18741 will be written there.
18742
18743 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
18744 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
18745
18746 @item htrace mode continuous
18747 Set continuous trace mode.
18748
18749 @item htrace mode suspend
18750 Set suspend trace mode.
18751
18752 @end table
18753
18754 @node PowerPC Embedded
18755 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
18756
18757 @cindex DVC register
18758 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
18759 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
18760
18761 @smallexample
18762 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
18763 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
18764 @end smallexample
18765
18766 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
18767 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
18768 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
18769 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
18770 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
18771 or newer.
18772
18773 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
18774 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
18775 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
18776 watching variables of scalar types.
18777
18778 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
18779 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
18780
18781 @smallexample
18782 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
18783 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
18784 @end smallexample
18785
18786 @cindex ranged breakpoint
18787 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
18788 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
18789 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
18790 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
18791 use the @code{break-range} command.
18792
18793 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
18794
18795 @table @code
18796 @kindex break-range
18797 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
18798 Set a breakpoint for an address range.
18799 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location} can specify a function name,
18800 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
18801 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
18802 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
18803 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
18804 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
18805 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
18806
18807 @kindex set powerpc
18808 @item set powerpc soft-float
18809 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
18810 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
18811 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
18812 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
18813
18814 @item set powerpc vector-abi
18815 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
18816 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
18817 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
18818 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
18819 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
18820 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
18821 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
18822
18823 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
18824 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
18825 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
18826 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
18827 address of its first byte.
18828
18829 @kindex target dink32
18830 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
18831 DINK32 ROM monitor.
18832
18833 @kindex target ppcbug
18834 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
18835 @kindex target ppcbug1
18836 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
18837 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
18838
18839 @kindex target sds
18840 @item target sds @var{dev}
18841 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
18842 @end table
18843
18844 @cindex SDS protocol
18845 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
18846 by @value{GDBN}:
18847
18848 @table @code
18849 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
18850 @kindex set sdstimeout
18851 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
18852 default is 2 seconds.
18853
18854 @item show sdstimeout
18855 @kindex show sdstimeout
18856 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
18857
18858 @item sds @var{command}
18859 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
18860 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
18861 @end table
18862
18863
18864 @node PA
18865 @subsection HP PA Embedded
18866
18867 @table @code
18868
18869 @kindex target op50n
18870 @item target op50n @var{dev}
18871 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
18872
18873 @kindex target w89k
18874 @item target w89k @var{dev}
18875 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
18876
18877 @end table
18878
18879 @node Sparclet
18880 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
18881
18882 @cindex Sparclet
18883
18884 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
18885 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
18886 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
18887 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
18888 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
18889
18890 @table @code
18891 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
18892 @kindex remotetimeout
18893 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
18894 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
18895 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
18896 @end table
18897
18898 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
18899 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
18900 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
18901 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
18902 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
18903
18904 @smallexample
18905 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
18906 @end smallexample
18907
18908 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
18909
18910 @smallexample
18911 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
18912 @end smallexample
18913
18914 @cindex running, on Sparclet
18915 Once you have set
18916 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
18917 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
18918 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
18919
18920 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
18921
18922 @smallexample
18923 (gdbslet)
18924 @end smallexample
18925
18926 @menu
18927 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
18928 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
18929 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
18930 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
18931 @end menu
18932
18933 @node Sparclet File
18934 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
18935
18936 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
18937
18938 @smallexample
18939 (gdbslet) file prog
18940 @end smallexample
18941
18942 @need 1000
18943 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
18944 @value{GDBN} locates
18945 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
18946 path.
18947 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
18948 files will be searched as well.
18949 @value{GDBN} locates
18950 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
18951 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
18952 If it fails
18953 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
18954
18955 @smallexample
18956 prog: No such file or directory.
18957 @end smallexample
18958
18959 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
18960 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
18961 @code{target} command again.
18962
18963 @node Sparclet Connection
18964 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
18965
18966 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
18967 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
18968
18969 @smallexample
18970 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
18971 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
18972 main () at ../prog.c:3
18973 @end smallexample
18974
18975 @need 750
18976 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
18977
18978 @smallexample
18979 Connected to ttya.
18980 @end smallexample
18981
18982 @node Sparclet Download
18983 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
18984
18985 @cindex download to Sparclet
18986 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
18987 you can use the @value{GDBN}
18988 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
18989 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
18990 command.
18991 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
18992 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
18993 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
18994 of each of the file's sections.
18995 For instance, if the program
18996 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
18997 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
18998
18999 @smallexample
19000 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
19001 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
19002 @end smallexample
19003
19004 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
19005 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
19006 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
19007
19008 @node Sparclet Execution
19009 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
19010
19011 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
19012 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
19013 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
19014 manual for the list of commands.
19015
19016 @smallexample
19017 (gdbslet) b main
19018 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
19019 (gdbslet) run
19020 Starting program: prog
19021 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
19022 3 char *symarg = 0;
19023 (gdbslet) step
19024 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
19025 (gdbslet)
19026 @end smallexample
19027
19028 @node Sparclite
19029 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
19030
19031 @table @code
19032
19033 @kindex target sparclite
19034 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
19035 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
19036 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
19037 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
19038 remote protocol.
19039
19040 @end table
19041
19042 @node Z8000
19043 @subsection Zilog Z8000
19044
19045 @cindex Z8000
19046 @cindex simulator, Z8000
19047 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
19048
19049 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
19050 a Z8000 simulator.
19051
19052 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
19053 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
19054 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
19055 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
19056
19057 @table @code
19058 @item target sim @var{args}
19059 @kindex sim
19060 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
19061 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
19062 options, specify them via @var{args}.
19063 @end table
19064
19065 @noindent
19066 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
19067 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
19068 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
19069 to run your program, and so on.
19070
19071 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
19072 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
19073 additional items of information as specially named registers:
19074
19075 @table @code
19076
19077 @item cycles
19078 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
19079
19080 @item insts
19081 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
19082
19083 @item time
19084 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
19085
19086 @end table
19087
19088 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
19089 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
19090 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
19091 simulated clock ticks.
19092
19093 @node AVR
19094 @subsection Atmel AVR
19095 @cindex AVR
19096
19097 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
19098 following AVR-specific commands:
19099
19100 @table @code
19101 @item info io_registers
19102 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
19103 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
19104 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
19105 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
19106 @end table
19107
19108 @node CRIS
19109 @subsection CRIS
19110 @cindex CRIS
19111
19112 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
19113 following CRIS-specific commands:
19114
19115 @table @code
19116 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
19117 @cindex CRIS version
19118 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
19119 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
19120 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
19121
19122 @item show cris-version
19123 Show the current CRIS version.
19124
19125 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
19126 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
19127 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
19128 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
19129 @code{R59}.
19130
19131 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
19132 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
19133
19134 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
19135 @cindex CRIS mode
19136 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
19137 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
19138 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
19139
19140 @item show cris-mode
19141 Show the current CRIS mode.
19142 @end table
19143
19144 @node Super-H
19145 @subsection Renesas Super-H
19146 @cindex Super-H
19147
19148 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
19149 commands:
19150
19151 @table @code
19152 @item regs
19153 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
19154 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
19155
19156 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
19157 @kindex set sh calling-convention
19158 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
19159 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
19160 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
19161 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
19162 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
19163 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
19164 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
19165 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
19166 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
19167 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
19168
19169 @item show sh calling-convention
19170 @kindex show sh calling-convention
19171 Show the current calling convention setting.
19172
19173 @end table
19174
19175
19176 @node Architectures
19177 @section Architectures
19178
19179 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
19180 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
19181
19182 @menu
19183 * i386::
19184 * A29K::
19185 * Alpha::
19186 * MIPS::
19187 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
19188 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
19189 * PowerPC::
19190 @end menu
19191
19192 @node i386
19193 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
19194
19195 @table @code
19196 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
19197 @kindex set struct-convention
19198 @cindex struct return convention
19199 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
19200 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
19201 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
19202 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
19203 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
19204 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
19205 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
19206 be returned in a register.
19207
19208 @item show struct-convention
19209 @kindex show struct-convention
19210 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
19211 from functions.
19212 @end table
19213
19214 @node A29K
19215 @subsection A29K
19216
19217 @table @code
19218
19219 @kindex set rstack_high_address
19220 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
19221 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
19222 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
19223 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
19224 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
19225 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
19226 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
19227 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
19228 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
19229 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
19230 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
19231 hexadecimal.
19232
19233 @kindex show rstack_high_address
19234 @item show rstack_high_address
19235 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
19236 processors.
19237
19238 @end table
19239
19240 @node Alpha
19241 @subsection Alpha
19242
19243 See the following section.
19244
19245 @node MIPS
19246 @subsection MIPS
19247
19248 @cindex stack on Alpha
19249 @cindex stack on MIPS
19250 @cindex Alpha stack
19251 @cindex MIPS stack
19252 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
19253 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
19254 find the beginning of a function.
19255
19256 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
19257 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
19258 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
19259 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
19260 commands:
19261
19262 @table @code
19263 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
19264 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
19265 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
19266 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
19267 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
19268 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
19269 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
19270 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
19271
19272 @item show heuristic-fence-post
19273 Display the current limit.
19274 @end table
19275
19276 @noindent
19277 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
19278 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
19279
19280 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
19281 programs:
19282
19283 @table @code
19284 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
19285 @kindex set mips abi
19286 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
19287 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
19288 values of @var{arg} are:
19289
19290 @table @samp
19291 @item auto
19292 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
19293 default).
19294 @item o32
19295 @item o64
19296 @item n32
19297 @item n64
19298 @item eabi32
19299 @item eabi64
19300 @item auto
19301 @end table
19302
19303 @item show mips abi
19304 @kindex show mips abi
19305 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
19306
19307 @item set mipsfpu
19308 @itemx show mipsfpu
19309 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
19310
19311 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
19312 @kindex set mips mask-address
19313 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
19314 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
19315 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
19316 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
19317 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
19318
19319 @item show mips mask-address
19320 @kindex show mips mask-address
19321 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
19322 not.
19323
19324 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19325 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19326 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
19327 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
19328 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
19329 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
19330
19331 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19332 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19333 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
19334
19335 @item set debug mips
19336 @kindex set debug mips
19337 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
19338 target code in @value{GDBN}.
19339
19340 @item show debug mips
19341 @kindex show debug mips
19342 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
19343 @end table
19344
19345
19346 @node HPPA
19347 @subsection HPPA
19348 @cindex HPPA support
19349
19350 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
19351 following special commands:
19352
19353 @table @code
19354 @item set debug hppa
19355 @kindex set debug hppa
19356 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
19357 messages are to be displayed.
19358
19359 @item show debug hppa
19360 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
19361
19362 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
19363 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
19364 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
19365 given @var{address}.
19366
19367 @end table
19368
19369
19370 @node SPU
19371 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
19372 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
19373 @cindex SPU
19374
19375 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
19376 it provides the following special commands:
19377
19378 @table @code
19379 @item info spu event
19380 @kindex info spu
19381 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
19382 and pending event status.
19383
19384 @item info spu signal
19385 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
19386 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
19387 notification channels.
19388
19389 @item info spu mailbox
19390 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
19391 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
19392 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
19393
19394 @item info spu dma
19395 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
19396 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
19397 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
19398
19399 @item info spu proxydma
19400 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
19401 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
19402 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
19403
19404 @end table
19405
19406 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
19407 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
19408 special commands:
19409
19410 @table @code
19411 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
19412 @kindex set spu
19413 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
19414 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
19415 function. The default is @code{off}.
19416
19417 @item show spu stop-on-load
19418 @kindex show spu
19419 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
19420
19421 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
19422 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
19423 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
19424 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
19425 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
19426 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
19427
19428 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
19429 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
19430
19431 @end table
19432
19433 @node PowerPC
19434 @subsection PowerPC
19435 @cindex PowerPC architecture
19436
19437 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
19438 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
19439 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
19440 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
19441 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
19442
19443 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
19444 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
19445 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
19446
19447 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
19448 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
19449
19450
19451 @node Controlling GDB
19452 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
19453
19454 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
19455 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
19456 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
19457 described here.
19458
19459 @menu
19460 * Prompt:: Prompt
19461 * Editing:: Command editing
19462 * Command History:: Command history
19463 * Screen Size:: Screen size
19464 * Numbers:: Numbers
19465 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
19466 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
19467 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
19468 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
19469 @end menu
19470
19471 @node Prompt
19472 @section Prompt
19473
19474 @cindex prompt
19475
19476 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
19477 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
19478 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
19479 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
19480 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
19481 which one you are talking to.
19482
19483 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
19484 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
19485 or a prompt that does not.
19486
19487 @table @code
19488 @kindex set prompt
19489 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
19490 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
19491
19492 @kindex show prompt
19493 @item show prompt
19494 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
19495 @end table
19496
19497 @node Editing
19498 @section Command Editing
19499 @cindex readline
19500 @cindex command line editing
19501
19502 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
19503 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
19504 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
19505 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
19506 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
19507 debugging sessions.
19508
19509 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
19510 command @code{set}.
19511
19512 @table @code
19513 @kindex set editing
19514 @cindex editing
19515 @item set editing
19516 @itemx set editing on
19517 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
19518
19519 @item set editing off
19520 Disable command line editing.
19521
19522 @kindex show editing
19523 @item show editing
19524 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
19525 @end table
19526
19527 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
19528 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
19529 @end ifset
19530 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
19531 @xref{Command Line Editing},
19532 @end ifclear
19533 for more details about the Readline
19534 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
19535 encouraged to read that chapter.
19536
19537 @node Command History
19538 @section Command History
19539 @cindex command history
19540
19541 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
19542 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
19543 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
19544 history facility.
19545
19546 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
19547 package, to provide the history facility.
19548 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
19549 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
19550 @end ifset
19551 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
19552 @xref{Using History Interactively},
19553 @end ifclear
19554 for the detailed description of the History library.
19555
19556 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
19557 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
19558 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
19559 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
19560 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
19561 pressed on a line by itself.
19562
19563 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
19564 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
19565 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
19566 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
19567
19568 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
19569 history.
19570
19571 @table @code
19572 @cindex history substitution
19573 @cindex history file
19574 @kindex set history filename
19575 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
19576 @item set history filename @var{fname}
19577 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
19578 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
19579 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
19580 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
19581 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
19582 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
19583 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
19584 is not set.
19585
19586 @cindex save command history
19587 @kindex set history save
19588 @item set history save
19589 @itemx set history save on
19590 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
19591 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
19592
19593 @item set history save off
19594 Stop recording command history in a file.
19595
19596 @cindex history size
19597 @kindex set history size
19598 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
19599 @item set history size @var{size}
19600 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
19601 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
19602 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
19603 @end table
19604
19605 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
19606 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
19607 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
19608 @end ifset
19609 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
19610 @xref{Event Designators},
19611 @end ifclear
19612 for more details.
19613
19614 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
19615 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
19616 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
19617 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
19618 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
19619 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
19620 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
19621 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
19622
19623 The commands to control history expansion are:
19624
19625 @table @code
19626 @item set history expansion on
19627 @itemx set history expansion
19628 @kindex set history expansion
19629 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
19630
19631 @item set history expansion off
19632 Disable history expansion.
19633
19634 @c @group
19635 @kindex show history
19636 @item show history
19637 @itemx show history filename
19638 @itemx show history save
19639 @itemx show history size
19640 @itemx show history expansion
19641 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
19642 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
19643 @c @end group
19644 @end table
19645
19646 @table @code
19647 @kindex show commands
19648 @cindex show last commands
19649 @cindex display command history
19650 @item show commands
19651 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
19652
19653 @item show commands @var{n}
19654 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
19655
19656 @item show commands +
19657 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
19658 @end table
19659
19660 @node Screen Size
19661 @section Screen Size
19662 @cindex size of screen
19663 @cindex pauses in output
19664
19665 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
19666 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
19667 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
19668 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
19669 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
19670 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
19671 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
19672 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
19673
19674 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
19675 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
19676 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
19677 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
19678 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
19679 width} commands:
19680
19681 @table @code
19682 @kindex set height
19683 @kindex set width
19684 @kindex show width
19685 @kindex show height
19686 @item set height @var{lpp}
19687 @itemx show height
19688 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
19689 @itemx show width
19690 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
19691 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
19692 commands display the current settings.
19693
19694 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
19695 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
19696 file or to an editor buffer.
19697
19698 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
19699 from wrapping its output.
19700
19701 @item set pagination on
19702 @itemx set pagination off
19703 @kindex set pagination
19704 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
19705 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}. Note that
19706 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
19707 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
19708
19709 @item show pagination
19710 @kindex show pagination
19711 Show the current pagination mode.
19712 @end table
19713
19714 @node Numbers
19715 @section Numbers
19716 @cindex number representation
19717 @cindex entering numbers
19718
19719 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
19720 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
19721 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
19722 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
19723 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
19724 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
19725 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
19726 both input and output with the commands described below.
19727
19728 @table @code
19729 @kindex set input-radix
19730 @item set input-radix @var{base}
19731 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
19732 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
19733 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
19734 example, any of
19735
19736 @smallexample
19737 set input-radix 012
19738 set input-radix 10.
19739 set input-radix 0xa
19740 @end smallexample
19741
19742 @noindent
19743 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
19744 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
19745 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
19746 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
19747 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
19748 change the radix.
19749
19750 @kindex set output-radix
19751 @item set output-radix @var{base}
19752 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
19753 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
19754 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
19755
19756 @kindex show input-radix
19757 @item show input-radix
19758 Display the current default base for numeric input.
19759
19760 @kindex show output-radix
19761 @item show output-radix
19762 Display the current default base for numeric display.
19763
19764 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
19765 @itemx show radix
19766 @kindex set radix
19767 @kindex show radix
19768 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
19769 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
19770 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
19771 default value of 10.
19772
19773 @end table
19774
19775 @node ABI
19776 @section Configuring the Current ABI
19777
19778 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
19779 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
19780 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
19781 current ABI.
19782
19783 @cindex OS ABI
19784 @kindex set osabi
19785 @kindex show osabi
19786
19787 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
19788 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
19789 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
19790 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
19791 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
19792 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
19793 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
19794 platform provides.
19795
19796 @table @code
19797 @item show osabi
19798 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
19799
19800 @item set osabi
19801 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
19802
19803 @item set osabi @var{abi}
19804 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
19805 @end table
19806
19807 @cindex float promotion
19808
19809 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
19810 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
19811 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
19812 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
19813 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
19814 @code{double} and then passed.
19815
19816 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
19817 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
19818 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
19819
19820 @table @code
19821 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
19822 @item set coerce-float-to-double
19823 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
19824 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
19825 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
19826
19827 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
19828 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
19829 functions.
19830
19831 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
19832 @item show coerce-float-to-double
19833 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
19834 @end table
19835
19836 @kindex set cp-abi
19837 @kindex show cp-abi
19838 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
19839 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
19840 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
19841 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
19842 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
19843 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
19844 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
19845 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
19846 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
19847 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
19848 ``auto''.
19849
19850 @table @code
19851 @item show cp-abi
19852 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
19853
19854 @item set cp-abi
19855 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
19856
19857 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
19858 @itemx set cp-abi auto
19859 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
19860 @end table
19861
19862 @node Messages/Warnings
19863 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
19864
19865 @cindex verbose operation
19866 @cindex optional warnings
19867 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
19868 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
19869 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
19870 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
19871
19872 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
19873 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
19874 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
19875
19876 @table @code
19877 @kindex set verbose
19878 @item set verbose on
19879 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
19880
19881 @item set verbose off
19882 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
19883
19884 @kindex show verbose
19885 @item show verbose
19886 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
19887 @end table
19888
19889 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
19890 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
19891 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
19892 Symbol Files}).
19893
19894 @table @code
19895
19896 @kindex set complaints
19897 @item set complaints @var{limit}
19898 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
19899 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
19900 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
19901 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
19902
19903 @kindex show complaints
19904 @item show complaints
19905 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
19906
19907 @end table
19908
19909 @anchor{confirmation requests}
19910 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
19911 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
19912 you try to run a program which is already running:
19913
19914 @smallexample
19915 (@value{GDBP}) run
19916 The program being debugged has been started already.
19917 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
19918 @end smallexample
19919
19920 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
19921 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
19922
19923 @table @code
19924
19925 @kindex set confirm
19926 @cindex flinching
19927 @cindex confirmation
19928 @cindex stupid questions
19929 @item set confirm off
19930 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
19931 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
19932 automatically disables confirmation requests.
19933
19934 @item set confirm on
19935 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
19936
19937 @kindex show confirm
19938 @item show confirm
19939 Displays state of confirmation requests.
19940
19941 @end table
19942
19943 @cindex command tracing
19944 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
19945 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
19946 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
19947 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
19948
19949 @table @code
19950 @kindex set trace-commands
19951 @cindex command scripts, debugging
19952 @item set trace-commands on
19953 Enable command tracing.
19954 @item set trace-commands off
19955 Disable command tracing.
19956 @item show trace-commands
19957 Display the current state of command tracing.
19958 @end table
19959
19960 @node Debugging Output
19961 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
19962 @cindex optional debugging messages
19963
19964 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
19965 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
19966 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
19967 section documents those commands.
19968
19969 @table @code
19970 @kindex set exec-done-display
19971 @item set exec-done-display
19972 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
19973 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
19974 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
19975 @kindex show exec-done-display
19976 @item show exec-done-display
19977 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
19978 notification.
19979 @kindex set debug
19980 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
19981 @cindex architecture debugging info
19982 @item set debug arch
19983 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
19984 @kindex show debug
19985 @item show debug arch
19986 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
19987 @item set debug aix-thread
19988 @cindex AIX threads
19989 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
19990 module.
19991 @item show debug aix-thread
19992 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
19993 @item set debug dwarf2-die
19994 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
19995 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
19996 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
19997 A value of zero turns off the display.
19998 @item show debug dwarf2-die
19999 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
20000 @item set debug displaced
20001 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
20002 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
20003 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
20004 @item show debug displaced
20005 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
20006 related to displaced stepping.
20007 @item set debug event
20008 @cindex event debugging info
20009 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
20010 default is off.
20011 @item show debug event
20012 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
20013 info.
20014 @item set debug expression
20015 @cindex expression debugging info
20016 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
20017 expression parsing. The default is off.
20018 @item show debug expression
20019 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
20020 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
20021 @item set debug frame
20022 @cindex frame debugging info
20023 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
20024 default is off.
20025 @item show debug frame
20026 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
20027 info.
20028 @item set debug gnu-nat
20029 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
20030 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
20031 @item show debug gnu-nat
20032 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
20033 @item set debug infrun
20034 @cindex inferior debugging info
20035 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
20036 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
20037 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
20038 @item show debug infrun
20039 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
20040 @item set debug jit
20041 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
20042 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
20043 @item show debug jit
20044 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
20045 @item set debug lin-lwp
20046 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
20047 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
20048 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
20049 @item show debug lin-lwp
20050 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
20051 @item set debug lin-lwp-async
20052 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP async debug messages
20053 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
20054 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP async debug support.
20055 @item show debug lin-lwp-async
20056 Show the current state of Linux LWP async debugging messages.
20057 @item set debug observer
20058 @cindex observer debugging info
20059 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
20060 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
20061 @item show debug observer
20062 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
20063 @item set debug overload
20064 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
20065 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
20066 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
20067 is off.
20068 @item show debug overload
20069 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
20070 debugging info.
20071 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
20072 @cindex debug expression parser
20073 @item set debug parser
20074 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
20075 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
20076 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
20077 details. The default is off.
20078 @item show debug parser
20079 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
20080 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
20081 @cindex serial connections, debugging
20082 @cindex debug remote protocol
20083 @cindex remote protocol debugging
20084 @cindex display remote packets
20085 @item set debug remote
20086 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
20087 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
20088 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
20089 @item show debug remote
20090 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
20091 @item set debug serial
20092 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
20093 default is off.
20094 @item show debug serial
20095 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
20096 info.
20097 @item set debug solib-frv
20098 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
20099 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
20100 @item show debug solib-frv
20101 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
20102 messages.
20103 @item set debug target
20104 @cindex target debugging info
20105 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
20106 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
20107 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
20108 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
20109 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
20110 @item show debug target
20111 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
20112 info.
20113 @item set debug timestamp
20114 @cindex timestampping debugging info
20115 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
20116 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
20117 message.
20118 @item show debug timestamp
20119 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
20120 debugging info.
20121 @item set debugvarobj
20122 @cindex variable object debugging info
20123 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
20124 info. The default is off.
20125 @item show debugvarobj
20126 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
20127 debugging info.
20128 @item set debug xml
20129 @cindex XML parser debugging
20130 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
20131 @item show debug xml
20132 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
20133 @end table
20134
20135 @node Other Misc Settings
20136 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
20137 @cindex miscellaneous settings
20138
20139 @table @code
20140 @kindex set interactive-mode
20141 @item set interactive-mode
20142 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
20143 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
20144 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
20145 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
20146 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
20147 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
20148 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
20149 is, non-interactively otherwise.
20150
20151 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
20152 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
20153 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
20154 inside a cygwin window.
20155
20156 @kindex show interactive-mode
20157 @item show interactive-mode
20158 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
20159 @end table
20160
20161 @node Extending GDB
20162 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
20163 @cindex extending GDB
20164
20165 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for extension. The first is based
20166 on composition of @value{GDBN} commands, and the second is based on the
20167 Python scripting language.
20168
20169 To facilitate the use of these extensions, @value{GDBN} is capable
20170 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
20171 can recognize which scripting language is being used by looking at
20172 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
20173 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
20174 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
20175
20176 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
20177 setting:
20178
20179 @table @code
20180 @kindex set script-extension
20181 @kindex show script-extension
20182 @item set script-extension off
20183 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
20184
20185 @item set script-extension soft
20186 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
20187 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
20188 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
20189 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
20190
20191 @item set script-extension strict
20192 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
20193 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
20194 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
20195
20196 @item show script-extension
20197 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
20198
20199 @end table
20200
20201 @menu
20202 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of Commands
20203 * Python:: Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
20204 @end menu
20205
20206 @node Sequences
20207 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
20208
20209 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
20210 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
20211 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
20212 files.
20213
20214 @menu
20215 * Define:: How to define your own commands
20216 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
20217 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
20218 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
20219 @end menu
20220
20221 @node Define
20222 @subsection User-defined Commands
20223
20224 @cindex user-defined command
20225 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
20226 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
20227 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
20228 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
20229 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
20230 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
20231
20232 @smallexample
20233 define adder
20234 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
20235 end
20236 @end smallexample
20237
20238 @noindent
20239 To execute the command use:
20240
20241 @smallexample
20242 adder 1 2 3
20243 @end smallexample
20244
20245 @noindent
20246 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
20247 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
20248 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
20249 functions calls.
20250
20251 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
20252 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
20253 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
20254 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
20255
20256 @smallexample
20257 define adder
20258 if $argc == 2
20259 print $arg0 + $arg1
20260 end
20261 if $argc == 3
20262 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
20263 end
20264 end
20265 @end smallexample
20266
20267 @table @code
20268
20269 @kindex define
20270 @item define @var{commandname}
20271 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
20272 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
20273 @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
20274 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
20275 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
20276 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
20277
20278 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
20279 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
20280 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
20281
20282 @kindex document
20283 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
20284 @item document @var{commandname}
20285 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
20286 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
20287 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
20288 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
20289 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
20290 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
20291
20292 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
20293 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
20294 does not change the documentation.
20295
20296 @kindex dont-repeat
20297 @cindex don't repeat command
20298 @item dont-repeat
20299 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
20300 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
20301 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
20302
20303 @kindex help user-defined
20304 @item help user-defined
20305 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
20306 (if any) for each.
20307
20308 @kindex show user
20309 @item show user
20310 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
20311 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
20312 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
20313 definitions for all user-defined commands.
20314
20315 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
20316 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
20317 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
20318 @item show max-user-call-depth
20319 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
20320 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
20321 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
20322 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
20323 @end table
20324
20325 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
20326 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
20327
20328 When user-defined commands are executed, the
20329 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
20330 stops execution of the user-defined command.
20331
20332 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
20333 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
20334 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
20335 messages when used in a user-defined command.
20336
20337 @node Hooks
20338 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
20339 @cindex command hooks
20340 @cindex hooks, for commands
20341 @cindex hooks, pre-command
20342
20343 @kindex hook
20344 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
20345 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
20346 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
20347 before that command.
20348
20349 @cindex hooks, post-command
20350 @kindex hookpost
20351 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
20352 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
20353 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
20354 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
20355 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
20356
20357 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
20358 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
20359
20360 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
20361 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
20362
20363 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
20364 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
20365 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
20366 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
20367 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
20368
20369 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
20370 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
20371 you could define:
20372
20373 @smallexample
20374 define hook-stop
20375 handle SIGALRM nopass
20376 end
20377
20378 define hook-run
20379 handle SIGALRM pass
20380 end
20381
20382 define hook-continue
20383 handle SIGALRM pass
20384 end
20385 @end smallexample
20386
20387 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
20388 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
20389 you could define:
20390
20391 @smallexample
20392 define hook-echo
20393 echo <<<---
20394 end
20395
20396 define hookpost-echo
20397 echo --->>>\n
20398 end
20399
20400 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
20401 <<<---Hello World--->>>
20402 (@value{GDBP})
20403
20404 @end smallexample
20405
20406 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
20407 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
20408 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
20409 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
20410 @c or not?
20411 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
20412 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
20413 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
20414
20415 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
20416 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
20417 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
20418
20419 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
20420 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
20421
20422 @node Command Files
20423 @subsection Command Files
20424
20425 @cindex command files
20426 @cindex scripting commands
20427 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
20428 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
20429 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
20430 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
20431 terminal.
20432
20433 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
20434 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
20435 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
20436 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
20437 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
20438
20439 @table @code
20440 @kindex source
20441 @cindex execute commands from a file
20442 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
20443 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
20444 @end table
20445
20446 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
20447 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
20448 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
20449 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
20450 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
20451
20452 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
20453 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
20454 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
20455 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
20456 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
20457 is not relevant to scripts.
20458
20459 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
20460 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
20461 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
20462 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
20463 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
20464 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
20465 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
20466 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
20467 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
20468 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
20469 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
20470 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
20471 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
20472 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
20473
20474 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
20475 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
20476 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
20477
20478 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
20479 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
20480 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
20481 when called from command files.
20482
20483 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
20484 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
20485 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
20486 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
20487 the next command.
20488
20489 @smallexample
20490 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
20491 @end smallexample
20492
20493 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
20494 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
20495 would be directed to @file{log}.
20496
20497 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
20498 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
20499 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
20500 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
20501 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
20502 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
20503 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
20504 conditionally, etc.
20505
20506 @table @code
20507 @kindex if
20508 @kindex else
20509 @item if
20510 @itemx else
20511 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
20512 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
20513 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
20514 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
20515 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
20516 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
20517 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
20518
20519 @kindex while
20520 @item while
20521 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
20522 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
20523 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
20524 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
20525 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
20526 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
20527
20528 @kindex loop_break
20529 @item loop_break
20530 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
20531 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
20532 line.
20533
20534 @kindex loop_continue
20535 @item loop_continue
20536 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
20537 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
20538 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
20539 the controlling expression.
20540
20541 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
20542 @item end
20543 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
20544 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
20545 @end table
20546
20547
20548 @node Output
20549 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
20550
20551 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
20552 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
20553 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
20554 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
20555 want.
20556
20557 @table @code
20558 @kindex echo
20559 @item echo @var{text}
20560 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
20561 @c because it is not in ANSI.
20562 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
20563 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
20564 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
20565 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
20566 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
20567 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
20568 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
20569 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
20570 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
20571
20572 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
20573 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
20574
20575 @smallexample
20576 echo This is some text\n\
20577 which is continued\n\
20578 onto several lines.\n
20579 @end smallexample
20580
20581 produces the same output as
20582
20583 @smallexample
20584 echo This is some text\n
20585 echo which is continued\n
20586 echo onto several lines.\n
20587 @end smallexample
20588
20589 @kindex output
20590 @item output @var{expression}
20591 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
20592 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
20593 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
20594 on expressions.
20595
20596 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
20597 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
20598 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
20599 Formats}, for more information.
20600
20601 @kindex printf
20602 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
20603 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
20604 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
20605 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
20606 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
20607 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
20608 executing the code below:
20609
20610 @smallexample
20611 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
20612 @end smallexample
20613
20614 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
20615 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
20616 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
20617 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
20618 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
20619 printed.
20620
20621 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
20622
20623 @smallexample
20624 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
20625 @end smallexample
20626
20627 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
20628 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
20629 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
20630
20631 @itemize @bullet
20632 @item
20633 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
20634
20635 @item
20636 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
20637 width.
20638
20639 @item
20640 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
20641 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
20642
20643 @item
20644 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
20645 supported.
20646
20647 @item
20648 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
20649
20650 @item
20651 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
20652 @end itemize
20653
20654 @noindent
20655 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
20656 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
20657 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
20658 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
20659
20660 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
20661 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
20662 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
20663 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
20664 supported.
20665
20666 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
20667 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
20668 together with a floating point specifier.
20669 letters:
20670
20671 @itemize @bullet
20672 @item
20673 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
20674
20675 @item
20676 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
20677
20678 @item
20679 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
20680 @end itemize
20681
20682 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
20683 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
20684 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
20685
20686 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
20687 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
20688
20689 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
20690 @smallexample
20691 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
20692 @end smallexample
20693
20694 @kindex eval
20695 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
20696 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
20697 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
20698
20699 @end table
20700
20701 @node Python
20702 @section Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
20703 @cindex python scripting
20704 @cindex scripting with python
20705
20706 You can script @value{GDBN} using the @uref{http://www.python.org/,
20707 Python programming language}. This feature is available only if
20708 @value{GDBN} was configured using @option{--with-python}.
20709
20710 @cindex python directory
20711 Python scripts used by @value{GDBN} should be installed in
20712 @file{@var{data-directory}/python}, where @var{data-directory} is
20713 the data directory as determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}).
20714 This directory, known as the @dfn{python directory},
20715 is automatically added to the Python Search Path in order to allow
20716 the Python interpreter to locate all scripts installed at this location.
20717
20718 @menu
20719 * Python Commands:: Accessing Python from @value{GDBN}.
20720 * Python API:: Accessing @value{GDBN} from Python.
20721 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading Python code.
20722 * Python modules:: Python modules provided by @value{GDBN}.
20723 @end menu
20724
20725 @node Python Commands
20726 @subsection Python Commands
20727 @cindex python commands
20728 @cindex commands to access python
20729
20730 @value{GDBN} provides one command for accessing the Python interpreter,
20731 and one related setting:
20732
20733 @table @code
20734 @kindex python
20735 @item python @r{[}@var{code}@r{]}
20736 The @code{python} command can be used to evaluate Python code.
20737
20738 If given an argument, the @code{python} command will evaluate the
20739 argument as a Python command. For example:
20740
20741 @smallexample
20742 (@value{GDBP}) python print 23
20743 23
20744 @end smallexample
20745
20746 If you do not provide an argument to @code{python}, it will act as a
20747 multi-line command, like @code{define}. In this case, the Python
20748 script is made up of subsequent command lines, given after the
20749 @code{python} command. This command list is terminated using a line
20750 containing @code{end}. For example:
20751
20752 @smallexample
20753 (@value{GDBP}) python
20754 Type python script
20755 End with a line saying just "end".
20756 >print 23
20757 >end
20758 23
20759 @end smallexample
20760
20761 @kindex maint set python print-stack
20762 @item maint set python print-stack
20763 By default, @value{GDBN} will print a stack trace when an error occurs
20764 in a Python script. This can be controlled using @code{maint set
20765 python print-stack}: if @code{on}, the default, then Python stack
20766 printing is enabled; if @code{off}, then Python stack printing is
20767 disabled.
20768 @end table
20769
20770 It is also possible to execute a Python script from the @value{GDBN}
20771 interpreter:
20772
20773 @table @code
20774 @item source @file{script-name}
20775 The script name must end with @samp{.py} and @value{GDBN} must be configured
20776 to recognize the script language based on filename extension using
20777 the @code{script-extension} setting. @xref{Extending GDB, ,Extending GDB}.
20778
20779 @item python execfile ("script-name")
20780 This method is based on the @code{execfile} Python built-in function,
20781 and thus is always available.
20782 @end table
20783
20784 @node Python API
20785 @subsection Python API
20786 @cindex python api
20787 @cindex programming in python
20788
20789 @cindex python stdout
20790 @cindex python pagination
20791 At startup, @value{GDBN} overrides Python's @code{sys.stdout} and
20792 @code{sys.stderr} to print using @value{GDBN}'s output-paging streams.
20793 A Python program which outputs to one of these streams may have its
20794 output interrupted by the user (@pxref{Screen Size}). In this
20795 situation, a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception is thrown.
20796
20797 @menu
20798 * Basic Python:: Basic Python Functions.
20799 * Exception Handling:: How Python exceptions are translated.
20800 * Values From Inferior:: Python representation of values.
20801 * Types In Python:: Python representation of types.
20802 * Pretty Printing API:: Pretty-printing values.
20803 * Selecting Pretty-Printers:: How GDB chooses a pretty-printer.
20804 * Writing a Pretty-Printer:: Writing a Pretty-Printer.
20805 * Inferiors In Python:: Python representation of inferiors (processes)
20806 * Events In Python:: Listening for events from @value{GDBN}.
20807 * Threads In Python:: Accessing inferior threads from Python.
20808 * Commands In Python:: Implementing new commands in Python.
20809 * Parameters In Python:: Adding new @value{GDBN} parameters.
20810 * Functions In Python:: Writing new convenience functions.
20811 * Progspaces In Python:: Program spaces.
20812 * Objfiles In Python:: Object files.
20813 * Frames In Python:: Accessing inferior stack frames from Python.
20814 * Blocks In Python:: Accessing frame blocks from Python.
20815 * Symbols In Python:: Python representation of symbols.
20816 * Symbol Tables In Python:: Python representation of symbol tables.
20817 * Lazy Strings In Python:: Python representation of lazy strings.
20818 * Breakpoints In Python:: Manipulating breakpoints using Python.
20819 @end menu
20820
20821 @node Basic Python
20822 @subsubsection Basic Python
20823
20824 @cindex python functions
20825 @cindex python module
20826 @cindex gdb module
20827 @value{GDBN} introduces a new Python module, named @code{gdb}. All
20828 methods and classes added by @value{GDBN} are placed in this module.
20829 @value{GDBN} automatically @code{import}s the @code{gdb} module for
20830 use in all scripts evaluated by the @code{python} command.
20831
20832 @findex gdb.PYTHONDIR
20833 @defvar PYTHONDIR
20834 A string containing the python directory (@pxref{Python}).
20835 @end defvar
20836
20837 @findex gdb.execute
20838 @defun execute command [from_tty] [to_string]
20839 Evaluate @var{command}, a string, as a @value{GDBN} CLI command.
20840 If a GDB exception happens while @var{command} runs, it is
20841 translated as described in @ref{Exception Handling,,Exception Handling}.
20842
20843 @var{from_tty} specifies whether @value{GDBN} ought to consider this
20844 command as having originated from the user invoking it interactively.
20845 It must be a boolean value. If omitted, it defaults to @code{False}.
20846
20847 By default, any output produced by @var{command} is sent to
20848 @value{GDBN}'s standard output. If the @var{to_string} parameter is
20849 @code{True}, then output will be collected by @code{gdb.execute} and
20850 returned as a string. The default is @code{False}, in which case the
20851 return value is @code{None}. If @var{to_string} is @code{True}, the
20852 @value{GDBN} virtual terminal will be temporarily set to unlimited width
20853 and height, and its pagination will be disabled; @pxref{Screen Size}.
20854 @end defun
20855
20856 @findex gdb.breakpoints
20857 @defun breakpoints
20858 Return a sequence holding all of @value{GDBN}'s breakpoints.
20859 @xref{Breakpoints In Python}, for more information.
20860 @end defun
20861
20862 @findex gdb.parameter
20863 @defun parameter parameter
20864 Return the value of a @value{GDBN} parameter. @var{parameter} is a
20865 string naming the parameter to look up; @var{parameter} may contain
20866 spaces if the parameter has a multi-part name. For example,
20867 @samp{print object} is a valid parameter name.
20868
20869 If the named parameter does not exist, this function throws a
20870 @code{gdb.error} (@pxref{Exception Handling}). Otherwise, the
20871 parameter's value is converted to a Python value of the appropriate
20872 type, and returned.
20873 @end defun
20874
20875 @findex gdb.history
20876 @defun history number
20877 Return a value from @value{GDBN}'s value history (@pxref{Value
20878 History}). @var{number} indicates which history element to return.
20879 If @var{number} is negative, then @value{GDBN} will take its absolute value
20880 and count backward from the last element (i.e., the most recent element) to
20881 find the value to return. If @var{number} is zero, then @value{GDBN} will
20882 return the most recent element. If the element specified by @var{number}
20883 doesn't exist in the value history, a @code{gdb.error} exception will be
20884 raised.
20885
20886 If no exception is raised, the return value is always an instance of
20887 @code{gdb.Value} (@pxref{Values From Inferior}).
20888 @end defun
20889
20890 @findex gdb.parse_and_eval
20891 @defun parse_and_eval expression
20892 Parse @var{expression} as an expression in the current language,
20893 evaluate it, and return the result as a @code{gdb.Value}.
20894 @var{expression} must be a string.
20895
20896 This function can be useful when implementing a new command
20897 (@pxref{Commands In Python}), as it provides a way to parse the
20898 command's argument as an expression. It is also useful simply to
20899 compute values, for example, it is the only way to get the value of a
20900 convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) as a @code{gdb.Value}.
20901 @end defun
20902
20903 @findex gdb.post_event
20904 @defun post_event event
20905 Put @var{event}, a callable object taking no arguments, into
20906 @value{GDBN}'s internal event queue. This callable will be invoked at
20907 some later point, during @value{GDBN}'s event processing. Events
20908 posted using @code{post_event} will be run in the order in which they
20909 were posted; however, there is no way to know when they will be
20910 processed relative to other events inside @value{GDBN}.
20911
20912 @value{GDBN} is not thread-safe. If your Python program uses multiple
20913 threads, you must be careful to only call @value{GDBN}-specific
20914 functions in the main @value{GDBN} thread. @code{post_event} ensures
20915 this. For example:
20916
20917 @smallexample
20918 (@value{GDBP}) python
20919 >import threading
20920 >
20921 >class Writer():
20922 > def __init__(self, message):
20923 > self.message = message;
20924 > def __call__(self):
20925 > gdb.write(self.message)
20926 >
20927 >class MyThread1 (threading.Thread):
20928 > def run (self):
20929 > gdb.post_event(Writer("Hello "))
20930 >
20931 >class MyThread2 (threading.Thread):
20932 > def run (self):
20933 > gdb.post_event(Writer("World\n"))
20934 >
20935 >MyThread1().start()
20936 >MyThread2().start()
20937 >end
20938 (@value{GDBP}) Hello World
20939 @end smallexample
20940 @end defun
20941
20942 @findex gdb.write
20943 @defun write string @r{[}stream{]}
20944 Print a string to @value{GDBN}'s paginated output stream. The
20945 optional @var{stream} determines the stream to print to. The default
20946 stream is @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream. Possible stream
20947 values are:
20948
20949 @table @code
20950 @findex STDOUT
20951 @findex gdb.STDOUT
20952 @item STDOUT
20953 @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream.
20954
20955 @findex STDERR
20956 @findex gdb.STDERR
20957 @item STDERR
20958 @value{GDBN}'s standard error stream.
20959
20960 @findex STDLOG
20961 @findex gdb.STDLOG
20962 @item STDLOG
20963 @value{GDBN}'s log stream (@pxref{Logging Output}).
20964 @end table
20965
20966 Writing to @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
20967 call this function and will automatically direct the output to the
20968 relevant stream.
20969 @end defun
20970
20971 @findex gdb.flush
20972 @defun flush
20973 Flush the buffer of a @value{GDBN} paginated stream so that the
20974 contents are displayed immediately. @value{GDBN} will flush the
20975 contents of a stream automatically when it encounters a newline in the
20976 buffer. The optional @var{stream} determines the stream to flush. The
20977 default stream is @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream. Possible
20978 stream values are:
20979
20980 @table @code
20981 @findex STDOUT
20982 @findex gdb.STDOUT
20983 @item STDOUT
20984 @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream.
20985
20986 @findex STDERR
20987 @findex gdb.STDERR
20988 @item STDERR
20989 @value{GDBN}'s standard error stream.
20990
20991 @findex STDLOG
20992 @findex gdb.STDLOG
20993 @item STDLOG
20994 @value{GDBN}'s log stream (@pxref{Logging Output}).
20995
20996 @end table
20997
20998 Flushing @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
20999 call this function for the relevant stream.
21000 @end defun
21001
21002 @findex gdb.target_charset
21003 @defun target_charset
21004 Return the name of the current target character set (@pxref{Character
21005 Sets}). This differs from @code{gdb.parameter('target-charset')} in
21006 that @samp{auto} is never returned.
21007 @end defun
21008
21009 @findex gdb.target_wide_charset
21010 @defun target_wide_charset
21011 Return the name of the current target wide character set
21012 (@pxref{Character Sets}). This differs from
21013 @code{gdb.parameter('target-wide-charset')} in that @samp{auto} is
21014 never returned.
21015 @end defun
21016
21017 @findex gdb.solib_name
21018 @defun solib_name address
21019 Return the name of the shared library holding the given @var{address}
21020 as a string, or @code{None}.
21021 @end defun
21022
21023 @findex gdb.decode_line
21024 @defun decode_line @r{[}expression@r{]}
21025 Return locations of the line specified by @var{expression}, or of the
21026 current line if no argument was given. This function returns a Python
21027 tuple containing two elements. The first element contains a string
21028 holding any unparsed section of @var{expression} (or @code{None} if
21029 the expression has been fully parsed). The second element contains
21030 either @code{None} or another tuple that contains all the locations
21031 that match the expression represented as @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line}
21032 objects (@pxref{Symbol Tables In Python}). If @var{expression} is
21033 provided, it is decoded the way that @value{GDBN}'s inbuilt
21034 @code{break} or @code{edit} commands do (@pxref{Specify Location}).
21035 @end defun
21036
21037 @node Exception Handling
21038 @subsubsection Exception Handling
21039 @cindex python exceptions
21040 @cindex exceptions, python
21041
21042 When executing the @code{python} command, Python exceptions
21043 uncaught within the Python code are translated to calls to
21044 @value{GDBN} error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called
21045 @code{python} does not handle the error, @value{GDBN} will
21046 terminate it and print an error message containing the Python
21047 exception name, the associated value, and the Python call stack
21048 backtrace at the point where the exception was raised. Example:
21049
21050 @smallexample
21051 (@value{GDBP}) python print foo
21052 Traceback (most recent call last):
21053 File "<string>", line 1, in <module>
21054 NameError: name 'foo' is not defined
21055 @end smallexample
21056
21057 @value{GDBN} errors that happen in @value{GDBN} commands invoked by
21058 Python code are converted to Python exceptions. The type of the
21059 Python exception depends on the error.
21060
21061 @ftable @code
21062 @item gdb.error
21063 This is the base class for most exceptions generated by @value{GDBN}.
21064 It is derived from @code{RuntimeError}, for compatibility with earlier
21065 versions of @value{GDBN}.
21066
21067 If an error occurring in @value{GDBN} does not fit into some more
21068 specific category, then the generated exception will have this type.
21069
21070 @item gdb.MemoryError
21071 This is a subclass of @code{gdb.error} which is thrown when an
21072 operation tried to access invalid memory in the inferior.
21073
21074 @item KeyboardInterrupt
21075 User interrupt (via @kbd{C-c} or by typing @kbd{q} at a pagination
21076 prompt) is translated to a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception.
21077 @end ftable
21078
21079 In all cases, your exception handler will see the @value{GDBN} error
21080 message as its value and the Python call stack backtrace at the Python
21081 statement closest to where the @value{GDBN} error occured as the
21082 traceback.
21083
21084 @findex gdb.GdbError
21085 When implementing @value{GDBN} commands in Python via @code{gdb.Command},
21086 it is useful to be able to throw an exception that doesn't cause a
21087 traceback to be printed. For example, the user may have invoked the
21088 command incorrectly. Use the @code{gdb.GdbError} exception
21089 to handle this case. Example:
21090
21091 @smallexample
21092 (gdb) python
21093 >class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
21094 > """Greet the whole world."""
21095 > def __init__ (self):
21096 > super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)
21097 > def invoke (self, args, from_tty):
21098 > argv = gdb.string_to_argv (args)
21099 > if len (argv) != 0:
21100 > raise gdb.GdbError ("hello-world takes no arguments")
21101 > print "Hello, World!"
21102 >HelloWorld ()
21103 >end
21104 (gdb) hello-world 42
21105 hello-world takes no arguments
21106 @end smallexample
21107
21108 @node Values From Inferior
21109 @subsubsection Values From Inferior
21110 @cindex values from inferior, with Python
21111 @cindex python, working with values from inferior
21112
21113 @cindex @code{gdb.Value}
21114 @value{GDBN} provides values it obtains from the inferior program in
21115 an object of type @code{gdb.Value}. @value{GDBN} uses this object
21116 for its internal bookkeeping of the inferior's values, and for
21117 fetching values when necessary.
21118
21119 Inferior values that are simple scalars can be used directly in
21120 Python expressions that are valid for the value's data type. Here's
21121 an example for an integer or floating-point value @code{some_val}:
21122
21123 @smallexample
21124 bar = some_val + 2
21125 @end smallexample
21126
21127 @noindent
21128 As result of this, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object
21129 whose values are of the same type as those of @code{some_val}.
21130
21131 Inferior values that are structures or instances of some class can
21132 be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}. For example, if
21133 @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance holding a structure, you
21134 can access its @code{foo} element with:
21135
21136 @smallexample
21137 bar = some_val['foo']
21138 @end smallexample
21139
21140 Again, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object.
21141
21142 A @code{gdb.Value} that represents a function can be executed via
21143 inferior function call. Any arguments provided to the call must match
21144 the function's prototype, and must be provided in the order specified
21145 by that prototype.
21146
21147 For example, @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance
21148 representing a function that takes two integers as arguments. To
21149 execute this function, call it like so:
21150
21151 @smallexample
21152 result = some_val (10,20)
21153 @end smallexample
21154
21155 Any values returned from a function call will be stored as a
21156 @code{gdb.Value}.
21157
21158 The following attributes are provided:
21159
21160 @table @code
21161 @defivar Value address
21162 If this object is addressable, this read-only attribute holds a
21163 @code{gdb.Value} object representing the address. Otherwise,
21164 this attribute holds @code{None}.
21165 @end defivar
21166
21167 @cindex optimized out value in Python
21168 @defivar Value is_optimized_out
21169 This read-only boolean attribute is true if the compiler optimized out
21170 this value, thus it is not available for fetching from the inferior.
21171 @end defivar
21172
21173 @defivar Value type
21174 The type of this @code{gdb.Value}. The value of this attribute is a
21175 @code{gdb.Type} object (@pxref{Types In Python}).
21176 @end defivar
21177
21178 @defivar Value dynamic_type
21179 The dynamic type of this @code{gdb.Value}. This uses C@t{++} run-time
21180 type information (@acronym{RTTI}) to determine the dynamic type of the
21181 value. If this value is of class type, it will return the class in
21182 which the value is embedded, if any. If this value is of pointer or
21183 reference to a class type, it will compute the dynamic type of the
21184 referenced object, and return a pointer or reference to that type,
21185 respectively. In all other cases, it will return the value's static
21186 type.
21187
21188 Note that this feature will only work when debugging a C@t{++} program
21189 that includes @acronym{RTTI} for the object in question. Otherwise,
21190 it will just return the static type of the value as in @kbd{ptype foo}
21191 (@pxref{Symbols, ptype}).
21192 @end defivar
21193 @end table
21194
21195 The following methods are provided:
21196
21197 @table @code
21198 @defmethod Value __init__ @var{val}
21199 Many Python values can be converted directly to a @code{gdb.Value} via
21200 this object initializer. Specifically:
21201
21202 @table @asis
21203 @item Python boolean
21204 A Python boolean is converted to the boolean type from the current
21205 language.
21206
21207 @item Python integer
21208 A Python integer is converted to the C @code{long} type for the
21209 current architecture.
21210
21211 @item Python long
21212 A Python long is converted to the C @code{long long} type for the
21213 current architecture.
21214
21215 @item Python float
21216 A Python float is converted to the C @code{double} type for the
21217 current architecture.
21218
21219 @item Python string
21220 A Python string is converted to a target string, using the current
21221 target encoding.
21222
21223 @item @code{gdb.Value}
21224 If @code{val} is a @code{gdb.Value}, then a copy of the value is made.
21225
21226 @item @code{gdb.LazyString}
21227 If @code{val} is a @code{gdb.LazyString} (@pxref{Lazy Strings In
21228 Python}), then the lazy string's @code{value} method is called, and
21229 its result is used.
21230 @end table
21231 @end defmethod
21232
21233 @defmethod Value cast type
21234 Return a new instance of @code{gdb.Value} that is the result of
21235 casting this instance to the type described by @var{type}, which must
21236 be a @code{gdb.Type} object. If the cast cannot be performed for some
21237 reason, this method throws an exception.
21238 @end defmethod
21239
21240 @defmethod Value dereference
21241 For pointer data types, this method returns a new @code{gdb.Value} object
21242 whose contents is the object pointed to by the pointer. For example, if
21243 @code{foo} is a C pointer to an @code{int}, declared in your C program as
21244
21245 @smallexample
21246 int *foo;
21247 @end smallexample
21248
21249 @noindent
21250 then you can use the corresponding @code{gdb.Value} to access what
21251 @code{foo} points to like this:
21252
21253 @smallexample
21254 bar = foo.dereference ()
21255 @end smallexample
21256
21257 The result @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Value} object holding the
21258 value pointed to by @code{foo}.
21259 @end defmethod
21260
21261 @defmethod Value dynamic_cast type
21262 Like @code{Value.cast}, but works as if the C@t{++} @code{dynamic_cast}
21263 operator were used. Consult a C@t{++} reference for details.
21264 @end defmethod
21265
21266 @defmethod Value reinterpret_cast type
21267 Like @code{Value.cast}, but works as if the C@t{++} @code{reinterpret_cast}
21268 operator were used. Consult a C@t{++} reference for details.
21269 @end defmethod
21270
21271 @defmethod Value string @r{[}encoding@r{]} @r{[}errors@r{]} @r{[}length@r{]}
21272 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
21273 converts the contents to a Python string. Otherwise, this method will
21274 throw an exception.
21275
21276 Strings are recognized in a language-specific way; whether a given
21277 @code{gdb.Value} represents a string is determined by the current
21278 language.
21279
21280 For C-like languages, a value is a string if it is a pointer to or an
21281 array of characters or ints. The string is assumed to be terminated
21282 by a zero of the appropriate width. However if the optional length
21283 argument is given, the string will be converted to that given length,
21284 ignoring any embedded zeros that the string may contain.
21285
21286 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
21287 naming the encoding of the string in the @code{gdb.Value}, such as
21288 @code{"ascii"}, @code{"iso-8859-6"} or @code{"utf-8"}. It accepts
21289 the same encodings as the corresponding argument to Python's
21290 @code{string.decode} method, and the Python codec machinery will be used
21291 to convert the string. If @var{encoding} is not given, or if
21292 @var{encoding} is the empty string, then either the @code{target-charset}
21293 (@pxref{Character Sets}) will be used, or a language-specific encoding
21294 will be used, if the current language is able to supply one.
21295
21296 The optional @var{errors} argument is the same as the corresponding
21297 argument to Python's @code{string.decode} method.
21298
21299 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
21300 fetched and converted to the given length.
21301 @end defmethod
21302
21303 @defmethod Value lazy_string @r{[}encoding@r{]} @r{[}length@r{]}
21304 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
21305 converts the contents to a @code{gdb.LazyString} (@pxref{Lazy Strings
21306 In Python}). Otherwise, this method will throw an exception.
21307
21308 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
21309 naming the encoding of the @code{gdb.LazyString}. Some examples are:
21310 @samp{ascii}, @samp{iso-8859-6} or @samp{utf-8}. If the
21311 @var{encoding} argument is an encoding that @value{GDBN} does
21312 recognize, @value{GDBN} will raise an error.
21313
21314 When a lazy string is printed, the @value{GDBN} encoding machinery is
21315 used to convert the string during printing. If the optional
21316 @var{encoding} argument is not provided, or is an empty string,
21317 @value{GDBN} will automatically select the encoding most suitable for
21318 the string type. For further information on encoding in @value{GDBN}
21319 please see @ref{Character Sets}.
21320
21321 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
21322 fetched and encoded to the length of characters specified. If
21323 the @var{length} argument is not provided, the string will be fetched
21324 and encoded until a null of appropriate width is found.
21325 @end defmethod
21326 @end table
21327
21328 @node Types In Python
21329 @subsubsection Types In Python
21330 @cindex types in Python
21331 @cindex Python, working with types
21332
21333 @tindex gdb.Type
21334 @value{GDBN} represents types from the inferior using the class
21335 @code{gdb.Type}.
21336
21337 The following type-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
21338 module:
21339
21340 @findex gdb.lookup_type
21341 @defun lookup_type name [block]
21342 This function looks up a type by name. @var{name} is the name of the
21343 type to look up. It must be a string.
21344
21345 If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope.
21346 Otherwise, it is searched for globally.
21347
21348 Ordinarily, this function will return an instance of @code{gdb.Type}.
21349 If the named type cannot be found, it will throw an exception.
21350 @end defun
21351
21352 An instance of @code{Type} has the following attributes:
21353
21354 @table @code
21355 @defivar Type code
21356 The type code for this type. The type code will be one of the
21357 @code{TYPE_CODE_} constants defined below.
21358 @end defivar
21359
21360 @defivar Type sizeof
21361 The size of this type, in target @code{char} units. Usually, a
21362 target's @code{char} type will be an 8-bit byte. However, on some
21363 unusual platforms, this type may have a different size.
21364 @end defivar
21365
21366 @defivar Type tag
21367 The tag name for this type. The tag name is the name after
21368 @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} in C and C@t{++}; not all
21369 languages have this concept. If this type has no tag name, then
21370 @code{None} is returned.
21371 @end defivar
21372 @end table
21373
21374 The following methods are provided:
21375
21376 @table @code
21377 @defmethod Type fields
21378 For structure and union types, this method returns the fields. Range
21379 types have two fields, the minimum and maximum values. Enum types
21380 have one field per enum constant. Function and method types have one
21381 field per parameter. The base types of C@t{++} classes are also
21382 represented as fields. If the type has no fields, or does not fit
21383 into one of these categories, an empty sequence will be returned.
21384
21385 Each field is an object, with some pre-defined attributes:
21386 @table @code
21387 @item bitpos
21388 This attribute is not available for @code{static} fields (as in
21389 C@t{++} or Java). For non-@code{static} fields, the value is the bit
21390 position of the field.
21391
21392 @item name
21393 The name of the field, or @code{None} for anonymous fields.
21394
21395 @item artificial
21396 This is @code{True} if the field is artificial, usually meaning that
21397 it was provided by the compiler and not the user. This attribute is
21398 always provided, and is @code{False} if the field is not artificial.
21399
21400 @item is_base_class
21401 This is @code{True} if the field represents a base class of a C@t{++}
21402 structure. This attribute is always provided, and is @code{False}
21403 if the field is not a base class of the type that is the argument of
21404 @code{fields}, or if that type was not a C@t{++} class.
21405
21406 @item bitsize
21407 If the field is packed, or is a bitfield, then this will have a
21408 non-zero value, which is the size of the field in bits. Otherwise,
21409 this will be zero; in this case the field's size is given by its type.
21410
21411 @item type
21412 The type of the field. This is usually an instance of @code{Type},
21413 but it can be @code{None} in some situations.
21414 @end table
21415 @end defmethod
21416
21417 @defmethod Type array @var{n1} @r{[}@var{n2}@r{]}
21418 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an array of this
21419 type. If one argument is given, it is the inclusive upper bound of
21420 the array; in this case the lower bound is zero. If two arguments are
21421 given, the first argument is the lower bound of the array, and the
21422 second argument is the upper bound of the array. An array's length
21423 must not be negative, but the bounds can be.
21424 @end defmethod
21425
21426 @defmethod Type const
21427 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
21428 @code{const}-qualified variant of this type.
21429 @end defmethod
21430
21431 @defmethod Type volatile
21432 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
21433 @code{volatile}-qualified variant of this type.
21434 @end defmethod
21435
21436 @defmethod Type unqualified
21437 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an unqualified
21438 variant of this type. That is, the result is neither @code{const} nor
21439 @code{volatile}.
21440 @end defmethod
21441
21442 @defmethod Type range
21443 Return a Python @code{Tuple} object that contains two elements: the
21444 low bound of the argument type and the high bound of that type. If
21445 the type does not have a range, @value{GDBN} will raise a
21446 @code{gdb.error} exception (@pxref{Exception Handling}).
21447 @end defmethod
21448
21449 @defmethod Type reference
21450 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a reference to this
21451 type.
21452 @end defmethod
21453
21454 @defmethod Type pointer
21455 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a pointer to this
21456 type.
21457 @end defmethod
21458
21459 @defmethod Type strip_typedefs
21460 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} that represents the real type,
21461 after removing all layers of typedefs.
21462 @end defmethod
21463
21464 @defmethod Type target
21465 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents the target type
21466 of this type.
21467
21468 For a pointer type, the target type is the type of the pointed-to
21469 object. For an array type (meaning C-like arrays), the target type is
21470 the type of the elements of the array. For a function or method type,
21471 the target type is the type of the return value. For a complex type,
21472 the target type is the type of the elements. For a typedef, the
21473 target type is the aliased type.
21474
21475 If the type does not have a target, this method will throw an
21476 exception.
21477 @end defmethod
21478
21479 @defmethod Type template_argument n [block]
21480 If this @code{gdb.Type} is an instantiation of a template, this will
21481 return a new @code{gdb.Type} which represents the type of the
21482 @var{n}th template argument.
21483
21484 If this @code{gdb.Type} is not a template type, this will throw an
21485 exception. Ordinarily, only C@t{++} code will have template types.
21486
21487 If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope.
21488 Otherwise, it is searched for globally.
21489 @end defmethod
21490 @end table
21491
21492
21493 Each type has a code, which indicates what category this type falls
21494 into. The available type categories are represented by constants
21495 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
21496
21497 @table @code
21498 @findex TYPE_CODE_PTR
21499 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_PTR
21500 @item TYPE_CODE_PTR
21501 The type is a pointer.
21502
21503 @findex TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
21504 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
21505 @item TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
21506 The type is an array.
21507
21508 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
21509 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
21510 @item TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
21511 The type is a structure.
21512
21513 @findex TYPE_CODE_UNION
21514 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_UNION
21515 @item TYPE_CODE_UNION
21516 The type is a union.
21517
21518 @findex TYPE_CODE_ENUM
21519 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ENUM
21520 @item TYPE_CODE_ENUM
21521 The type is an enum.
21522
21523 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
21524 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
21525 @item TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
21526 A bit flags type, used for things such as status registers.
21527
21528 @findex TYPE_CODE_FUNC
21529 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FUNC
21530 @item TYPE_CODE_FUNC
21531 The type is a function.
21532
21533 @findex TYPE_CODE_INT
21534 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INT
21535 @item TYPE_CODE_INT
21536 The type is an integer type.
21537
21538 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLT
21539 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLT
21540 @item TYPE_CODE_FLT
21541 A floating point type.
21542
21543 @findex TYPE_CODE_VOID
21544 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_VOID
21545 @item TYPE_CODE_VOID
21546 The special type @code{void}.
21547
21548 @findex TYPE_CODE_SET
21549 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_SET
21550 @item TYPE_CODE_SET
21551 A Pascal set type.
21552
21553 @findex TYPE_CODE_RANGE
21554 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_RANGE
21555 @item TYPE_CODE_RANGE
21556 A range type, that is, an integer type with bounds.
21557
21558 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRING
21559 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRING
21560 @item TYPE_CODE_STRING
21561 A string type. Note that this is only used for certain languages with
21562 language-defined string types; C strings are not represented this way.
21563
21564 @findex TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
21565 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
21566 @item TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
21567 A string of bits.
21568
21569 @findex TYPE_CODE_ERROR
21570 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ERROR
21571 @item TYPE_CODE_ERROR
21572 An unknown or erroneous type.
21573
21574 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHOD
21575 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHOD
21576 @item TYPE_CODE_METHOD
21577 A method type, as found in C@t{++} or Java.
21578
21579 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
21580 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
21581 @item TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
21582 A pointer-to-member-function.
21583
21584 @findex TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
21585 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
21586 @item TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
21587 A pointer-to-member.
21588
21589 @findex TYPE_CODE_REF
21590 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_REF
21591 @item TYPE_CODE_REF
21592 A reference type.
21593
21594 @findex TYPE_CODE_CHAR
21595 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_CHAR
21596 @item TYPE_CODE_CHAR
21597 A character type.
21598
21599 @findex TYPE_CODE_BOOL
21600 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BOOL
21601 @item TYPE_CODE_BOOL
21602 A boolean type.
21603
21604 @findex TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
21605 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
21606 @item TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
21607 A complex float type.
21608
21609 @findex TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
21610 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
21611 @item TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
21612 A typedef to some other type.
21613
21614 @findex TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
21615 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
21616 @item TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
21617 A C@t{++} namespace.
21618
21619 @findex TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
21620 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
21621 @item TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
21622 A decimal floating point type.
21623
21624 @findex TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
21625 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
21626 @item TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
21627 A function internal to @value{GDBN}. This is the type used to represent
21628 convenience functions.
21629 @end table
21630
21631 Further support for types is provided in the @code{gdb.types}
21632 Python module (@pxref{gdb.types}).
21633
21634 @node Pretty Printing API
21635 @subsubsection Pretty Printing API
21636
21637 An example output is provided (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
21638
21639 A pretty-printer is just an object that holds a value and implements a
21640 specific interface, defined here.
21641
21642 @defop Operation {pretty printer} children (self)
21643 @value{GDBN} will call this method on a pretty-printer to compute the
21644 children of the pretty-printer's value.
21645
21646 This method must return an object conforming to the Python iterator
21647 protocol. Each item returned by the iterator must be a tuple holding
21648 two elements. The first element is the ``name'' of the child; the
21649 second element is the child's value. The value can be any Python
21650 object which is convertible to a @value{GDBN} value.
21651
21652 This method is optional. If it does not exist, @value{GDBN} will act
21653 as though the value has no children.
21654 @end defop
21655
21656 @defop Operation {pretty printer} display_hint (self)
21657 The CLI may call this method and use its result to change the
21658 formatting of a value. The result will also be supplied to an MI
21659 consumer as a @samp{displayhint} attribute of the variable being
21660 printed.
21661
21662 This method is optional. If it does exist, this method must return a
21663 string.
21664
21665 Some display hints are predefined by @value{GDBN}:
21666
21667 @table @samp
21668 @item array
21669 Indicate that the object being printed is ``array-like''. The CLI
21670 uses this to respect parameters such as @code{set print elements} and
21671 @code{set print array}.
21672
21673 @item map
21674 Indicate that the object being printed is ``map-like'', and that the
21675 children of this value can be assumed to alternate between keys and
21676 values.
21677
21678 @item string
21679 Indicate that the object being printed is ``string-like''. If the
21680 printer's @code{to_string} method returns a Python string of some
21681 kind, then @value{GDBN} will call its internal language-specific
21682 string-printing function to format the string. For the CLI this means
21683 adding quotation marks, possibly escaping some characters, respecting
21684 @code{set print elements}, and the like.
21685 @end table
21686 @end defop
21687
21688 @defop Operation {pretty printer} to_string (self)
21689 @value{GDBN} will call this method to display the string
21690 representation of the value passed to the object's constructor.
21691
21692 When printing from the CLI, if the @code{to_string} method exists,
21693 then @value{GDBN} will prepend its result to the values returned by
21694 @code{children}. Exactly how this formatting is done is dependent on
21695 the display hint, and may change as more hints are added. Also,
21696 depending on the print settings (@pxref{Print Settings}), the CLI may
21697 print just the result of @code{to_string} in a stack trace, omitting
21698 the result of @code{children}.
21699
21700 If this method returns a string, it is printed verbatim.
21701
21702 Otherwise, if this method returns an instance of @code{gdb.Value},
21703 then @value{GDBN} prints this value. This may result in a call to
21704 another pretty-printer.
21705
21706 If instead the method returns a Python value which is convertible to a
21707 @code{gdb.Value}, then @value{GDBN} performs the conversion and prints
21708 the resulting value. Again, this may result in a call to another
21709 pretty-printer. Python scalars (integers, floats, and booleans) and
21710 strings are convertible to @code{gdb.Value}; other types are not.
21711
21712 Finally, if this method returns @code{None} then no further operations
21713 are peformed in this method and nothing is printed.
21714
21715 If the result is not one of these types, an exception is raised.
21716 @end defop
21717
21718 @value{GDBN} provides a function which can be used to look up the
21719 default pretty-printer for a @code{gdb.Value}:
21720
21721 @findex gdb.default_visualizer
21722 @defun default_visualizer value
21723 This function takes a @code{gdb.Value} object as an argument. If a
21724 pretty-printer for this value exists, then it is returned. If no such
21725 printer exists, then this returns @code{None}.
21726 @end defun
21727
21728 @node Selecting Pretty-Printers
21729 @subsubsection Selecting Pretty-Printers
21730
21731 The Python list @code{gdb.pretty_printers} contains an array of
21732 functions or callable objects that have been registered via addition
21733 as a pretty-printer. Printers in this list are called @code{global}
21734 printers, they're available when debugging all inferiors.
21735 Each @code{gdb.Progspace} contains a @code{pretty_printers} attribute.
21736 Each @code{gdb.Objfile} also contains a @code{pretty_printers}
21737 attribute.
21738
21739 Each function on these lists is passed a single @code{gdb.Value}
21740 argument and should return a pretty-printer object conforming to the
21741 interface definition above (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}). If a function
21742 cannot create a pretty-printer for the value, it should return
21743 @code{None}.
21744
21745 @value{GDBN} first checks the @code{pretty_printers} attribute of each
21746 @code{gdb.Objfile} in the current program space and iteratively calls
21747 each enabled lookup routine in the list for that @code{gdb.Objfile}
21748 until it receives a pretty-printer object.
21749 If no pretty-printer is found in the objfile lists, @value{GDBN} then
21750 searches the pretty-printer list of the current program space,
21751 calling each enabled function until an object is returned.
21752 After these lists have been exhausted, it tries the global
21753 @code{gdb.pretty_printers} list, again calling each enabled function until an
21754 object is returned.
21755
21756 The order in which the objfiles are searched is not specified. For a
21757 given list, functions are always invoked from the head of the list,
21758 and iterated over sequentially until the end of the list, or a printer
21759 object is returned.
21760
21761 For various reasons a pretty-printer may not work.
21762 For example, the underlying data structure may have changed and
21763 the pretty-printer is out of date.
21764
21765 The consequences of a broken pretty-printer are severe enough that
21766 @value{GDBN} provides support for enabling and disabling individual
21767 printers. For example, if @code{print frame-arguments} is on,
21768 a backtrace can become highly illegible if any argument is printed
21769 with a broken printer.
21770
21771 Pretty-printers are enabled and disabled by attaching an @code{enabled}
21772 attribute to the registered function or callable object. If this attribute
21773 is present and its value is @code{False}, the printer is disabled, otherwise
21774 the printer is enabled.
21775
21776 @node Writing a Pretty-Printer
21777 @subsubsection Writing a Pretty-Printer
21778 @cindex writing a pretty-printer
21779
21780 A pretty-printer consists of two parts: a lookup function to detect
21781 if the type is supported, and the printer itself.
21782
21783 Here is an example showing how a @code{std::string} printer might be
21784 written. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for details on the API this class
21785 must provide.
21786
21787 @smallexample
21788 class StdStringPrinter(object):
21789 "Print a std::string"
21790
21791 def __init__(self, val):
21792 self.val = val
21793
21794 def to_string(self):
21795 return self.val['_M_dataplus']['_M_p']
21796
21797 def display_hint(self):
21798 return 'string'
21799 @end smallexample
21800
21801 And here is an example showing how a lookup function for the printer
21802 example above might be written.
21803
21804 @smallexample
21805 def str_lookup_function(val):
21806 lookup_tag = val.type.tag
21807 if lookup_tag == None:
21808 return None
21809 regex = re.compile("^std::basic_string<char,.*>$")
21810 if regex.match(lookup_tag):
21811 return StdStringPrinter(val)
21812 return None
21813 @end smallexample
21814
21815 The example lookup function extracts the value's type, and attempts to
21816 match it to a type that it can pretty-print. If it is a type the
21817 printer can pretty-print, it will return a printer object. If not, it
21818 returns @code{None}.
21819
21820 We recommend that you put your core pretty-printers into a Python
21821 package. If your pretty-printers are for use with a library, we
21822 further recommend embedding a version number into the package name.
21823 This practice will enable @value{GDBN} to load multiple versions of
21824 your pretty-printers at the same time, because they will have
21825 different names.
21826
21827 You should write auto-loaded code (@pxref{Auto-loading}) such that it
21828 can be evaluated multiple times without changing its meaning. An
21829 ideal auto-load file will consist solely of @code{import}s of your
21830 printer modules, followed by a call to a register pretty-printers with
21831 the current objfile.
21832
21833 Taken as a whole, this approach will scale nicely to multiple
21834 inferiors, each potentially using a different library version.
21835 Embedding a version number in the Python package name will ensure that
21836 @value{GDBN} is able to load both sets of printers simultaneously.
21837 Then, because the search for pretty-printers is done by objfile, and
21838 because your auto-loaded code took care to register your library's
21839 printers with a specific objfile, @value{GDBN} will find the correct
21840 printers for the specific version of the library used by each
21841 inferior.
21842
21843 To continue the @code{std::string} example (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}),
21844 this code might appear in @code{gdb.libstdcxx.v6}:
21845
21846 @smallexample
21847 def register_printers(objfile):
21848 objfile.pretty_printers.add(str_lookup_function)
21849 @end smallexample
21850
21851 @noindent
21852 And then the corresponding contents of the auto-load file would be:
21853
21854 @smallexample
21855 import gdb.libstdcxx.v6
21856 gdb.libstdcxx.v6.register_printers(gdb.current_objfile())
21857 @end smallexample
21858
21859 The previous example illustrates a basic pretty-printer.
21860 There are a few things that can be improved on.
21861 The printer doesn't have a name, making it hard to identify in a
21862 list of installed printers. The lookup function has a name, but
21863 lookup functions can have arbitrary, even identical, names.
21864
21865 Second, the printer only handles one type, whereas a library typically has
21866 several types. One could install a lookup function for each desired type
21867 in the library, but one could also have a single lookup function recognize
21868 several types. The latter is the conventional way this is handled.
21869 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
21870 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
21871
21872 The @code{gdb.printing} module provides a formal way of solving these
21873 problems (@pxref{gdb.printing}).
21874 Here is another example that handles multiple types.
21875
21876 These are the types we are going to pretty-print:
21877
21878 @smallexample
21879 struct foo @{ int a, b; @};
21880 struct bar @{ struct foo x, y; @};
21881 @end smallexample
21882
21883 Here are the printers:
21884
21885 @smallexample
21886 class fooPrinter:
21887 """Print a foo object."""
21888
21889 def __init__(self, val):
21890 self.val = val
21891
21892 def to_string(self):
21893 return ("a=<" + str(self.val["a"]) +
21894 "> b=<" + str(self.val["b"]) + ">")
21895
21896 class barPrinter:
21897 """Print a bar object."""
21898
21899 def __init__(self, val):
21900 self.val = val
21901
21902 def to_string(self):
21903 return ("x=<" + str(self.val["x"]) +
21904 "> y=<" + str(self.val["y"]) + ">")
21905 @end smallexample
21906
21907 This example doesn't need a lookup function, that is handled by the
21908 @code{gdb.printing} module. Instead a function is provided to build up
21909 the object that handles the lookup.
21910
21911 @smallexample
21912 import gdb.printing
21913
21914 def build_pretty_printer():
21915 pp = gdb.printing.RegexpCollectionPrettyPrinter(
21916 "my_library")
21917 pp.add_printer('foo', '^foo$', fooPrinter)
21918 pp.add_printer('bar', '^bar$', barPrinter)
21919 return pp
21920 @end smallexample
21921
21922 And here is the autoload support:
21923
21924 @smallexample
21925 import gdb.printing
21926 import my_library
21927 gdb.printing.register_pretty_printer(
21928 gdb.current_objfile(),
21929 my_library.build_pretty_printer())
21930 @end smallexample
21931
21932 Finally, when this printer is loaded into @value{GDBN}, here is the
21933 corresponding output of @samp{info pretty-printer}:
21934
21935 @smallexample
21936 (gdb) info pretty-printer
21937 my_library.so:
21938 my_library
21939 foo
21940 bar
21941 @end smallexample
21942
21943 @node Inferiors In Python
21944 @subsubsection Inferiors In Python
21945 @cindex inferiors in Python
21946
21947 @findex gdb.Inferior
21948 Programs which are being run under @value{GDBN} are called inferiors
21949 (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). Python scripts can access
21950 information about and manipulate inferiors controlled by @value{GDBN}
21951 via objects of the @code{gdb.Inferior} class.
21952
21953 The following inferior-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
21954 module:
21955
21956 @defun inferiors
21957 Return a tuple containing all inferior objects.
21958 @end defun
21959
21960 A @code{gdb.Inferior} object has the following attributes:
21961
21962 @table @code
21963 @defivar Inferior num
21964 ID of inferior, as assigned by GDB.
21965 @end defivar
21966
21967 @defivar Inferior pid
21968 Process ID of the inferior, as assigned by the underlying operating
21969 system.
21970 @end defivar
21971
21972 @defivar Inferior was_attached
21973 Boolean signaling whether the inferior was created using `attach', or
21974 started by @value{GDBN} itself.
21975 @end defivar
21976 @end table
21977
21978 A @code{gdb.Inferior} object has the following methods:
21979
21980 @table @code
21981 @defmethod Inferior is_valid
21982 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Inferior} object is valid,
21983 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Inferior} object will become invalid
21984 if the inferior no longer exists within @value{GDBN}. All other
21985 @code{gdb.Inferior} methods will throw an exception if it is invalid
21986 at the time the method is called.
21987 @end defmethod
21988
21989 @defmethod Inferior threads
21990 This method returns a tuple holding all the threads which are valid
21991 when it is called. If there are no valid threads, the method will
21992 return an empty tuple.
21993 @end defmethod
21994
21995 @findex gdb.read_memory
21996 @defmethod Inferior read_memory address length
21997 Read @var{length} bytes of memory from the inferior, starting at
21998 @var{address}. Returns a buffer object, which behaves much like an array
21999 or a string. It can be modified and given to the @code{gdb.write_memory}
22000 function.
22001 @end defmethod
22002
22003 @findex gdb.write_memory
22004 @defmethod Inferior write_memory address buffer @r{[}length@r{]}
22005 Write the contents of @var{buffer} to the inferior, starting at
22006 @var{address}. The @var{buffer} parameter must be a Python object
22007 which supports the buffer protocol, i.e., a string, an array or the
22008 object returned from @code{gdb.read_memory}. If given, @var{length}
22009 determines the number of bytes from @var{buffer} to be written.
22010 @end defmethod
22011
22012 @findex gdb.search_memory
22013 @defmethod Inferior search_memory address length pattern
22014 Search a region of the inferior memory starting at @var{address} with
22015 the given @var{length} using the search pattern supplied in
22016 @var{pattern}. The @var{pattern} parameter must be a Python object
22017 which supports the buffer protocol, i.e., a string, an array or the
22018 object returned from @code{gdb.read_memory}. Returns a Python @code{Long}
22019 containing the address where the pattern was found, or @code{None} if
22020 the pattern could not be found.
22021 @end defmethod
22022 @end table
22023
22024 @node Events In Python
22025 @subsubsection Events In Python
22026 @cindex inferior events in Python
22027
22028 @value{GDBN} provides a general event facility so that Python code can be
22029 notified of various state changes, particularly changes that occur in
22030 the inferior.
22031
22032 An @dfn{event} is just an object that describes some state change. The
22033 type of the object and its attributes will vary depending on the details
22034 of the change. All the existing events are described below.
22035
22036 In order to be notified of an event, you must register an event handler
22037 with an @dfn{event registry}. An event registry is an object in the
22038 @code{gdb.events} module which dispatches particular events. A registry
22039 provides methods to register and unregister event handlers:
22040
22041 @table @code
22042 @defmethod EventRegistry connect object
22043 Add the given callable @var{object} to the registry. This object will be
22044 called when an event corresponding to this registry occurs.
22045 @end defmethod
22046
22047 @defmethod EventRegistry disconnect object
22048 Remove the given @var{object} from the registry. Once removed, the object
22049 will no longer receive notifications of events.
22050 @end defmethod
22051 @end table
22052
22053 Here is an example:
22054
22055 @smallexample
22056 def exit_handler (event):
22057 print "event type: exit"
22058 print "exit code: %d" % (event.exit_code)
22059
22060 gdb.events.exited.connect (exit_handler)
22061 @end smallexample
22062
22063 In the above example we connect our handler @code{exit_handler} to the
22064 registry @code{events.exited}. Once connected, @code{exit_handler} gets
22065 called when the inferior exits. The argument @dfn{event} in this example is
22066 of type @code{gdb.ExitedEvent}. As you can see in the example the
22067 @code{ExitedEvent} object has an attribute which indicates the exit code of
22068 the inferior.
22069
22070 The following is a listing of the event registries that are available and
22071 details of the events they emit:
22072
22073 @table @code
22074
22075 @item events.cont
22076 Emits @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}.
22077
22078 Some events can be thread specific when @value{GDBN} is running in non-stop
22079 mode. When represented in Python, these events all extend
22080 @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}. Note, this event is not emitted directly; instead,
22081 events which are emitted by this or other modules might extend this event.
22082 Examples of these events are @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent} and
22083 @code{gdb.ContinueEvent}.
22084
22085 @table @code
22086 @defivar ThreadEvent inferior_thread
22087 In non-stop mode this attribute will be set to the specific thread which was
22088 involved in the emitted event. Otherwise, it will be set to @code{None}.
22089 @end defivar
22090 @end table
22091
22092 Emits @code{gdb.ContinueEvent} which extends @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}.
22093
22094 This event indicates that the inferior has been continued after a stop. For
22095 inherited attribute refer to @code{gdb.ThreadEvent} above.
22096
22097 @item events.exited
22098 Emits @code{events.ExitedEvent} which indicates that the inferior has exited.
22099 @code{events.ExitedEvent} has one attribute:
22100 @table @code
22101 @defivar ExitedEvent exit_code
22102 An integer representing the exit code which the inferior has returned.
22103 @end defivar
22104 @end table
22105
22106 @item events.stop
22107 Emits @code{gdb.StopEvent} which extends @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}.
22108
22109 Indicates that the inferior has stopped. All events emitted by this registry
22110 extend StopEvent. As a child of @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}, @code{gdb.StopEvent}
22111 will indicate the stopped thread when @value{GDBN} is running in non-stop
22112 mode. Refer to @code{gdb.ThreadEvent} above for more details.
22113
22114 Emits @code{gdb.SignalEvent} which extends @code{gdb.StopEvent}.
22115
22116 This event indicates that the inferior or one of its threads has received as
22117 signal. @code{gdb.SignalEvent} has the following attributes:
22118
22119 @table @code
22120 @defivar SignalEvent stop_signal
22121 A string representing the signal received by the inferior. A list of possible
22122 signal values can be obtained by running the command @code{info signals} in
22123 the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
22124 @end defivar
22125 @end table
22126
22127 Also emits @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent} which extends @code{gdb.StopEvent}.
22128
22129 @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent} event indicates that a breakpoint has been hit, and
22130 has the following attributes:
22131
22132 @table @code
22133 @defivar BreakpointEvent breakpoint
22134 A reference to the breakpoint that was hit of type @code{gdb.Breakpoint}.
22135 @xref{Breakpoints In Python}, for details of the @code{gdb.Breakpoint} object.
22136 @end defivar
22137 @end table
22138
22139 @end table
22140
22141 @node Threads In Python
22142 @subsubsection Threads In Python
22143 @cindex threads in python
22144
22145 @findex gdb.InferiorThread
22146 Python scripts can access information about, and manipulate inferior threads
22147 controlled by @value{GDBN}, via objects of the @code{gdb.InferiorThread} class.
22148
22149 The following thread-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
22150 module:
22151
22152 @findex gdb.selected_thread
22153 @defun selected_thread
22154 This function returns the thread object for the selected thread. If there
22155 is no selected thread, this will return @code{None}.
22156 @end defun
22157
22158 A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object has the following attributes:
22159
22160 @table @code
22161 @defivar InferiorThread name
22162 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using
22163 @code{thread name}, then this returns that name. Otherwise, if an
22164 OS-supplied name is available, then it is returned. Otherwise, this
22165 returns @code{None}.
22166
22167 This attribute can be assigned to. The new value must be a string
22168 object, which sets the new name, or @code{None}, which removes any
22169 user-specified thread name.
22170 @end defivar
22171
22172 @defivar InferiorThread num
22173 ID of the thread, as assigned by GDB.
22174 @end defivar
22175
22176 @defivar InferiorThread ptid
22177 ID of the thread, as assigned by the operating system. This attribute is a
22178 tuple containing three integers. The first is the Process ID (PID); the second
22179 is the Lightweight Process ID (LWPID), and the third is the Thread ID (TID).
22180 Either the LWPID or TID may be 0, which indicates that the operating system
22181 does not use that identifier.
22182 @end defivar
22183 @end table
22184
22185 A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object has the following methods:
22186
22187 @table @code
22188 @defmethod InferiorThread is_valid
22189 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object is valid,
22190 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object will become
22191 invalid if the thread exits, or the inferior that the thread belongs
22192 is deleted. All other @code{gdb.InferiorThread} methods will throw an
22193 exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
22194 @end defmethod
22195
22196 @defmethod InferiorThread switch
22197 This changes @value{GDBN}'s currently selected thread to the one represented
22198 by this object.
22199 @end defmethod
22200
22201 @defmethod InferiorThread is_stopped
22202 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is stopped.
22203 @end defmethod
22204
22205 @defmethod InferiorThread is_running
22206 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is running.
22207 @end defmethod
22208
22209 @defmethod InferiorThread is_exited
22210 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is exited.
22211 @end defmethod
22212 @end table
22213
22214 @node Commands In Python
22215 @subsubsection Commands In Python
22216
22217 @cindex commands in python
22218 @cindex python commands
22219 You can implement new @value{GDBN} CLI commands in Python. A CLI
22220 command is implemented using an instance of the @code{gdb.Command}
22221 class, most commonly using a subclass.
22222
22223 @defmethod Command __init__ name @var{command_class} @r{[}@var{completer_class}@r{]} @r{[}@var{prefix}@r{]}
22224 The object initializer for @code{Command} registers the new command
22225 with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked from the
22226 subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
22227
22228 @var{name} is the name of the command. If @var{name} consists of
22229 multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
22230 commands. In this case, if one of the prefix commands does not exist,
22231 an exception is raised.
22232
22233 There is no support for multi-line commands.
22234
22235 @var{command_class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
22236 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to categorize the
22237 new command in the help system.
22238
22239 @var{completer_class} is an optional argument. If given, it should be
22240 one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined below. This argument
22241 tells @value{GDBN} how to perform completion for this command. If not
22242 given, @value{GDBN} will attempt to complete using the object's
22243 @code{complete} method (see below); if no such method is found, an
22244 error will occur when completion is attempted.
22245
22246 @var{prefix} is an optional argument. If @code{True}, then the new
22247 command is a prefix command; sub-commands of this command may be
22248 registered.
22249
22250 The help text for the new command is taken from the Python
22251 documentation string for the command's class, if there is one. If no
22252 documentation string is provided, the default value ``This command is
22253 not documented.'' is used.
22254 @end defmethod
22255
22256 @cindex don't repeat Python command
22257 @defmethod Command dont_repeat
22258 By default, a @value{GDBN} command is repeated when the user enters a
22259 blank line at the command prompt. A command can suppress this
22260 behavior by invoking the @code{dont_repeat} method. This is similar
22261 to the user command @code{dont-repeat}, see @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
22262 @end defmethod
22263
22264 @defmethod Command invoke argument from_tty
22265 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when this command is invoked.
22266
22267 @var{argument} is a string. It is the argument to the command, after
22268 leading and trailing whitespace has been stripped.
22269
22270 @var{from_tty} is a boolean argument. When true, this means that the
22271 command was entered by the user at the terminal; when false it means
22272 that the command came from elsewhere.
22273
22274 If this method throws an exception, it is turned into a @value{GDBN}
22275 @code{error} call. Otherwise, the return value is ignored.
22276
22277 @findex gdb.string_to_argv
22278 To break @var{argument} up into an argv-like string use
22279 @code{gdb.string_to_argv}. This function behaves identically to
22280 @value{GDBN}'s internal argument lexer @code{buildargv}.
22281 It is recommended to use this for consistency.
22282 Arguments are separated by spaces and may be quoted.
22283 Example:
22284
22285 @smallexample
22286 print gdb.string_to_argv ("1 2\ \\\"3 '4 \"5' \"6 '7\"")
22287 ['1', '2 "3', '4 "5', "6 '7"]
22288 @end smallexample
22289
22290 @end defmethod
22291
22292 @cindex completion of Python commands
22293 @defmethod Command complete text word
22294 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when the user attempts
22295 completion on this command. All forms of completion are handled by
22296 this method, that is, the @key{TAB} and @key{M-?} key bindings
22297 (@pxref{Completion}), and the @code{complete} command (@pxref{Help,
22298 complete}).
22299
22300 The arguments @var{text} and @var{word} are both strings. @var{text}
22301 holds the complete command line up to the cursor's location.
22302 @var{word} holds the last word of the command line; this is computed
22303 using a word-breaking heuristic.
22304
22305 The @code{complete} method can return several values:
22306 @itemize @bullet
22307 @item
22308 If the return value is a sequence, the contents of the sequence are
22309 used as the completions. It is up to @code{complete} to ensure that the
22310 contents actually do complete the word. A zero-length sequence is
22311 allowed, it means that there were no completions available. Only
22312 string elements of the sequence are used; other elements in the
22313 sequence are ignored.
22314
22315 @item
22316 If the return value is one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined
22317 below, then the corresponding @value{GDBN}-internal completion
22318 function is invoked, and its result is used.
22319
22320 @item
22321 All other results are treated as though there were no available
22322 completions.
22323 @end itemize
22324 @end defmethod
22325
22326 When a new command is registered, it must be declared as a member of
22327 some general class of commands. This is used to classify top-level
22328 commands in the on-line help system; note that prefix commands are not
22329 listed under their own category but rather that of their top-level
22330 command. The available classifications are represented by constants
22331 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
22332
22333 @table @code
22334 @findex COMMAND_NONE
22335 @findex gdb.COMMAND_NONE
22336 @item COMMAND_NONE
22337 The command does not belong to any particular class. A command in
22338 this category will not be displayed in any of the help categories.
22339
22340 @findex COMMAND_RUNNING
22341 @findex gdb.COMMAND_RUNNING
22342 @item COMMAND_RUNNING
22343 The command is related to running the inferior. For example,
22344 @code{start}, @code{step}, and @code{continue} are in this category.
22345 Type @kbd{help running} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
22346 commands in this category.
22347
22348 @findex COMMAND_DATA
22349 @findex gdb.COMMAND_DATA
22350 @item COMMAND_DATA
22351 The command is related to data or variables. For example,
22352 @code{call}, @code{find}, and @code{print} are in this category. Type
22353 @kbd{help data} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands
22354 in this category.
22355
22356 @findex COMMAND_STACK
22357 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STACK
22358 @item COMMAND_STACK
22359 The command has to do with manipulation of the stack. For example,
22360 @code{backtrace}, @code{frame}, and @code{return} are in this
22361 category. Type @kbd{help stack} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a
22362 list of commands in this category.
22363
22364 @findex COMMAND_FILES
22365 @findex gdb.COMMAND_FILES
22366 @item COMMAND_FILES
22367 This class is used for file-related commands. For example,
22368 @code{file}, @code{list} and @code{section} are in this category.
22369 Type @kbd{help files} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
22370 commands in this category.
22371
22372 @findex COMMAND_SUPPORT
22373 @findex gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT
22374 @item COMMAND_SUPPORT
22375 This should be used for ``support facilities'', generally meaning
22376 things that are useful to the user when interacting with @value{GDBN},
22377 but not related to the state of the inferior. For example,
22378 @code{help}, @code{make}, and @code{shell} are in this category. Type
22379 @kbd{help support} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
22380 commands in this category.
22381
22382 @findex COMMAND_STATUS
22383 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STATUS
22384 @item COMMAND_STATUS
22385 The command is an @samp{info}-related command, that is, related to the
22386 state of @value{GDBN} itself. For example, @code{info}, @code{macro},
22387 and @code{show} are in this category. Type @kbd{help status} at the
22388 @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
22389
22390 @findex COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
22391 @findex gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
22392 @item COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
22393 The command has to do with breakpoints. For example, @code{break},
22394 @code{clear}, and @code{delete} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
22395 breakpoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in
22396 this category.
22397
22398 @findex COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
22399 @findex gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
22400 @item COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
22401 The command has to do with tracepoints. For example, @code{trace},
22402 @code{actions}, and @code{tfind} are in this category. Type
22403 @kbd{help tracepoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
22404 commands in this category.
22405
22406 @findex COMMAND_OBSCURE
22407 @findex gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE
22408 @item COMMAND_OBSCURE
22409 The command is only used in unusual circumstances, or is not of
22410 general interest to users. For example, @code{checkpoint},
22411 @code{fork}, and @code{stop} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
22412 obscure} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this
22413 category.
22414
22415 @findex COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
22416 @findex gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
22417 @item COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
22418 The command is only useful to @value{GDBN} maintainers. The
22419 @code{maintenance} and @code{flushregs} commands are in this category.
22420 Type @kbd{help internals} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
22421 commands in this category.
22422 @end table
22423
22424 A new command can use a predefined completion function, either by
22425 specifying it via an argument at initialization, or by returning it
22426 from the @code{complete} method. These predefined completion
22427 constants are all defined in the @code{gdb} module:
22428
22429 @table @code
22430 @findex COMPLETE_NONE
22431 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_NONE
22432 @item COMPLETE_NONE
22433 This constant means that no completion should be done.
22434
22435 @findex COMPLETE_FILENAME
22436 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME
22437 @item COMPLETE_FILENAME
22438 This constant means that filename completion should be performed.
22439
22440 @findex COMPLETE_LOCATION
22441 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION
22442 @item COMPLETE_LOCATION
22443 This constant means that location completion should be done.
22444 @xref{Specify Location}.
22445
22446 @findex COMPLETE_COMMAND
22447 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND
22448 @item COMPLETE_COMMAND
22449 This constant means that completion should examine @value{GDBN}
22450 command names.
22451
22452 @findex COMPLETE_SYMBOL
22453 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL
22454 @item COMPLETE_SYMBOL
22455 This constant means that completion should be done using symbol names
22456 as the source.
22457 @end table
22458
22459 The following code snippet shows how a trivial CLI command can be
22460 implemented in Python:
22461
22462 @smallexample
22463 class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
22464 """Greet the whole world."""
22465
22466 def __init__ (self):
22467 super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)
22468
22469 def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):
22470 print "Hello, World!"
22471
22472 HelloWorld ()
22473 @end smallexample
22474
22475 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
22476 registration of the command with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
22477 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
22478 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
22479
22480 @node Parameters In Python
22481 @subsubsection Parameters In Python
22482
22483 @cindex parameters in python
22484 @cindex python parameters
22485 @tindex gdb.Parameter
22486 @tindex Parameter
22487 You can implement new @value{GDBN} parameters using Python. A new
22488 parameter is implemented as an instance of the @code{gdb.Parameter}
22489 class.
22490
22491 Parameters are exposed to the user via the @code{set} and
22492 @code{show} commands. @xref{Help}.
22493
22494 There are many parameters that already exist and can be set in
22495 @value{GDBN}. Two examples are: @code{set follow fork} and
22496 @code{set charset}. Setting these parameters influences certain
22497 behavior in @value{GDBN}. Similarly, you can define parameters that
22498 can be used to influence behavior in custom Python scripts and commands.
22499
22500 @defmethod Parameter __init__ name @var{command-class} @var{parameter-class} @r{[}@var{enum-sequence}@r{]}
22501 The object initializer for @code{Parameter} registers the new
22502 parameter with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked
22503 from the subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
22504
22505 @var{name} is the name of the new parameter. If @var{name} consists
22506 of multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
22507 parameters. An example of this can be illustrated with the
22508 @code{set print} set of parameters. If @var{name} is
22509 @code{print foo}, then @code{print} will be searched as the prefix
22510 parameter. In this case the parameter can subsequently be accessed in
22511 @value{GDBN} as @code{set print foo}.
22512
22513 If @var{name} consists of multiple words, and no prefix parameter group
22514 can be found, an exception is raised.
22515
22516 @var{command-class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
22517 (@pxref{Commands In Python}). This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to
22518 categorize the new parameter in the help system.
22519
22520 @var{parameter-class} should be one of the @samp{PARAM_} constants
22521 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} the type of the new
22522 parameter; this information is used for input validation and
22523 completion.
22524
22525 If @var{parameter-class} is @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then
22526 @var{enum-sequence} must be a sequence of strings. These strings
22527 represent the possible values for the parameter.
22528
22529 If @var{parameter-class} is not @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then the presence
22530 of a fourth argument will cause an exception to be thrown.
22531
22532 The help text for the new parameter is taken from the Python
22533 documentation string for the parameter's class, if there is one. If
22534 there is no documentation string, a default value is used.
22535 @end defmethod
22536
22537 @defivar Parameter set_doc
22538 If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as
22539 the help text for this parameter's @code{set} command. The value is
22540 examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes
22541 have no effect.
22542 @end defivar
22543
22544 @defivar Parameter show_doc
22545 If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as
22546 the help text for this parameter's @code{show} command. The value is
22547 examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes
22548 have no effect.
22549 @end defivar
22550
22551 @defivar Parameter value
22552 The @code{value} attribute holds the underlying value of the
22553 parameter. It can be read and assigned to just as any other
22554 attribute. @value{GDBN} does validation when assignments are made.
22555 @end defivar
22556
22557 There are two methods that should be implemented in any
22558 @code{Parameter} class. These are:
22559
22560 @defop Operation {parameter} get_set_string self
22561 @value{GDBN} will call this method when a @var{parameter}'s value has
22562 been changed via the @code{set} API (for example, @kbd{set foo off}).
22563 The @code{value} attribute has already been populated with the new
22564 value and may be used in output. This method must return a string.
22565 @end defop
22566
22567 @defop Operation {parameter} get_show_string self svalue
22568 @value{GDBN} will call this method when a @var{parameter}'s
22569 @code{show} API has been invoked (for example, @kbd{show foo}). The
22570 argument @code{svalue} receives the string representation of the
22571 current value. This method must return a string.
22572 @end defop
22573
22574 When a new parameter is defined, its type must be specified. The
22575 available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb}
22576 module:
22577
22578 @table @code
22579 @findex PARAM_BOOLEAN
22580 @findex gdb.PARAM_BOOLEAN
22581 @item PARAM_BOOLEAN
22582 The value is a plain boolean. The Python boolean values, @code{True}
22583 and @code{False} are the only valid values.
22584
22585 @findex PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
22586 @findex gdb.PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
22587 @item PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
22588 The value has three possible states: true, false, and @samp{auto}. In
22589 Python, true and false are represented using boolean constants, and
22590 @samp{auto} is represented using @code{None}.
22591
22592 @findex PARAM_UINTEGER
22593 @findex gdb.PARAM_UINTEGER
22594 @item PARAM_UINTEGER
22595 The value is an unsigned integer. The value of 0 should be
22596 interpreted to mean ``unlimited''.
22597
22598 @findex PARAM_INTEGER
22599 @findex gdb.PARAM_INTEGER
22600 @item PARAM_INTEGER
22601 The value is a signed integer. The value of 0 should be interpreted
22602 to mean ``unlimited''.
22603
22604 @findex PARAM_STRING
22605 @findex gdb.PARAM_STRING
22606 @item PARAM_STRING
22607 The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, any escape
22608 sequences, such as @samp{\t}, @samp{\f}, and octal escapes, are
22609 translated into corresponding characters and encoded into the current
22610 host charset.
22611
22612 @findex PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
22613 @findex gdb.PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
22614 @item PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
22615 The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, escapes are
22616 passed through untranslated.
22617
22618 @findex PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
22619 @findex gdb.PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
22620 @item PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
22621 The value is a either a filename (a string), or @code{None}.
22622
22623 @findex PARAM_FILENAME
22624 @findex gdb.PARAM_FILENAME
22625 @item PARAM_FILENAME
22626 The value is a filename. This is just like
22627 @code{PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE}, but uses file names for completion.
22628
22629 @findex PARAM_ZINTEGER
22630 @findex gdb.PARAM_ZINTEGER
22631 @item PARAM_ZINTEGER
22632 The value is an integer. This is like @code{PARAM_INTEGER}, except 0
22633 is interpreted as itself.
22634
22635 @findex PARAM_ENUM
22636 @findex gdb.PARAM_ENUM
22637 @item PARAM_ENUM
22638 The value is a string, which must be one of a collection string
22639 constants provided when the parameter is created.
22640 @end table
22641
22642 @node Functions In Python
22643 @subsubsection Writing new convenience functions
22644
22645 @cindex writing convenience functions
22646 @cindex convenience functions in python
22647 @cindex python convenience functions
22648 @tindex gdb.Function
22649 @tindex Function
22650 You can implement new convenience functions (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
22651 in Python. A convenience function is an instance of a subclass of the
22652 class @code{gdb.Function}.
22653
22654 @defmethod Function __init__ name
22655 The initializer for @code{Function} registers the new function with
22656 @value{GDBN}. The argument @var{name} is the name of the function,
22657 a string. The function will be visible to the user as a convenience
22658 variable of type @code{internal function}, whose name is the same as
22659 the given @var{name}.
22660
22661 The documentation for the new function is taken from the documentation
22662 string for the new class.
22663 @end defmethod
22664
22665 @defmethod Function invoke @var{*args}
22666 When a convenience function is evaluated, its arguments are converted
22667 to instances of @code{gdb.Value}, and then the function's
22668 @code{invoke} method is called. Note that @value{GDBN} does not
22669 predetermine the arity of convenience functions. Instead, all
22670 available arguments are passed to @code{invoke}, following the
22671 standard Python calling convention. In particular, a convenience
22672 function can have default values for parameters without ill effect.
22673
22674 The return value of this method is used as its value in the enclosing
22675 expression. If an ordinary Python value is returned, it is converted
22676 to a @code{gdb.Value} following the usual rules.
22677 @end defmethod
22678
22679 The following code snippet shows how a trivial convenience function can
22680 be implemented in Python:
22681
22682 @smallexample
22683 class Greet (gdb.Function):
22684 """Return string to greet someone.
22685 Takes a name as argument."""
22686
22687 def __init__ (self):
22688 super (Greet, self).__init__ ("greet")
22689
22690 def invoke (self, name):
22691 return "Hello, %s!" % name.string ()
22692
22693 Greet ()
22694 @end smallexample
22695
22696 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
22697 registration of the function with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
22698 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
22699 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
22700
22701 @node Progspaces In Python
22702 @subsubsection Program Spaces In Python
22703
22704 @cindex progspaces in python
22705 @tindex gdb.Progspace
22706 @tindex Progspace
22707 A program space, or @dfn{progspace}, represents a symbolic view
22708 of an address space.
22709 It consists of all of the objfiles of the program.
22710 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
22711 @xref{Inferiors and Programs, program spaces}, for more details
22712 about program spaces.
22713
22714 The following progspace-related functions are available in the
22715 @code{gdb} module:
22716
22717 @findex gdb.current_progspace
22718 @defun current_progspace
22719 This function returns the program space of the currently selected inferior.
22720 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}.
22721 @end defun
22722
22723 @findex gdb.progspaces
22724 @defun progspaces
22725 Return a sequence of all the progspaces currently known to @value{GDBN}.
22726 @end defun
22727
22728 Each progspace is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Progspace}
22729 class.
22730
22731 @defivar Progspace filename
22732 The file name of the progspace as a string.
22733 @end defivar
22734
22735 @defivar Progspace pretty_printers
22736 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
22737 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
22738 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
22739 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
22740 which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more
22741 information.
22742 @end defivar
22743
22744 @node Objfiles In Python
22745 @subsubsection Objfiles In Python
22746
22747 @cindex objfiles in python
22748 @tindex gdb.Objfile
22749 @tindex Objfile
22750 @value{GDBN} loads symbols for an inferior from various
22751 symbol-containing files (@pxref{Files}). These include the primary
22752 executable file, any shared libraries used by the inferior, and any
22753 separate debug info files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}).
22754 @value{GDBN} calls these symbol-containing files @dfn{objfiles}.
22755
22756 The following objfile-related functions are available in the
22757 @code{gdb} module:
22758
22759 @findex gdb.current_objfile
22760 @defun current_objfile
22761 When auto-loading a Python script (@pxref{Auto-loading}), @value{GDBN}
22762 sets the ``current objfile'' to the corresponding objfile. This
22763 function returns the current objfile. If there is no current objfile,
22764 this function returns @code{None}.
22765 @end defun
22766
22767 @findex gdb.objfiles
22768 @defun objfiles
22769 Return a sequence of all the objfiles current known to @value{GDBN}.
22770 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
22771 @end defun
22772
22773 Each objfile is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Objfile}
22774 class.
22775
22776 @defivar Objfile filename
22777 The file name of the objfile as a string.
22778 @end defivar
22779
22780 @defivar Objfile pretty_printers
22781 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
22782 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
22783 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
22784 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
22785 which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more
22786 information.
22787 @end defivar
22788
22789 A @code{gdb.Objfile} object has the following methods:
22790
22791 @defmethod Objfile is_valid
22792 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Objfile} object is valid,
22793 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Objfile} object can become invalid
22794 if the object file it refers to is not loaded in @value{GDBN} any
22795 longer. All other @code{gdb.Objfile} methods will throw an exception
22796 if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
22797 @end defmethod
22798
22799 @node Frames In Python
22800 @subsubsection Accessing inferior stack frames from Python.
22801
22802 @cindex frames in python
22803 When the debugged program stops, @value{GDBN} is able to analyze its call
22804 stack (@pxref{Frames,,Stack frames}). The @code{gdb.Frame} class
22805 represents a frame in the stack. A @code{gdb.Frame} object is only valid
22806 while its corresponding frame exists in the inferior's stack. If you try
22807 to use an invalid frame object, @value{GDBN} will throw a @code{gdb.error}
22808 exception (@pxref{Exception Handling}).
22809
22810 Two @code{gdb.Frame} objects can be compared for equality with the @code{==}
22811 operator, like:
22812
22813 @smallexample
22814 (@value{GDBP}) python print gdb.newest_frame() == gdb.selected_frame ()
22815 True
22816 @end smallexample
22817
22818 The following frame-related functions are available in the @code{gdb} module:
22819
22820 @findex gdb.selected_frame
22821 @defun selected_frame
22822 Return the selected frame object. (@pxref{Selection,,Selecting a Frame}).
22823 @end defun
22824
22825 @findex gdb.newest_frame
22826 @defun newest_frame
22827 Return the newest frame object for the selected thread.
22828 @end defun
22829
22830 @defun frame_stop_reason_string reason
22831 Return a string explaining the reason why @value{GDBN} stopped unwinding
22832 frames, as expressed by the given @var{reason} code (an integer, see the
22833 @code{unwind_stop_reason} method further down in this section).
22834 @end defun
22835
22836 A @code{gdb.Frame} object has the following methods:
22837
22838 @table @code
22839 @defmethod Frame is_valid
22840 Returns true if the @code{gdb.Frame} object is valid, false if not.
22841 A frame object can become invalid if the frame it refers to doesn't
22842 exist anymore in the inferior. All @code{gdb.Frame} methods will throw
22843 an exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
22844 @end defmethod
22845
22846 @defmethod Frame name
22847 Returns the function name of the frame, or @code{None} if it can't be
22848 obtained.
22849 @end defmethod
22850
22851 @defmethod Frame type
22852 Returns the type of the frame. The value can be one of:
22853 @table @code
22854 @item gdb.NORMAL_FRAME
22855 An ordinary stack frame.
22856
22857 @item gdb.DUMMY_FRAME
22858 A fake stack frame that was created by @value{GDBN} when performing an
22859 inferior function call.
22860
22861 @item gdb.INLINE_FRAME
22862 A frame representing an inlined function. The function was inlined
22863 into a @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME} that is older than this one.
22864
22865 @item gdb.SIGTRAMP_FRAME
22866 A signal trampoline frame. This is the frame created by the OS when
22867 it calls into a signal handler.
22868
22869 @item gdb.ARCH_FRAME
22870 A fake stack frame representing a cross-architecture call.
22871
22872 @item gdb.SENTINEL_FRAME
22873 This is like @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME}, but it is only used for the
22874 newest frame.
22875 @end table
22876 @end defmethod
22877
22878 @defmethod Frame unwind_stop_reason
22879 Return an integer representing the reason why it's not possible to find
22880 more frames toward the outermost frame. Use
22881 @code{gdb.frame_stop_reason_string} to convert the value returned by this
22882 function to a string.
22883 @end defmethod
22884
22885 @defmethod Frame pc
22886 Returns the frame's resume address.
22887 @end defmethod
22888
22889 @defmethod Frame block
22890 Return the frame's code block. @xref{Blocks In Python}.
22891 @end defmethod
22892
22893 @defmethod Frame function
22894 Return the symbol for the function corresponding to this frame.
22895 @xref{Symbols In Python}.
22896 @end defmethod
22897
22898 @defmethod Frame older
22899 Return the frame that called this frame.
22900 @end defmethod
22901
22902 @defmethod Frame newer
22903 Return the frame called by this frame.
22904 @end defmethod
22905
22906 @defmethod Frame find_sal
22907 Return the frame's symtab and line object.
22908 @xref{Symbol Tables In Python}.
22909 @end defmethod
22910
22911 @defmethod Frame read_var variable @r{[}block@r{]}
22912 Return the value of @var{variable} in this frame. If the optional
22913 argument @var{block} is provided, search for the variable from that
22914 block; otherwise start at the frame's current block (which is
22915 determined by the frame's current program counter). @var{variable}
22916 must be a string or a @code{gdb.Symbol} object. @var{block} must be a
22917 @code{gdb.Block} object.
22918 @end defmethod
22919
22920 @defmethod Frame select
22921 Set this frame to be the selected frame. @xref{Stack, ,Examining the
22922 Stack}.
22923 @end defmethod
22924 @end table
22925
22926 @node Blocks In Python
22927 @subsubsection Accessing frame blocks from Python.
22928
22929 @cindex blocks in python
22930 @tindex gdb.Block
22931
22932 Within each frame, @value{GDBN} maintains information on each block
22933 stored in that frame. These blocks are organized hierarchically, and
22934 are represented individually in Python as a @code{gdb.Block}.
22935 Please see @ref{Frames In Python}, for a more in-depth discussion on
22936 frames. Furthermore, see @ref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}, for more
22937 detailed technical information on @value{GDBN}'s book-keeping of the
22938 stack.
22939
22940 The following block-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
22941 module:
22942
22943 @findex gdb.block_for_pc
22944 @defun block_for_pc pc
22945 Return the @code{gdb.Block} containing the given @var{pc} value. If the
22946 block cannot be found for the @var{pc} value specified, the function
22947 will return @code{None}.
22948 @end defun
22949
22950 A @code{gdb.Block} object has the following methods:
22951
22952 @table @code
22953 @defmethod Block is_valid
22954 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Block} object is valid,
22955 @code{False} if not. A block object can become invalid if the block it
22956 refers to doesn't exist anymore in the inferior. All other
22957 @code{gdb.Block} methods will throw an exception if it is invalid at
22958 the time the method is called. This method is also made available to
22959 the Python iterator object that @code{gdb.Block} provides in an iteration
22960 context and via the Python @code{iter} built-in function.
22961 @end defmethod
22962 @end table
22963
22964 A @code{gdb.Block} object has the following attributes:
22965
22966 @table @code
22967 @defivar Block start
22968 The start address of the block. This attribute is not writable.
22969 @end defivar
22970
22971 @defivar Block end
22972 The end address of the block. This attribute is not writable.
22973 @end defivar
22974
22975 @defivar Block function
22976 The name of the block represented as a @code{gdb.Symbol}. If the
22977 block is not named, then this attribute holds @code{None}. This
22978 attribute is not writable.
22979 @end defivar
22980
22981 @defivar Block superblock
22982 The block containing this block. If this parent block does not exist,
22983 this attribute holds @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
22984 @end defivar
22985 @end table
22986
22987 @node Symbols In Python
22988 @subsubsection Python representation of Symbols.
22989
22990 @cindex symbols in python
22991 @tindex gdb.Symbol
22992
22993 @value{GDBN} represents every variable, function and type as an
22994 entry in a symbol table. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
22995 Similarly, Python represents these symbols in @value{GDBN} with the
22996 @code{gdb.Symbol} object.
22997
22998 The following symbol-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
22999 module:
23000
23001 @findex gdb.lookup_symbol
23002 @defun lookup_symbol name @r{[}block@r{]} @r{[}domain@r{]}
23003 This function searches for a symbol by name. The search scope can be
23004 restricted to the parameters defined in the optional domain and block
23005 arguments.
23006
23007 @var{name} is the name of the symbol. It must be a string. The
23008 optional @var{block} argument restricts the search to symbols visible
23009 in that @var{block}. The @var{block} argument must be a
23010 @code{gdb.Block} object. If omitted, the block for the current frame
23011 is used. The optional @var{domain} argument restricts
23012 the search to the domain type. The @var{domain} argument must be a
23013 domain constant defined in the @code{gdb} module and described later
23014 in this chapter.
23015
23016 The result is a tuple of two elements.
23017 The first element is a @code{gdb.Symbol} object or @code{None} if the symbol
23018 is not found.
23019 If the symbol is found, the second element is @code{True} if the symbol
23020 is a field of a method's object (e.g., @code{this} in C@t{++}),
23021 otherwise it is @code{False}.
23022 If the symbol is not found, the second element is @code{False}.
23023 @end defun
23024
23025 @findex gdb.lookup_global_symbol
23026 @defun lookup_global_symbol name @r{[}domain@r{]}
23027 This function searches for a global symbol by name.
23028 The search scope can be restricted to by the domain argument.
23029
23030 @var{name} is the name of the symbol. It must be a string.
23031 The optional @var{domain} argument restricts the search to the domain type.
23032 The @var{domain} argument must be a domain constant defined in the @code{gdb}
23033 module and described later in this chapter.
23034
23035 The result is a @code{gdb.Symbol} object or @code{None} if the symbol
23036 is not found.
23037 @end defun
23038
23039 A @code{gdb.Symbol} object has the following attributes:
23040
23041 @table @code
23042 @defivar Symbol symtab
23043 The symbol table in which the symbol appears. This attribute is
23044 represented as a @code{gdb.Symtab} object. @xref{Symbol Tables In
23045 Python}. This attribute is not writable.
23046 @end defivar
23047
23048 @defivar Symbol name
23049 The name of the symbol as a string. This attribute is not writable.
23050 @end defivar
23051
23052 @defivar Symbol linkage_name
23053 The name of the symbol, as used by the linker (i.e., may be mangled).
23054 This attribute is not writable.
23055 @end defivar
23056
23057 @defivar Symbol print_name
23058 The name of the symbol in a form suitable for output. This is either
23059 @code{name} or @code{linkage_name}, depending on whether the user
23060 asked @value{GDBN} to display demangled or mangled names.
23061 @end defivar
23062
23063 @defivar Symbol addr_class
23064 The address class of the symbol. This classifies how to find the value
23065 of a symbol. Each address class is a constant defined in the
23066 @code{gdb} module and described later in this chapter.
23067 @end defivar
23068
23069 @defivar Symbol is_argument
23070 @code{True} if the symbol is an argument of a function.
23071 @end defivar
23072
23073 @defivar Symbol is_constant
23074 @code{True} if the symbol is a constant.
23075 @end defivar
23076
23077 @defivar Symbol is_function
23078 @code{True} if the symbol is a function or a method.
23079 @end defivar
23080
23081 @defivar Symbol is_variable
23082 @code{True} if the symbol is a variable.
23083 @end defivar
23084 @end table
23085
23086 A @code{gdb.Symbol} object has the following methods:
23087
23088 @table @code
23089 @defmethod Symbol is_valid
23090 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Symbol} object is valid,
23091 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Symbol} object can become invalid if
23092 the symbol it refers to does not exist in @value{GDBN} any longer.
23093 All other @code{gdb.Symbol} methods will throw an exception if it is
23094 invalid at the time the method is called.
23095 @end defmethod
23096 @end table
23097
23098 The available domain categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented
23099 as constants in the @code{gdb} module:
23100
23101 @table @code
23102 @findex SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
23103 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
23104 @item SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
23105 This is used when a domain has not been discovered or none of the
23106 following domains apply. This usually indicates an error either
23107 in the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols.
23108 @findex SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
23109 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
23110 @item SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
23111 This domain contains variables, function names, typedef names and enum
23112 type values.
23113 @findex SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
23114 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
23115 @item SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
23116 This domain holds struct, union and enum type names.
23117 @findex SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
23118 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
23119 @item SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
23120 This domain contains names of labels (for gotos).
23121 @findex SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
23122 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
23123 @item SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
23124 This domain holds a subset of the @code{SYMBOLS_VAR_DOMAIN}; it
23125 contains everything minus functions and types.
23126 @findex SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN
23127 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN
23128 @item SYMBOL_FUNCTION_DOMAIN
23129 This domain contains all functions.
23130 @findex SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
23131 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
23132 @item SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
23133 This domain contains all types.
23134 @end table
23135
23136 The available address class categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented
23137 as constants in the @code{gdb} module:
23138
23139 @table @code
23140 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
23141 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
23142 @item SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
23143 If this is returned by address class, it indicates an error either in
23144 the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols.
23145 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
23146 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
23147 @item SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
23148 Value is constant int.
23149 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
23150 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
23151 @item SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
23152 Value is at a fixed address.
23153 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
23154 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
23155 @item SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
23156 Value is in a register.
23157 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
23158 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
23159 @item SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
23160 Value is an argument. This value is at the offset stored within the
23161 symbol inside the frame's argument list.
23162 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
23163 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
23164 @item SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
23165 Value address is stored in the frame's argument list. Just like
23166 @code{LOC_ARG} except that the value's address is stored at the
23167 offset, not the value itself.
23168 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
23169 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
23170 @item SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
23171 Value is a specified register. Just like @code{LOC_REGISTER} except
23172 the register holds the address of the argument instead of the argument
23173 itself.
23174 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
23175 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
23176 @item SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
23177 Value is a local variable.
23178 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
23179 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
23180 @item SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
23181 Value not used. Symbols in the domain @code{SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN} all
23182 have this class.
23183 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
23184 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
23185 @item SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
23186 Value is a block.
23187 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
23188 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
23189 @item SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
23190 Value is a byte-sequence.
23191 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
23192 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
23193 @item SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
23194 Value is at a fixed address, but the address of the variable has to be
23195 determined from the minimal symbol table whenever the variable is
23196 referenced.
23197 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
23198 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
23199 @item SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
23200 The value does not actually exist in the program.
23201 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
23202 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
23203 @item SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
23204 The value's address is a computed location.
23205 @end table
23206
23207 @node Symbol Tables In Python
23208 @subsubsection Symbol table representation in Python.
23209
23210 @cindex symbol tables in python
23211 @tindex gdb.Symtab
23212 @tindex gdb.Symtab_and_line
23213
23214 Access to symbol table data maintained by @value{GDBN} on the inferior
23215 is exposed to Python via two objects: @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} and
23216 @code{gdb.Symtab}. Symbol table and line data for a frame is returned
23217 from the @code{find_sal} method in @code{gdb.Frame} object.
23218 @xref{Frames In Python}.
23219
23220 For more information on @value{GDBN}'s symbol table management, see
23221 @ref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, for more information.
23222
23223 A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object has the following attributes:
23224
23225 @table @code
23226 @defivar Symtab_and_line symtab
23227 The symbol table object (@code{gdb.Symtab}) for this frame.
23228 This attribute is not writable.
23229 @end defivar
23230
23231 @defivar Symtab_and_line pc
23232 Indicates the current program counter address. This attribute is not
23233 writable.
23234 @end defivar
23235
23236 @defivar Symtab_and_line line
23237 Indicates the current line number for this object. This
23238 attribute is not writable.
23239 @end defivar
23240 @end table
23241
23242 A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object has the following methods:
23243
23244 @table @code
23245 @defmethod Symtab_and_line is_valid
23246 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object is valid,
23247 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object can become
23248 invalid if the Symbol table and line object it refers to does not
23249 exist in @value{GDBN} any longer. All other
23250 @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} methods will throw an exception if it is
23251 invalid at the time the method is called.
23252 @end defmethod
23253 @end table
23254
23255 A @code{gdb.Symtab} object has the following attributes:
23256
23257 @table @code
23258 @defivar Symtab filename
23259 The symbol table's source filename. This attribute is not writable.
23260 @end defivar
23261
23262 @defivar Symtab objfile
23263 The symbol table's backing object file. @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
23264 This attribute is not writable.
23265 @end defivar
23266 @end table
23267
23268 A @code{gdb.Symtab} object has the following methods:
23269
23270 @table @code
23271 @defmethod Symtab is_valid
23272 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Symtab} object is valid,
23273 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Symtab} object can become invalid if
23274 the symbol table it refers to does not exist in @value{GDBN} any
23275 longer. All other @code{gdb.Symtab} methods will throw an exception
23276 if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
23277 @end defmethod
23278
23279 @defmethod Symtab fullname
23280 Return the symbol table's source absolute file name.
23281 @end defmethod
23282 @end table
23283
23284 @node Breakpoints In Python
23285 @subsubsection Manipulating breakpoints using Python
23286
23287 @cindex breakpoints in python
23288 @tindex gdb.Breakpoint
23289
23290 Python code can manipulate breakpoints via the @code{gdb.Breakpoint}
23291 class.
23292
23293 @defmethod Breakpoint __init__ spec @r{[}type@r{]} @r{[}wp_class@r{]} @r{[}internal@r{]}
23294 Create a new breakpoint. @var{spec} is a string naming the
23295 location of the breakpoint, or an expression that defines a
23296 watchpoint. The contents can be any location recognized by the
23297 @code{break} command, or in the case of a watchpoint, by the @code{watch}
23298 command. The optional @var{type} denotes the breakpoint to create
23299 from the types defined later in this chapter. This argument can be
23300 either: @code{BP_BREAKPOINT} or @code{BP_WATCHPOINT}. @var{type}
23301 defaults to @code{BP_BREAKPOINT}. The optional @var{internal} argument
23302 allows the breakpoint to become invisible to the user. The breakpoint
23303 will neither be reported when created, nor will it be listed in the
23304 output from @code{info breakpoints} (but will be listed with the
23305 @code{maint info breakpoints} command). The optional @var{wp_class}
23306 argument defines the class of watchpoint to create, if @var{type} is
23307 @code{BP_WATCHPOINT}. If a watchpoint class is not provided, it is
23308 assumed to be a @var{WP_WRITE} class.
23309 @end defmethod
23310
23311 @defop Operation {gdb.Breakpoint} stop (self)
23312 The @code{gdb.Breakpoint} class can be sub-classed and, in
23313 particular, you may choose to implement the @code{stop} method.
23314 If this method is defined as a sub-class of @code{gdb.Breakpoint},
23315 it will be called when the inferior reaches any location of a
23316 breakpoint which instantiates that sub-class. If the method returns
23317 @code{True}, the inferior will be stopped at the location of the
23318 breakpoint, otherwise the inferior will continue.
23319
23320 If there are multiple breakpoints at the same location with a
23321 @code{stop} method, each one will be called regardless of the
23322 return status of the previous. This ensures that all @code{stop}
23323 methods have a chance to execute at that location. In this scenario
23324 if one of the methods returns @code{True} but the others return
23325 @code{False}, the inferior will still be stopped.
23326
23327 Example @code{stop} implementation:
23328
23329 @smallexample
23330 class MyBreakpoint (gdb.Breakpoint):
23331 def stop (self):
23332 inf_val = gdb.parse_and_eval("foo")
23333 if inf_val == 3:
23334 return True
23335 return False
23336 @end smallexample
23337 @end defop
23338
23339 The available watchpoint types represented by constants are defined in the
23340 @code{gdb} module:
23341
23342 @table @code
23343 @findex WP_READ
23344 @findex gdb.WP_READ
23345 @item WP_READ
23346 Read only watchpoint.
23347
23348 @findex WP_WRITE
23349 @findex gdb.WP_WRITE
23350 @item WP_WRITE
23351 Write only watchpoint.
23352
23353 @findex WP_ACCESS
23354 @findex gdb.WP_ACCESS
23355 @item WP_ACCESS
23356 Read/Write watchpoint.
23357 @end table
23358
23359 @defmethod Breakpoint is_valid
23360 Return @code{True} if this @code{Breakpoint} object is valid,
23361 @code{False} otherwise. A @code{Breakpoint} object can become invalid
23362 if the user deletes the breakpoint. In this case, the object still
23363 exists, but the underlying breakpoint does not. In the cases of
23364 watchpoint scope, the watchpoint remains valid even if execution of the
23365 inferior leaves the scope of that watchpoint.
23366 @end defmethod
23367
23368 @defmethod Breakpoint delete
23369 Permanently deletes the @value{GDBN} breakpoint. This also
23370 invalidates the Python @code{Breakpoint} object. Any further access
23371 to this object's attributes or methods will raise an error.
23372 @end defmethod
23373
23374 @defivar Breakpoint enabled
23375 This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is enabled, and
23376 @code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable.
23377 @end defivar
23378
23379 @defivar Breakpoint silent
23380 This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is silent, and
23381 @code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable.
23382
23383 Note that a breakpoint can also be silent if it has commands and the
23384 first command is @code{silent}. This is not reported by the
23385 @code{silent} attribute.
23386 @end defivar
23387
23388 @defivar Breakpoint thread
23389 If the breakpoint is thread-specific, this attribute holds the thread
23390 id. If the breakpoint is not thread-specific, this attribute is
23391 @code{None}. This attribute is writable.
23392 @end defivar
23393
23394 @defivar Breakpoint task
23395 If the breakpoint is Ada task-specific, this attribute holds the Ada task
23396 id. If the breakpoint is not task-specific (or the underlying
23397 language is not Ada), this attribute is @code{None}. This attribute
23398 is writable.
23399 @end defivar
23400
23401 @defivar Breakpoint ignore_count
23402 This attribute holds the ignore count for the breakpoint, an integer.
23403 This attribute is writable.
23404 @end defivar
23405
23406 @defivar Breakpoint number
23407 This attribute holds the breakpoint's number --- the identifier used by
23408 the user to manipulate the breakpoint. This attribute is not writable.
23409 @end defivar
23410
23411 @defivar Breakpoint type
23412 This attribute holds the breakpoint's type --- the identifier used to
23413 determine the actual breakpoint type or use-case. This attribute is not
23414 writable.
23415 @end defivar
23416
23417 @defivar Breakpoint visible
23418 This attribute tells whether the breakpoint is visible to the user
23419 when set, or when the @samp{info breakpoints} command is run. This
23420 attribute is not writable.
23421 @end defivar
23422
23423 The available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb}
23424 module:
23425
23426 @table @code
23427 @findex BP_BREAKPOINT
23428 @findex gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT
23429 @item BP_BREAKPOINT
23430 Normal code breakpoint.
23431
23432 @findex BP_WATCHPOINT
23433 @findex gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT
23434 @item BP_WATCHPOINT
23435 Watchpoint breakpoint.
23436
23437 @findex BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
23438 @findex gdb.BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
23439 @item BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
23440 Hardware assisted watchpoint.
23441
23442 @findex BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
23443 @findex gdb.BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
23444 @item BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
23445 Hardware assisted read watchpoint.
23446
23447 @findex BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
23448 @findex gdb.BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
23449 @item BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
23450 Hardware assisted access watchpoint.
23451 @end table
23452
23453 @defivar Breakpoint hit_count
23454 This attribute holds the hit count for the breakpoint, an integer.
23455 This attribute is writable, but currently it can only be set to zero.
23456 @end defivar
23457
23458 @defivar Breakpoint location
23459 This attribute holds the location of the breakpoint, as specified by
23460 the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have a location
23461 (that is, it is a watchpoint) the attribute's value is @code{None}. This
23462 attribute is not writable.
23463 @end defivar
23464
23465 @defivar Breakpoint expression
23466 This attribute holds a breakpoint expression, as specified by
23467 the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have an
23468 expression (the breakpoint is not a watchpoint) the attribute's value
23469 is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
23470 @end defivar
23471
23472 @defivar Breakpoint condition
23473 This attribute holds the condition of the breakpoint, as specified by
23474 the user. It is a string. If there is no condition, this attribute's
23475 value is @code{None}. This attribute is writable.
23476 @end defivar
23477
23478 @defivar Breakpoint commands
23479 This attribute holds the commands attached to the breakpoint. If
23480 there are commands, this attribute's value is a string holding all the
23481 commands, separated by newlines. If there are no commands, this
23482 attribute is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
23483 @end defivar
23484
23485 @node Lazy Strings In Python
23486 @subsubsection Python representation of lazy strings.
23487
23488 @cindex lazy strings in python
23489 @tindex gdb.LazyString
23490
23491 A @dfn{lazy string} is a string whose contents is not retrieved or
23492 encoded until it is needed.
23493
23494 A @code{gdb.LazyString} is represented in @value{GDBN} as an
23495 @code{address} that points to a region of memory, an @code{encoding}
23496 that will be used to encode that region of memory, and a @code{length}
23497 to delimit the region of memory that represents the string. The
23498 difference between a @code{gdb.LazyString} and a string wrapped within
23499 a @code{gdb.Value} is that a @code{gdb.LazyString} will be treated
23500 differently by @value{GDBN} when printing. A @code{gdb.LazyString} is
23501 retrieved and encoded during printing, while a @code{gdb.Value}
23502 wrapping a string is immediately retrieved and encoded on creation.
23503
23504 A @code{gdb.LazyString} object has the following functions:
23505
23506 @defmethod LazyString value
23507 Convert the @code{gdb.LazyString} to a @code{gdb.Value}. This value
23508 will point to the string in memory, but will lose all the delayed
23509 retrieval, encoding and handling that @value{GDBN} applies to a
23510 @code{gdb.LazyString}.
23511 @end defmethod
23512
23513 @defivar LazyString address
23514 This attribute holds the address of the string. This attribute is not
23515 writable.
23516 @end defivar
23517
23518 @defivar LazyString length
23519 This attribute holds the length of the string in characters. If the
23520 length is -1, then the string will be fetched and encoded up to the
23521 first null of appropriate width. This attribute is not writable.
23522 @end defivar
23523
23524 @defivar LazyString encoding
23525 This attribute holds the encoding that will be applied to the string
23526 when the string is printed by @value{GDBN}. If the encoding is not
23527 set, or contains an empty string, then @value{GDBN} will select the
23528 most appropriate encoding when the string is printed. This attribute
23529 is not writable.
23530 @end defivar
23531
23532 @defivar LazyString type
23533 This attribute holds the type that is represented by the lazy string's
23534 type. For a lazy string this will always be a pointer type. To
23535 resolve this to the lazy string's character type, use the type's
23536 @code{target} method. @xref{Types In Python}. This attribute is not
23537 writable.
23538 @end defivar
23539
23540 @node Auto-loading
23541 @subsection Auto-loading
23542 @cindex auto-loading, Python
23543
23544 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
23545 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
23546 @value{GDBN} will look for Python support scripts in several ways:
23547 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} and @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
23548
23549 @menu
23550 * objfile-gdb.py file:: The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} file
23551 * .debug_gdb_scripts section:: The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23552 * Which flavor to choose?::
23553 @end menu
23554
23555 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
23556 debugging commands and scripts.
23557
23558 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled.
23559
23560 @table @code
23561 @kindex set auto-load-scripts
23562 @item set auto-load-scripts [yes|no]
23563 Enable or disable the auto-loading of Python scripts.
23564
23565 @kindex show auto-load-scripts
23566 @item show auto-load-scripts
23567 Show whether auto-loading of Python scripts is enabled or disabled.
23568 @end table
23569
23570 When reading an auto-loaded file, @value{GDBN} sets the
23571 @dfn{current objfile}. This is available via the @code{gdb.current_objfile}
23572 function (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}). This can be useful for
23573 registering objfile-specific pretty-printers.
23574
23575 @node objfile-gdb.py file
23576 @subsubsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} file
23577 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
23578
23579 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for
23580 a file named @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py},
23581 where @var{objfile} is the object file's real name, formed by ensuring
23582 that the file name is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving
23583 @code{.} and @code{..} components. If this file exists and is
23584 readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a Python script.
23585
23586 If this file does not exist, and if the parameter
23587 @code{debug-file-directory} is set (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}),
23588 then @value{GDBN} will look for @var{real-name} in all of the
23589 directories mentioned in the value of @code{debug-file-directory}.
23590
23591 Finally, if this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
23592 a file named @file{@var{data-directory}/python/auto-load/@var{real-name}}, where
23593 @var{data-directory} is @value{GDBN}'s data directory (available via
23594 @code{show data-directory}, @pxref{Data Files}), and @var{real-name}
23595 is the object file's real name, as described above.
23596
23597 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
23598 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
23599 @var{objfile} is opened.
23600 So your @file{-gdb.py} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
23601 is evaluated more than once.
23602
23603 @node .debug_gdb_scripts section
23604 @subsubsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23605 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23606
23607 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
23608 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
23609 it will look for a special section named @samp{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
23610 If this section exists, its contents is a list of names of scripts to load.
23611
23612 @value{GDBN} will look for each specified script file first in the
23613 current directory and then along the source search path
23614 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
23615 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
23616 directory is not relevant to scripts.
23617
23618 Entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
23619 for example, this GCC macro:
23620
23621 @example
23622 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
23623 #define DEFINE_GDB_SCRIPT(script_name) \
23624 asm("\
23625 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
23626 .byte 1\n\
23627 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
23628 .popsection \n\
23629 ");
23630 @end example
23631
23632 @noindent
23633 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
23634
23635 @example
23636 DEFINE_GDB_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
23637 @end example
23638
23639 The script name may include directories if desired.
23640
23641 If the macro is put in a header, any application or library
23642 using this header will get a reference to the specified script.
23643
23644 @node Which flavor to choose?
23645 @subsubsection Which flavor to choose?
23646
23647 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading Python scripts, it might not always
23648 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
23649
23650 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.py} way:
23651
23652 @itemize @bullet
23653 @item
23654 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
23655
23656 @item
23657 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
23658
23659 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
23660 in the source search path.
23661 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
23662 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
23663
23664 @item
23665 Doesn't require source code additions.
23666 @end itemize
23667
23668 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
23669
23670 @itemize @bullet
23671 @item
23672 Works with static linking.
23673
23674 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.py} way require an objfile to
23675 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
23676 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
23677 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's @file{-gdb.py} script.
23678
23679 @item
23680 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
23681
23682 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
23683 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.py} script to.
23684
23685 @item
23686 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
23687
23688 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
23689 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
23690 @file{-gdb.py} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
23691 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
23692 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
23693 top of the source tree to the source search path.
23694 @end itemize
23695
23696 @node Python modules
23697 @subsection Python modules
23698 @cindex python modules
23699
23700 @value{GDBN} comes with a module to assist writing Python code.
23701
23702 @menu
23703 * gdb.printing:: Building and registering pretty-printers.
23704 * gdb.types:: Utilities for working with types.
23705 @end menu
23706
23707 @node gdb.printing
23708 @subsubsection gdb.printing
23709 @cindex gdb.printing
23710
23711 This module provides a collection of utilities for working with
23712 pretty-printers.
23713
23714 @table @code
23715 @item PrettyPrinter (@var{name}, @var{subprinters}=None)
23716 This class specifies the API that makes @samp{info pretty-printer},
23717 @samp{enable pretty-printer} and @samp{disable pretty-printer} work.
23718 Pretty-printers should generally inherit from this class.
23719
23720 @item SubPrettyPrinter (@var{name})
23721 For printers that handle multiple types, this class specifies the
23722 corresponding API for the subprinters.
23723
23724 @item RegexpCollectionPrettyPrinter (@var{name})
23725 Utility class for handling multiple printers, all recognized via
23726 regular expressions.
23727 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for an example.
23728
23729 @item register_pretty_printer (@var{obj}, @var{printer})
23730 Register @var{printer} with the pretty-printer list of @var{obj}.
23731 @end table
23732
23733 @node gdb.types
23734 @subsubsection gdb.types
23735 @cindex gdb.types
23736
23737 This module provides a collection of utilities for working with
23738 @code{gdb.Types} objects.
23739
23740 @table @code
23741 @item get_basic_type (@var{type})
23742 Return @var{type} with const and volatile qualifiers stripped,
23743 and with typedefs and C@t{++} references converted to the underlying type.
23744
23745 C@t{++} example:
23746
23747 @smallexample
23748 typedef const int const_int;
23749 const_int foo (3);
23750 const_int& foo_ref (foo);
23751 int main () @{ return 0; @}
23752 @end smallexample
23753
23754 Then in gdb:
23755
23756 @smallexample
23757 (gdb) start
23758 (gdb) python import gdb.types
23759 (gdb) python foo_ref = gdb.parse_and_eval("foo_ref")
23760 (gdb) python print gdb.types.get_basic_type(foo_ref.type)
23761 int
23762 @end smallexample
23763
23764 @item has_field (@var{type}, @var{field})
23765 Return @code{True} if @var{type}, assumed to be a type with fields
23766 (e.g., a structure or union), has field @var{field}.
23767
23768 @item make_enum_dict (@var{enum_type})
23769 Return a Python @code{dictionary} type produced from @var{enum_type}.
23770 @end table
23771
23772 @node Interpreters
23773 @chapter Command Interpreters
23774 @cindex command interpreters
23775
23776 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
23777 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
23778 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
23779
23780 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
23781 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
23782 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
23783 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
23784
23785 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
23786 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
23787 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
23788 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
23789
23790 @table @code
23791 @item console
23792 @cindex console interpreter
23793 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
23794 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
23795 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
23796
23797 @item mi
23798 @cindex mi interpreter
23799 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
23800 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
23801 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
23802 Interface}.
23803
23804 @item mi2
23805 @cindex mi2 interpreter
23806 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
23807
23808 @item mi1
23809 @cindex mi1 interpreter
23810 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
23811
23812 @end table
23813
23814 @cindex invoke another interpreter
23815 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
23816 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
23817 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
23818 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
23819 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
23820 the IDE inoperable!
23821
23822 @kindex interpreter-exec
23823 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
23824 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
23825 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
23826 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
23827
23828 @smallexample
23829 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
23830 @end smallexample
23831
23832 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
23833 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
23834
23835 @node TUI
23836 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
23837 @cindex TUI
23838 @cindex Text User Interface
23839
23840 @menu
23841 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
23842 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
23843 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
23844 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
23845 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
23846 @end menu
23847
23848 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
23849 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
23850 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
23851 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
23852 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
23853 is available.
23854
23855 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
23856 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
23857 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
23858 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
23859 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
23860 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
23861
23862 @node TUI Overview
23863 @section TUI Overview
23864
23865 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
23866
23867 @table @emph
23868 @item command
23869 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
23870 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
23871 managed using readline.
23872
23873 @item source
23874 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
23875 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
23876
23877 @item assembly
23878 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
23879
23880 @item register
23881 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
23882 when their values change.
23883 @end table
23884
23885 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
23886 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
23887 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
23888 indicates the breakpoint type:
23889
23890 @table @code
23891 @item B
23892 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
23893
23894 @item b
23895 Breakpoint which was never hit.
23896
23897 @item H
23898 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
23899
23900 @item h
23901 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
23902 @end table
23903
23904 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
23905
23906 @table @code
23907 @item +
23908 Breakpoint is enabled.
23909
23910 @item -
23911 Breakpoint is disabled.
23912 @end table
23913
23914 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
23915 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
23916 changes.
23917
23918 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
23919 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
23920 layouts:
23921
23922 @itemize @bullet
23923 @item
23924 source only,
23925
23926 @item
23927 assembly only,
23928
23929 @item
23930 source and assembly,
23931
23932 @item
23933 source and registers, or
23934
23935 @item
23936 assembly and registers.
23937 @end itemize
23938
23939 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
23940
23941 @table @emph
23942 @item target
23943 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
23944 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
23945
23946 @item process
23947 Gives the current process or thread number.
23948 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
23949
23950 @item function
23951 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
23952 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
23953 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
23954 the string @code{??} is displayed.
23955
23956 @item line
23957 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
23958 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
23959
23960 @item pc
23961 Indicates the current program counter address.
23962 @end table
23963
23964 @node TUI Keys
23965 @section TUI Key Bindings
23966 @cindex TUI key bindings
23967
23968 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
23969 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23970 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
23971 @end ifset
23972 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23973 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
23974 @end ifclear
23975 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
23976 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
23977
23978 @table @kbd
23979 @kindex C-x C-a
23980 @item C-x C-a
23981 @kindex C-x a
23982 @itemx C-x a
23983 @kindex C-x A
23984 @itemx C-x A
23985 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
23986 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
23987 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
23988 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
23989 The screen is then refreshed.
23990
23991 @kindex C-x 1
23992 @item C-x 1
23993 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
23994 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
23995 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
23996
23997 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
23998
23999 @kindex C-x 2
24000 @item C-x 2
24001 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
24002 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
24003 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
24004 previous layout and the new one.
24005
24006 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
24007
24008 @kindex C-x o
24009 @item C-x o
24010 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
24011 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
24012 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
24013
24014 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
24015
24016 @kindex C-x s
24017 @item C-x s
24018 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
24019 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
24020 @end table
24021
24022 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
24023
24024 @table @asis
24025 @kindex PgUp
24026 @item @key{PgUp}
24027 Scroll the active window one page up.
24028
24029 @kindex PgDn
24030 @item @key{PgDn}
24031 Scroll the active window one page down.
24032
24033 @kindex Up
24034 @item @key{Up}
24035 Scroll the active window one line up.
24036
24037 @kindex Down
24038 @item @key{Down}
24039 Scroll the active window one line down.
24040
24041 @kindex Left
24042 @item @key{Left}
24043 Scroll the active window one column left.
24044
24045 @kindex Right
24046 @item @key{Right}
24047 Scroll the active window one column right.
24048
24049 @kindex C-L
24050 @item @kbd{C-L}
24051 Refresh the screen.
24052 @end table
24053
24054 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
24055 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
24056 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
24057 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
24058 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
24059
24060 @node TUI Single Key Mode
24061 @section TUI Single Key Mode
24062 @cindex TUI single key mode
24063
24064 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
24065 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
24066 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
24067
24068 @table @kbd
24069 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24070 @item c
24071 continue
24072
24073 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24074 @item d
24075 down
24076
24077 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24078 @item f
24079 finish
24080
24081 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24082 @item n
24083 next
24084
24085 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24086 @item q
24087 exit the SingleKey mode.
24088
24089 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24090 @item r
24091 run
24092
24093 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24094 @item s
24095 step
24096
24097 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24098 @item u
24099 up
24100
24101 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24102 @item v
24103 info locals
24104
24105 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24106 @item w
24107 where
24108 @end table
24109
24110 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
24111 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
24112 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
24113 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
24114 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
24115 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
24116
24117
24118 @node TUI Commands
24119 @section TUI-specific Commands
24120 @cindex TUI commands
24121
24122 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
24123 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
24124 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
24125 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
24126
24127 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
24128 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
24129 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
24130 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
24131 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
24132
24133 @table @code
24134 @item info win
24135 @kindex info win
24136 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
24137
24138 @item layout next
24139 @kindex layout
24140 Display the next layout.
24141
24142 @item layout prev
24143 Display the previous layout.
24144
24145 @item layout src
24146 Display the source window only.
24147
24148 @item layout asm
24149 Display the assembly window only.
24150
24151 @item layout split
24152 Display the source and assembly window.
24153
24154 @item layout regs
24155 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
24156
24157 @item focus next
24158 @kindex focus
24159 Make the next window active for scrolling.
24160
24161 @item focus prev
24162 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
24163
24164 @item focus src
24165 Make the source window active for scrolling.
24166
24167 @item focus asm
24168 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
24169
24170 @item focus regs
24171 Make the register window active for scrolling.
24172
24173 @item focus cmd
24174 Make the command window active for scrolling.
24175
24176 @item refresh
24177 @kindex refresh
24178 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
24179
24180 @item tui reg float
24181 @kindex tui reg
24182 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
24183
24184 @item tui reg general
24185 Show the general registers in the register window.
24186
24187 @item tui reg next
24188 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
24189 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
24190 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
24191 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
24192
24193 @item tui reg system
24194 Show the system registers in the register window.
24195
24196 @item update
24197 @kindex update
24198 Update the source window and the current execution point.
24199
24200 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
24201 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
24202 @kindex winheight
24203 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
24204 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
24205 decrease it.
24206
24207 @item tabset @var{nchars}
24208 @kindex tabset
24209 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
24210 @end table
24211
24212 @node TUI Configuration
24213 @section TUI Configuration Variables
24214 @cindex TUI configuration variables
24215
24216 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
24217
24218 @table @code
24219 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
24220 @kindex set tui border-kind
24221 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
24222 The possible values are the following:
24223 @table @code
24224 @item space
24225 Use a space character to draw the border.
24226
24227 @item ascii
24228 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
24229
24230 @item acs
24231 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
24232 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
24233 @end table
24234
24235 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
24236 @kindex set tui border-mode
24237 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
24238 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
24239 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
24240 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
24241 @table @code
24242 @item normal
24243 Use normal attributes to display the border.
24244
24245 @item standout
24246 Use standout mode.
24247
24248 @item reverse
24249 Use reverse video mode.
24250
24251 @item half
24252 Use half bright mode.
24253
24254 @item half-standout
24255 Use half bright and standout mode.
24256
24257 @item bold
24258 Use extra bright or bold mode.
24259
24260 @item bold-standout
24261 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
24262 @end table
24263 @end table
24264
24265 @node Emacs
24266 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
24267
24268 @cindex Emacs
24269 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
24270 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
24271 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
24272 @value{GDBN}.
24273
24274 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
24275 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
24276 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
24277 created Emacs buffer.
24278 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
24279
24280 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
24281 things:
24282
24283 @itemize @bullet
24284 @item
24285 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
24286 the GUD buffer.
24287
24288 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
24289 and output done by the program you are debugging.
24290
24291 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
24292 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
24293 in this way.
24294
24295 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
24296 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
24297 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
24298 stop.
24299
24300 @item
24301 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
24302
24303 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
24304 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
24305 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
24306 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
24307 and the source.
24308
24309 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
24310 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
24311 @end itemize
24312
24313 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
24314 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
24315 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
24316 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
24317
24318 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
24319 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
24320 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
24321 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
24322 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
24323 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
24324 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
24325 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
24326 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
24327
24328 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
24329 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
24330 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
24331 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
24332
24333 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
24334 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
24335 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
24336 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
24337 one you want.
24338
24339 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
24340 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
24341
24342 @table @kbd
24343 @item C-h m
24344 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
24345
24346 @item C-c C-s
24347 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
24348 update the display window to show the current file and location.
24349
24350 @item C-c C-n
24351 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
24352 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
24353 to show the current file and location.
24354
24355 @item C-c C-i
24356 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
24357 display window accordingly.
24358
24359 @item C-c C-f
24360 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
24361 @code{finish} command.
24362
24363 @item C-c C-r
24364 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
24365 command.
24366
24367 @item C-c <
24368 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
24369 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
24370 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
24371
24372 @item C-c >
24373 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
24374 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
24375 @end table
24376
24377 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
24378 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
24379
24380 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
24381 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
24382 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
24383 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
24384 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
24385 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
24386 speedbar displays watch expressions.
24387
24388 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
24389 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
24390 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
24391 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
24392 frame.
24393
24394 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
24395 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
24396 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
24397 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
24398 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
24399 to correspond properly with the code.
24400
24401 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
24402 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
24403 Emacs Manual}).
24404
24405 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
24406 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
24407 @ignore
24408 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
24409 @kindex Epoch
24410 @kindex inspect
24411
24412 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
24413 called the @code{epoch}
24414 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
24415 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
24416 each value is printed in its own window.
24417 @end ignore
24418
24419
24420 @node GDB/MI
24421 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
24422
24423 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
24424
24425 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
24426 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
24427 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
24428 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
24429 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
24430 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
24431
24432 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
24433 in the form of a reference manual.
24434
24435 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
24436 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
24437 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
24438
24439 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
24440
24441 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
24442 This chapter uses the following notation:
24443
24444 @itemize @bullet
24445 @item
24446 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
24447
24448 @item
24449 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
24450 it may or may not be given.
24451
24452 @item
24453 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
24454 may repeat zero or more times.
24455
24456 @item
24457 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
24458 may repeat one or more times.
24459
24460 @item
24461 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
24462 @end itemize
24463
24464 @ignore
24465 @heading Dependencies
24466 @end ignore
24467
24468 @menu
24469 * GDB/MI General Design::
24470 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
24471 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
24472 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
24473 * GDB/MI Output Records::
24474 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
24475 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
24476 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
24477 * GDB/MI Program Context::
24478 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
24479 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
24480 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
24481 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
24482 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
24483 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
24484 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
24485 * GDB/MI File Commands::
24486 @ignore
24487 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
24488 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
24489 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
24490 @end ignore
24491 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
24492 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
24493 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
24494 @end menu
24495
24496 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24497 @node GDB/MI General Design
24498 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
24499 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
24500
24501 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
24502 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
24503 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
24504 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
24505 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
24506 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
24507 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
24508 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
24509 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
24510 a command and reported as part of that command response.
24511
24512 The important examples of notifications are:
24513 @itemize @bullet
24514
24515 @item
24516 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
24517 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
24518 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
24519 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
24520 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
24521 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
24522 command itself was successfully executed.
24523
24524 @item
24525 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
24526 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
24527 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
24528 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
24529 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
24530 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
24531
24532 @item
24533 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
24534 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
24535 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
24536 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
24537 orthogonal frontend design.
24538
24539 @end itemize
24540
24541 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
24542 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
24543 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
24544 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
24545 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
24546 the user interface.
24547
24548
24549 @menu
24550 * Context management::
24551 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
24552 * Thread groups::
24553 @end menu
24554
24555 @node Context management
24556 @subsection Context management
24557
24558 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
24559 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
24560 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
24561 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
24562 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
24563 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
24564 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
24565 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
24566 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
24567
24568 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
24569 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
24570 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
24571 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
24572 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
24573 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
24574 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
24575 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
24576 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
24577 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
24578 for thread and frame to operate on.
24579
24580 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
24581 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
24582 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
24583 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
24584 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
24585 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
24586 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
24587 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
24588 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
24589 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
24590
24591 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
24592 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
24593 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
24594 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
24595 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
24596 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
24597 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
24598 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
24599 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
24600 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
24601 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
24602 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
24603 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
24604 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
24605 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
24606 @samp{--frame} options.
24607
24608 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
24609 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
24610
24611 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
24612 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
24613 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
24614 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
24615 @code{-gdb-set target-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
24616 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
24617 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
24618 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
24619 @code{-list-target-features} command.
24620
24621 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
24622 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
24623 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
24624 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
24625 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
24626 are running.
24627
24628 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
24629 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
24630 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
24631 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
24632 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
24633 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
24634 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
24635 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
24636 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
24637 @samp{--thread} option).
24638
24639 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
24640 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
24641 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
24642 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
24643
24644 @node Thread groups
24645 @subsection Thread groups
24646 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
24647 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
24648 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
24649 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
24650 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
24651
24652 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
24653 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
24654 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
24655 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
24656 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
24657 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
24658 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
24659 into processes.
24660
24661 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
24662 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
24663 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
24664 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
24665 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
24666 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
24667 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
24668 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
24669 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
24670 the members of specific thread group.
24671
24672 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
24673 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
24674 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
24675 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
24676 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
24677 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
24678 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
24679 after attaching to that thread group.
24680
24681 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
24682 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
24683 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
24684 such thread groups.
24685
24686 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24687 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
24688 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
24689
24690 @menu
24691 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
24692 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
24693 @end menu
24694
24695 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
24696 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
24697
24698 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
24699 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
24700 @table @code
24701 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
24702 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
24703
24704 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
24705 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
24706 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
24707
24708 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
24709 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
24710 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
24711
24712 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
24713 "any sequence of digits"
24714
24715 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
24716 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
24717
24718 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
24719 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
24720
24721 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
24722 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
24723
24724 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
24725 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
24726 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
24727
24728 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
24729 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
24730
24731 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
24732 @code{CR | CR-LF}
24733 @end table
24734
24735 @noindent
24736 Notes:
24737
24738 @itemize @bullet
24739 @item
24740 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
24741 output is described below.
24742
24743 @item
24744 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
24745 finishes.
24746
24747 @item
24748 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
24749 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
24750 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
24751 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
24752 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
24753 @end itemize
24754
24755 Pragmatics:
24756
24757 @itemize @bullet
24758 @item
24759 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
24760
24761 @item
24762 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
24763 @end itemize
24764
24765 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
24766 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
24767
24768 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
24769 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
24770 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
24771 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
24772 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
24773 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
24774
24775 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
24776 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
24777 @var{token}.
24778
24779 @table @code
24780 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
24781 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
24782
24783 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
24784 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
24785
24786 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
24787 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
24788
24789 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
24790 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
24791
24792 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
24793 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
24794
24795 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
24796 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
24797
24798 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
24799 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
24800
24801 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
24802 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
24803
24804 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
24805 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
24806
24807 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
24808 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
24809 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
24810
24811 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
24812 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
24813
24814 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
24815 @code{ @var{string} }
24816
24817 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
24818 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
24819
24820 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
24821 @code{@var{c-string}}
24822
24823 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
24824 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
24825
24826 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
24827 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
24828 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
24829
24830 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
24831 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
24832
24833 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
24834 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
24835
24836 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
24837 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
24838
24839 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
24840 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
24841
24842 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
24843 @code{CR | CR-LF}
24844
24845 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
24846 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
24847 @end table
24848
24849 @noindent
24850 Notes:
24851
24852 @itemize @bullet
24853 @item
24854 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
24855
24856 @item
24857 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
24858 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
24859 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
24860 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
24861 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
24862 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
24863 prior command.
24864
24865 @item
24866 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24867 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
24868 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
24869 prefixed by @samp{+}.
24870
24871 @item
24872 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24873 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
24874 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
24875 @samp{*}.
24876
24877 @item
24878 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24879 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
24880 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
24881 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
24882
24883 @item
24884 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24885 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
24886 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
24887 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
24888
24889 @item
24890 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24891 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
24892 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
24893
24894 @item
24895 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24896 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
24897 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
24898 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
24899
24900 @item
24901 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24902 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
24903 @var{values}.
24904
24905
24906 @end itemize
24907
24908 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
24909 details about the various output records.
24910
24911 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24912 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
24913 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
24914
24915 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
24916 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
24917
24918 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
24919 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
24920 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
24921 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
24922 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
24923 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
24924
24925 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
24926 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
24927 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
24928
24929 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24930 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
24931 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
24932 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
24933
24934 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
24935 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
24936
24937 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
24938 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
24939 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
24940 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
24941 might change.
24942
24943 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
24944 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
24945 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
24946 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
24947
24948 @itemize @bullet
24949 @item
24950 New MI commands may be added.
24951
24952 @item
24953 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
24954
24955 @item
24956 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
24957 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
24958
24959 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
24960 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
24961
24962 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
24963 @c resolve inconsistencies.
24964 @end itemize
24965
24966 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
24967 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
24968 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
24969 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
24970 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
24971
24972 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
24973 @c version?
24974
24975 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
24976 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
24977 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
24978 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
24979 @cindex mailing lists
24980
24981 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24982 @node GDB/MI Output Records
24983 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
24984
24985 @menu
24986 * GDB/MI Result Records::
24987 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
24988 * GDB/MI Async Records::
24989 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
24990 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
24991 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
24992 @end menu
24993
24994 @node GDB/MI Result Records
24995 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
24996
24997 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
24998 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
24999 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
25000 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
25001
25002 @table @code
25003 @findex ^done
25004 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
25005 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
25006 values.
25007
25008 @item "^running"
25009 @findex ^running
25010 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
25011 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
25012 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
25013 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
25014 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
25015 which threads are resumed.
25016
25017 @item "^connected"
25018 @findex ^connected
25019 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
25020
25021 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
25022 @findex ^error
25023 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
25024 error message.
25025
25026 @item "^exit"
25027 @findex ^exit
25028 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
25029
25030 @end table
25031
25032 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
25033 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
25034
25035 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
25036 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25037 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
25038 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
25039 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
25040
25041 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
25042 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
25043 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
25044 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
25045 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
25046
25047 @table @code
25048 @item "~" @var{string-output}
25049 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
25050 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
25051
25052 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
25053 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
25054 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
25055 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
25056
25057 @item "&" @var{string-output}
25058 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
25059 internals.
25060 @end table
25061
25062 @node GDB/MI Async Records
25063 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
25064
25065 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25066 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
25067 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
25068 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
25069 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
25070 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
25071
25072 The following is the list of possible async records:
25073
25074 @table @code
25075
25076 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
25077 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
25078 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
25079 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
25080 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
25081 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
25082 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
25083 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
25084 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
25085 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
25086
25087 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
25088 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
25089 following values:
25090
25091 @table @code
25092 @item breakpoint-hit
25093 A breakpoint was reached.
25094 @item watchpoint-trigger
25095 A watchpoint was triggered.
25096 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
25097 A read watchpoint was triggered.
25098 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
25099 An access watchpoint was triggered.
25100 @item function-finished
25101 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25102 @item location-reached
25103 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25104 @item watchpoint-scope
25105 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
25106 @item end-stepping-range
25107 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
25108 similar CLI command was accomplished.
25109 @item exited-signalled
25110 The inferior exited because of a signal.
25111 @item exited
25112 The inferior exited.
25113 @item exited-normally
25114 The inferior exited normally.
25115 @item signal-received
25116 A signal was received by the inferior.
25117 @end table
25118
25119 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
25120 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
25121 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
25122 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
25123 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
25124 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
25125 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
25126 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
25127 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
25128 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
25129 if such information is not available.
25130
25131 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
25132 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
25133 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
25134 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
25135 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
25136 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
25137 cannot be used in any way.
25138
25139 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
25140 A thread group became associated with a running program,
25141 either because the program was just started or the thread group
25142 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
25143 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
25144 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
25145
25146 @itemx =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"
25147 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
25148 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
25149 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
25150 thread group.
25151
25152 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25153 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25154 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
25155 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
25156 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
25157
25158 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
25159 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
25160 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
25161 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
25162 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
25163 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
25164 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
25165
25166 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
25167 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
25168 that thread.
25169
25170 @item =library-loaded,...
25171 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
25172 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
25173 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
25174 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
25175 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
25176 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
25177 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
25178 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
25179 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
25180 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
25181 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
25182 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
25183 thread groups.
25184
25185 @item =library-unloaded,...
25186 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
25187 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
25188 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
25189 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
25190 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
25191 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
25192 thread groups.
25193
25194 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
25195 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
25196 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,bkpt=@{...@}
25197 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
25198 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
25199 user.
25200
25201 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
25202 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}.
25203
25204 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
25205 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
25206
25207 @end table
25208
25209 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
25210 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
25211
25212 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
25213 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
25214 fields:
25215
25216 @table @code
25217 @item level
25218 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
25219 zero. This field is always present.
25220
25221 @item func
25222 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
25223 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
25224
25225 @item addr
25226 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
25227
25228 @item file
25229 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
25230 address. This field may be absent.
25231
25232 @item line
25233 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
25234 may be absent.
25235
25236 @item from
25237 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
25238 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
25239
25240 @end table
25241
25242 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
25243 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
25244
25245 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
25246 uses a tuple with the following fields:
25247
25248 @table @code
25249 @item id
25250 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
25251 always present.
25252
25253 @item target-id
25254 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
25255
25256 @item details
25257 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
25258 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
25259 frontend. This field is optional.
25260
25261 @item state
25262 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
25263 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
25264
25265 @item core
25266 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
25267 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
25268 @end table
25269
25270 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
25271 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
25272
25273 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
25274 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
25275 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
25276 the @code{exception-name} field.
25277
25278 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25279 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
25280 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
25281 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
25282
25283 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
25284 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
25285 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
25286 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
25287
25288 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
25289 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
25290
25291 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
25292
25293 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
25294 information of the breakpoint.
25295
25296 @smallexample
25297 -> -break-insert main
25298 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25299 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
25300 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
25301 <- (gdb)
25302 @end smallexample
25303
25304 @subheading Program Execution
25305
25306 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
25307 reason that execution stopped.
25308
25309 @smallexample
25310 -> -exec-run
25311 <- ^running
25312 <- (gdb)
25313 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
25314 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
25315 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
25316 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
25317 <- (gdb)
25318 -> -exec-continue
25319 <- ^running
25320 <- (gdb)
25321 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
25322 <- (gdb)
25323 @end smallexample
25324
25325 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
25326
25327 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
25328
25329 @smallexample
25330 -> (gdb)
25331 <- -gdb-exit
25332 <- ^exit
25333 @end smallexample
25334
25335 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
25336 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
25337 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
25338 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
25339 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
25340 fails to exit in reasonable time.
25341
25342 @subheading A Bad Command
25343
25344 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
25345
25346 @smallexample
25347 -> -rubbish
25348 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
25349 <- (gdb)
25350 @end smallexample
25351
25352
25353 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25354 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
25355 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
25356
25357 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
25358 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
25359
25360 @subheading Motivation
25361
25362 The motivation for this collection of commands.
25363
25364 @subheading Introduction
25365
25366 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
25367
25368 @subheading Commands
25369
25370 For each command in the block, the following is described:
25371
25372 @subsubheading Synopsis
25373
25374 @smallexample
25375 -command @var{args}@dots{}
25376 @end smallexample
25377
25378 @subsubheading Result
25379
25380 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25381
25382 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
25383
25384 @subsubheading Example
25385
25386 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
25387 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
25388
25389
25390 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25391 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
25392 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
25393
25394 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
25395 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
25396 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
25397 breakpoints.
25398
25399 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
25400 @findex -break-after
25401
25402 @subsubheading Synopsis
25403
25404 @smallexample
25405 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
25406 @end smallexample
25407
25408 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
25409 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
25410 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
25411 @samp{-break-list} command below.
25412
25413 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25414
25415 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
25416
25417 @subsubheading Example
25418
25419 @smallexample
25420 (gdb)
25421 -break-insert main
25422 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25423 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
25424 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
25425 (gdb)
25426 -break-after 1 3
25427 ~
25428 ^done
25429 (gdb)
25430 -break-list
25431 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25432 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25433 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25434 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25435 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25436 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25437 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25438 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25439 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25440 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
25441 (gdb)
25442 @end smallexample
25443
25444 @ignore
25445 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
25446 @findex -break-catch
25447 @end ignore
25448
25449 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
25450 @findex -break-commands
25451
25452 @subsubheading Synopsis
25453
25454 @smallexample
25455 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
25456 @end smallexample
25457
25458 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
25459 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
25460 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
25461 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
25462 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
25463 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
25464
25465 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25466
25467 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
25468
25469 @subsubheading Example
25470
25471 @smallexample
25472 (gdb)
25473 -break-insert main
25474 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25475 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
25476 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
25477 (gdb)
25478 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
25479 ^done
25480 (gdb)
25481 @end smallexample
25482
25483 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
25484 @findex -break-condition
25485
25486 @subsubheading Synopsis
25487
25488 @smallexample
25489 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
25490 @end smallexample
25491
25492 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
25493 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
25494 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
25495 command below).
25496
25497 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25498
25499 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
25500
25501 @subsubheading Example
25502
25503 @smallexample
25504 (gdb)
25505 -break-condition 1 1
25506 ^done
25507 (gdb)
25508 -break-list
25509 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25510 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25511 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25512 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25513 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25514 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25515 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25516 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25517 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25518 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
25519 (gdb)
25520 @end smallexample
25521
25522 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
25523 @findex -break-delete
25524
25525 @subsubheading Synopsis
25526
25527 @smallexample
25528 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25529 @end smallexample
25530
25531 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
25532 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
25533
25534 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25535
25536 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
25537
25538 @subsubheading Example
25539
25540 @smallexample
25541 (gdb)
25542 -break-delete 1
25543 ^done
25544 (gdb)
25545 -break-list
25546 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
25547 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25548 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25549 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25550 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25551 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25552 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25553 body=[]@}
25554 (gdb)
25555 @end smallexample
25556
25557 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
25558 @findex -break-disable
25559
25560 @subsubheading Synopsis
25561
25562 @smallexample
25563 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25564 @end smallexample
25565
25566 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
25567 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
25568
25569 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25570
25571 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
25572
25573 @subsubheading Example
25574
25575 @smallexample
25576 (gdb)
25577 -break-disable 2
25578 ^done
25579 (gdb)
25580 -break-list
25581 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25582 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25583 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25584 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25585 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25586 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25587 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25588 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
25589 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25590 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
25591 (gdb)
25592 @end smallexample
25593
25594 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
25595 @findex -break-enable
25596
25597 @subsubheading Synopsis
25598
25599 @smallexample
25600 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25601 @end smallexample
25602
25603 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
25604
25605 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25606
25607 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
25608
25609 @subsubheading Example
25610
25611 @smallexample
25612 (gdb)
25613 -break-enable 2
25614 ^done
25615 (gdb)
25616 -break-list
25617 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25618 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25619 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25620 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25621 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25622 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25623 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25624 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25625 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25626 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
25627 (gdb)
25628 @end smallexample
25629
25630 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
25631 @findex -break-info
25632
25633 @subsubheading Synopsis
25634
25635 @smallexample
25636 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
25637 @end smallexample
25638
25639 @c REDUNDANT???
25640 Get information about a single breakpoint.
25641
25642 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25643
25644 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
25645
25646 @subsubheading Example
25647 N.A.
25648
25649 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
25650 @findex -break-insert
25651
25652 @subsubheading Synopsis
25653
25654 @smallexample
25655 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
25656 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
25657 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
25658 @end smallexample
25659
25660 @noindent
25661 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
25662
25663 @itemize @bullet
25664 @item function
25665 @c @item +offset
25666 @c @item -offset
25667 @c @item linenum
25668 @item filename:linenum
25669 @item filename:function
25670 @item *address
25671 @end itemize
25672
25673 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
25674
25675 @table @samp
25676 @item -t
25677 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
25678 @item -h
25679 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
25680 @item -c @var{condition}
25681 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
25682 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
25683 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
25684 @item -f
25685 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
25686 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
25687 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
25688 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
25689 cannot be parsed.
25690 @item -d
25691 Create a disabled breakpoint.
25692 @item -a
25693 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
25694 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
25695 @end table
25696
25697 @subsubheading Result
25698
25699 The result is in the form:
25700
25701 @smallexample
25702 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
25703 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
25704 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
25705 times="@var{times}"@}
25706 @end smallexample
25707
25708 @noindent
25709 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
25710 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
25711 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
25712 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
25713 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
25714 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
25715 which use the same output).
25716
25717 Note: this format is open to change.
25718 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
25719
25720 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25721
25722 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
25723 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
25724
25725 @subsubheading Example
25726
25727 @smallexample
25728 (gdb)
25729 -break-insert main
25730 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
25731 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
25732 (gdb)
25733 -break-insert -t foo
25734 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
25735 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
25736 (gdb)
25737 -break-list
25738 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
25739 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25740 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25741 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25742 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25743 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25744 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25745 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25746 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
25747 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
25748 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
25749 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
25750 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
25751 (gdb)
25752 -break-insert -r foo.*
25753 ~int foo(int, int);
25754 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
25755 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
25756 (gdb)
25757 @end smallexample
25758
25759 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
25760 @findex -break-list
25761
25762 @subsubheading Synopsis
25763
25764 @smallexample
25765 -break-list
25766 @end smallexample
25767
25768 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
25769
25770 @table @samp
25771 @item Number
25772 number of the breakpoint
25773 @item Type
25774 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
25775 @item Disposition
25776 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
25777 or @samp{nokeep}
25778 @item Enabled
25779 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
25780 @item Address
25781 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
25782 @item What
25783 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
25784 name, line number
25785 @item Times
25786 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
25787 @end table
25788
25789 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
25790 @code{body} field is an empty list.
25791
25792 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25793
25794 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
25795
25796 @subsubheading Example
25797
25798 @smallexample
25799 (gdb)
25800 -break-list
25801 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
25802 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25803 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25804 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25805 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25806 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25807 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25808 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25809 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
25810 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25811 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25812 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
25813 (gdb)
25814 @end smallexample
25815
25816 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
25817
25818 @smallexample
25819 (gdb)
25820 -break-list
25821 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
25822 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25823 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25824 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25825 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25826 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25827 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25828 body=[]@}
25829 (gdb)
25830 @end smallexample
25831
25832 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
25833 @findex -break-passcount
25834
25835 @subsubheading Synopsis
25836
25837 @smallexample
25838 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
25839 @end smallexample
25840
25841 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
25842 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
25843 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
25844 command @samp{passcount}.
25845
25846 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
25847 @findex -break-watch
25848
25849 @subsubheading Synopsis
25850
25851 @smallexample
25852 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
25853 @end smallexample
25854
25855 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
25856 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
25857 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
25858 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
25859 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
25860 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
25861 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
25862 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
25863
25864 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
25865 breakpoints inserted.
25866
25867 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25868
25869 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
25870 @samp{rwatch}.
25871
25872 @subsubheading Example
25873
25874 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
25875
25876 @smallexample
25877 (gdb)
25878 -break-watch x
25879 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
25880 (gdb)
25881 -exec-continue
25882 ^running
25883 (gdb)
25884 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
25885 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
25886 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
25887 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
25888 (gdb)
25889 @end smallexample
25890
25891 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
25892 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
25893 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
25894
25895 @smallexample
25896 (gdb)
25897 -break-watch C
25898 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
25899 (gdb)
25900 -exec-continue
25901 ^running
25902 (gdb)
25903 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
25904 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
25905 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
25906 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25907 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
25908 (gdb)
25909 -exec-continue
25910 ^running
25911 (gdb)
25912 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
25913 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
25914 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
25915 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25916 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
25917 (gdb)
25918 @end smallexample
25919
25920 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
25921 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
25922 deleted.
25923
25924 @smallexample
25925 (gdb)
25926 -break-watch C
25927 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
25928 (gdb)
25929 -break-list
25930 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
25931 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25932 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25933 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25934 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25935 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25936 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25937 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25938 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
25939 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25940 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
25941 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
25942 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
25943 (gdb)
25944 -exec-continue
25945 ^running
25946 (gdb)
25947 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
25948 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
25949 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
25950 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25951 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
25952 (gdb)
25953 -break-list
25954 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
25955 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25956 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25957 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25958 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25959 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25960 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25961 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25962 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
25963 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25964 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
25965 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
25966 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
25967 (gdb)
25968 -exec-continue
25969 ^running
25970 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
25971 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
25972 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
25973 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25974 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
25975 (gdb)
25976 -break-list
25977 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25978 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25979 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25980 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25981 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25982 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25983 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25984 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25985 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
25986 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25987 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
25988 times="1"@}]@}
25989 (gdb)
25990 @end smallexample
25991
25992 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25993 @node GDB/MI Program Context
25994 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
25995
25996 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
25997 @findex -exec-arguments
25998
25999
26000 @subsubheading Synopsis
26001
26002 @smallexample
26003 -exec-arguments @var{args}
26004 @end smallexample
26005
26006 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
26007 @samp{-exec-run}.
26008
26009 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26010
26011 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
26012
26013 @subsubheading Example
26014
26015 @smallexample
26016 (gdb)
26017 -exec-arguments -v word
26018 ^done
26019 (gdb)
26020 @end smallexample
26021
26022
26023 @ignore
26024 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
26025 @findex -exec-show-arguments
26026
26027 @subsubheading Synopsis
26028
26029 @smallexample
26030 -exec-show-arguments
26031 @end smallexample
26032
26033 Print the arguments of the program.
26034
26035 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26036
26037 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
26038
26039 @subsubheading Example
26040 N.A.
26041 @end ignore
26042
26043
26044 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
26045 @findex -environment-cd
26046
26047 @subsubheading Synopsis
26048
26049 @smallexample
26050 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
26051 @end smallexample
26052
26053 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
26054
26055 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26056
26057 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
26058
26059 @subsubheading Example
26060
26061 @smallexample
26062 (gdb)
26063 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
26064 ^done
26065 (gdb)
26066 @end smallexample
26067
26068
26069 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
26070 @findex -environment-directory
26071
26072 @subsubheading Synopsis
26073
26074 @smallexample
26075 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
26076 @end smallexample
26077
26078 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
26079 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
26080 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
26081 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
26082 occurs as normal.
26083 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
26084 multiple directories in a single command
26085 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
26086 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
26087 If blanks are needed as
26088 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
26089 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
26090 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
26091 character must not be used
26092 in any directory name.
26093 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
26094
26095 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26096
26097 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
26098
26099 @subsubheading Example
26100
26101 @smallexample
26102 (gdb)
26103 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
26104 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
26105 (gdb)
26106 -environment-directory ""
26107 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
26108 (gdb)
26109 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
26110 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
26111 (gdb)
26112 -environment-directory -r
26113 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
26114 (gdb)
26115 @end smallexample
26116
26117
26118 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
26119 @findex -environment-path
26120
26121 @subsubheading Synopsis
26122
26123 @smallexample
26124 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
26125 @end smallexample
26126
26127 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
26128 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
26129 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
26130 supplied in addition to the
26131 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
26132 occurs as normal.
26133 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
26134 multiple directories in a single command
26135 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
26136 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
26137 If blanks are needed as
26138 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
26139 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
26140 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
26141 character must not be used
26142 in any directory name.
26143 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
26144
26145
26146 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26147
26148 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
26149
26150 @subsubheading Example
26151
26152 @smallexample
26153 (gdb)
26154 -environment-path
26155 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
26156 (gdb)
26157 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
26158 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
26159 (gdb)
26160 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
26161 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
26162 (gdb)
26163 @end smallexample
26164
26165
26166 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
26167 @findex -environment-pwd
26168
26169 @subsubheading Synopsis
26170
26171 @smallexample
26172 -environment-pwd
26173 @end smallexample
26174
26175 Show the current working directory.
26176
26177 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26178
26179 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
26180
26181 @subsubheading Example
26182
26183 @smallexample
26184 (gdb)
26185 -environment-pwd
26186 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
26187 (gdb)
26188 @end smallexample
26189
26190 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26191 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
26192 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
26193
26194
26195 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
26196 @findex -thread-info
26197
26198 @subsubheading Synopsis
26199
26200 @smallexample
26201 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
26202 @end smallexample
26203
26204 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
26205 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
26206 threads. When printing information about all threads,
26207 also reports the current thread.
26208
26209 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26210
26211 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
26212 about all threads.
26213
26214 @subsubheading Result
26215
26216 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
26217 defined for a given thread:
26218
26219 @table @samp
26220 @item current
26221 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
26222
26223 @item id
26224 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
26225
26226 @item target-id
26227 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
26228
26229 @item details
26230 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
26231 field is optional.
26232
26233 @item name
26234 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
26235 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
26236 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
26237 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
26238 field is omitted.
26239
26240 @item frame
26241 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
26242
26243 @item state
26244 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
26245 values:
26246
26247 @table @code
26248 @item stopped
26249 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
26250 threads.
26251
26252 @item running
26253 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
26254 threads.
26255
26256 @end table
26257
26258 @item core
26259 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
26260 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
26261
26262 @end table
26263
26264 @subsubheading Example
26265
26266 @smallexample
26267 -thread-info
26268 ^done,threads=[
26269 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
26270 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
26271 args=[]@},state="running"@},
26272 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
26273 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
26274 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
26275 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
26276 state="running"@}],
26277 current-thread-id="1"
26278 (gdb)
26279 @end smallexample
26280
26281 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
26282 @findex -thread-list-ids
26283
26284 @subsubheading Synopsis
26285
26286 @smallexample
26287 -thread-list-ids
26288 @end smallexample
26289
26290 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
26291 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
26292
26293 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
26294 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
26295
26296 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26297
26298 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
26299
26300 @subsubheading Example
26301
26302 @smallexample
26303 (gdb)
26304 -thread-list-ids
26305 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
26306 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
26307 (gdb)
26308 @end smallexample
26309
26310
26311 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
26312 @findex -thread-select
26313
26314 @subsubheading Synopsis
26315
26316 @smallexample
26317 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
26318 @end smallexample
26319
26320 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
26321 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
26322
26323 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
26324 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
26325
26326 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26327
26328 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
26329
26330 @subsubheading Example
26331
26332 @smallexample
26333 (gdb)
26334 -exec-next
26335 ^running
26336 (gdb)
26337 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
26338 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
26339 (gdb)
26340 -thread-list-ids
26341 ^done,
26342 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
26343 number-of-threads="3"
26344 (gdb)
26345 -thread-select 3
26346 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
26347 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
26348 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
26349 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
26350 (gdb)
26351 @end smallexample
26352
26353 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26354 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
26355 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
26356
26357 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
26358 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
26359 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
26360 other cases.
26361
26362 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
26363 @findex -exec-continue
26364
26365 @subsubheading Synopsis
26366
26367 @smallexample
26368 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
26369 @end smallexample
26370
26371 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
26372 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
26373 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
26374 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
26375 @itemize @bullet
26376 @item
26377 breakpoints or watchpoints
26378 @item
26379 signals or exceptions
26380 @item
26381 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
26382 @item
26383 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
26384 @end itemize
26385 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
26386 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
26387 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
26388 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
26389 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
26390 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
26391
26392 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26393
26394 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
26395
26396 @subsubheading Example
26397
26398 @smallexample
26399 -exec-continue
26400 ^running
26401 (gdb)
26402 @@Hello world
26403 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
26404 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
26405 line="13"@}
26406 (gdb)
26407 @end smallexample
26408
26409
26410 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
26411 @findex -exec-finish
26412
26413 @subsubheading Synopsis
26414
26415 @smallexample
26416 -exec-finish [--reverse]
26417 @end smallexample
26418
26419 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
26420 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
26421 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
26422 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
26423 function was called.
26424
26425 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26426
26427 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
26428
26429 @subsubheading Example
26430
26431 Function returning @code{void}.
26432
26433 @smallexample
26434 -exec-finish
26435 ^running
26436 (gdb)
26437 @@hello from foo
26438 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
26439 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
26440 (gdb)
26441 @end smallexample
26442
26443 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
26444 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
26445 value itself.
26446
26447 @smallexample
26448 -exec-finish
26449 ^running
26450 (gdb)
26451 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
26452 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
26453 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26454 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
26455 (gdb)
26456 @end smallexample
26457
26458
26459 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
26460 @findex -exec-interrupt
26461
26462 @subsubheading Synopsis
26463
26464 @smallexample
26465 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
26466 @end smallexample
26467
26468 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
26469 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
26470 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
26471 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
26472 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
26473
26474 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
26475 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
26476 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
26477 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
26478
26479 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
26480 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
26481 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
26482 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
26483
26484 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26485
26486 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
26487
26488 @subsubheading Example
26489
26490 @smallexample
26491 (gdb)
26492 111-exec-continue
26493 111^running
26494
26495 (gdb)
26496 222-exec-interrupt
26497 222^done
26498 (gdb)
26499 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
26500 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
26501 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
26502 (gdb)
26503
26504 (gdb)
26505 -exec-interrupt
26506 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
26507 (gdb)
26508 @end smallexample
26509
26510 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
26511 @findex -exec-jump
26512
26513 @subsubheading Synopsis
26514
26515 @smallexample
26516 -exec-jump @var{location}
26517 @end smallexample
26518
26519 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
26520 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
26521 different forms of @var{location}.
26522
26523 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26524
26525 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
26526
26527 @subsubheading Example
26528
26529 @smallexample
26530 -exec-jump foo.c:10
26531 *running,thread-id="all"
26532 ^running
26533 @end smallexample
26534
26535
26536 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
26537 @findex -exec-next
26538
26539 @subsubheading Synopsis
26540
26541 @smallexample
26542 -exec-next [--reverse]
26543 @end smallexample
26544
26545 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
26546 of the next source line is reached.
26547
26548 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
26549 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
26550 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
26551 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
26552 source line where the function was called.
26553
26554
26555 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26556
26557 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
26558
26559 @subsubheading Example
26560
26561 @smallexample
26562 -exec-next
26563 ^running
26564 (gdb)
26565 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
26566 (gdb)
26567 @end smallexample
26568
26569
26570 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
26571 @findex -exec-next-instruction
26572
26573 @subsubheading Synopsis
26574
26575 @smallexample
26576 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
26577 @end smallexample
26578
26579 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
26580 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
26581 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
26582 printed as well.
26583
26584 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
26585 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
26586 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
26587 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
26588 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
26589
26590 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26591
26592 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
26593
26594 @subsubheading Example
26595
26596 @smallexample
26597 (gdb)
26598 -exec-next-instruction
26599 ^running
26600
26601 (gdb)
26602 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
26603 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
26604 (gdb)
26605 @end smallexample
26606
26607
26608 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
26609 @findex -exec-return
26610
26611 @subsubheading Synopsis
26612
26613 @smallexample
26614 -exec-return
26615 @end smallexample
26616
26617 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
26618 Displays the new current frame.
26619
26620 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26621
26622 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
26623
26624 @subsubheading Example
26625
26626 @smallexample
26627 (gdb)
26628 200-break-insert callee4
26629 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
26630 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
26631 (gdb)
26632 000-exec-run
26633 000^running
26634 (gdb)
26635 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
26636 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26637 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26638 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
26639 (gdb)
26640 205-break-delete
26641 205^done
26642 (gdb)
26643 111-exec-return
26644 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
26645 args=[@{name="strarg",
26646 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26647 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26648 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26649 (gdb)
26650 @end smallexample
26651
26652
26653 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
26654 @findex -exec-run
26655
26656 @subsubheading Synopsis
26657
26658 @smallexample
26659 -exec-run [--all | --thread-group N]
26660 @end smallexample
26661
26662 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
26663 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
26664 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
26665 the program has exited exceptionally.
26666
26667 When no option is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
26668 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
26669 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
26670 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
26671
26672 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26673
26674 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
26675
26676 @subsubheading Examples
26677
26678 @smallexample
26679 (gdb)
26680 -break-insert main
26681 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
26682 (gdb)
26683 -exec-run
26684 ^running
26685 (gdb)
26686 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
26687 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
26688 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
26689 (gdb)
26690 @end smallexample
26691
26692 @noindent
26693 Program exited normally:
26694
26695 @smallexample
26696 (gdb)
26697 -exec-run
26698 ^running
26699 (gdb)
26700 x = 55
26701 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26702 (gdb)
26703 @end smallexample
26704
26705 @noindent
26706 Program exited exceptionally:
26707
26708 @smallexample
26709 (gdb)
26710 -exec-run
26711 ^running
26712 (gdb)
26713 x = 55
26714 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
26715 (gdb)
26716 @end smallexample
26717
26718 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
26719 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
26720
26721 @smallexample
26722 (gdb)
26723 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
26724 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
26725 @end smallexample
26726
26727
26728 @c @subheading -exec-signal
26729
26730
26731 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
26732 @findex -exec-step
26733
26734 @subsubheading Synopsis
26735
26736 @smallexample
26737 -exec-step [--reverse]
26738 @end smallexample
26739
26740 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
26741 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
26742 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
26743 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
26744 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
26745 previously executed source line.
26746
26747 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26748
26749 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
26750
26751 @subsubheading Example
26752
26753 Stepping into a function:
26754
26755 @smallexample
26756 -exec-step
26757 ^running
26758 (gdb)
26759 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
26760 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
26761 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
26762 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
26763 (gdb)
26764 @end smallexample
26765
26766 Regular stepping:
26767
26768 @smallexample
26769 -exec-step
26770 ^running
26771 (gdb)
26772 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
26773 (gdb)
26774 @end smallexample
26775
26776
26777 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
26778 @findex -exec-step-instruction
26779
26780 @subsubheading Synopsis
26781
26782 @smallexample
26783 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
26784 @end smallexample
26785
26786 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
26787 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
26788 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
26789 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
26790 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
26791 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
26792 as well.
26793
26794 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26795
26796 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
26797
26798 @subsubheading Example
26799
26800 @smallexample
26801 (gdb)
26802 -exec-step-instruction
26803 ^running
26804
26805 (gdb)
26806 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
26807 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
26808 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
26809 (gdb)
26810 -exec-step-instruction
26811 ^running
26812
26813 (gdb)
26814 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
26815 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
26816 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
26817 (gdb)
26818 @end smallexample
26819
26820
26821 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
26822 @findex -exec-until
26823
26824 @subsubheading Synopsis
26825
26826 @smallexample
26827 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
26828 @end smallexample
26829
26830 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
26831 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
26832 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
26833 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
26834
26835 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26836
26837 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
26838
26839 @subsubheading Example
26840
26841 @smallexample
26842 (gdb)
26843 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
26844 ^running
26845 (gdb)
26846 x = 55
26847 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
26848 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
26849 (gdb)
26850 @end smallexample
26851
26852 @ignore
26853 @subheading -file-clear
26854 Is this going away????
26855 @end ignore
26856
26857 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26858 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
26859 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
26860
26861
26862 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
26863 @findex -stack-info-frame
26864
26865 @subsubheading Synopsis
26866
26867 @smallexample
26868 -stack-info-frame
26869 @end smallexample
26870
26871 Get info on the selected frame.
26872
26873 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26874
26875 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
26876 (without arguments).
26877
26878 @subsubheading Example
26879
26880 @smallexample
26881 (gdb)
26882 -stack-info-frame
26883 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
26884 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26885 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
26886 (gdb)
26887 @end smallexample
26888
26889 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
26890 @findex -stack-info-depth
26891
26892 @subsubheading Synopsis
26893
26894 @smallexample
26895 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
26896 @end smallexample
26897
26898 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
26899 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
26900
26901 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26902
26903 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
26904
26905 @subsubheading Example
26906
26907 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
26908
26909 @smallexample
26910 (gdb)
26911 -stack-info-depth
26912 ^done,depth="12"
26913 (gdb)
26914 -stack-info-depth 4
26915 ^done,depth="4"
26916 (gdb)
26917 -stack-info-depth 12
26918 ^done,depth="12"
26919 (gdb)
26920 -stack-info-depth 11
26921 ^done,depth="11"
26922 (gdb)
26923 -stack-info-depth 13
26924 ^done,depth="12"
26925 (gdb)
26926 @end smallexample
26927
26928 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
26929 @findex -stack-list-arguments
26930
26931 @subsubheading Synopsis
26932
26933 @smallexample
26934 -stack-list-arguments @var{print-values}
26935 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
26936 @end smallexample
26937
26938 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
26939 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
26940 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
26941 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
26942 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
26943 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
26944 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
26945 which case only existing frames will be returned.
26946
26947 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
26948 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
26949 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
26950 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
26951 structures and unions.
26952
26953 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
26954 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
26955
26956 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26957
26958 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
26959 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
26960 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
26961
26962 @subsubheading Example
26963
26964 @smallexample
26965 (gdb)
26966 -stack-list-frames
26967 ^done,
26968 stack=[
26969 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26970 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26971 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
26972 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
26973 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26974 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
26975 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
26976 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26977 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
26978 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
26979 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26980 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
26981 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
26982 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26983 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
26984 (gdb)
26985 -stack-list-arguments 0
26986 ^done,
26987 stack-args=[
26988 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
26989 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
26990 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
26991 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
26992 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
26993 (gdb)
26994 -stack-list-arguments 1
26995 ^done,
26996 stack-args=[
26997 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
26998 frame=@{level="1",
26999 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
27000 frame=@{level="2",args=[
27001 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27002 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
27003 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
27004 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27005 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
27006 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
27007 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
27008 (gdb)
27009 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
27010 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
27011 (gdb)
27012 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
27013 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
27014 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27015 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
27016 (gdb)
27017 @end smallexample
27018
27019 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
27020
27021
27022 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
27023 @findex -stack-list-frames
27024
27025 @subsubheading Synopsis
27026
27027 @smallexample
27028 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
27029 @end smallexample
27030
27031 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
27032 following info:
27033
27034 @table @samp
27035 @item @var{level}
27036 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
27037 @item @var{addr}
27038 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
27039 @item @var{func}
27040 Function name.
27041 @item @var{file}
27042 File name of the source file where the function lives.
27043 @item @var{fullname}
27044 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
27045 @item @var{line}
27046 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
27047 @item @var{from}
27048 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
27049 if the frame's function is not known.
27050 @end table
27051
27052 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
27053 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
27054 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
27055 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
27056 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
27057 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
27058 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
27059
27060 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27061
27062 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
27063
27064 @subsubheading Example
27065
27066 Full stack backtrace:
27067
27068 @smallexample
27069 (gdb)
27070 -stack-list-frames
27071 ^done,stack=
27072 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
27073 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
27074 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27075 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27076 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27077 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27078 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27079 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27080 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27081 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27082 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27083 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27084 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27085 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27086 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27087 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27088 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27089 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27090 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27091 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27092 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27093 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27094 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
27095 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
27096 (gdb)
27097 @end smallexample
27098
27099 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
27100
27101 @smallexample
27102 (gdb)
27103 -stack-list-frames 3 5
27104 ^done,stack=
27105 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27106 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27107 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27108 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27109 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27110 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
27111 (gdb)
27112 @end smallexample
27113
27114 Show a single frame:
27115
27116 @smallexample
27117 (gdb)
27118 -stack-list-frames 3 3
27119 ^done,stack=
27120 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27121 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
27122 (gdb)
27123 @end smallexample
27124
27125
27126 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
27127 @findex -stack-list-locals
27128
27129 @subsubheading Synopsis
27130
27131 @smallexample
27132 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
27133 @end smallexample
27134
27135 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
27136 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27137 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27138 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27139 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27140 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
27141 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
27142 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
27143 more detail.
27144
27145 This command is deprecated in favor of the
27146 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
27147
27148 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27149
27150 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
27151
27152 @subsubheading Example
27153
27154 @smallexample
27155 (gdb)
27156 -stack-list-locals 0
27157 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
27158 (gdb)
27159 -stack-list-locals --all-values
27160 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
27161 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
27162 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
27163 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
27164 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
27165 (gdb)
27166 @end smallexample
27167
27168 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
27169 @findex -stack-list-variables
27170
27171 @subsubheading Synopsis
27172
27173 @smallexample
27174 -stack-list-variables @var{print-values}
27175 @end smallexample
27176
27177 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
27178 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27179 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27180 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27181 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27182 structures and unions.
27183
27184 @subsubheading Example
27185
27186 @smallexample
27187 (gdb)
27188 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
27189 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
27190 (gdb)
27191 @end smallexample
27192
27193
27194 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
27195 @findex -stack-select-frame
27196
27197 @subsubheading Synopsis
27198
27199 @smallexample
27200 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
27201 @end smallexample
27202
27203 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
27204 the stack.
27205
27206 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
27207 option to every command.
27208
27209 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27210
27211 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
27212 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
27213
27214 @subsubheading Example
27215
27216 @smallexample
27217 (gdb)
27218 -stack-select-frame 2
27219 ^done
27220 (gdb)
27221 @end smallexample
27222
27223 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27224 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
27225 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
27226
27227 @ignore
27228
27229 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
27230
27231 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
27232 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
27233 used by @code{Insight}.
27234
27235 The two main reasons for that are:
27236
27237 @enumerate 1
27238 @item
27239 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
27240
27241 @item
27242 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
27243 now).
27244 @end enumerate
27245
27246 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
27247 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
27248 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
27249 hints about their use.
27250
27251 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
27252 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
27253 least, the following operations:
27254
27255 @itemize @bullet
27256 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
27257 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
27258 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
27259 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
27260 @end itemize
27261
27262 @end ignore
27263
27264 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
27265
27266 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
27267
27268 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
27269 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
27270 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
27271 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
27272 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
27273 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
27274 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
27275 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
27276 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
27277 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
27278 object, or to change display format.
27279
27280 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
27281 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
27282 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
27283 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
27284 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
27285 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
27286 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
27287 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
27288 child will be created.
27289
27290 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
27291 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
27292 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
27293 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
27294 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
27295
27296 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
27297 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
27298 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
27299 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
27300 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
27301 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
27302 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
27303 variables that frontend has created.
27304
27305 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
27306 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
27307 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
27308 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
27309 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
27310 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
27311 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
27312 implicitly updated.
27313
27314 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
27315 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
27316 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
27317 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
27318 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
27319 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
27320 frame. Consider this example:
27321
27322 @smallexample
27323 void do_work(...)
27324 @{
27325 struct work_state state;
27326
27327 if (...)
27328 do_work(...);
27329 @}
27330 @end smallexample
27331
27332 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
27333 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
27334 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
27335 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
27336 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
27337
27338 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
27339 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
27340 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
27341 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
27342 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
27343 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
27344
27345 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
27346 access this functionality:
27347
27348 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
27349 @item @strong{Operation}
27350 @tab @strong{Description}
27351
27352 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
27353 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
27354 @item @code{-var-create}
27355 @tab create a variable object
27356 @item @code{-var-delete}
27357 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
27358 @item @code{-var-set-format}
27359 @tab set the display format of this variable
27360 @item @code{-var-show-format}
27361 @tab show the display format of this variable
27362 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
27363 @tab tells how many children this object has
27364 @item @code{-var-list-children}
27365 @tab return a list of the object's children
27366 @item @code{-var-info-type}
27367 @tab show the type of this variable object
27368 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
27369 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
27370 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
27371 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
27372 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
27373 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
27374 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
27375 @tab get the value of this variable
27376 @item @code{-var-assign}
27377 @tab set the value of this variable
27378 @item @code{-var-update}
27379 @tab update the variable and its children
27380 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
27381 @tab set frozeness attribute
27382 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
27383 @tab set range of children to display on update
27384 @end multitable
27385
27386 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
27387 how it can be used.
27388
27389 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
27390
27391 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
27392 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
27393
27394 @smallexample
27395 -enable-pretty-printing
27396 @end smallexample
27397
27398 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
27399 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
27400 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
27401 request that this functionality be enabled.
27402
27403 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
27404
27405 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
27406 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
27407
27408 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
27409 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
27410
27411 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
27412 @findex -var-create
27413
27414 @subsubheading Synopsis
27415
27416 @smallexample
27417 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
27418 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
27419 @end smallexample
27420
27421 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
27422 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
27423 register.
27424
27425 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
27426 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
27427 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
27428 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
27429 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
27430
27431 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
27432 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
27433 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
27434 object must be created.
27435
27436 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
27437 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
27438
27439 @itemize @bullet
27440 @item
27441 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
27442
27443 @item
27444 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
27445
27446 @item
27447 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
27448 @end itemize
27449
27450 @cindex dynamic varobj
27451 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
27452 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
27453 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
27454 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
27455 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
27456 compatibility for existing clients.
27457
27458 @subsubheading Result
27459
27460 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
27461 are:
27462
27463 @table @samp
27464 @item name
27465 The name of the varobj.
27466
27467 @item numchild
27468 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
27469 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
27470 @samp{has_more} attribute.
27471
27472 @item value
27473 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
27474 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
27475 will not be interesting.
27476
27477 @item type
27478 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
27479 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI.
27480
27481 @item thread-id
27482 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
27483 thread's identifier.
27484
27485 @item has_more
27486 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
27487 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
27488
27489 @item dynamic
27490 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
27491 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
27492 then this attribute will not be present.
27493
27494 @item displayhint
27495 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
27496 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
27497 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
27498 @end table
27499
27500 Typical output will look like this:
27501
27502 @smallexample
27503 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
27504 has_more="@var{has_more}"
27505 @end smallexample
27506
27507
27508 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
27509 @findex -var-delete
27510
27511 @subsubheading Synopsis
27512
27513 @smallexample
27514 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
27515 @end smallexample
27516
27517 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
27518 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
27519
27520 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
27521
27522
27523 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
27524 @findex -var-set-format
27525
27526 @subsubheading Synopsis
27527
27528 @smallexample
27529 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
27530 @end smallexample
27531
27532 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
27533 @var{format-spec}.
27534
27535 @anchor{-var-set-format}
27536 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
27537
27538 @smallexample
27539 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
27540 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
27541 @end smallexample
27542
27543 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
27544 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
27545 for pointers, etc.).
27546
27547 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
27548 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
27549
27550 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
27551 @findex -var-show-format
27552
27553 @subsubheading Synopsis
27554
27555 @smallexample
27556 -var-show-format @var{name}
27557 @end smallexample
27558
27559 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
27560
27561 @smallexample
27562 @var{format} @expansion{}
27563 @var{format-spec}
27564 @end smallexample
27565
27566
27567 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
27568 @findex -var-info-num-children
27569
27570 @subsubheading Synopsis
27571
27572 @smallexample
27573 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
27574 @end smallexample
27575
27576 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
27577
27578 @smallexample
27579 numchild=@var{n}
27580 @end smallexample
27581
27582 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
27583 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
27584 be available.
27585
27586
27587 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
27588 @findex -var-list-children
27589
27590 @subsubheading Synopsis
27591
27592 @smallexample
27593 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
27594 @end smallexample
27595 @anchor{-var-list-children}
27596
27597 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
27598 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
27599 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
27600 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
27601 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
27602 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
27603 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
27604 and unions.
27605
27606 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
27607 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
27608 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
27609 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
27610 reported.
27611
27612 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
27613 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
27614 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
27615 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
27616 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
27617 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
27618 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
27619 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
27620 the visible items.
27621
27622 For each child the following results are returned:
27623
27624 @table @var
27625
27626 @item name
27627 Name of the variable object created for this child.
27628
27629 @item exp
27630 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
27631 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
27632
27633 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
27634 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
27635
27636 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
27637 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
27638 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
27639 type and value are not present.
27640
27641 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
27642 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
27643 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
27644
27645 @item numchild
27646 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
27647 0.
27648
27649 @item type
27650 The type of the child.
27651
27652 @item value
27653 If values were requested, this is the value.
27654
27655 @item thread-id
27656 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
27657 Otherwise this result is not present.
27658
27659 @item frozen
27660 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
27661 @end table
27662
27663 The result may have its own attributes:
27664
27665 @table @samp
27666 @item displayhint
27667 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
27668 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
27669 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
27670
27671 @item has_more
27672 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
27673 remaining after the end of the selected range.
27674 @end table
27675
27676 @subsubheading Example
27677
27678 @smallexample
27679 (gdb)
27680 -var-list-children n
27681 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
27682 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
27683 (gdb)
27684 -var-list-children --all-values n
27685 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
27686 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
27687 @end smallexample
27688
27689
27690 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
27691 @findex -var-info-type
27692
27693 @subsubheading Synopsis
27694
27695 @smallexample
27696 -var-info-type @var{name}
27697 @end smallexample
27698
27699 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
27700 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
27701 @value{GDBN} CLI:
27702
27703 @smallexample
27704 type=@var{typename}
27705 @end smallexample
27706
27707
27708 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
27709 @findex -var-info-expression
27710
27711 @subsubheading Synopsis
27712
27713 @smallexample
27714 -var-info-expression @var{name}
27715 @end smallexample
27716
27717 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
27718 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
27719 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
27720
27721 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
27722 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
27723
27724 @smallexample
27725 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
27726 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
27727 @end smallexample
27728
27729 @noindent
27730 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
27731
27732 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
27733 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
27734 is of limited use.
27735
27736 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
27737 @findex -var-info-path-expression
27738
27739 @subsubheading Synopsis
27740
27741 @smallexample
27742 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
27743 @end smallexample
27744
27745 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
27746 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
27747 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
27748 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
27749 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
27750 watchpoint from a variable object.
27751
27752 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
27753 and will give an error when invoked on one.
27754
27755 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
27756 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
27757 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
27758 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
27759 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
27760 @smallexample
27761 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
27762 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
27763 @end smallexample
27764
27765 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
27766 @findex -var-show-attributes
27767
27768 @subsubheading Synopsis
27769
27770 @smallexample
27771 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
27772 @end smallexample
27773
27774 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
27775
27776 @smallexample
27777 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
27778 @end smallexample
27779
27780 @noindent
27781 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
27782
27783 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
27784 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
27785
27786 @subsubheading Synopsis
27787
27788 @smallexample
27789 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
27790 @end smallexample
27791
27792 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
27793 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
27794 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
27795 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
27796 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
27797 the current display format will be used. The current display format
27798 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
27799
27800 @smallexample
27801 value=@var{value}
27802 @end smallexample
27803
27804 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
27805 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
27806
27807 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
27808 @findex -var-assign
27809
27810 @subsubheading Synopsis
27811
27812 @smallexample
27813 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
27814 @end smallexample
27815
27816 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
27817 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
27818 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
27819 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
27820
27821 @subsubheading Example
27822
27823 @smallexample
27824 (gdb)
27825 -var-assign var1 3
27826 ^done,value="3"
27827 (gdb)
27828 -var-update *
27829 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
27830 (gdb)
27831 @end smallexample
27832
27833 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
27834 @findex -var-update
27835
27836 @subsubheading Synopsis
27837
27838 @smallexample
27839 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
27840 @end smallexample
27841
27842 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
27843 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
27844 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
27845 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
27846 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
27847 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
27848 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
27849 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
27850 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
27851 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
27852 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
27853 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
27854 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
27855
27856 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
27857 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
27858 diagnostic.
27859
27860 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
27861 only the selected range of children will be reported.
27862
27863 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
27864 @samp{changelist}.
27865
27866 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
27867
27868 @table @samp
27869 @item name
27870 The name of the varobj.
27871
27872 @item value
27873 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
27874 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
27875
27876 @item in_scope
27877 @anchor{-var-update}
27878 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
27879
27880 @table @code
27881 @item "true"
27882 The variable object's current value is valid.
27883
27884 @item "false"
27885 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
27886 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
27887 scope.
27888
27889 @item "invalid"
27890 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
27891 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
27892 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
27893 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
27894 objects.
27895 @end table
27896
27897 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
27898 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
27899
27900 @item type_changed
27901 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
27902 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
27903 be @samp{false}.
27904
27905 @item new_type
27906 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
27907 hold the new type.
27908
27909 @item new_num_children
27910 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
27911 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
27912
27913 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
27914 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
27915 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
27916 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
27917 children which may be available.
27918
27919 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
27920 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
27921 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
27922 only happen at the end of the update range).
27923
27924 @item displayhint
27925 The display hint, if any.
27926
27927 @item has_more
27928 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
27929 available outside the varobj's update range.
27930
27931 @item dynamic
27932 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
27933 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
27934 then this attribute will not be present.
27935
27936 @item new_children
27937 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
27938 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
27939 be listed in this attribute.
27940 @end table
27941
27942 @subsubheading Example
27943
27944 @smallexample
27945 (gdb)
27946 -var-assign var1 3
27947 ^done,value="3"
27948 (gdb)
27949 -var-update --all-values var1
27950 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
27951 type_changed="false"@}]
27952 (gdb)
27953 @end smallexample
27954
27955 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
27956 @findex -var-set-frozen
27957 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
27958
27959 @subsubheading Synopsis
27960
27961 @smallexample
27962 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
27963 @end smallexample
27964
27965 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
27966 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
27967 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
27968 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
27969 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
27970 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
27971 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
27972 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
27973 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
27974 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
27975 @code{-var-update} does.
27976
27977 @subsubheading Example
27978
27979 @smallexample
27980 (gdb)
27981 -var-set-frozen V 1
27982 ^done
27983 (gdb)
27984 @end smallexample
27985
27986 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
27987 @findex -var-set-update-range
27988 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
27989
27990 @subsubheading Synopsis
27991
27992 @smallexample
27993 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
27994 @end smallexample
27995
27996 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
27997 @code{-var-update}.
27998
27999 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
28000 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
28001 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
28002 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
28003
28004 @subsubheading Example
28005
28006 @smallexample
28007 (gdb)
28008 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
28009 ^done
28010 @end smallexample
28011
28012 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
28013 @findex -var-set-visualizer
28014 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
28015
28016 @subsubheading Synopsis
28017
28018 @smallexample
28019 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
28020 @end smallexample
28021
28022 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
28023
28024 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
28025 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
28026
28027 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
28028 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
28029 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
28030 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
28031 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
28032 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
28033 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
28034
28035 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
28036 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
28037 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
28038 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
28039
28040 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
28041 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands})
28042 can be used to check this.
28043
28044 @subsubheading Example
28045
28046 Resetting the visualizer:
28047
28048 @smallexample
28049 (gdb)
28050 -var-set-visualizer V None
28051 ^done
28052 @end smallexample
28053
28054 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
28055
28056 @smallexample
28057 (gdb)
28058 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
28059 ^done
28060 @end smallexample
28061
28062 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
28063 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
28064
28065 @smallexample
28066 (gdb)
28067 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
28068 ^done
28069 @end smallexample
28070
28071 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28072 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
28073 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
28074
28075 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
28076 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
28077 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
28078 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
28079
28080 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
28081 @c @subheading -data-assign
28082 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
28083 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
28084 @c set variable
28085 @c @subsubheading Example
28086 @c N.A.
28087
28088 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
28089 @findex -data-disassemble
28090
28091 @subsubheading Synopsis
28092
28093 @smallexample
28094 -data-disassemble
28095 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
28096 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
28097 -- @var{mode}
28098 @end smallexample
28099
28100 @noindent
28101 Where:
28102
28103 @table @samp
28104 @item @var{start-addr}
28105 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
28106 @item @var{end-addr}
28107 is the end address
28108 @item @var{filename}
28109 is the name of the file to disassemble
28110 @item @var{linenum}
28111 is the line number to disassemble around
28112 @item @var{lines}
28113 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
28114 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
28115 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
28116 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
28117 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
28118 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
28119 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
28120 are displayed.
28121 @item @var{mode}
28122 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly), 1 (meaning mixed source and
28123 disassembly), 2 (meaning disassembly with raw opcodes), or 3 (meaning
28124 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes).
28125 @end table
28126
28127 @subsubheading Result
28128
28129 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
28130
28131 @itemize @bullet
28132 @item Address
28133 @item Func-name
28134 @item Offset
28135 @item Instruction
28136 @end itemize
28137
28138 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
28139 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
28140
28141 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28142
28143 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
28144
28145 @subsubheading Example
28146
28147 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
28148
28149 @smallexample
28150 (gdb)
28151 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
28152 ^done,
28153 asm_insns=[
28154 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
28155 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
28156 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
28157 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
28158 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
28159 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
28160 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
28161 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
28162 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
28163 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
28164 (gdb)
28165 @end smallexample
28166
28167 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
28168 @code{main}.
28169
28170 @smallexample
28171 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
28172 ^done,asm_insns=[
28173 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
28174 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
28175 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
28176 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
28177 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
28178 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
28179 [@dots{}]
28180 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
28181 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
28182 (gdb)
28183 @end smallexample
28184
28185 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
28186
28187 @smallexample
28188 (gdb)
28189 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
28190 ^done,asm_insns=[
28191 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
28192 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
28193 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
28194 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
28195 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
28196 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
28197 (gdb)
28198 @end smallexample
28199
28200 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
28201
28202 @smallexample
28203 (gdb)
28204 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
28205 ^done,asm_insns=[
28206 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
28207 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
28208 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
28209 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
28210 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
28211 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
28212 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
28213 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
28214 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
28215 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
28216 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
28217 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
28218 (gdb)
28219 @end smallexample
28220
28221
28222 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
28223 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
28224
28225 @subsubheading Synopsis
28226
28227 @smallexample
28228 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
28229 @end smallexample
28230
28231 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
28232 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
28233 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
28234
28235 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28236
28237 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
28238 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
28239 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
28240
28241 @subsubheading Example
28242
28243 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
28244 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
28245 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
28246 output.
28247
28248 @smallexample
28249 211-data-evaluate-expression A
28250 211^done,value="1"
28251 (gdb)
28252 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
28253 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
28254 (gdb)
28255 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
28256 411^done,value="4"
28257 (gdb)
28258 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
28259 511^done,value="4"
28260 (gdb)
28261 @end smallexample
28262
28263
28264 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
28265 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
28266
28267 @subsubheading Synopsis
28268
28269 @smallexample
28270 -data-list-changed-registers
28271 @end smallexample
28272
28273 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
28274
28275 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28276
28277 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
28278 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
28279
28280 @subsubheading Example
28281
28282 On a PPC MBX board:
28283
28284 @smallexample
28285 (gdb)
28286 -exec-continue
28287 ^running
28288
28289 (gdb)
28290 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
28291 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
28292 line="5"@}
28293 (gdb)
28294 -data-list-changed-registers
28295 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
28296 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
28297 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
28298 (gdb)
28299 @end smallexample
28300
28301
28302 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
28303 @findex -data-list-register-names
28304
28305 @subsubheading Synopsis
28306
28307 @smallexample
28308 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
28309 @end smallexample
28310
28311 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
28312 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
28313 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
28314 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
28315 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
28316 include empty register names.
28317
28318 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28319
28320 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
28321 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
28322 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
28323
28324 @subsubheading Example
28325
28326 For the PPC MBX board:
28327 @smallexample
28328 (gdb)
28329 -data-list-register-names
28330 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
28331 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
28332 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
28333 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
28334 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
28335 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
28336 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
28337 (gdb)
28338 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
28339 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
28340 (gdb)
28341 @end smallexample
28342
28343 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
28344 @findex -data-list-register-values
28345
28346 @subsubheading Synopsis
28347
28348 @smallexample
28349 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
28350 @end smallexample
28351
28352 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
28353 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
28354 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
28355 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
28356
28357 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
28358
28359 @table @code
28360 @item x
28361 Hexadecimal
28362 @item o
28363 Octal
28364 @item t
28365 Binary
28366 @item d
28367 Decimal
28368 @item r
28369 Raw
28370 @item N
28371 Natural
28372 @end table
28373
28374 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28375
28376 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
28377 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
28378
28379 @subsubheading Example
28380
28381 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
28382 don't appear in the actual output):
28383
28384 @smallexample
28385 (gdb)
28386 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
28387 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
28388 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
28389 (gdb)
28390 -data-list-register-values x
28391 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
28392 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
28393 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
28394 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
28395 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
28396 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
28397 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
28398 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
28399 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
28400 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
28401 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
28402 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
28403 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
28404 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
28405 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
28406 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
28407 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
28408 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
28409 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
28410 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
28411 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
28412 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
28413 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
28414 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
28415 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
28416 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
28417 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
28418 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
28419 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
28420 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
28421 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
28422 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
28423 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
28424 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
28425 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
28426 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
28427 (gdb)
28428 @end smallexample
28429
28430
28431 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
28432 @findex -data-read-memory
28433
28434 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
28435
28436 @subsubheading Synopsis
28437
28438 @smallexample
28439 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
28440 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
28441 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
28442 @end smallexample
28443
28444 @noindent
28445 where:
28446
28447 @table @samp
28448 @item @var{address}
28449 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
28450 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
28451 quoted using the C convention.
28452
28453 @item @var{word-format}
28454 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
28455 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
28456 ,Output Formats}).
28457
28458 @item @var{word-size}
28459 The size of each memory word in bytes.
28460
28461 @item @var{nr-rows}
28462 The number of rows in the output table.
28463
28464 @item @var{nr-cols}
28465 The number of columns in the output table.
28466
28467 @item @var{aschar}
28468 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
28469 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
28470 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
28471 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
28472
28473 @item @var{byte-offset}
28474 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
28475 @end table
28476
28477 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
28478 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
28479 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
28480 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
28481 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
28482 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
28483 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
28484 @samp{addr}.
28485
28486 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
28487 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
28488 @samp{prev-page}.
28489
28490 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28491
28492 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
28493 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
28494
28495 @subsubheading Example
28496
28497 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
28498 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
28499 word. Display each word in hex.
28500
28501 @smallexample
28502 (gdb)
28503 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
28504 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
28505 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
28506 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
28507 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
28508 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
28509 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
28510 (gdb)
28511 @end smallexample
28512
28513 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
28514 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
28515
28516 @smallexample
28517 (gdb)
28518 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
28519 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
28520 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
28521 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
28522 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
28523 (gdb)
28524 @end smallexample
28525
28526 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
28527 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
28528 used as the non-printable character.
28529
28530 @smallexample
28531 (gdb)
28532 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
28533 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
28534 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
28535 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
28536 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
28537 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
28538 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
28539 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
28540 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
28541 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
28542 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
28543 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
28544 (gdb)
28545 @end smallexample
28546
28547 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
28548 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
28549
28550 @subsubheading Synopsis
28551
28552 @smallexample
28553 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
28554 @var{address} @var{count}
28555 @end smallexample
28556
28557 @noindent
28558 where:
28559
28560 @table @samp
28561 @item @var{address}
28562 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
28563 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
28564 quoted using the C convention.
28565
28566 @item @var{count}
28567 The number of bytes to read. This should be an integer literal.
28568
28569 @item @var{byte-offset}
28570 The offsets in bytes relative to @var{address} at which to start
28571 reading. This should be an integer literal. This option is provided
28572 so that a frontend is not required to first evaluate address and then
28573 perform address arithmetics itself.
28574
28575 @end table
28576
28577 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
28578 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
28579 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
28580 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
28581 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
28582 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
28583
28584 In general, every single byte in the region may be readable or not,
28585 and the only way to read every readable byte is to try a read at
28586 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
28587 attempt to read all accessible bytes at either beginning or the end
28588 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
28589 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
28590 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
28591 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
28592
28593 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
28594 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
28595 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
28596 and has the following fields:
28597
28598 @table @code
28599 @item begin
28600 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
28601
28602 @item end
28603 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
28604
28605 @item offset
28606 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
28607 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
28608
28609 @item contents
28610 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
28611
28612 @end table
28613
28614
28615
28616 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28617
28618 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
28619
28620 @subsubheading Example
28621
28622 @smallexample
28623 (gdb)
28624 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
28625 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
28626 end="0xbffff15e",
28627 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
28628 (gdb)
28629 @end smallexample
28630
28631
28632 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
28633 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
28634
28635 @subsubheading Synopsis
28636
28637 @smallexample
28638 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
28639 @end smallexample
28640
28641 @noindent
28642 where:
28643
28644 @table @samp
28645 @item @var{address}
28646 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
28647 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
28648 quoted using the C convention.
28649
28650 @item @var{contents}
28651 The hex-encoded bytes to write.
28652
28653 @end table
28654
28655 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28656
28657 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
28658
28659 @subsubheading Example
28660
28661 @smallexample
28662 (gdb)
28663 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
28664 ^done
28665 (gdb)
28666 @end smallexample
28667
28668
28669 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28670 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
28671 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
28672
28673 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
28674 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
28675
28676 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
28677 @findex -trace-find
28678
28679 @subsubheading Synopsis
28680
28681 @smallexample
28682 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
28683 @end smallexample
28684
28685 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
28686 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
28687 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
28688
28689 @table @samp
28690
28691 @item none
28692 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
28693
28694 @item frame-number
28695 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
28696 that index.
28697
28698 @item tracepoint-number
28699 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
28700 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
28701
28702 @item pc
28703 An address is required as parameter. Finds
28704 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
28705 address.
28706
28707 @item pc-inside-range
28708 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
28709 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
28710 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
28711
28712 @item pc-outside-range
28713 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
28714 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
28715 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
28716
28717 @item line
28718 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
28719 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
28720 the specified location.
28721
28722 @end table
28723
28724 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
28725 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
28726
28727 @table @samp
28728 @item found
28729 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
28730 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
28731
28732 @item traceframe
28733 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
28734 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
28735
28736 @item tracepoint
28737 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
28738 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
28739
28740 @item frame
28741 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
28742 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
28743 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
28744
28745 @end table
28746
28747 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28748
28749 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
28750
28751 @subheading -trace-define-variable
28752 @findex -trace-define-variable
28753
28754 @subsubheading Synopsis
28755
28756 @smallexample
28757 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
28758 @end smallexample
28759
28760 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
28761 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
28762 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
28763 with the @samp{$} character.
28764
28765 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28766
28767 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
28768
28769 @subheading -trace-list-variables
28770 @findex -trace-list-variables
28771
28772 @subsubheading Synopsis
28773
28774 @smallexample
28775 -trace-list-variables
28776 @end smallexample
28777
28778 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
28779 table has the following fields:
28780
28781 @table @samp
28782 @item name
28783 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
28784
28785 @item initial
28786 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
28787 field is always present.
28788
28789 @item current
28790 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
28791 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
28792 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
28793 presently running.
28794
28795 @end table
28796
28797 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28798
28799 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
28800
28801 @subsubheading Example
28802
28803 @smallexample
28804 (gdb)
28805 -trace-list-variables
28806 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
28807 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
28808 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
28809 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
28810 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
28811 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
28812 (gdb)
28813 @end smallexample
28814
28815 @subheading -trace-save
28816 @findex -trace-save
28817
28818 @subsubheading Synopsis
28819
28820 @smallexample
28821 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
28822 @end smallexample
28823
28824 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
28825 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
28826 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
28827 to perform the save.
28828
28829 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28830
28831 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
28832
28833
28834 @subheading -trace-start
28835 @findex -trace-start
28836
28837 @subsubheading Synopsis
28838
28839 @smallexample
28840 -trace-start
28841 @end smallexample
28842
28843 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
28844 have any fields.
28845
28846 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28847
28848 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
28849
28850 @subheading -trace-status
28851 @findex -trace-status
28852
28853 @subsubheading Synopsis
28854
28855 @smallexample
28856 -trace-status
28857 @end smallexample
28858
28859 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
28860 the following fields:
28861
28862 @table @samp
28863
28864 @item supported
28865 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
28866 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
28867 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
28868 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
28869 started. This field is always present.
28870
28871 @item running
28872 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
28873 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
28874 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
28875
28876 @item stop-reason
28877 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
28878 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
28879 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
28880 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
28881 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
28882 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
28883 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
28884 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
28885 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
28886
28887 @item stopping-tracepoint
28888 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
28889 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
28890 @samp{passcount}.
28891
28892 @item frames
28893 @itemx frames-created
28894 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
28895 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
28896 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
28897 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
28898
28899 @item buffer-size
28900 @itemx buffer-free
28901 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
28902 remaining space. These fields are optional.
28903
28904 @item circular
28905 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
28906 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
28907 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
28908 and may fill up.
28909
28910 @item disconnected
28911 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
28912 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
28913 that the trace run will stop.
28914
28915 @end table
28916
28917 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28918
28919 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
28920
28921 @subheading -trace-stop
28922 @findex -trace-stop
28923
28924 @subsubheading Synopsis
28925
28926 @smallexample
28927 -trace-stop
28928 @end smallexample
28929
28930 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
28931 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
28932 @samp{running} fields are not output.
28933
28934 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28935
28936 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
28937
28938
28939 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28940 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
28941 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
28942
28943
28944 @ignore
28945 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
28946 @findex -symbol-info-address
28947
28948 @subsubheading Synopsis
28949
28950 @smallexample
28951 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
28952 @end smallexample
28953
28954 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
28955
28956 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28957
28958 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
28959
28960 @subsubheading Example
28961 N.A.
28962
28963
28964 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
28965 @findex -symbol-info-file
28966
28967 @subsubheading Synopsis
28968
28969 @smallexample
28970 -symbol-info-file
28971 @end smallexample
28972
28973 Show the file for the symbol.
28974
28975 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28976
28977 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
28978 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
28979
28980 @subsubheading Example
28981 N.A.
28982
28983
28984 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
28985 @findex -symbol-info-function
28986
28987 @subsubheading Synopsis
28988
28989 @smallexample
28990 -symbol-info-function
28991 @end smallexample
28992
28993 Show which function the symbol lives in.
28994
28995 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28996
28997 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
28998
28999 @subsubheading Example
29000 N.A.
29001
29002
29003 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
29004 @findex -symbol-info-line
29005
29006 @subsubheading Synopsis
29007
29008 @smallexample
29009 -symbol-info-line
29010 @end smallexample
29011
29012 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
29013
29014 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29015
29016 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
29017 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
29018
29019 @subsubheading Example
29020 N.A.
29021
29022
29023 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
29024 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
29025
29026 @subsubheading Synopsis
29027
29028 @smallexample
29029 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
29030 @end smallexample
29031
29032 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
29033
29034 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29035
29036 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
29037
29038 @subsubheading Example
29039 N.A.
29040
29041
29042 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
29043 @findex -symbol-list-functions
29044
29045 @subsubheading Synopsis
29046
29047 @smallexample
29048 -symbol-list-functions
29049 @end smallexample
29050
29051 List the functions in the executable.
29052
29053 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29054
29055 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
29056 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
29057
29058 @subsubheading Example
29059 N.A.
29060 @end ignore
29061
29062
29063 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
29064 @findex -symbol-list-lines
29065
29066 @subsubheading Synopsis
29067
29068 @smallexample
29069 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
29070 @end smallexample
29071
29072 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
29073 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
29074 ascending PC order.
29075
29076 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29077
29078 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29079
29080 @subsubheading Example
29081 @smallexample
29082 (gdb)
29083 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
29084 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
29085 (gdb)
29086 @end smallexample
29087
29088
29089 @ignore
29090 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
29091 @findex -symbol-list-types
29092
29093 @subsubheading Synopsis
29094
29095 @smallexample
29096 -symbol-list-types
29097 @end smallexample
29098
29099 List all the type names.
29100
29101 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29102
29103 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
29104 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
29105
29106 @subsubheading Example
29107 N.A.
29108
29109
29110 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
29111 @findex -symbol-list-variables
29112
29113 @subsubheading Synopsis
29114
29115 @smallexample
29116 -symbol-list-variables
29117 @end smallexample
29118
29119 List all the global and static variable names.
29120
29121 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29122
29123 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
29124
29125 @subsubheading Example
29126 N.A.
29127
29128
29129 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
29130 @findex -symbol-locate
29131
29132 @subsubheading Synopsis
29133
29134 @smallexample
29135 -symbol-locate
29136 @end smallexample
29137
29138 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29139
29140 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
29141
29142 @subsubheading Example
29143 N.A.
29144
29145
29146 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
29147 @findex -symbol-type
29148
29149 @subsubheading Synopsis
29150
29151 @smallexample
29152 -symbol-type @var{variable}
29153 @end smallexample
29154
29155 Show type of @var{variable}.
29156
29157 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29158
29159 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
29160 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
29161
29162 @subsubheading Example
29163 N.A.
29164 @end ignore
29165
29166
29167 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29168 @node GDB/MI File Commands
29169 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
29170
29171 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
29172 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
29173
29174 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
29175 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
29176
29177 @subsubheading Synopsis
29178
29179 @smallexample
29180 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
29181 @end smallexample
29182
29183 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
29184 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
29185 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
29186 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
29187 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
29188 notification.
29189
29190 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29191
29192 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
29193
29194 @subsubheading Example
29195
29196 @smallexample
29197 (gdb)
29198 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
29199 ^done
29200 (gdb)
29201 @end smallexample
29202
29203
29204 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
29205 @findex -file-exec-file
29206
29207 @subsubheading Synopsis
29208
29209 @smallexample
29210 -file-exec-file @var{file}
29211 @end smallexample
29212
29213 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
29214 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
29215 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
29216 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
29217 notification.
29218
29219 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29220
29221 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
29222
29223 @subsubheading Example
29224
29225 @smallexample
29226 (gdb)
29227 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
29228 ^done
29229 (gdb)
29230 @end smallexample
29231
29232
29233 @ignore
29234 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
29235 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
29236
29237 @subsubheading Synopsis
29238
29239 @smallexample
29240 -file-list-exec-sections
29241 @end smallexample
29242
29243 List the sections of the current executable file.
29244
29245 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29246
29247 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
29248 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
29249 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
29250
29251 @subsubheading Example
29252 N.A.
29253 @end ignore
29254
29255
29256 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
29257 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
29258
29259 @subsubheading Synopsis
29260
29261 @smallexample
29262 -file-list-exec-source-file
29263 @end smallexample
29264
29265 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
29266 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
29267 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
29268 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
29269
29270 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29271
29272 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
29273
29274 @subsubheading Example
29275
29276 @smallexample
29277 (gdb)
29278 123-file-list-exec-source-file
29279 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
29280 (gdb)
29281 @end smallexample
29282
29283
29284 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
29285 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
29286
29287 @subsubheading Synopsis
29288
29289 @smallexample
29290 -file-list-exec-source-files
29291 @end smallexample
29292
29293 List the source files for the current executable.
29294
29295 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
29296 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
29297
29298 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29299
29300 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
29301 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
29302
29303 @subsubheading Example
29304 @smallexample
29305 (gdb)
29306 -file-list-exec-source-files
29307 ^done,files=[
29308 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
29309 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
29310 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
29311 (gdb)
29312 @end smallexample
29313
29314 @ignore
29315 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
29316 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
29317
29318 @subsubheading Synopsis
29319
29320 @smallexample
29321 -file-list-shared-libraries
29322 @end smallexample
29323
29324 List the shared libraries in the program.
29325
29326 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29327
29328 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
29329
29330 @subsubheading Example
29331 N.A.
29332
29333
29334 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
29335 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
29336
29337 @subsubheading Synopsis
29338
29339 @smallexample
29340 -file-list-symbol-files
29341 @end smallexample
29342
29343 List symbol files.
29344
29345 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29346
29347 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
29348
29349 @subsubheading Example
29350 N.A.
29351 @end ignore
29352
29353
29354 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
29355 @findex -file-symbol-file
29356
29357 @subsubheading Synopsis
29358
29359 @smallexample
29360 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
29361 @end smallexample
29362
29363 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
29364 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
29365 produced, except for a completion notification.
29366
29367 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29368
29369 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
29370
29371 @subsubheading Example
29372
29373 @smallexample
29374 (gdb)
29375 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
29376 ^done
29377 (gdb)
29378 @end smallexample
29379
29380 @ignore
29381 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29382 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
29383 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
29384
29385 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
29386
29387 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
29388
29389 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
29390
29391 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
29392
29393 @c @subheading -overlay-map
29394
29395 @c @subheading -overlay-off
29396
29397 @c @subheading -overlay-on
29398
29399 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
29400
29401 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29402 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
29403 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
29404
29405 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
29406
29407 @c @subheading -signal-handle
29408
29409 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
29410
29411 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
29412 @end ignore
29413
29414
29415 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29416 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
29417 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
29418
29419
29420 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
29421 @findex -target-attach
29422
29423 @subsubheading Synopsis
29424
29425 @smallexample
29426 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
29427 @end smallexample
29428
29429 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
29430 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
29431 group, the id previously returned by
29432 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
29433
29434 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29435
29436 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
29437
29438 @subsubheading Example
29439 @smallexample
29440 (gdb)
29441 -target-attach 34
29442 =thread-created,id="1"
29443 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
29444 ^done
29445 (gdb)
29446 @end smallexample
29447
29448 @ignore
29449 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
29450 @findex -target-compare-sections
29451
29452 @subsubheading Synopsis
29453
29454 @smallexample
29455 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
29456 @end smallexample
29457
29458 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
29459 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
29460
29461 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29462
29463 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
29464
29465 @subsubheading Example
29466 N.A.
29467 @end ignore
29468
29469
29470 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
29471 @findex -target-detach
29472
29473 @subsubheading Synopsis
29474
29475 @smallexample
29476 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
29477 @end smallexample
29478
29479 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
29480 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
29481 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
29482
29483 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29484
29485 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
29486
29487 @subsubheading Example
29488
29489 @smallexample
29490 (gdb)
29491 -target-detach
29492 ^done
29493 (gdb)
29494 @end smallexample
29495
29496
29497 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
29498 @findex -target-disconnect
29499
29500 @subsubheading Synopsis
29501
29502 @smallexample
29503 -target-disconnect
29504 @end smallexample
29505
29506 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
29507 generally not resumed.
29508
29509 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29510
29511 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
29512
29513 @subsubheading Example
29514
29515 @smallexample
29516 (gdb)
29517 -target-disconnect
29518 ^done
29519 (gdb)
29520 @end smallexample
29521
29522
29523 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
29524 @findex -target-download
29525
29526 @subsubheading Synopsis
29527
29528 @smallexample
29529 -target-download
29530 @end smallexample
29531
29532 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
29533 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
29534
29535 @table @samp
29536 @item section
29537 The name of the section.
29538 @item section-sent
29539 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
29540 @item section-size
29541 The size of the section.
29542 @item total-sent
29543 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
29544 @item total-size
29545 The size of the overall executable to download.
29546 @end table
29547
29548 @noindent
29549 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
29550 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
29551
29552 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
29553 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
29554
29555 @table @samp
29556 @item section
29557 The name of the section.
29558 @item section-size
29559 The size of the section.
29560 @item total-size
29561 The size of the overall executable to download.
29562 @end table
29563
29564 @noindent
29565 At the end, a summary is printed.
29566
29567 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29568
29569 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
29570
29571 @subsubheading Example
29572
29573 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
29574 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
29575
29576 @smallexample
29577 (gdb)
29578 -target-download
29579 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
29580 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
29581 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
29582 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
29583 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
29584 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
29585 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
29586 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
29587 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
29588 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
29589 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
29590 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
29591 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
29592 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
29593 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
29594 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
29595 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
29596 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
29597 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
29598 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
29599 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
29600 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
29601 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
29602 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
29603 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
29604 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
29605 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
29606 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
29607 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
29608 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
29609 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
29610 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
29611 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
29612 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
29613 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
29614 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
29615 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
29616 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
29617 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
29618 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
29619 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
29620 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
29621 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
29622 write-rate="429"
29623 (gdb)
29624 @end smallexample
29625
29626
29627 @ignore
29628 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
29629 @findex -target-exec-status
29630
29631 @subsubheading Synopsis
29632
29633 @smallexample
29634 -target-exec-status
29635 @end smallexample
29636
29637 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
29638 not, for instance).
29639
29640 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29641
29642 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
29643
29644 @subsubheading Example
29645 N.A.
29646
29647
29648 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
29649 @findex -target-list-available-targets
29650
29651 @subsubheading Synopsis
29652
29653 @smallexample
29654 -target-list-available-targets
29655 @end smallexample
29656
29657 List the possible targets to connect to.
29658
29659 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29660
29661 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
29662
29663 @subsubheading Example
29664 N.A.
29665
29666
29667 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
29668 @findex -target-list-current-targets
29669
29670 @subsubheading Synopsis
29671
29672 @smallexample
29673 -target-list-current-targets
29674 @end smallexample
29675
29676 Describe the current target.
29677
29678 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29679
29680 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
29681 other things).
29682
29683 @subsubheading Example
29684 N.A.
29685
29686
29687 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
29688 @findex -target-list-parameters
29689
29690 @subsubheading Synopsis
29691
29692 @smallexample
29693 -target-list-parameters
29694 @end smallexample
29695
29696 @c ????
29697 @end ignore
29698
29699 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29700
29701 No equivalent.
29702
29703 @subsubheading Example
29704 N.A.
29705
29706
29707 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
29708 @findex -target-select
29709
29710 @subsubheading Synopsis
29711
29712 @smallexample
29713 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
29714 @end smallexample
29715
29716 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
29717
29718 @table @samp
29719 @item @var{type}
29720 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
29721 @item @var{parameters}
29722 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
29723 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
29724 @end table
29725
29726 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
29727 which the target program is, in the following form:
29728
29729 @smallexample
29730 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
29731 args=[@var{arg list}]
29732 @end smallexample
29733
29734 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29735
29736 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
29737
29738 @subsubheading Example
29739
29740 @smallexample
29741 (gdb)
29742 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
29743 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
29744 (gdb)
29745 @end smallexample
29746
29747 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29748 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
29749 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
29750
29751
29752 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
29753 @findex -target-file-put
29754
29755 @subsubheading Synopsis
29756
29757 @smallexample
29758 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
29759 @end smallexample
29760
29761 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
29762 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
29763
29764 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29765
29766 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
29767
29768 @subsubheading Example
29769
29770 @smallexample
29771 (gdb)
29772 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
29773 ^done
29774 (gdb)
29775 @end smallexample
29776
29777
29778 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
29779 @findex -target-file-get
29780
29781 @subsubheading Synopsis
29782
29783 @smallexample
29784 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
29785 @end smallexample
29786
29787 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
29788 on the host system.
29789
29790 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29791
29792 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
29793
29794 @subsubheading Example
29795
29796 @smallexample
29797 (gdb)
29798 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
29799 ^done
29800 (gdb)
29801 @end smallexample
29802
29803
29804 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
29805 @findex -target-file-delete
29806
29807 @subsubheading Synopsis
29808
29809 @smallexample
29810 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
29811 @end smallexample
29812
29813 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
29814
29815 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29816
29817 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
29818
29819 @subsubheading Example
29820
29821 @smallexample
29822 (gdb)
29823 -target-file-delete remotefile
29824 ^done
29825 (gdb)
29826 @end smallexample
29827
29828
29829 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29830 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
29831 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
29832
29833 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
29834
29835 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
29836 @findex -gdb-exit
29837
29838 @subsubheading Synopsis
29839
29840 @smallexample
29841 -gdb-exit
29842 @end smallexample
29843
29844 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
29845
29846 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29847
29848 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
29849
29850 @subsubheading Example
29851
29852 @smallexample
29853 (gdb)
29854 -gdb-exit
29855 ^exit
29856 @end smallexample
29857
29858
29859 @ignore
29860 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
29861 @findex -exec-abort
29862
29863 @subsubheading Synopsis
29864
29865 @smallexample
29866 -exec-abort
29867 @end smallexample
29868
29869 Kill the inferior running program.
29870
29871 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29872
29873 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
29874
29875 @subsubheading Example
29876 N.A.
29877 @end ignore
29878
29879
29880 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
29881 @findex -gdb-set
29882
29883 @subsubheading Synopsis
29884
29885 @smallexample
29886 -gdb-set
29887 @end smallexample
29888
29889 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
29890 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
29891
29892 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29893
29894 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
29895
29896 @subsubheading Example
29897
29898 @smallexample
29899 (gdb)
29900 -gdb-set $foo=3
29901 ^done
29902 (gdb)
29903 @end smallexample
29904
29905
29906 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
29907 @findex -gdb-show
29908
29909 @subsubheading Synopsis
29910
29911 @smallexample
29912 -gdb-show
29913 @end smallexample
29914
29915 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
29916
29917 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29918
29919 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
29920
29921 @subsubheading Example
29922
29923 @smallexample
29924 (gdb)
29925 -gdb-show annotate
29926 ^done,value="0"
29927 (gdb)
29928 @end smallexample
29929
29930 @c @subheading -gdb-source
29931
29932
29933 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
29934 @findex -gdb-version
29935
29936 @subsubheading Synopsis
29937
29938 @smallexample
29939 -gdb-version
29940 @end smallexample
29941
29942 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
29943
29944 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29945
29946 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
29947 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
29948
29949 @subsubheading Example
29950
29951 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
29952 @c box in TeX.
29953 @smallexample
29954 (gdb)
29955 -gdb-version
29956 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
29957 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
29958 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
29959 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
29960 ~ certain conditions.
29961 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
29962 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
29963 ~ details.
29964 ~This GDB was configured as
29965 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
29966 ^done
29967 (gdb)
29968 @end smallexample
29969
29970 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
29971 @findex -list-features
29972
29973 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
29974 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
29975 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
29976 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
29977 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
29978 startup.
29979
29980 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
29981 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
29982 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
29983 is given below.
29984
29985 Example output:
29986
29987 @smallexample
29988 (gdb) -list-features
29989 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
29990 @end smallexample
29991
29992 The current list of features is:
29993
29994 @table @samp
29995 @item frozen-varobjs
29996 Indicates presence of the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
29997 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
29998 of @code{-varobj-create}.
29999 @item pending-breakpoints
30000 Indicates presence of the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
30001 @item python
30002 Indicates presence of Python scripting support, Python-based
30003 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
30004 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
30005 @item thread-info
30006 Indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command.
30007 @item data-read-memory-bytes
30008 Indicates presense of the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
30009 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
30010
30011 @end table
30012
30013 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
30014 @findex -list-target-features
30015
30016 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
30017 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
30018 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
30019 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
30020 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
30021 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
30022 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
30023 Example output:
30024
30025 @smallexample
30026 (gdb) -list-features
30027 ^done,result=["async"]
30028 @end smallexample
30029
30030 The current list of features is:
30031
30032 @table @samp
30033 @item async
30034 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
30035 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
30036 while the target is running.
30037
30038 @item reverse
30039 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
30040 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
30041
30042 @end table
30043
30044 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
30045 @findex -list-thread-groups
30046
30047 @subheading Synopsis
30048
30049 @smallexample
30050 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
30051 @end smallexample
30052
30053 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
30054 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
30055 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
30056 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
30057 top-level thread groups.
30058
30059 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
30060 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
30061 available on the target.
30062
30063 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
30064 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
30065 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
30066 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
30067 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
30068 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
30069 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
30070 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
30071
30072 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
30073 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
30074 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
30075 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
30076 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
30077 @samp{threads} field.
30078
30079 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
30080 the following caveats:
30081
30082 @itemize @bullet
30083 @item
30084 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
30085 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
30086 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
30087
30088 @item
30089 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
30090 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
30091 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
30092 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
30093 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
30094 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
30095
30096 @end itemize
30097
30098 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
30099 have the following fields:
30100
30101 @table @code
30102 @item id
30103 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
30104 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
30105 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
30106
30107 @item type
30108 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
30109 valid type.
30110
30111 @item pid
30112 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
30113 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
30114
30115 @item num_children
30116 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
30117 absent for an available thread group.
30118
30119 @item threads
30120 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
30121 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
30122 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
30123
30124 @item cores
30125 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
30126 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
30127 such information is not available.
30128
30129 @item executable
30130 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
30131 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
30132 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
30133
30134 @end table
30135
30136 @subheading Example
30137
30138 @smallexample
30139 @value{GDBP}
30140 -list-thread-groups
30141 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
30142 -list-thread-groups 17
30143 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
30144 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
30145 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
30146 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
30147 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
30148 -list-thread-groups --available
30149 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
30150 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
30151 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
30152 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
30153 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
30154 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
30155 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
30156 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
30157 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
30158 @end smallexample
30159
30160
30161 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
30162 @findex -add-inferior
30163
30164 @subheading Synopsis
30165
30166 @smallexample
30167 -add-inferior
30168 @end smallexample
30169
30170 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
30171 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
30172 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
30173 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
30174 field, @samp{thread-group}, whose value is the identifier of the
30175 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
30176
30177 @subheading Example
30178
30179 @smallexample
30180 @value{GDBP}
30181 -add-inferior
30182 ^done,thread-group="i3"
30183 @end smallexample
30184
30185 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
30186 @findex -interpreter-exec
30187
30188 @subheading Synopsis
30189
30190 @smallexample
30191 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
30192 @end smallexample
30193 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
30194
30195 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
30196
30197 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
30198
30199 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
30200
30201 @subheading Example
30202
30203 @smallexample
30204 (gdb)
30205 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
30206 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
30207 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
30208 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
30209 ^done
30210 (gdb)
30211 @end smallexample
30212
30213 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
30214 @findex -inferior-tty-set
30215
30216 @subheading Synopsis
30217
30218 @smallexample
30219 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
30220 @end smallexample
30221
30222 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
30223
30224 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
30225
30226 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
30227
30228 @subheading Example
30229
30230 @smallexample
30231 (gdb)
30232 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
30233 ^done
30234 (gdb)
30235 @end smallexample
30236
30237 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
30238 @findex -inferior-tty-show
30239
30240 @subheading Synopsis
30241
30242 @smallexample
30243 -inferior-tty-show
30244 @end smallexample
30245
30246 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
30247
30248 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
30249
30250 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
30251
30252 @subheading Example
30253
30254 @smallexample
30255 (gdb)
30256 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
30257 ^done
30258 (gdb)
30259 -inferior-tty-show
30260 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
30261 (gdb)
30262 @end smallexample
30263
30264 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
30265 @findex -enable-timings
30266
30267 @subheading Synopsis
30268
30269 @smallexample
30270 -enable-timings [yes | no]
30271 @end smallexample
30272
30273 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
30274 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
30275 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
30276 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
30277
30278 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
30279
30280 No equivalent.
30281
30282 @subheading Example
30283
30284 @smallexample
30285 (gdb)
30286 -enable-timings
30287 ^done
30288 (gdb)
30289 -break-insert main
30290 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30291 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
30292 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
30293 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
30294 (gdb)
30295 -enable-timings no
30296 ^done
30297 (gdb)
30298 -exec-run
30299 ^running
30300 (gdb)
30301 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
30302 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
30303 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
30304 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
30305 (gdb)
30306 @end smallexample
30307
30308 @node Annotations
30309 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
30310
30311 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
30312 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
30313 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
30314 relatively high level.
30315
30316 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
30317 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
30318
30319 @ignore
30320 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
30321 @end ignore
30322
30323 @menu
30324 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
30325 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
30326 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
30327 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
30328 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
30329 * Annotations for Running::
30330 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
30331 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
30332 @end menu
30333
30334 @node Annotations Overview
30335 @section What is an Annotation?
30336 @cindex annotations
30337
30338 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
30339 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
30340 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
30341 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
30342 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
30343 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
30344 cannot contain newline characters.
30345
30346 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
30347 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
30348 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
30349 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
30350 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
30351 means those three characters as output.
30352
30353 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
30354 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
30355 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
30356 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
30357 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
30358 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
30359 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
30360 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
30361 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
30362
30363 @table @code
30364 @kindex set annotate
30365 @item set annotate @var{level}
30366 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
30367 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
30368
30369 @item show annotate
30370 @kindex show annotate
30371 Show the current annotation level.
30372 @end table
30373
30374 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
30375
30376 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
30377
30378 @smallexample
30379 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
30380 GNU gdb 6.0
30381 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
30382 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
30383 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
30384 under certain conditions.
30385 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
30386 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
30387 for details.
30388 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
30389
30390 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
30391 (@value{GDBP})
30392 ^Z^Zprompt
30393 @kbd{quit}
30394
30395 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
30396 $
30397 @end smallexample
30398
30399 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
30400 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
30401 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
30402 output from @value{GDBN}.
30403
30404 @node Server Prefix
30405 @section The Server Prefix
30406 @cindex server prefix
30407
30408 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
30409 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
30410 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
30411 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
30412 a transparent manner.
30413
30414 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
30415 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
30416 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
30417 @code{print} command.
30418
30419 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
30420 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
30421
30422 @node Prompting
30423 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
30424
30425 @cindex annotations for prompts
30426 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
30427 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
30428 over, etc.
30429
30430 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
30431 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
30432 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
30433 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
30434 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
30435 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
30436 features the following annotations:
30437
30438 @smallexample
30439 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
30440 ^Z^Zprompt
30441 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
30442 @end smallexample
30443
30444 The input types are
30445
30446 @table @code
30447 @findex pre-prompt annotation
30448 @findex prompt annotation
30449 @findex post-prompt annotation
30450 @item prompt
30451 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
30452
30453 @findex pre-commands annotation
30454 @findex commands annotation
30455 @findex post-commands annotation
30456 @item commands
30457 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
30458 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
30459
30460 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
30461 @findex overload-choice annotation
30462 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
30463 @item overload-choice
30464 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
30465
30466 @findex pre-query annotation
30467 @findex query annotation
30468 @findex post-query annotation
30469 @item query
30470 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
30471
30472 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
30473 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
30474 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
30475 @item prompt-for-continue
30476 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
30477 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
30478 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
30479 presence of annotations.
30480 @end table
30481
30482 @node Errors
30483 @section Errors
30484 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
30485
30486 @findex quit annotation
30487 @smallexample
30488 ^Z^Zquit
30489 @end smallexample
30490
30491 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
30492
30493 @findex error annotation
30494 @smallexample
30495 ^Z^Zerror
30496 @end smallexample
30497
30498 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
30499
30500 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
30501 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
30502 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
30503 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
30504 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
30505 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
30506 to the top level.
30507
30508 @findex error-begin annotation
30509 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
30510
30511 @smallexample
30512 ^Z^Zerror-begin
30513 @end smallexample
30514
30515 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
30516 message.
30517
30518 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
30519 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
30520 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
30521
30522 @node Invalidation
30523 @section Invalidation Notices
30524
30525 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
30526 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
30527 changed.
30528
30529 @table @code
30530 @findex frames-invalid annotation
30531 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
30532
30533 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
30534 have changed.
30535
30536 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
30537 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
30538
30539 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
30540 deleted a breakpoint.
30541 @end table
30542
30543 @node Annotations for Running
30544 @section Running the Program
30545 @cindex annotations for running programs
30546
30547 @findex starting annotation
30548 @findex stopping annotation
30549 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
30550 @code{step} or @code{continue},
30551
30552 @smallexample
30553 ^Z^Zstarting
30554 @end smallexample
30555
30556 is output. When the program stops,
30557
30558 @smallexample
30559 ^Z^Zstopped
30560 @end smallexample
30561
30562 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
30563 annotations describe how the program stopped.
30564
30565 @table @code
30566 @findex exited annotation
30567 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
30568 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
30569 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
30570
30571 @findex signalled annotation
30572 @findex signal-name annotation
30573 @findex signal-name-end annotation
30574 @findex signal-string annotation
30575 @findex signal-string-end annotation
30576 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
30577 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
30578 annotation continues:
30579
30580 @smallexample
30581 @var{intro-text}
30582 ^Z^Zsignal-name
30583 @var{name}
30584 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
30585 @var{middle-text}
30586 ^Z^Zsignal-string
30587 @var{string}
30588 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
30589 @var{end-text}
30590 @end smallexample
30591
30592 @noindent
30593 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
30594 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
30595 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
30596 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
30597 user's benefit and have no particular format.
30598
30599 @findex signal annotation
30600 @item ^Z^Zsignal
30601 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
30602 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
30603 terminated with it.
30604
30605 @findex breakpoint annotation
30606 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
30607 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
30608
30609 @findex watchpoint annotation
30610 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
30611 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
30612 @end table
30613
30614 @node Source Annotations
30615 @section Displaying Source
30616 @cindex annotations for source display
30617
30618 @findex source annotation
30619 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
30620
30621 @smallexample
30622 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
30623 @end smallexample
30624
30625 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
30626 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
30627 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
30628 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
30629 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
30630 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
30631 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
30632 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
30633 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
30634 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
30635 depend on the language).
30636
30637 @node JIT Interface
30638 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
30639 @cindex just-in-time compilation
30640 @cindex JIT compilation interface
30641
30642 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
30643 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
30644 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
30645 performance while maintaining platform independence.
30646
30647 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
30648 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
30649 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
30650 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
30651 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
30652 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
30653
30654 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
30655 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
30656 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
30657 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
30658 LLVM JIT.
30659
30660 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
30661 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
30662 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
30663 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
30664 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
30665 out about additional code.
30666
30667 @menu
30668 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
30669 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
30670 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
30671 @end menu
30672
30673 @node Declarations
30674 @section JIT Declarations
30675
30676 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
30677 implement the interface:
30678
30679 @smallexample
30680 typedef enum
30681 @{
30682 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
30683 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
30684 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
30685 @} jit_actions_t;
30686
30687 struct jit_code_entry
30688 @{
30689 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
30690 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
30691 const char *symfile_addr;
30692 uint64_t symfile_size;
30693 @};
30694
30695 struct jit_descriptor
30696 @{
30697 uint32_t version;
30698 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
30699 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
30700 uint32_t action_flag;
30701 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
30702 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
30703 @};
30704
30705 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
30706 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
30707
30708 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
30709 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
30710 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
30711 @end smallexample
30712
30713 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
30714 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
30715 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
30716
30717 @node Registering Code
30718 @section Registering Code
30719
30720 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
30721
30722 @itemize @bullet
30723 @item
30724 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
30725 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
30726
30727 @item
30728 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
30729 file.
30730
30731 @item
30732 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
30733
30734 @item
30735 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
30736
30737 @item
30738 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
30739 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
30740 @end itemize
30741
30742 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
30743 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
30744 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
30745 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
30746
30747 @node Unregistering Code
30748 @section Unregistering Code
30749
30750 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
30751
30752 @itemize @bullet
30753 @item
30754 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
30755
30756 @item
30757 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
30758
30759 @item
30760 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
30761 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
30762 @end itemize
30763
30764 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
30765 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
30766
30767 @node GDB Bugs
30768 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
30769 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
30770 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
30771
30772 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
30773
30774 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
30775 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
30776 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
30777 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
30778
30779 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
30780 information that enables us to fix the bug.
30781
30782 @menu
30783 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
30784 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
30785 @end menu
30786
30787 @node Bug Criteria
30788 @section Have You Found a Bug?
30789 @cindex bug criteria
30790
30791 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
30792
30793 @itemize @bullet
30794 @cindex fatal signal
30795 @cindex debugger crash
30796 @cindex crash of debugger
30797 @item
30798 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
30799 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
30800
30801 @cindex error on valid input
30802 @item
30803 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
30804 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
30805 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
30806
30807 @cindex invalid input
30808 @item
30809 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
30810 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
30811 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
30812 for traditional practice''.
30813
30814 @item
30815 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
30816 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
30817 @end itemize
30818
30819 @node Bug Reporting
30820 @section How to Report Bugs
30821 @cindex bug reports
30822 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
30823
30824 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
30825 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
30826 contact that organization first.
30827
30828 You can find contact information for many support companies and
30829 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
30830 distribution.
30831 @c should add a web page ref...
30832
30833 @ifset BUGURL
30834 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
30835 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
30836 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
30837 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
30838 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
30839 be used.
30840
30841 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
30842 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
30843 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
30844 @samp{bug-gdb}.
30845
30846 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
30847 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
30848 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
30849 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
30850 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
30851 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
30852 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
30853 bug reports to the mailing list.
30854 @end ifset
30855 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
30856 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
30857 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
30858 @end ifclear
30859 @end ifset
30860
30861 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
30862 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
30863 fact or leave it out, state it!
30864
30865 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
30866 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
30867 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
30868 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
30869 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
30870 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
30871 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
30872 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
30873 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
30874
30875 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
30876 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
30877 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
30878 self-contained.
30879
30880 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
30881 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
30882 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
30883 bugs properly.
30884
30885 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
30886
30887 @itemize @bullet
30888 @item
30889 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
30890 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
30891 version}.
30892
30893 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
30894 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
30895
30896 @item
30897 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
30898 version number.
30899
30900 @item
30901 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
30902 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
30903
30904 @item
30905 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
30906 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
30907 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
30908 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
30909 those compilers.
30910
30911 @item
30912 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
30913 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
30914 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
30915 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
30916
30917 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
30918 and then we might not encounter the bug.
30919
30920 @item
30921 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
30922 reproduce the bug.
30923
30924 @item
30925 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
30926 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
30927
30928 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
30929 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
30930 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
30931 a chance to make a mistake.
30932
30933 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
30934 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
30935 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
30936 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
30937 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
30938 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
30939 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
30940 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
30941
30942 @pindex script
30943 @cindex recording a session script
30944 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
30945 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
30946 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
30947 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
30948
30949 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
30950 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
30951
30952 @item
30953 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
30954 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
30955 it by context, not by line number.
30956
30957 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
30958 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
30959
30960 @end itemize
30961
30962 Here are some things that are not necessary:
30963
30964 @itemize @bullet
30965 @item
30966 A description of the envelope of the bug.
30967
30968 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
30969 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
30970 changes will not affect it.
30971
30972 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
30973 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
30974 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
30975 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
30976
30977 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
30978 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
30979 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
30980 less time, and so on.
30981
30982 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
30983 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
30984
30985 @item
30986 A patch for the bug.
30987
30988 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
30989 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
30990 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
30991 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
30992
30993 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
30994 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
30995 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
30996 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
30997
30998 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
30999 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
31000 help us to understand.
31001
31002 @item
31003 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
31004
31005 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
31006 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
31007 @end itemize
31008
31009 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
31010 @c and consists of the two following files:
31011 @c rluser.texinfo
31012 @c inc-hist.texinfo
31013 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
31014 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
31015 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
31016 @include rluser.texi
31017 @include inc-hist.texinfo
31018 @end ifclear
31019
31020
31021 @node Formatting Documentation
31022 @appendix Formatting Documentation
31023
31024 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
31025 @cindex reference card
31026 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
31027 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
31028 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
31029 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
31030 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
31031 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
31032
31033 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
31034 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
31035
31036 @smallexample
31037 make refcard.dvi
31038 @end smallexample
31039
31040 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
31041 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
31042 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
31043 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
31044 your @sc{dvi} output program.
31045
31046 @cindex documentation
31047
31048 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
31049 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
31050 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
31051 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
31052 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
31053 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
31054
31055 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
31056 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
31057 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
31058 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
31059 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
31060 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
31061 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
31062 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
31063
31064 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
31065 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
31066 @code{makeinfo}.
31067
31068 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
31069 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
31070 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
31071
31072 @smallexample
31073 cd gdb
31074 make gdb.info
31075 @end smallexample
31076
31077 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
31078 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
31079 Texinfo definitions file.
31080
31081 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
31082 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
31083 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
31084 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
31085 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
31086 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
31087 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
31088
31089 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
31090 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
31091 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
31092 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
31093 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
31094 directory.
31095
31096 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
31097 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
31098 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
31099 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
31100
31101 @smallexample
31102 make gdb.dvi
31103 @end smallexample
31104
31105 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
31106
31107 @node Installing GDB
31108 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
31109 @cindex installation
31110
31111 @menu
31112 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
31113 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
31114 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
31115 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
31116 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
31117 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
31118 @end menu
31119
31120 @node Requirements
31121 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
31122 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
31123
31124 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
31125 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
31126
31127 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
31128 @table @asis
31129 @item ISO C90 compiler
31130 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
31131 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
31132
31133 @end table
31134
31135 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
31136 @table @asis
31137 @item Expat
31138 @anchor{Expat}
31139 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
31140 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
31141 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
31142 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
31143 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
31144 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
31145
31146 Expat is used for:
31147
31148 @itemize @bullet
31149 @item
31150 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
31151 @item
31152 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
31153 @item
31154 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
31155 @item
31156 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
31157 @item
31158 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
31159 @end itemize
31160
31161 @item zlib
31162 @cindex compressed debug sections
31163 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
31164 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
31165 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
31166 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
31167 information in such binaries.
31168
31169 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
31170 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
31171 @url{http://zlib.net}.
31172
31173 @item iconv
31174 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
31175 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
31176 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
31177 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
31178
31179 On systems with @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
31180 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
31181 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
31182
31183 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
31184 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
31185 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
31186 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
31187 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
31188 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
31189 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
31190 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
31191 @end table
31192
31193 @node Running Configure
31194 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
31195 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
31196 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
31197 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
31198 build the @code{gdb} program.
31199 @iftex
31200 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
31201 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
31202 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
31203 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
31204 @end iftex
31205
31206 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
31207 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
31208 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
31209
31210 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
31211 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
31212
31213 @table @code
31214 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
31215 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
31216
31217 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
31218 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
31219
31220 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
31221 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
31222
31223 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
31224 @sc{gnu} include files
31225
31226 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
31227 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
31228
31229 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
31230 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
31231
31232 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
31233 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
31234
31235 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
31236 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
31237
31238 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
31239 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
31240 @end table
31241
31242 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
31243 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
31244 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
31245
31246 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
31247 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
31248 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
31249 argument.
31250
31251 For example:
31252
31253 @smallexample
31254 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
31255 ./configure @var{host}
31256 make
31257 @end smallexample
31258
31259 @noindent
31260 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
31261 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
31262 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
31263 correct value by examining your system.)
31264
31265 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
31266 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
31267 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
31268 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
31269
31270 @need 750
31271 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
31272 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
31273 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
31274
31275 @smallexample
31276 sh configure @var{host}
31277 @end smallexample
31278
31279 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
31280 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
31281 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
31282 @file{configure}
31283 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
31284 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
31285
31286 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
31287 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
31288 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
31289 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
31290 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
31291 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
31292 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
31293 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
31294 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
31295
31296 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
31297 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
31298 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
31299 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
31300 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
31301
31302 @node Separate Objdir
31303 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
31304
31305 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
31306 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
31307 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
31308 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
31309 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
31310 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
31311 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
31312 program specified there.
31313
31314 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
31315 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
31316 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
31317 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
31318 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
31319 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
31320
31321 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
31322 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
31323
31324 @smallexample
31325 @group
31326 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
31327 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
31328 cd ../gdb-sun4
31329 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
31330 make
31331 @end group
31332 @end smallexample
31333
31334 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
31335 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
31336 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
31337 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
31338 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
31339 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
31340
31341 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
31342 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
31343 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
31344 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
31345 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
31346
31347 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
31348 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
31349 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
31350 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
31351 You specify a cross-debugging target by
31352 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
31353
31354 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
31355 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
31356 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
31357
31358 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
31359 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
31360 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
31361 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
31362 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
31363
31364 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
31365 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
31366 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
31367 with each other.
31368
31369 @node Config Names
31370 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
31371
31372 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
31373 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
31374 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
31375 of information in the following pattern:
31376
31377 @smallexample
31378 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
31379 @end smallexample
31380
31381 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
31382 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
31383 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
31384
31385 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
31386 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
31387 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
31388 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
31389 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
31390 abbreviations---for example:
31391
31392 @smallexample
31393 % sh config.sub i386-linux
31394 i386-pc-linux-gnu
31395 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
31396 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
31397 % sh config.sub hp9k700
31398 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
31399 % sh config.sub sun4
31400 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
31401 % sh config.sub sun3
31402 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
31403 % sh config.sub i986v
31404 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
31405 @end smallexample
31406
31407 @noindent
31408 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
31409 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
31410
31411 @node Configure Options
31412 @section @file{configure} Options
31413
31414 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
31415 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
31416 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
31417 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
31418
31419 @smallexample
31420 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
31421 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
31422 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
31423 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
31424 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
31425 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
31426 @var{host}
31427 @end smallexample
31428
31429 @noindent
31430 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
31431 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
31432 @samp{--}.
31433
31434 @table @code
31435 @item --help
31436 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
31437
31438 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
31439 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
31440 @file{@var{dir}}.
31441
31442 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
31443 Configure the source to install programs under directory
31444 @file{@var{dir}}.
31445
31446 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
31447 @need 2000
31448 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
31449 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
31450 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
31451 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
31452 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
31453 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
31454 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
31455 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
31456 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
31457 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
31458 @var{dirname}.
31459
31460 @item --norecursion
31461 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
31462 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
31463
31464 @item --target=@var{target}
31465 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
31466 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
31467 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
31468
31469 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
31470
31471 @item @var{host} @dots{}
31472 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
31473
31474 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
31475 @end table
31476
31477 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
31478 needed for special purposes only.
31479
31480 @node System-wide configuration
31481 @section System-wide configuration and settings
31482 @cindex system-wide init file
31483
31484 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
31485 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
31486 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
31487
31488 Here is the corresponding configure option:
31489
31490 @table @code
31491 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
31492 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
31493 @var{file}.
31494 @end table
31495
31496 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
31497 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
31498
31499 @itemize @bullet
31500 @item
31501 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
31502 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
31503 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
31504 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
31505 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
31506 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
31507
31508 @item
31509 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
31510 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
31511 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
31512 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
31513 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
31514 @end itemize
31515
31516 @node Maintenance Commands
31517 @appendix Maintenance Commands
31518 @cindex maintenance commands
31519 @cindex internal commands
31520
31521 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
31522 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
31523 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
31524 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
31525 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
31526
31527 @table @code
31528 @kindex maint agent
31529 @kindex maint agent-eval
31530 @item maint agent @var{expression}
31531 @itemx maint agent-eval @var{expression}
31532 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
31533 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
31534 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
31535 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
31536 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
31537 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
31538 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
31539 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
31540 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
31541 addition and return the sum.
31542
31543 @kindex maint info breakpoints
31544 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
31545 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
31546 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
31547 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
31548 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
31549 is shown:
31550
31551 @table @code
31552 @item breakpoint
31553 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
31554
31555 @item watchpoint
31556 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
31557
31558 @item longjmp
31559 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
31560 @code{longjmp} calls.
31561
31562 @item longjmp resume
31563 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
31564
31565 @item until
31566 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
31567
31568 @item finish
31569 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
31570
31571 @item shlib events
31572 Shared library events.
31573
31574 @end table
31575
31576 @kindex set displaced-stepping
31577 @kindex show displaced-stepping
31578 @cindex displaced stepping support
31579 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
31580 @item set displaced-stepping
31581 @itemx show displaced-stepping
31582 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
31583 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
31584 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
31585 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
31586 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
31587
31588 @table @code
31589 @item set displaced-stepping on
31590 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
31591 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
31592
31593 @item set displaced-stepping off
31594 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
31595 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
31596
31597 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
31598 @item set displaced-stepping auto
31599 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
31600 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
31601 architecture supports displaced stepping.
31602 @end table
31603
31604 @kindex maint check-symtabs
31605 @item maint check-symtabs
31606 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
31607
31608 @kindex maint cplus first_component
31609 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
31610 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
31611
31612 @kindex maint cplus namespace
31613 @item maint cplus namespace
31614 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
31615
31616 @kindex maint demangle
31617 @item maint demangle @var{name}
31618 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
31619
31620 @kindex maint deprecate
31621 @kindex maint undeprecate
31622 @cindex deprecated commands
31623 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
31624 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
31625 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
31626 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
31627 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
31628 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
31629 the replacement as part of the warning.
31630
31631 @kindex maint dump-me
31632 @item maint dump-me
31633 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
31634 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
31635 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
31636 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
31637
31638 @kindex maint internal-error
31639 @kindex maint internal-warning
31640 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
31641 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
31642 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
31643 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
31644 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
31645 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
31646 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
31647 @value{GDBN} session.
31648
31649 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
31650 used as the text of the error or warning message.
31651
31652 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
31653
31654 @smallexample
31655 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
31656 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
31657 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
31658 debugging may prove unreliable.
31659 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
31660 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
31661 (@value{GDBP})
31662 @end smallexample
31663
31664 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
31665 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
31666
31667 @kindex maint set internal-error
31668 @kindex maint show internal-error
31669 @kindex maint set internal-warning
31670 @kindex maint show internal-warning
31671 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
31672 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
31673 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
31674 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
31675 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
31676 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
31677 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
31678 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
31679 described in the table below.
31680
31681 @table @samp
31682 @item quit
31683 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
31684 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
31685
31686 @item corefile
31687 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
31688 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do.
31689 @end table
31690
31691 @kindex maint packet
31692 @item maint packet @var{text}
31693 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
31694 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
31695 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
31696 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
31697 checksum.
31698
31699 @kindex maint print architecture
31700 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31701 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
31702 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
31703
31704 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
31705 @item maint print c-tdesc
31706 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
31707 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
31708 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
31709
31710 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
31711 @item maint print dummy-frames
31712 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
31713
31714 @smallexample
31715 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
31716 @dots{}
31717 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
31718 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
31719 58 return (a + b);
31720 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
31721 @dots{}
31722 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
31723 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
31724 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
31725 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
31726 (@value{GDBP})
31727 @end smallexample
31728
31729 Takes an optional file parameter.
31730
31731 @kindex maint print registers
31732 @kindex maint print raw-registers
31733 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
31734 @kindex maint print register-groups
31735 @kindex maint print remote-registers
31736 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31737 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31738 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31739 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31740 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31741 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
31742
31743 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
31744 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
31745 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
31746 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
31747 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
31748 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
31749 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
31750 and offsets in the `G' packets. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
31751 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
31752
31753 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
31754 write the information.
31755
31756 @kindex maint print reggroups
31757 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31758 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
31759 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
31760 information.
31761
31762 The register groups info looks like this:
31763
31764 @smallexample
31765 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
31766 Group Type
31767 general user
31768 float user
31769 all user
31770 vector user
31771 system user
31772 save internal
31773 restore internal
31774 @end smallexample
31775
31776 @kindex flushregs
31777 @item flushregs
31778 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
31779
31780 @kindex maint print objfiles
31781 @cindex info for known object files
31782 @item maint print objfiles
31783 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
31784 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
31785 and symtabs.
31786
31787 @kindex maint print section-scripts
31788 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
31789 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
31790 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
31791 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
31792 matching @var{regexp}.
31793 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
31794 and the full path if known.
31795 @xref{.debug_gdb_scripts section}.
31796
31797 @kindex maint print statistics
31798 @cindex bcache statistics
31799 @item maint print statistics
31800 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
31801 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
31802 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
31803 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
31804 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
31805 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
31806 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
31807 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
31808 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
31809 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
31810 lengths.
31811
31812 @kindex maint print target-stack
31813 @cindex target stack description
31814 @item maint print target-stack
31815 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
31816 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
31817 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
31818 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
31819 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
31820 address.
31821
31822 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
31823 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
31824
31825 @kindex maint print type
31826 @cindex type chain of a data type
31827 @item maint print type @var{expr}
31828 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
31829 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
31830 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
31831 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
31832 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
31833
31834 @kindex maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
31835 @kindex maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
31836 @item maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
31837 @item maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
31838 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
31839 information.
31840
31841 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
31842 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
31843 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
31844 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
31845 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
31846 always see the disassembly form.
31847
31848 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
31849
31850 @smallexample
31851 (gdb) info addr argc
31852 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
31853 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
31854 @end smallexample
31855
31856 For more information on these expressions, see
31857 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
31858
31859 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
31860 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
31861 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
31862 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
31863 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
31864
31865 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
31866 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
31867 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
31868 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
31869 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
31870 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
31871 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
31872 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
31873 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
31874
31875 @kindex maint set profile
31876 @kindex maint show profile
31877 @cindex profiling GDB
31878 @item maint set profile
31879 @itemx maint show profile
31880 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
31881
31882 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
31883 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
31884 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
31885 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
31886 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
31887 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
31888 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
31889
31890 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
31891 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
31892
31893 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
31894 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
31895 @cindex hardware debug registers
31896 @item maint set show-debug-regs
31897 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
31898 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
31899 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
31900 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
31901 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
31902 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
31903
31904 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
31905 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
31906 @item maint set show-all-tib
31907 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
31908 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
31909 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
31910 command.
31911
31912 @kindex maint space
31913 @cindex memory used by commands
31914 @item maint space
31915 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
31916 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
31917 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
31918 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
31919 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
31920
31921 @kindex maint time
31922 @cindex time of command execution
31923 @item maint time
31924 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
31925 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
31926 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
31927 The time is not printed for the commands that run the target, since
31928 there's no mechanism currently to compute how much time was spend
31929 by @value{GDBN} and how much time was spend by the program been debugged.
31930 it's not possibly currently
31931 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
31932 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
31933
31934 @kindex maint translate-address
31935 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
31936 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
31937 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
31938 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
31939 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
31940 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
31941 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
31942
31943 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
31944 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
31945 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
31946
31947 @end table
31948
31949 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
31950 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
31951
31952 @table @code
31953 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
31954 @kindex set watchdog
31955 @cindex watchdog timer
31956 @cindex timeout for commands
31957 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
31958 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
31959 reports and error and the command is aborted.
31960
31961 @item show watchdog
31962 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
31963 @end table
31964
31965 @node Remote Protocol
31966 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
31967
31968 @menu
31969 * Overview::
31970 * Packets::
31971 * Stop Reply Packets::
31972 * General Query Packets::
31973 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
31974 * Tracepoint Packets::
31975 * Host I/O Packets::
31976 * Interrupts::
31977 * Notification Packets::
31978 * Remote Non-Stop::
31979 * Packet Acknowledgment::
31980 * Examples::
31981 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
31982 * Library List Format::
31983 * Memory Map Format::
31984 * Thread List Format::
31985 * Traceframe Info Format::
31986 @end menu
31987
31988 @node Overview
31989 @section Overview
31990
31991 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
31992 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
31993 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
31994 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
31995
31996 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
31997 transmitted and received data, respectively.
31998
31999 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
32000 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
32001 @cindex remote serial protocol
32002 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
32003 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
32004 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
32005 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
32006 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
32007
32008 @smallexample
32009 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
32010 @end smallexample
32011 @noindent
32012
32013 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
32014 @noindent
32015 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
32016 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
32017 eight bit unsigned checksum).
32018
32019 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
32020 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
32021
32022 @smallexample
32023 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
32024 @end smallexample
32025
32026 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
32027 @noindent
32028 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
32029 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
32030 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
32031
32032 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
32033 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
32034 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
32035 retransmission):
32036
32037 @smallexample
32038 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
32039 <- @code{+}
32040 @end smallexample
32041 @noindent
32042
32043 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
32044 once a connection is established.
32045 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
32046
32047 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
32048 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
32049 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
32050 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
32051 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
32052 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
32053 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
32054
32055 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
32056 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
32057 exceptions).
32058
32059 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
32060 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
32061 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
32062 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
32063
32064 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
32065 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
32066 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
32067
32068 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
32069 @anchor{Binary Data}
32070 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
32071 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
32072 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
32073 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
32074 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
32075 binary data.
32076
32077 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
32078 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
32079 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
32080 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
32081 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
32082 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
32083 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
32084 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
32085 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
32086 (described next).
32087
32088 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
32089 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
32090 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
32091 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
32092 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
32093 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
32094 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
32095 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
32096 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
32097 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
32098 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
32099 3}} more times.
32100
32101 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
32102 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
32103 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
32104 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
32105 @samp{0*"00}.
32106
32107 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
32108 error number. That number is not well defined.
32109
32110 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
32111 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
32112 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
32113 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
32114 on that response.
32115
32116 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
32117 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
32118 optional.
32119
32120 @node Packets
32121 @section Packets
32122
32123 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
32124 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
32125 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
32126 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
32127
32128 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
32129 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
32130 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
32131 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
32132 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
32133 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
32134 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
32135 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
32136 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
32137 @var{baz}.
32138
32139 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
32140 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
32141 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
32142 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
32143 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
32144 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
32145 pick any thread.
32146
32147 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
32148 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
32149 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
32150 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
32151 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
32152 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
32153 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
32154 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
32155 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
32156 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
32157 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
32158 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
32159 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
32160
32161 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
32162 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
32163 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
32164 more information.
32165
32166 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
32167 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
32168
32169 Here are the packet descriptions.
32170
32171 @table @samp
32172
32173 @item !
32174 @cindex @samp{!} packet
32175 @anchor{extended mode}
32176 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
32177 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
32178 debugged.
32179
32180 Reply:
32181 @table @samp
32182 @item OK
32183 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
32184 @end table
32185
32186 @item ?
32187 @cindex @samp{?} packet
32188 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
32189 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
32190 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
32191
32192 Reply:
32193 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
32194
32195 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
32196 @cindex @samp{A} packet
32197 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
32198 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
32199 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
32200
32201 Reply:
32202 @table @samp
32203 @item OK
32204 The arguments were set.
32205 @item E @var{NN}
32206 An error occurred.
32207 @end table
32208
32209 @item b @var{baud}
32210 @cindex @samp{b} packet
32211 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
32212 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
32213
32214 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
32215 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
32216 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
32217
32218 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
32219 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
32220 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
32221 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
32222 of view, nothing actually happened.}
32223
32224 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
32225 @cindex @samp{B} packet
32226 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
32227 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
32228
32229 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
32230 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
32231
32232 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
32233 @anchor{bc}
32234 @item bc
32235 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
32236 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
32237
32238 Reply:
32239 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
32240
32241 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
32242 @anchor{bs}
32243 @item bs
32244 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
32245 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
32246
32247 Reply:
32248 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
32249
32250 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
32251 @cindex @samp{c} packet
32252 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
32253 resume at current address.
32254
32255 Reply:
32256 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
32257
32258 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
32259 @cindex @samp{C} packet
32260 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
32261 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
32262
32263 Reply:
32264 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
32265
32266 @item d
32267 @cindex @samp{d} packet
32268 Toggle debug flag.
32269
32270 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
32271 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
32272
32273 @item D
32274 @itemx D;@var{pid}
32275 @cindex @samp{D} packet
32276 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
32277 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
32278 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
32279
32280 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
32281 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
32282 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
32283 big-endian hex string.
32284
32285 Reply:
32286 @table @samp
32287 @item OK
32288 for success
32289 @item E @var{NN}
32290 for an error
32291 @end table
32292
32293 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
32294 @cindex @samp{F} packet
32295 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
32296 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
32297 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
32298
32299 @item g
32300 @anchor{read registers packet}
32301 @cindex @samp{g} packet
32302 Read general registers.
32303
32304 Reply:
32305 @table @samp
32306 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
32307 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
32308 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
32309 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
32310 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
32311 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
32312 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
32313
32314 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
32315 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
32316 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
32317 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
32318 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
32319 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
32320 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
32321 have been collected, and both have zero value:
32322
32323 @smallexample
32324 -> @code{g}
32325 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
32326 @end smallexample
32327
32328 @item E @var{NN}
32329 for an error.
32330 @end table
32331
32332 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
32333 @cindex @samp{G} packet
32334 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
32335 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
32336
32337 Reply:
32338 @table @samp
32339 @item OK
32340 for success
32341 @item E @var{NN}
32342 for an error
32343 @end table
32344
32345 @item H @var{c} @var{thread-id}
32346 @cindex @samp{H} packet
32347 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
32348 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
32349 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
32350 operations. The thread designator @var{thread-id} has the format and
32351 interpretation described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
32352
32353 Reply:
32354 @table @samp
32355 @item OK
32356 for success
32357 @item E @var{NN}
32358 for an error
32359 @end table
32360
32361 @c FIXME: JTC:
32362 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
32363 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
32364 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
32365 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
32366 @c described. For example:
32367 @c
32368 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
32369 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
32370 @c otherwise returns current registers.
32371 @c
32372 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
32373 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
32374 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
32375
32376 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
32377 @anchor{cycle step packet}
32378 @cindex @samp{i} packet
32379 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
32380 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
32381 step starting at that address.
32382
32383 @item I
32384 @cindex @samp{I} packet
32385 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
32386 step packet}.
32387
32388 @item k
32389 @cindex @samp{k} packet
32390 Kill request.
32391
32392 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
32393 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
32394 thread?)}.
32395
32396 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
32397 @cindex @samp{m} packet
32398 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
32399 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
32400
32401 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
32402 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
32403 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
32404 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
32405 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
32406 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
32407 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
32408 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
32409
32410 Reply:
32411 @table @samp
32412 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
32413 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
32414 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
32415 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
32416 @item E @var{NN}
32417 @var{NN} is errno
32418 @end table
32419
32420 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
32421 @cindex @samp{M} packet
32422 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
32423 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
32424 hexadecimal number.
32425
32426 Reply:
32427 @table @samp
32428 @item OK
32429 for success
32430 @item E @var{NN}
32431 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
32432 written).
32433 @end table
32434
32435 @item p @var{n}
32436 @cindex @samp{p} packet
32437 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
32438 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
32439 register value is encoded.
32440
32441 Reply:
32442 @table @samp
32443 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
32444 the register's value
32445 @item E @var{NN}
32446 for an error
32447 @item
32448 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
32449 @end table
32450
32451 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
32452 @anchor{write register packet}
32453 @cindex @samp{P} packet
32454 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
32455 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
32456 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
32457
32458 Reply:
32459 @table @samp
32460 @item OK
32461 for success
32462 @item E @var{NN}
32463 for an error
32464 @end table
32465
32466 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
32467 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
32468 @cindex @samp{q} packet
32469 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
32470 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
32471 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
32472
32473 @item r
32474 @cindex @samp{r} packet
32475 Reset the entire system.
32476
32477 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
32478
32479 @item R @var{XX}
32480 @cindex @samp{R} packet
32481 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
32482 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
32483
32484 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
32485
32486 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
32487 @cindex @samp{s} packet
32488 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
32489 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
32490
32491 Reply:
32492 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
32493
32494 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
32495 @anchor{step with signal packet}
32496 @cindex @samp{S} packet
32497 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
32498 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
32499
32500 Reply:
32501 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
32502
32503 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
32504 @cindex @samp{t} packet
32505 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
32506 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
32507 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
32508
32509 @item T @var{thread-id}
32510 @cindex @samp{T} packet
32511 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
32512
32513 Reply:
32514 @table @samp
32515 @item OK
32516 thread is still alive
32517 @item E @var{NN}
32518 thread is dead
32519 @end table
32520
32521 @item v
32522 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
32523 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
32524
32525 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
32526 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
32527 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
32528 The process ID is a
32529 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
32530 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
32531 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
32532
32533 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
32534 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
32535 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
32536 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
32537 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
32538 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
32539 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
32540 @c stopping or restarting threads.
32541
32542 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
32543
32544 Reply:
32545 @table @samp
32546 @item E @var{nn}
32547 for an error
32548 @item @r{Any stop packet}
32549 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
32550 @item OK
32551 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
32552 @end table
32553
32554 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
32555 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
32556 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
32557 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
32558 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
32559 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
32560 in their current state in non-stop mode.
32561 Specifying multiple
32562 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
32563 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
32564
32565 Currently supported actions are:
32566
32567 @table @samp
32568 @item c
32569 Continue.
32570 @item C @var{sig}
32571 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
32572 @item s
32573 Step.
32574 @item S @var{sig}
32575 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
32576 @item t
32577 Stop.
32578 @end table
32579
32580 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
32581 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
32582 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
32583
32584 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
32585 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
32586 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
32587 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
32588 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
32589 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
32590 as an implementation detail.
32591
32592 Reply:
32593 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
32594
32595 @item vCont?
32596 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
32597 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
32598
32599 Reply:
32600 @table @samp
32601 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
32602 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
32603 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
32604 @item
32605 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
32606 @end table
32607
32608 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
32609 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
32610 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
32611 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
32612
32613 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
32614 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
32615 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
32616 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
32617 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
32618 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
32619 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
32620 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
32621 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
32622 packet is received.
32623
32624 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
32625 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
32626 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
32627 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
32628 @var{thread-id}.
32629
32630 Reply:
32631 @table @samp
32632 @item OK
32633 for success
32634 @item E @var{NN}
32635 for an error
32636 @end table
32637
32638 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
32639 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
32640 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
32641 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
32642 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
32643 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
32644 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
32645 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
32646 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
32647 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
32648 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
32649 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
32650
32651
32652 Reply:
32653 @table @samp
32654 @item OK
32655 for success
32656 @item E.memtype
32657 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
32658 @item E @var{NN}
32659 for an error
32660 @end table
32661
32662 @item vFlashDone
32663 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
32664 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
32665 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
32666 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
32667 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
32668 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
32669 request is completed.
32670
32671 @item vKill;@var{pid}
32672 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
32673 Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
32674 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
32675 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
32676 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
32677
32678 Reply:
32679 @table @samp
32680 @item E @var{nn}
32681 for an error
32682 @item OK
32683 for success
32684 @end table
32685
32686 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
32687 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
32688 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
32689 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
32690 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
32691 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
32692 state.
32693
32694 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
32695
32696 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
32697
32698 Reply:
32699 @table @samp
32700 @item E @var{nn}
32701 for an error
32702 @item @r{Any stop packet}
32703 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
32704 @end table
32705
32706 @item vStopped
32707 @anchor{vStopped packet}
32708 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
32709
32710 In non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}), acknowledge a previous stop
32711 reply and prompt for the stub to report another one.
32712
32713 Reply:
32714 @table @samp
32715 @item @r{Any stop packet}
32716 if there is another unreported stop event (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
32717 @item OK
32718 if there are no unreported stop events
32719 @end table
32720
32721 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
32722 @anchor{X packet}
32723 @cindex @samp{X} packet
32724 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
32725 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
32726 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
32727
32728 Reply:
32729 @table @samp
32730 @item OK
32731 for success
32732 @item E @var{NN}
32733 for an error
32734 @end table
32735
32736 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
32737 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
32738 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
32739 @cindex @samp{z} packet
32740 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
32741 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
32742 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
32743
32744 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
32745 separately.
32746
32747 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
32748 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
32749 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
32750 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
32751 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
32752 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
32753
32754 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32755 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32756 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
32757 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
32758 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
32759 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
32760
32761 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
32762 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
32763 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
32764 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
32765 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
32766 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
32767 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
32768
32769 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
32770 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
32771 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
32772 target, is not defined.}
32773
32774 Reply:
32775 @table @samp
32776 @item OK
32777 success
32778 @item
32779 not supported
32780 @item E @var{NN}
32781 for an error
32782 @end table
32783
32784 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32785 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32786 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
32787 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
32788 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
32789 address @var{addr}.
32790
32791 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
32792 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. @var{kind}
32793 has the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
32794
32795 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
32796 movement.}
32797
32798 Reply:
32799 @table @samp
32800 @item OK
32801 success
32802 @item
32803 not supported
32804 @item E @var{NN}
32805 for an error
32806 @end table
32807
32808 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32809 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32810 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
32811 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
32812 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
32813 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
32814
32815 Reply:
32816 @table @samp
32817 @item OK
32818 success
32819 @item
32820 not supported
32821 @item E @var{NN}
32822 for an error
32823 @end table
32824
32825 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32826 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32827 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
32828 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
32829 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
32830 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
32831
32832 Reply:
32833 @table @samp
32834 @item OK
32835 success
32836 @item
32837 not supported
32838 @item E @var{NN}
32839 for an error
32840 @end table
32841
32842 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32843 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32844 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
32845 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
32846 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
32847 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
32848
32849 Reply:
32850 @table @samp
32851 @item OK
32852 success
32853 @item
32854 not supported
32855 @item E @var{NN}
32856 for an error
32857 @end table
32858
32859 @end table
32860
32861 @node Stop Reply Packets
32862 @section Stop Reply Packets
32863 @cindex stop reply packets
32864
32865 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
32866 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
32867 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
32868 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
32869 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
32870 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
32871 @value{GDBN} source code.
32872
32873 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
32874 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
32875 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
32876 components.
32877
32878 @table @samp
32879
32880 @item S @var{AA}
32881 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
32882 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
32883 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
32884
32885 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
32886 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
32887 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
32888 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
32889 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
32890 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
32891 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
32892 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
32893
32894 @itemize @bullet
32895 @item
32896 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
32897 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
32898 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
32899 two-digit hex number.
32900
32901 @item
32902 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
32903 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
32904
32905 @item
32906 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
32907 the core on which the stop event was detected.
32908
32909 @item
32910 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
32911 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
32912 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
32913 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
32914
32915 @item
32916 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
32917 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
32918 future.
32919 @end itemize
32920
32921 The currently defined stop reasons are:
32922
32923 @table @samp
32924 @item watch
32925 @itemx rwatch
32926 @itemx awatch
32927 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
32928 hex.
32929
32930 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
32931 @item library
32932 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
32933 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
32934 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
32935
32936 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
32937 @item replaylog
32938 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
32939 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
32940 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
32941 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
32942 for more information.
32943 @end table
32944
32945 @item W @var{AA}
32946 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
32947 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
32948 applicable to certain targets.
32949
32950 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
32951 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
32952 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
32953 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
32954
32955 @item X @var{AA}
32956 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
32957 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
32958
32959 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
32960 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
32961 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
32962 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
32963
32964 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
32965 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
32966 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
32967 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
32968 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
32969
32970 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
32971 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
32972 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
32973 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
32974 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
32975 system calls.
32976
32977 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
32978 this very system call.
32979
32980 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
32981 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
32982 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
32983 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
32984 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
32985 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
32986
32987 @end table
32988
32989 @node General Query Packets
32990 @section General Query Packets
32991 @cindex remote query requests
32992
32993 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
32994 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
32995 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
32996 sending information to and from the stub.
32997
32998 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
32999 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
33000 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
33001 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
33002 conventions:
33003
33004 @itemize @bullet
33005 @item
33006 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
33007 @item
33008 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
33009 letter.
33010 @item
33011 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
33012 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
33013 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
33014 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
33015 @end itemize
33016
33017 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
33018 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
33019 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
33020 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
33021 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
33022 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
33023 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
33024 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
33025 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
33026 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
33027 packet.}.
33028
33029 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
33030 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
33031 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
33032 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
33033 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
33034
33035 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
33036
33037 @table @samp
33038
33039 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
33040 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
33041 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
33042 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
33043 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
33044 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
33045 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
33046 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
33047 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
33048 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
33049 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
33050
33051 @item qC
33052 @cindex current thread, remote request
33053 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
33054 Return the current thread ID.
33055
33056 Reply:
33057 @table @samp
33058 @item QC @var{thread-id}
33059 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
33060 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
33061 @item @r{(anything else)}
33062 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
33063 @end table
33064
33065 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
33066 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
33067 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
33068 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
33069 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
33070 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
33071 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
33072
33073 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
33074 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
33075 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
33076 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
33077 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
33078 detect trailing zeros.
33079
33080 Reply:
33081 @table @samp
33082 @item E @var{NN}
33083 An error (such as memory fault)
33084 @item C @var{crc32}
33085 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
33086 @end table
33087
33088 @item qfThreadInfo
33089 @itemx qsThreadInfo
33090 @cindex list active threads, remote request
33091 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
33092 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
33093 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
33094 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
33095 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
33096 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
33097 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
33098 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
33099
33100 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
33101
33102 Reply:
33103 @table @samp
33104 @item m @var{thread-id}
33105 A single thread ID
33106 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
33107 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
33108 @item l
33109 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
33110 @end table
33111
33112 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
33113 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
33114 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
33115 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
33116 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
33117 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
33118 fields.
33119
33120 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
33121 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
33122 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
33123 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
33124 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
33125
33126 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
33127 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
33128
33129 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
33130 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
33131 information associated with the variable.)
33132
33133 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
33134 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
33135 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
33136 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
33137 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
33138 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
33139
33140 Reply:
33141 @table @samp
33142 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
33143 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
33144 local storage requested.
33145
33146 @item E @var{nn}
33147 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
33148
33149 @item
33150 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
33151 @end table
33152
33153 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
33154 @cindex get thread information block address
33155 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
33156 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
33157
33158 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
33159
33160 Reply:
33161 @table @samp
33162 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
33163 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
33164 thread information block.
33165
33166 @item E @var{nn}
33167 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
33168 address could not be retrieved.
33169
33170 @item
33171 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
33172 @end table
33173
33174 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
33175 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
33176 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
33177 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
33178 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
33179 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
33180 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
33181
33182 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
33183
33184 Reply:
33185 @table @samp
33186 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
33187 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
33188 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
33189 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
33190 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
33191 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
33192 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
33193 @end table
33194
33195 @item qOffsets
33196 @cindex section offsets, remote request
33197 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
33198 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
33199 image.
33200
33201 Reply:
33202 @table @samp
33203 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
33204 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
33205 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
33206 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
33207 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
33208 segments by the supplied offsets.
33209
33210 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
33211 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
33212 to the @code{Bss} section.}
33213
33214 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
33215 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
33216 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
33217 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
33218 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
33219 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
33220 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
33221 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
33222 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
33223 @end table
33224
33225 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
33226 @cindex thread information, remote request
33227 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
33228 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
33229 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
33230 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
33231
33232 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
33233 (see below).
33234
33235 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
33236
33237 @item QNonStop:1
33238 @item QNonStop:0
33239 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
33240 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
33241 @anchor{QNonStop}
33242 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
33243 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
33244
33245 Reply:
33246 @table @samp
33247 @item OK
33248 The request succeeded.
33249
33250 @item E @var{nn}
33251 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
33252
33253 @item
33254 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
33255 the stub.
33256 @end table
33257
33258 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33259 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33260 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
33261 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
33262
33263 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
33264 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
33265 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
33266 @anchor{QPassSignals}
33267 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
33268 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
33269 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
33270 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
33271 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
33272 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
33273 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
33274 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
33275 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
33276
33277 Reply:
33278 @table @samp
33279 @item OK
33280 The request succeeded.
33281
33282 @item E @var{nn}
33283 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
33284
33285 @item
33286 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
33287 the stub.
33288 @end table
33289
33290 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
33291 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
33292 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33293 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33294
33295 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
33296 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
33297 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
33298 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
33299 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
33300 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
33301 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
33302 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
33303 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
33304
33305 Reply:
33306 @table @samp
33307 @item OK
33308 A command response with no output.
33309 @item @var{OUTPUT}
33310 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
33311 @item E @var{NN}
33312 Indicate a badly formed request.
33313 @item
33314 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
33315 @end table
33316
33317 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
33318 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
33319 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
33320 packets.)
33321
33322 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
33323 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
33324 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
33325 @anchor{qSearch memory}
33326 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
33327 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
33328 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
33329
33330 Reply:
33331 @table @samp
33332 @item 0
33333 The pattern was not found.
33334 @item 1,address
33335 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
33336 @item E @var{NN}
33337 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
33338 @item
33339 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
33340 @end table
33341
33342 @item QStartNoAckMode
33343 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
33344 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
33345 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
33346 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
33347
33348 Reply:
33349 @table @samp
33350 @item OK
33351 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
33352 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
33353 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
33354 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
33355 @item
33356 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
33357 @end table
33358
33359 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
33360 @cindex supported packets, remote query
33361 @cindex features of the remote protocol
33362 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
33363 @anchor{qSupported}
33364 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
33365 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
33366 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
33367 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
33368 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
33369 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
33370 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
33371 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
33372 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
33373 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
33374 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
33375 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
33376 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
33377 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
33378
33379 Reply:
33380 @table @samp
33381 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
33382 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
33383 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
33384 possible forms).
33385 @item
33386 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
33387 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
33388 @end table
33389
33390 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
33391 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
33392 are:
33393
33394 @table @samp
33395 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
33396 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
33397 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
33398 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
33399 @item @var{name}+
33400 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
33401 need an associated value.
33402 @item @var{name}-
33403 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
33404 @item @var{name}?
33405 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
33406 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
33407 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
33408 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
33409 @end table
33410
33411 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
33412 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
33413 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
33414 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
33415 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
33416
33417 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
33418 are defined:
33419
33420 @table @samp
33421 @item multiprocess
33422 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
33423 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
33424 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
33425 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
33426 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
33427
33428 @item xmlRegisters
33429 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
33430 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
33431 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
33432 description.
33433
33434 @item qRelocInsn
33435 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
33436 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
33437 instruction reply packet}).
33438 @end table
33439
33440 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
33441 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
33442 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
33443 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
33444 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
33445 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
33446 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
33447 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
33448 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
33449 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
33450 all the features it supports.
33451
33452 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
33453 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
33454
33455 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
33456 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
33457 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
33458 form response.
33459
33460 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
33461 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
33462 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
33463 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
33464
33465 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
33466 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
33467 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
33468 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
33469 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
33470
33471 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
33472
33473 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
33474 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
33475 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
33476 @item Feature Name
33477 @tab Value Required
33478 @tab Default
33479 @tab Probe Allowed
33480
33481 @item @samp{PacketSize}
33482 @tab Yes
33483 @tab @samp{-}
33484 @tab No
33485
33486 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
33487 @tab No
33488 @tab @samp{-}
33489 @tab Yes
33490
33491 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
33492 @tab No
33493 @tab @samp{-}
33494 @tab Yes
33495
33496 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
33497 @tab No
33498 @tab @samp{-}
33499 @tab Yes
33500
33501 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
33502 @tab No
33503 @tab @samp{-}
33504 @tab Yes
33505
33506 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
33507 @tab No
33508 @tab @samp{-}
33509 @tab Yes
33510
33511 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
33512 @tab No
33513 @tab @samp{-}
33514 @tab Yes
33515
33516 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
33517 @tab No
33518 @tab @samp{-}
33519 @tab Yes
33520
33521 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
33522 @tab No
33523 @tab @samp{-}
33524 @tab Yes
33525
33526 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
33527 @tab No
33528 @tab @samp{-}
33529 @tab Yes
33530
33531 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
33532 @tab No
33533 @tab @samp{-}
33534 @tab Yes
33535
33536 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
33537 @tab No
33538 @tab @samp{-}
33539 @tab Yes
33540
33541
33542 @item @samp{QNonStop}
33543 @tab No
33544 @tab @samp{-}
33545 @tab Yes
33546
33547 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
33548 @tab No
33549 @tab @samp{-}
33550 @tab Yes
33551
33552 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
33553 @tab No
33554 @tab @samp{-}
33555 @tab Yes
33556
33557 @item @samp{multiprocess}
33558 @tab No
33559 @tab @samp{-}
33560 @tab No
33561
33562 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
33563 @tab No
33564 @tab @samp{-}
33565 @tab No
33566
33567 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
33568 @tab No
33569 @tab @samp{-}
33570 @tab No
33571
33572 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
33573 @tab No
33574 @tab @samp{-}
33575 @tab No
33576
33577 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
33578 @tab No
33579 @tab @samp{-}
33580 @tab No
33581
33582 @item @samp{QAllow}
33583 @tab No
33584 @tab @samp{-}
33585 @tab No
33586
33587 @end multitable
33588
33589 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
33590
33591 @table @samp
33592 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
33593 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
33594 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
33595 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
33596 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
33597 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
33598 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
33599 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
33600 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
33601 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
33602
33603 @item qXfer:auxv:read
33604 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
33605 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
33606
33607 @item qXfer:features:read
33608 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
33609 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
33610
33611 @item qXfer:libraries:read
33612 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
33613 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
33614
33615 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
33616 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
33617 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
33618
33619 @item qXfer:sdata:read
33620 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
33621 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
33622
33623 @item qXfer:spu:read
33624 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
33625 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
33626
33627 @item qXfer:spu:write
33628 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
33629 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
33630
33631 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
33632 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
33633 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
33634
33635 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
33636 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
33637 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
33638
33639 @item qXfer:threads:read
33640 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
33641 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
33642
33643 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
33644 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
33645 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
33646
33647 @item QNonStop
33648 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
33649 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
33650
33651 @item QPassSignals
33652 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
33653 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
33654
33655 @item QStartNoAckMode
33656 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
33657 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
33658
33659 @item multiprocess
33660 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
33661 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
33662 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
33663 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
33664 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
33665 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
33666 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
33667 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
33668 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
33669 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
33670 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
33671
33672 @item qXfer:osdata:read
33673 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
33674 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
33675
33676 @item ConditionalTracepoints
33677 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
33678 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
33679
33680 @item ReverseContinue
33681 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
33682 (@pxref{bc}).
33683
33684 @item ReverseStep
33685 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
33686 (@pxref{bs}).
33687
33688 @item TracepointSource
33689 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
33690 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
33691
33692 @item QAllow
33693 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
33694
33695 @item StaticTracepoint
33696 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
33697 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
33698
33699 @end table
33700
33701 @item qSymbol::
33702 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
33703 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
33704 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
33705 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
33706
33707 Reply:
33708 @table @samp
33709 @item OK
33710 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
33711 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
33712 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
33713 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
33714 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
33715 below.
33716 @end table
33717
33718 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
33719 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
33720
33721 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
33722 target has previously requested.
33723
33724 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
33725 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
33726 will be empty.
33727
33728 Reply:
33729 @table @samp
33730 @item OK
33731 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
33732 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
33733 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
33734 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
33735 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
33736 @end table
33737
33738 @item qTBuffer
33739 @item QTBuffer
33740 @item QTDisconnected
33741 @itemx QTDP
33742 @itemx QTDPsrc
33743 @itemx QTDV
33744 @itemx qTfP
33745 @itemx qTfV
33746 @itemx QTFrame
33747 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
33748
33749 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
33750 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
33751 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
33752 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
33753 the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID;
33754 see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This
33755 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
33756 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
33757 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
33758 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
33759 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
33760
33761 Reply:
33762 @table @samp
33763 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
33764 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
33765 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
33766 the thread's attributes.
33767 @end table
33768
33769 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
33770 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
33771 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
33772 packets.)
33773
33774 @item QTSave
33775 @item qTsP
33776 @item qTsV
33777 @itemx QTStart
33778 @itemx QTStop
33779 @itemx QTinit
33780 @itemx QTro
33781 @itemx qTStatus
33782 @itemx qTV
33783 @itemx qTfSTM
33784 @itemx qTsSTM
33785 @itemx qTSTMat
33786 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
33787
33788 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
33789 @cindex read special object, remote request
33790 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
33791 @anchor{qXfer read}
33792 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
33793 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
33794 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
33795 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
33796 additional details about what data to access.
33797
33798 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
33799 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
33800 formats, listed below.
33801
33802 @table @samp
33803 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33804 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
33805 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
33806 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
33807
33808 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33809 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33810
33811 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
33812 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
33813 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
33814 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
33815 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
33816
33817 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33818 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33819
33820 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
33821 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
33822 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
33823 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
33824 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
33825
33826 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
33827 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
33828 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
33829
33830 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33831 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33832
33833 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33834 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
33835 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
33836 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
33837 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
33838
33839 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33840 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33841
33842 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33843 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
33844
33845 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
33846 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
33847 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
33848 Action Lists}.
33849
33850 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33851 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
33852 (@pxref{qSupported}).
33853
33854 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33855 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
33856 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
33857 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
33858 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
33859
33860 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33861 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
33862 (@pxref{qSupported}).
33863
33864 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
33865 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
33866 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
33867 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
33868 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
33869 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
33870 in that context to be accessed.
33871
33872 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33873 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
33874 (@pxref{qSupported}).
33875
33876 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33877 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
33878 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
33879 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
33880 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
33881
33882 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33883 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33884
33885 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33886 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
33887
33888 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
33889 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
33890 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
33891
33892 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33893 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33894
33895 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33896 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
33897 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
33898 @xref{Operating System Information}.
33899
33900 @end table
33901
33902 Reply:
33903 @table @samp
33904 @item m @var{data}
33905 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
33906 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
33907 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
33908 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
33909 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
33910 request.
33911
33912 @item l @var{data}
33913 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
33914 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
33915 than the @var{length} in the request.
33916
33917 @item l
33918 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
33919 There is no more data to be read.
33920
33921 @item E00
33922 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
33923
33924 @item E @var{nn}
33925 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
33926 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
33927
33928 @item
33929 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
33930 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
33931 @end table
33932
33933 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
33934 @cindex write data into object, remote request
33935 @anchor{qXfer write}
33936 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
33937 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
33938 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
33939 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
33940 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
33941 to access.
33942
33943 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
33944 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
33945 formats, listed below.
33946
33947 @table @samp
33948 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
33949 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
33950 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
33951 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
33952 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
33953
33954 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33955 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
33956 (@pxref{qSupported}).
33957
33958 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
33959 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
33960 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
33961 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
33962 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
33963 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
33964 in that context to be accessed.
33965
33966 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33967 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33968 @end table
33969
33970 Reply:
33971 @table @samp
33972 @item @var{nn}
33973 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
33974 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
33975
33976 @item E00
33977 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
33978
33979 @item E @var{nn}
33980 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
33981 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
33982
33983 @item
33984 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
33985 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
33986 @end table
33987
33988 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
33989 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
33990 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
33991 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
33992 must respond with an empty packet.
33993
33994 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
33995 @cindex query attached, remote request
33996 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
33997 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
33998 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
33999 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
34000 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
34001 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
34002 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
34003
34004 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
34005 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
34006 the @code{quit} command.
34007
34008 Reply:
34009 @table @samp
34010 @item 1
34011 The remote server attached to an existing process.
34012 @item 0
34013 The remote server created a new process.
34014 @item E @var{NN}
34015 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
34016 @end table
34017
34018 @end table
34019
34020 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
34021 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
34022
34023 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
34024 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
34025 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
34026
34027 @subsection ARM
34028
34029 @subsubsection Breakpoint Kinds
34030
34031 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
34032
34033 @table @r
34034
34035 @item 2
34036 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
34037
34038 @item 3
34039 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
34040
34041 @item 4
34042 32-bit ARM mode breakpoint.
34043
34044 @end table
34045
34046 @subsection MIPS
34047
34048 @subsubsection Register Packet Format
34049
34050 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
34051 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
34052 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
34053 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
34054 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
34055 most-significant - least-significant.
34056
34057 @table @r
34058
34059 @item MIPS32
34060
34061 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
34062 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
34063 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
34064
34065 @item MIPS64
34066
34067 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
34068 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
34069 as @code{MIPS32}.
34070
34071 @end table
34072
34073 @node Tracepoint Packets
34074 @section Tracepoint Packets
34075 @cindex tracepoint packets
34076 @cindex packets, tracepoint
34077
34078 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
34079 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
34080
34081 @table @samp
34082
34083 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
34084 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
34085 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
34086 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
34087 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
34088 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
34089 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
34090 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
34091 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
34092 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
34093 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
34094 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
34095 actions.
34096
34097 Replies:
34098 @table @samp
34099 @item OK
34100 The packet was understood and carried out.
34101 @item qRelocInsn
34102 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
34103 @item
34104 The packet was not recognized.
34105 @end table
34106
34107 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
34108 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
34109 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
34110 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
34111 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
34112 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
34113 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
34114
34115 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
34116 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
34117 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
34118 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
34119 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
34120 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
34121 tracepoint actions.
34122
34123 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
34124 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
34125 following forms:
34126
34127 @table @samp
34128
34129 @item R @var{mask}
34130 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
34131 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
34132 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
34133 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
34134 not fit in a 32-bit word.
34135
34136 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
34137 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
34138 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
34139 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
34140 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
34141 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
34142 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
34143
34144 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
34145 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
34146 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
34147 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
34148 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
34149 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
34150 packet).
34151
34152 @end table
34153
34154 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
34155 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
34156 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
34157 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
34158 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
34159 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
34160 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
34161 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
34162
34163 Replies:
34164 @table @samp
34165 @item OK
34166 The packet was understood and carried out.
34167 @item qRelocInsn
34168 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
34169 @item
34170 The packet was not recognized.
34171 @end table
34172
34173 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
34174 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
34175 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
34176 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
34177 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. @var{type}
34178 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
34179 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
34180 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
34181
34182 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
34183 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
34184 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
34185 fit in a single packet.
34186 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
34187 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
34188
34189 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
34190 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
34191 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
34192 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
34193
34194 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
34195 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
34196 query packets.
34197
34198 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
34199 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
34200 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
34201 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
34202 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
34203 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
34204 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
34205 be found.
34206
34207 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}
34208 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
34209 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
34210 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
34211 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
34212 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
34213 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
34214 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
34215 mentioned in expressions.
34216
34217 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
34218 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
34219 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
34220 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
34221
34222 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
34223 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
34224 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
34225 one of the following forms:
34226
34227 @table @samp
34228 @item F @var{f}
34229 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
34230 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
34231 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
34232
34233 @item T @var{t}
34234 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
34235 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
34236
34237 @end table
34238
34239 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
34240 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
34241 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
34242 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
34243
34244 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
34245 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
34246 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
34247 is a hexadecimal number.
34248
34249 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
34250 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
34251 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
34252 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
34253 numbers.
34254
34255 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
34256 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
34257 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
34258
34259 @item QTStart
34260 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
34261 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
34262 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
34263 instruction reply packet}).
34264
34265 @item QTStop
34266 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
34267
34268 @item QTinit
34269 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
34270
34271 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
34272 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
34273 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
34274 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
34275
34276 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
34277 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
34278 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
34279 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
34280
34281 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
34282 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
34283 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
34284 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
34285 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
34286
34287 @item qTStatus
34288 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
34289
34290 The reply has the form:
34291
34292 @table @samp
34293
34294 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
34295 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
34296 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
34297 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
34298
34299 @end table
34300
34301 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
34302 explanations as one of the optional fields:
34303
34304 @table @samp
34305
34306 @item tnotrun:0
34307 No trace has been run yet.
34308
34309 @item tstop:0
34310 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command.
34311
34312 @item tfull:0
34313 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
34314
34315 @item tdisconnected:0
34316 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
34317
34318 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
34319 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
34320
34321 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
34322 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
34323 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
34324 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression).
34325 @var{text} is hex encoded.
34326
34327 @item tunknown:0
34328 The trace stopped for some other reason.
34329
34330 @end table
34331
34332 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
34333 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
34334 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
34335 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
34336 trace.
34337
34338 @table @samp
34339
34340 @item tframes:@var{n}
34341 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
34342
34343 @item tcreated:@var{n}
34344 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
34345 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
34346
34347 @item tsize:@var{n}
34348 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
34349
34350 @item tfree:@var{n}
34351 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
34352
34353 @item circular:@var{n}
34354 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
34355 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
34356 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
34357 and may fill up.
34358
34359 @item disconn:@var{n}
34360 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
34361 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
34362 that the trace run will stop.
34363
34364 @end table
34365
34366 @item qTV:@var{var}
34367 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
34368 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
34369 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
34370
34371 Replies:
34372 @table @samp
34373 @item V@var{value}
34374 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
34375 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
34376 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
34377 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
34378 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
34379 program is running.
34380
34381 @item U
34382 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
34383 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
34384 was not collected.
34385 @end table
34386
34387 @item qTfP
34388 @itemx qTsP
34389 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
34390 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
34391 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
34392 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
34393 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
34394
34395 @item qTfV
34396 @itemx qTsV
34397 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
34398 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
34399 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
34400 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
34401 trace state variables.
34402
34403 @item qTfSTM
34404 @itemx qTsSTM
34405 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
34406 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
34407 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
34408 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
34409
34410 Reply:
34411 @table @samp
34412 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
34413 A single marker
34414 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
34415 a comma-separated list of markers
34416 @item l
34417 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
34418 @item E @var{nn}
34419 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
34420 @item
34421 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
34422 stub.
34423 @end table
34424
34425 @var{address} is encoded in hex.
34426 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
34427
34428 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
34429 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
34430 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
34431 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
34432 @dfn{last}).
34433
34434 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
34435 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
34436 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
34437 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
34438 tracepoint markers.
34439
34440 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
34441 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
34442 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. @var{filename} is encoded
34443 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
34444 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
34445
34446 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
34447 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
34448 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
34449 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
34450 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
34451 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
34452 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
34453 available.
34454
34455 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
34456 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
34457 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
34458
34459 @end table
34460
34461 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
34462 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
34463 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
34464 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
34465 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
34466 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
34467 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
34468 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
34469 it had executed in the original location.
34470
34471 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
34472 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
34473 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
34474 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
34475 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
34476 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
34477 format of the request is:
34478
34479 @table @samp
34480 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
34481
34482 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
34483 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
34484 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
34485 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
34486 memory starting at @var{to}.
34487 @end table
34488
34489 Replies:
34490 @table @samp
34491 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
34492 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. @var{adjusted_size} is
34493 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
34494 @item E @var{NN}
34495 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
34496 relocating the instruction.
34497 @end table
34498
34499 @node Host I/O Packets
34500 @section Host I/O Packets
34501 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
34502 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
34503
34504 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
34505 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
34506 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
34507 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
34508 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
34509 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
34510 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
34511 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
34512 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
34513 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
34514
34515 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
34516 its arguments. They have this format:
34517
34518 @table @samp
34519
34520 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
34521 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
34522 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
34523 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
34524 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
34525 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
34526 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
34527 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
34528 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
34529
34530 @end table
34531
34532 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
34533
34534 @table @samp
34535
34536 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
34537 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
34538 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
34539 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
34540 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
34541 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
34542 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
34543 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
34544 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
34545 @var{attachment}.
34546
34547 @item
34548 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
34549
34550 @end table
34551
34552 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
34553
34554 @table @samp
34555 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
34556 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
34557 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
34558 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
34559 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
34560 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
34561 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
34562
34563 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
34564 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
34565 -1 if an error occurs.
34566
34567 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
34568 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
34569 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
34570 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
34571 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
34572 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
34573 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
34574 @var{count} was zero.
34575
34576 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
34577 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
34578 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
34579 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
34580 some characters were escaped.
34581
34582 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
34583 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
34584 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
34585 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
34586 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
34587 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
34588 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
34589 error occurred.
34590
34591 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
34592 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
34593 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
34594
34595 @end table
34596
34597 @node Interrupts
34598 @section Interrupts
34599 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
34600
34601 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
34602 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
34603 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
34604 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
34605
34606 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
34607 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
34608 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
34609 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
34610 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
34611
34612 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
34613 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
34614 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
34615 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
34616 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
34617 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
34618 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
34619 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
34620
34621 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
34622 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
34623 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
34624
34625 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
34626 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
34627 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
34628 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
34629 currently-executing threads and processes.
34630 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
34631 running program, it should send one of the stop
34632 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
34633 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
34634 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
34635 Interrupts received while the
34636 program is stopped are discarded.
34637
34638 @node Notification Packets
34639 @section Notification Packets
34640 @cindex notification packets
34641 @cindex packets, notification
34642
34643 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
34644 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
34645 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
34646 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
34647 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
34648 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
34649 is not a problem.
34650
34651 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
34652 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
34653 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
34654 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
34655 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
34656 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
34657 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
34658
34659 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
34660 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
34661
34662 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
34663 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
34664 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
34665 not they understand it.
34666
34667 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
34668 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
34669 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
34670 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
34671 recipients.
34672
34673 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
34674 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
34675 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
34676 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
34677 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
34678
34679 The following notification packets from the stub to @value{GDBN} are
34680 defined:
34681
34682 @table @samp
34683 @item Stop: @var{reply}
34684 Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
34685 The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
34686 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
34687 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
34688 @value{GDBN}.
34689 @end table
34690
34691 @node Remote Non-Stop
34692 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
34693
34694 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
34695 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
34696 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
34697 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34698
34699 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
34700 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
34701 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
34702 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
34703 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
34704 probe the target state after a mode change.
34705
34706 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
34707 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
34708 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
34709 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
34710 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
34711 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
34712 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
34713 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
34714 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
34715 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
34716 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
34717
34718 Only one stop reply notification at a time may be pending; if
34719 additional stop events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
34720 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
34721 synchronous transmission in response to @samp{vStopped} packets from
34722 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
34723 the stub is permitted to resend a stop reply notification
34724 if it believes @value{GDBN} may not have received it. @value{GDBN}
34725 ignores additional stop reply notifications received before it has
34726 finished processing a previous notification and the stub has completed
34727 sending any queued stop events.
34728
34729 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} must be prepared to receive a stop reply
34730 notification at any time. Specifically, they may appear when
34731 @value{GDBN} is not otherwise reading input from the stub, or when
34732 @value{GDBN} is expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
34733 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
34734 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
34735 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
34736
34737 After receiving a stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall
34738 acknowledge it by sending a @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{vStopped packet})
34739 as a regular, synchronous request to the stub. Such acknowledgment
34740 is not required to happen immediately, as @value{GDBN} is permitted to
34741 send other, unrelated packets to the stub first, which the stub should
34742 process normally.
34743
34744 Upon receiving a @samp{vStopped} packet, if the stub has other queued
34745 stop events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
34746 normal stop reply response. @value{GDBN} shall then send another
34747 @samp{vStopped} packet to solicit further responses; again, it is
34748 permitted to send other, unrelated packets as well which the stub
34749 should process normally.
34750
34751 If the stub receives a @samp{vStopped} packet and there are no
34752 additional stop events to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK}
34753 response. At this point, if further stop events occur, the stub shall
34754 send a new stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the
34755 notification, and the process shall be repeated.
34756
34757 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
34758 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
34759 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
34760 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
34761 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
34762 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
34763 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
34764 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
34765 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
34766 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
34767 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
34768 @samp{OK}.
34769
34770 @node Packet Acknowledgment
34771 @section Packet Acknowledgment
34772
34773 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
34774 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
34775 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
34776 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
34777 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
34778 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
34779 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
34780
34781 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
34782 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
34783 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
34784 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
34785 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
34786
34787 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
34788 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
34789 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
34790 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
34791
34792 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
34793 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
34794 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
34795 @pxref{qSupported}.
34796 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
34797 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
34798 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
34799 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
34800 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
34801 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
34802 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
34803
34804 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
34805 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
34806 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
34807 connection.
34808 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
34809 new connection is established,
34810 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
34811 for the current connection, once disabled.
34812
34813 @node Examples
34814 @section Examples
34815
34816 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
34817 does not get any direct output:
34818
34819 @smallexample
34820 -> @code{R00}
34821 <- @code{+}
34822 @emph{target restarts}
34823 -> @code{?}
34824 <- @code{+}
34825 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
34826 -> @code{+}
34827 @end smallexample
34828
34829 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
34830
34831 @smallexample
34832 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
34833 <- @code{+}
34834 -> @code{s}
34835 <- @code{+}
34836 @emph{time passes}
34837 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
34838 -> @code{+}
34839 -> @code{g}
34840 <- @code{+}
34841 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
34842 -> @code{+}
34843 @end smallexample
34844
34845 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
34846 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
34847 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
34848
34849 @menu
34850 * File-I/O Overview::
34851 * Protocol Basics::
34852 * The F Request Packet::
34853 * The F Reply Packet::
34854 * The Ctrl-C Message::
34855 * Console I/O::
34856 * List of Supported Calls::
34857 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
34858 * Constants::
34859 * File-I/O Examples::
34860 @end menu
34861
34862 @node File-I/O Overview
34863 @subsection File-I/O Overview
34864 @cindex file-i/o overview
34865
34866 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
34867 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
34868 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
34869 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
34870 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
34871 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
34872
34873 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
34874 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
34875 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
34876 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
34877 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
34878
34879 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
34880 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
34881 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
34882 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
34883 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
34884 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
34885 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
34886
34887 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
34888 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
34889 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
34890 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
34891 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
34892
34893 @smallexample
34894 (@value{GDBP}) continue
34895 <- target requests 'system call X'
34896 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
34897 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
34898 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
34899 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
34900 @end smallexample
34901
34902 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
34903 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
34904 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
34905 system are not supported by this protocol.
34906
34907 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
34908
34909 @node Protocol Basics
34910 @subsection Protocol Basics
34911 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
34912
34913 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
34914 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
34915 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
34916 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
34917 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
34918 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
34919 to call the appropriate host system call:
34920
34921 @itemize @bullet
34922 @item
34923 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
34924
34925 @item
34926 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
34927 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
34928 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
34929 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
34930
34931 @end itemize
34932
34933 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
34934
34935 @itemize @bullet
34936 @item
34937 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
34938 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
34939 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
34940 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
34941 packet.
34942
34943 @item
34944 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
34945 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
34946
34947 @item
34948 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
34949
34950 @item
34951 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
34952
34953 @item
34954 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
34955 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
34956 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
34957 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
34958 packet.
34959
34960 @end itemize
34961
34962 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
34963 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
34964
34965 @itemize @bullet
34966 @item
34967 Return value.
34968
34969 @item
34970 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
34971
34972 @item
34973 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
34974
34975 @end itemize
34976
34977 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
34978 the latest continue or step action.
34979
34980 @node The F Request Packet
34981 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
34982 @cindex file-i/o request packet
34983 @cindex @code{F} request packet
34984
34985 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
34986
34987 @table @samp
34988 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
34989
34990 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
34991 This is just the name of the function.
34992
34993 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
34994 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
34995 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
34996 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
34997 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
34998 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
34999 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
35000
35001 @end table
35002
35003
35004
35005 @node The F Reply Packet
35006 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
35007 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
35008 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
35009
35010 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
35011
35012 @table @samp
35013
35014 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
35015
35016 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
35017
35018 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
35019 representation.
35020 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
35021
35022 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
35023 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
35024 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
35025
35026 @smallexample
35027 F0,0,C
35028 @end smallexample
35029
35030 @noindent
35031 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
35032
35033 @smallexample
35034 F-1,4,C
35035 @end smallexample
35036
35037 @noindent
35038 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
35039
35040 @end table
35041
35042
35043 @node The Ctrl-C Message
35044 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
35045 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
35046
35047 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
35048 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
35049 the target should behave as if it had
35050 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
35051 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
35052 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
35053 packet.
35054
35055 It's important for the target to know in which
35056 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
35057
35058 @itemize @bullet
35059 @item
35060 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
35061
35062 @item
35063 The system call on the host has been finished.
35064
35065 @end itemize
35066
35067 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
35068 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
35069 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
35070 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
35071 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
35072 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
35073
35074 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
35075 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
35076 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
35077 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
35078 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
35079 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
35080 or the full action has been completed.
35081
35082 @node Console I/O
35083 @subsection Console I/O
35084 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
35085
35086 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
35087 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
35088 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
35089 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
35090 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
35091 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
35092 conditions is met:
35093
35094 @itemize @bullet
35095 @item
35096 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
35097 @code{read}
35098 system call is treated as finished.
35099
35100 @item
35101 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
35102 newline.
35103
35104 @item
35105 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
35106 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
35107
35108 @end itemize
35109
35110 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
35111 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
35112 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
35113 is stopped at the user's request.
35114
35115
35116 @node List of Supported Calls
35117 @subsection List of Supported Calls
35118 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
35119
35120 @menu
35121 * open::
35122 * close::
35123 * read::
35124 * write::
35125 * lseek::
35126 * rename::
35127 * unlink::
35128 * stat/fstat::
35129 * gettimeofday::
35130 * isatty::
35131 * system::
35132 @end menu
35133
35134 @node open
35135 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
35136 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
35137
35138 @table @asis
35139 @item Synopsis:
35140 @smallexample
35141 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
35142 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
35143 @end smallexample
35144
35145 @item Request:
35146 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
35147
35148 @noindent
35149 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
35150
35151 @table @code
35152 @item O_CREAT
35153 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
35154 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
35155 are concerned.
35156
35157 @item O_EXCL
35158 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
35159 an error and open() fails.
35160
35161 @item O_TRUNC
35162 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
35163 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
35164 truncated to zero length.
35165
35166 @item O_APPEND
35167 The file is opened in append mode.
35168
35169 @item O_RDONLY
35170 The file is opened for reading only.
35171
35172 @item O_WRONLY
35173 The file is opened for writing only.
35174
35175 @item O_RDWR
35176 The file is opened for reading and writing.
35177 @end table
35178
35179 @noindent
35180 Other bits are silently ignored.
35181
35182
35183 @noindent
35184 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
35185
35186 @table @code
35187 @item S_IRUSR
35188 User has read permission.
35189
35190 @item S_IWUSR
35191 User has write permission.
35192
35193 @item S_IRGRP
35194 Group has read permission.
35195
35196 @item S_IWGRP
35197 Group has write permission.
35198
35199 @item S_IROTH
35200 Others have read permission.
35201
35202 @item S_IWOTH
35203 Others have write permission.
35204 @end table
35205
35206 @noindent
35207 Other bits are silently ignored.
35208
35209
35210 @item Return value:
35211 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
35212 occurred.
35213
35214 @item Errors:
35215
35216 @table @code
35217 @item EEXIST
35218 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
35219
35220 @item EISDIR
35221 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
35222
35223 @item EACCES
35224 The requested access is not allowed.
35225
35226 @item ENAMETOOLONG
35227 @var{pathname} was too long.
35228
35229 @item ENOENT
35230 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
35231
35232 @item ENODEV
35233 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
35234
35235 @item EROFS
35236 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
35237 write access was requested.
35238
35239 @item EFAULT
35240 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
35241
35242 @item ENOSPC
35243 No space on device to create the file.
35244
35245 @item EMFILE
35246 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
35247
35248 @item ENFILE
35249 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
35250 has been reached.
35251
35252 @item EINTR
35253 The call was interrupted by the user.
35254 @end table
35255
35256 @end table
35257
35258 @node close
35259 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
35260 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
35261
35262 @table @asis
35263 @item Synopsis:
35264 @smallexample
35265 int close(int fd);
35266 @end smallexample
35267
35268 @item Request:
35269 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
35270
35271 @item Return value:
35272 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
35273
35274 @item Errors:
35275
35276 @table @code
35277 @item EBADF
35278 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
35279
35280 @item EINTR
35281 The call was interrupted by the user.
35282 @end table
35283
35284 @end table
35285
35286 @node read
35287 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
35288 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
35289
35290 @table @asis
35291 @item Synopsis:
35292 @smallexample
35293 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
35294 @end smallexample
35295
35296 @item Request:
35297 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
35298
35299 @item Return value:
35300 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
35301 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
35302 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
35303
35304 @item Errors:
35305
35306 @table @code
35307 @item EBADF
35308 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
35309 reading.
35310
35311 @item EFAULT
35312 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
35313
35314 @item EINTR
35315 The call was interrupted by the user.
35316 @end table
35317
35318 @end table
35319
35320 @node write
35321 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
35322 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
35323
35324 @table @asis
35325 @item Synopsis:
35326 @smallexample
35327 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
35328 @end smallexample
35329
35330 @item Request:
35331 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
35332
35333 @item Return value:
35334 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
35335 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
35336 is returned.
35337
35338 @item Errors:
35339
35340 @table @code
35341 @item EBADF
35342 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
35343 writing.
35344
35345 @item EFAULT
35346 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
35347
35348 @item EFBIG
35349 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
35350 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
35351
35352 @item ENOSPC
35353 No space on device to write the data.
35354
35355 @item EINTR
35356 The call was interrupted by the user.
35357 @end table
35358
35359 @end table
35360
35361 @node lseek
35362 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
35363 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
35364
35365 @table @asis
35366 @item Synopsis:
35367 @smallexample
35368 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
35369 @end smallexample
35370
35371 @item Request:
35372 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
35373
35374 @var{flag} is one of:
35375
35376 @table @code
35377 @item SEEK_SET
35378 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
35379
35380 @item SEEK_CUR
35381 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
35382 bytes.
35383
35384 @item SEEK_END
35385 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
35386 bytes.
35387 @end table
35388
35389 @item Return value:
35390 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
35391 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
35392 value of -1 is returned.
35393
35394 @item Errors:
35395
35396 @table @code
35397 @item EBADF
35398 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
35399
35400 @item ESPIPE
35401 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
35402
35403 @item EINVAL
35404 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
35405
35406 @item EINTR
35407 The call was interrupted by the user.
35408 @end table
35409
35410 @end table
35411
35412 @node rename
35413 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
35414 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
35415
35416 @table @asis
35417 @item Synopsis:
35418 @smallexample
35419 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
35420 @end smallexample
35421
35422 @item Request:
35423 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
35424
35425 @item Return value:
35426 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
35427
35428 @item Errors:
35429
35430 @table @code
35431 @item EISDIR
35432 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
35433 directory.
35434
35435 @item EEXIST
35436 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
35437
35438 @item EBUSY
35439 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
35440 process.
35441
35442 @item EINVAL
35443 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
35444 of itself.
35445
35446 @item ENOTDIR
35447 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
35448 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
35449 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
35450
35451 @item EFAULT
35452 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
35453
35454 @item EACCES
35455 No access to the file or the path of the file.
35456
35457 @item ENAMETOOLONG
35458
35459 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
35460
35461 @item ENOENT
35462 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
35463
35464 @item EROFS
35465 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
35466
35467 @item ENOSPC
35468 The device containing the file has no room for the new
35469 directory entry.
35470
35471 @item EINTR
35472 The call was interrupted by the user.
35473 @end table
35474
35475 @end table
35476
35477 @node unlink
35478 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
35479 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
35480
35481 @table @asis
35482 @item Synopsis:
35483 @smallexample
35484 int unlink(const char *pathname);
35485 @end smallexample
35486
35487 @item Request:
35488 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
35489
35490 @item Return value:
35491 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
35492
35493 @item Errors:
35494
35495 @table @code
35496 @item EACCES
35497 No access to the file or the path of the file.
35498
35499 @item EPERM
35500 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
35501
35502 @item EBUSY
35503 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
35504 being used by another process.
35505
35506 @item EFAULT
35507 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
35508
35509 @item ENAMETOOLONG
35510 @var{pathname} was too long.
35511
35512 @item ENOENT
35513 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
35514
35515 @item ENOTDIR
35516 A component of the path is not a directory.
35517
35518 @item EROFS
35519 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
35520
35521 @item EINTR
35522 The call was interrupted by the user.
35523 @end table
35524
35525 @end table
35526
35527 @node stat/fstat
35528 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
35529 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
35530 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
35531
35532 @table @asis
35533 @item Synopsis:
35534 @smallexample
35535 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
35536 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
35537 @end smallexample
35538
35539 @item Request:
35540 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
35541 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
35542
35543 @item Return value:
35544 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
35545
35546 @item Errors:
35547
35548 @table @code
35549 @item EBADF
35550 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
35551
35552 @item ENOENT
35553 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
35554 path is an empty string.
35555
35556 @item ENOTDIR
35557 A component of the path is not a directory.
35558
35559 @item EFAULT
35560 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
35561
35562 @item EACCES
35563 No access to the file or the path of the file.
35564
35565 @item ENAMETOOLONG
35566 @var{pathname} was too long.
35567
35568 @item EINTR
35569 The call was interrupted by the user.
35570 @end table
35571
35572 @end table
35573
35574 @node gettimeofday
35575 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
35576 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
35577
35578 @table @asis
35579 @item Synopsis:
35580 @smallexample
35581 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
35582 @end smallexample
35583
35584 @item Request:
35585 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
35586
35587 @item Return value:
35588 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
35589
35590 @item Errors:
35591
35592 @table @code
35593 @item EINVAL
35594 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
35595
35596 @item EFAULT
35597 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
35598 @end table
35599
35600 @end table
35601
35602 @node isatty
35603 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
35604 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
35605
35606 @table @asis
35607 @item Synopsis:
35608 @smallexample
35609 int isatty(int fd);
35610 @end smallexample
35611
35612 @item Request:
35613 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
35614
35615 @item Return value:
35616 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
35617
35618 @item Errors:
35619
35620 @table @code
35621 @item EINTR
35622 The call was interrupted by the user.
35623 @end table
35624
35625 @end table
35626
35627 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
35628 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
35629 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
35630 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
35631 needed.
35632
35633
35634 @node system
35635 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
35636 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
35637
35638 @table @asis
35639 @item Synopsis:
35640 @smallexample
35641 int system(const char *command);
35642 @end smallexample
35643
35644 @item Request:
35645 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
35646
35647 @item Return value:
35648 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
35649 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
35650 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
35651 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
35652 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
35653 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
35654 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
35655
35656 @item Errors:
35657
35658 @table @code
35659 @item EINTR
35660 The call was interrupted by the user.
35661 @end table
35662
35663 @end table
35664
35665 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
35666 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
35667 the host is simplified before it's returned
35668 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
35669 is discarded, and the return value consists
35670 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
35671
35672 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
35673 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
35674 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
35675
35676 @table @code
35677 @item set remote system-call-allowed
35678 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
35679 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
35680 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
35681
35682 @item show remote system-call-allowed
35683 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
35684 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
35685 protocol.
35686 @end table
35687
35688 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
35689 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
35690 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
35691
35692 @menu
35693 * Integral Datatypes::
35694 * Pointer Values::
35695 * Memory Transfer::
35696 * struct stat::
35697 * struct timeval::
35698 @end menu
35699
35700 @node Integral Datatypes
35701 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
35702 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
35703
35704 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
35705 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
35706 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
35707
35708 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
35709 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
35710
35711 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
35712
35713 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
35714 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
35715
35716 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
35717
35718 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
35719 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
35720 byte order.
35721
35722 @node Pointer Values
35723 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
35724 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
35725
35726 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
35727 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
35728 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
35729 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
35730
35731 @smallexample
35732 @code{1aaf/12}
35733 @end smallexample
35734
35735 @noindent
35736 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
35737 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
35738 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
35739 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
35740
35741 @smallexample
35742 @code{123456/d}
35743 @end smallexample
35744
35745 @node Memory Transfer
35746 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
35747 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
35748
35749 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
35750 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
35751 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
35752 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
35753 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
35754 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
35755 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
35756
35757
35758 @node struct stat
35759 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
35760 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
35761
35762 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
35763 is defined as follows:
35764
35765 @smallexample
35766 struct stat @{
35767 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
35768 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
35769 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
35770 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
35771 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
35772 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
35773 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
35774 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
35775 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
35776 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
35777 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
35778 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
35779 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
35780 @};
35781 @end smallexample
35782
35783 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
35784 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
35785 structure is of size 64 bytes.
35786
35787 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
35788 range of values.
35789
35790 @table @code
35791
35792 @item st_dev
35793 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
35794
35795 @item st_ino
35796 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
35797
35798 @item st_mode
35799 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
35800 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
35801
35802 @item st_uid
35803 @itemx st_gid
35804 @itemx st_rdev
35805 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
35806
35807 @item st_atime
35808 @itemx st_mtime
35809 @itemx st_ctime
35810 These values have a host and file system dependent
35811 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
35812 support exact timing values.
35813 @end table
35814
35815 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
35816 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
35817 continuing.
35818
35819 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
35820 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
35821 get truncated on the target.
35822
35823 @node struct timeval
35824 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
35825 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
35826
35827 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
35828 is defined as follows:
35829
35830 @smallexample
35831 struct timeval @{
35832 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
35833 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
35834 @};
35835 @end smallexample
35836
35837 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
35838 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
35839 structure is of size 8 bytes.
35840
35841 @node Constants
35842 @subsection Constants
35843 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
35844
35845 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
35846 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
35847 values before and after the call as needed.
35848
35849 @menu
35850 * Open Flags::
35851 * mode_t Values::
35852 * Errno Values::
35853 * Lseek Flags::
35854 * Limits::
35855 @end menu
35856
35857 @node Open Flags
35858 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
35859 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
35860
35861 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
35862
35863 @smallexample
35864 O_RDONLY 0x0
35865 O_WRONLY 0x1
35866 O_RDWR 0x2
35867 O_APPEND 0x8
35868 O_CREAT 0x200
35869 O_TRUNC 0x400
35870 O_EXCL 0x800
35871 @end smallexample
35872
35873 @node mode_t Values
35874 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
35875 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
35876
35877 All values are given in octal representation.
35878
35879 @smallexample
35880 S_IFREG 0100000
35881 S_IFDIR 040000
35882 S_IRUSR 0400
35883 S_IWUSR 0200
35884 S_IXUSR 0100
35885 S_IRGRP 040
35886 S_IWGRP 020
35887 S_IXGRP 010
35888 S_IROTH 04
35889 S_IWOTH 02
35890 S_IXOTH 01
35891 @end smallexample
35892
35893 @node Errno Values
35894 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
35895 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
35896
35897 All values are given in decimal representation.
35898
35899 @smallexample
35900 EPERM 1
35901 ENOENT 2
35902 EINTR 4
35903 EBADF 9
35904 EACCES 13
35905 EFAULT 14
35906 EBUSY 16
35907 EEXIST 17
35908 ENODEV 19
35909 ENOTDIR 20
35910 EISDIR 21
35911 EINVAL 22
35912 ENFILE 23
35913 EMFILE 24
35914 EFBIG 27
35915 ENOSPC 28
35916 ESPIPE 29
35917 EROFS 30
35918 ENAMETOOLONG 91
35919 EUNKNOWN 9999
35920 @end smallexample
35921
35922 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
35923 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
35924
35925 @node Lseek Flags
35926 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
35927 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
35928
35929 @smallexample
35930 SEEK_SET 0
35931 SEEK_CUR 1
35932 SEEK_END 2
35933 @end smallexample
35934
35935 @node Limits
35936 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
35937 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
35938
35939 All values are given in decimal representation.
35940
35941 @smallexample
35942 INT_MIN -2147483648
35943 INT_MAX 2147483647
35944 UINT_MAX 4294967295
35945 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
35946 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
35947 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
35948 @end smallexample
35949
35950 @node File-I/O Examples
35951 @subsection File-I/O Examples
35952 @cindex file-i/o examples
35953
35954 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
35955 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
35956
35957 @smallexample
35958 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
35959 @emph{request memory read from target}
35960 -> @code{m1234,6}
35961 <- XXXXXX
35962 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
35963 -> @code{F6}
35964 @end smallexample
35965
35966 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
35967 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
35968
35969 @smallexample
35970 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
35971 @emph{request memory write to target}
35972 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
35973 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
35974 -> @code{F6}
35975 @end smallexample
35976
35977 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
35978 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
35979
35980 @smallexample
35981 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
35982 -> @code{F-1,9}
35983 @end smallexample
35984
35985 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
35986 host is called:
35987
35988 @smallexample
35989 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
35990 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
35991 <- @code{T02}
35992 @end smallexample
35993
35994 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
35995 host is called:
35996
35997 @smallexample
35998 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
35999 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
36000 <- @code{T02}
36001 @end smallexample
36002
36003 @node Library List Format
36004 @section Library List Format
36005 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
36006
36007 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
36008 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
36009 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
36010 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
36011 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
36012 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
36013 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
36014 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
36015 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
36016 are loaded.
36017
36018 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
36019 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
36020 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
36021 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
36022
36023 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
36024 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
36025 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
36026 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
36027 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
36028 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
36029
36030 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
36031 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
36032
36033 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
36034 offset, looks like this:
36035
36036 @smallexample
36037 <library-list>
36038 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
36039 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
36040 </library>
36041 </library-list>
36042 @end smallexample
36043
36044 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
36045 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
36046
36047 @smallexample
36048 <library-list>
36049 <library name="sharedlib.o">
36050 <section address="0x10000000"/>
36051 <section address="0x20000000"/>
36052 <section address="0x30000000"/>
36053 </library>
36054 </library-list>
36055 @end smallexample
36056
36057 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
36058
36059 @smallexample
36060 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
36061 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
36062 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
36063 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
36064 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
36065 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
36066 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
36067 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
36068 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
36069 @end smallexample
36070
36071 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
36072 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
36073 section for each library.
36074
36075 @node Memory Map Format
36076 @section Memory Map Format
36077 @cindex memory map format
36078
36079 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
36080 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
36081 memory map.
36082
36083 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
36084 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
36085 lists memory regions.
36086
36087 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
36088 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
36089
36090 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
36091
36092 @smallexample
36093 <?xml version="1.0"?>
36094 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
36095 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
36096 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
36097 <memory-map>
36098 region...
36099 </memory-map>
36100 @end smallexample
36101
36102 Each region can be either:
36103
36104 @itemize
36105
36106 @item
36107 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
36108 bytes from there:
36109
36110 @smallexample
36111 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
36112 @end smallexample
36113
36114
36115 @item
36116 A region of read-only memory:
36117
36118 @smallexample
36119 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
36120 @end smallexample
36121
36122
36123 @item
36124 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
36125 bytes in length:
36126
36127 @smallexample
36128 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
36129 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
36130 </memory>
36131 @end smallexample
36132
36133 @end itemize
36134
36135 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
36136 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
36137 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
36138
36139 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
36140
36141 @smallexample
36142 <!-- ................................................... -->
36143 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
36144 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
36145 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
36146 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
36147 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
36148 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
36149 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
36150 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
36151 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
36152 and its type, or device. -->
36153 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
36154 start CDATA #REQUIRED
36155 length CDATA #REQUIRED
36156 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
36157 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
36158 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
36159 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
36160 @end smallexample
36161
36162 @node Thread List Format
36163 @section Thread List Format
36164 @cindex thread list format
36165
36166 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
36167 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
36168 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
36169 the following structure:
36170
36171 @smallexample
36172 <?xml version="1.0"?>
36173 <threads>
36174 <thread id="id" core="0">
36175 ... description ...
36176 </thread>
36177 </threads>
36178 @end smallexample
36179
36180 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
36181 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
36182 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
36183 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
36184 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
36185
36186 @node Traceframe Info Format
36187 @section Traceframe Info Format
36188 @cindex traceframe info format
36189
36190 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
36191 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
36192 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
36193 collected in a traceframe.
36194
36195 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36196 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
36197
36198 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
36199 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
36200
36201 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
36202
36203 @smallexample
36204 <?xml version="1.0"?>
36205 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
36206 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
36207 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
36208 <traceframe-info>
36209 block...
36210 </traceframe-info>
36211 @end smallexample
36212
36213 Each traceframe block can be either:
36214
36215 @itemize
36216
36217 @item
36218 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
36219 @var{length} bytes from there:
36220
36221 @smallexample
36222 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
36223 @end smallexample
36224
36225 @end itemize
36226
36227 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
36228
36229 @smallexample
36230 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory)* >
36231 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
36232
36233 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
36234 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
36235 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
36236 @end smallexample
36237
36238 @include agentexpr.texi
36239
36240 @node Target Descriptions
36241 @appendix Target Descriptions
36242 @cindex target descriptions
36243
36244 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
36245 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
36246 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
36247
36248 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
36249 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
36250 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
36251 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
36252 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
36253 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
36254 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
36255
36256 @itemize @bullet
36257 @item
36258 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
36259 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
36260 @item
36261 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
36262 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
36263 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
36264 @item
36265 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
36266 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
36267 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
36268 @end itemize
36269
36270 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
36271 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
36272 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
36273 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
36274 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
36275
36276 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
36277 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
36278
36279 @menu
36280 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
36281 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
36282 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
36283 descriptions.
36284 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
36285 @end menu
36286
36287 @node Retrieving Descriptions
36288 @section Retrieving Descriptions
36289
36290 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
36291 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
36292 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
36293 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
36294 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
36295 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
36296 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
36297 Format}.
36298
36299 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
36300 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
36301 specify a file are:
36302
36303 @table @code
36304 @cindex set tdesc filename
36305 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
36306 Read the target description from @var{path}.
36307
36308 @cindex unset tdesc filename
36309 @item unset tdesc filename
36310 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
36311 will use the description supplied by the current target.
36312
36313 @cindex show tdesc filename
36314 @item show tdesc filename
36315 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
36316 @end table
36317
36318
36319 @node Target Description Format
36320 @section Target Description Format
36321 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
36322
36323 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
36324 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
36325 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
36326 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
36327 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
36328 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
36329 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
36330
36331 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
36332 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
36333 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
36334 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
36335 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
36336
36337 Here is a simple target description:
36338
36339 @smallexample
36340 <target version="1.0">
36341 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
36342 </target>
36343 @end smallexample
36344
36345 @noindent
36346 This minimal description only says that the target uses
36347 the x86-64 architecture.
36348
36349 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
36350 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
36351 are explained further below.
36352
36353 @smallexample
36354 <?xml version="1.0"?>
36355 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
36356 <target version="1.0">
36357 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
36358 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
36359 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
36360 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
36361 </target>
36362 @end smallexample
36363
36364 @noindent
36365 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
36366 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
36367 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
36368 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
36369 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
36370 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
36371 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
36372 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
36373 the version mismatch.
36374
36375 @subsection Inclusion
36376 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
36377 @cindex XInclude
36378 @ifnotinfo
36379 @cindex <xi:include>
36380 @end ifnotinfo
36381
36382 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
36383 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
36384 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
36385 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
36386 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
36387
36388 @smallexample
36389 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
36390 @end smallexample
36391
36392 @noindent
36393 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
36394 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
36395 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
36396 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
36397 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
36398 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
36399 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
36400 original description.
36401
36402 @subsection Architecture
36403 @cindex <architecture>
36404
36405 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
36406
36407 @smallexample
36408 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
36409 @end smallexample
36410
36411 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
36412 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
36413
36414 @subsection OS ABI
36415 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
36416
36417 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
36418 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
36419
36420 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
36421
36422 @smallexample
36423 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
36424 @end smallexample
36425
36426 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
36427 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
36428
36429 @subsection Compatible Architecture
36430 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
36431
36432 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
36433 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
36434
36435 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
36436
36437 @smallexample
36438 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
36439 @end smallexample
36440
36441 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
36442 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
36443
36444 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
36445 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
36446 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
36447 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
36448 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
36449 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
36450 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
36451
36452 @smallexample
36453 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
36454 <compatible>spu</compatible>
36455 @end smallexample
36456
36457 @subsection Features
36458 @cindex <feature>
36459
36460 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
36461 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
36462 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
36463 has this form:
36464
36465 @smallexample
36466 <feature name="@var{name}">
36467 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
36468 @var{reg}@dots{}
36469 </feature>
36470 @end smallexample
36471
36472 @noindent
36473 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
36474 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
36475 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
36476 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
36477
36478 @subsection Types
36479
36480 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
36481 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
36482 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
36483 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
36484 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
36485
36486 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
36487 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
36488 Types must be defined before they are used.
36489
36490 @cindex <vector>
36491 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
36492 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
36493 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
36494 @var{count}:
36495
36496 @smallexample
36497 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
36498 @end smallexample
36499
36500 @cindex <union>
36501 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
36502 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
36503 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
36504 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
36505
36506 @smallexample
36507 <union id="@var{id}">
36508 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
36509 @dots{}
36510 </union>
36511 @end smallexample
36512
36513 @cindex <struct>
36514 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
36515 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
36516 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
36517 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
36518 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
36519 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
36520 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
36521 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
36522
36523 @smallexample
36524 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
36525 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
36526 @dots{}
36527 </struct>
36528 @end smallexample
36529
36530 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
36531 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
36532
36533 @smallexample
36534 <struct id="@var{id}">
36535 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
36536 @dots{}
36537 </struct>
36538 @end smallexample
36539
36540 @cindex <flags>
36541 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
36542 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
36543 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
36544 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
36545 are supported.
36546
36547 @smallexample
36548 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
36549 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
36550 @dots{}
36551 </flags>
36552 @end smallexample
36553
36554 @subsection Registers
36555 @cindex <reg>
36556
36557 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
36558
36559 @smallexample
36560 <reg name="@var{name}"
36561 bitsize="@var{size}"
36562 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
36563 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
36564 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
36565 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
36566 @end smallexample
36567
36568 @noindent
36569 The components are as follows:
36570
36571 @table @var
36572
36573 @item name
36574 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
36575
36576 @item bitsize
36577 The register's size, in bits.
36578
36579 @item regnum
36580 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
36581 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
36582 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
36583 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
36584 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
36585 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
36586 in order of increasing register number.
36587
36588 @item save-restore
36589 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
36590 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
36591 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
36592 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
36593 ABI.
36594
36595 @item type
36596 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
36597 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
36598 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
36599 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
36600 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
36601 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
36602
36603 @item group
36604 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
36605 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
36606 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
36607 in @code{info registers}.
36608
36609 @end table
36610
36611 @node Predefined Target Types
36612 @section Predefined Target Types
36613 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
36614
36615 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
36616 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
36617 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
36618 types. The currently supported types are:
36619
36620 @table @code
36621
36622 @item int8
36623 @itemx int16
36624 @itemx int32
36625 @itemx int64
36626 @itemx int128
36627 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
36628
36629 @item uint8
36630 @itemx uint16
36631 @itemx uint32
36632 @itemx uint64
36633 @itemx uint128
36634 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
36635
36636 @item code_ptr
36637 @itemx data_ptr
36638 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
36639 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
36640 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
36641 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
36642 may be marked as data pointers.
36643
36644 @item ieee_single
36645 Single precision IEEE floating point.
36646
36647 @item ieee_double
36648 Double precision IEEE floating point.
36649
36650 @item arm_fpa_ext
36651 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
36652
36653 @item i387_ext
36654 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
36655
36656 @item i386_eflags
36657 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
36658
36659 @item i386_mxcsr
36660 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
36661
36662 @end table
36663
36664 @node Standard Target Features
36665 @section Standard Target Features
36666 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
36667
36668 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
36669 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
36670 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
36671 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
36672 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
36673 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
36674 can recognize them.
36675
36676 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
36677 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
36678 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
36679 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
36680 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
36681 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
36682 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
36683 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
36684
36685 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
36686 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
36687 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
36688
36689 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
36690 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
36691 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
36692 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
36693
36694 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
36695 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
36696 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
36697
36698 @menu
36699 * ARM Features::
36700 * i386 Features::
36701 * MIPS Features::
36702 * M68K Features::
36703 * PowerPC Features::
36704 @end menu
36705
36706
36707 @node ARM Features
36708 @subsection ARM Features
36709 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
36710
36711 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
36712 ARM targets.
36713 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
36714 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
36715
36716 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
36717 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
36718 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
36719 and @samp{xpsr}.
36720
36721 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
36722 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
36723
36724 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
36725 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
36726 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
36727 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
36728
36729 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
36730 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
36731 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
36732 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
36733 halves of the double-precision registers.
36734
36735 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
36736 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
36737 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
36738 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
36739 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
36740 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
36741
36742 @node i386 Features
36743 @subsection i386 Features
36744 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
36745
36746 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
36747 targets. It should describe the following registers:
36748
36749 @itemize @minus
36750 @item
36751 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
36752 @item
36753 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
36754 @item
36755 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
36756 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
36757 @item
36758 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
36759 @item
36760 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
36761 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
36762 @end itemize
36763
36764 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
36765
36766 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
36767 describe registers:
36768
36769 @itemize @minus
36770 @item
36771 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
36772 @item
36773 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
36774 @item
36775 @samp{mxcsr}
36776 @end itemize
36777
36778 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
36779 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
36780 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
36781
36782 @itemize @minus
36783 @item
36784 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
36785 @item
36786 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
36787 @end itemize
36788
36789 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
36790 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
36791
36792 @node MIPS Features
36793 @subsection MIPS Features
36794 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
36795
36796 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
36797 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
36798 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
36799 on the target.
36800
36801 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
36802 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
36803 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
36804
36805 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
36806 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
36807 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
36808 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
36809
36810 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
36811 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
36812 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
36813
36814 @node M68K Features
36815 @subsection M68K Features
36816 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
36817
36818 @table @code
36819 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
36820 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
36821 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
36822 One of those features must be always present.
36823 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
36824 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
36825 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
36826 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
36827
36828 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
36829 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
36830 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
36831 @samp{fpiaddr}.
36832 @end table
36833
36834 @node PowerPC Features
36835 @subsection PowerPC Features
36836 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
36837
36838 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
36839 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
36840 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
36841 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
36842
36843 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
36844 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
36845
36846 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
36847 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
36848 and @samp{vrsave}.
36849
36850 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
36851 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
36852 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
36853 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
36854 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
36855 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
36856
36857 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
36858 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
36859 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
36860 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
36861 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
36862 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
36863 user.
36864
36865 @node Operating System Information
36866 @appendix Operating System Information
36867 @cindex operating system information
36868
36869 @menu
36870 * Process list::
36871 @end menu
36872
36873 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
36874 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
36875 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
36876 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
36877 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
36878 on a different aspect of target.
36879
36880 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
36881 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
36882 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
36883 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
36884
36885 @node Process list
36886 @appendixsection Process list
36887 @cindex operating system information, process list
36888
36889 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
36890 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
36891 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
36892 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
36893
36894 An example document is:
36895
36896 @smallexample
36897 <?xml version="1.0"?>
36898 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
36899 <osdata type="processes">
36900 <item>
36901 <column name="pid">1</column>
36902 <column name="user">root</column>
36903 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
36904 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
36905 </item>
36906 </osdata>
36907 @end smallexample
36908
36909 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
36910 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
36911 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
36912 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
36913 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
36914 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
36915 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
36916
36917 @node Trace File Format
36918 @appendix Trace File Format
36919 @cindex trace file format
36920
36921 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
36922 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
36923
36924 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
36925 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
36926 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
36927 in the future.
36928
36929 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
36930 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
36931 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
36932 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
36933 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
36934 of this section.
36935
36936 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
36937
36938 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
36939 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
36940 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
36941 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
36942 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
36943 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
36944 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
36945 endianness.
36946
36947 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
36948
36949 @table @code
36950 @item R @var{bytes}
36951 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
36952 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
36953 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
36954 hexadecimal encoding.
36955
36956 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
36957 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
36958 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
36959 @var{length} bytes.
36960
36961 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
36962 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
36963 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
36964
36965 @end table
36966
36967 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
36968 of blocks.
36969
36970 @node Index Section Format
36971 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
36972 @cindex .gdb_index section format
36973 @cindex index section format
36974
36975 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
36976 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
36977 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
36978 description.
36979
36980 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
36981 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
36982 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
36983 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
36984 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
36985 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
36986
36987 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
36988
36989 @enumerate
36990 @item
36991 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
36992 unless otherwise noted:
36993
36994 @enumerate
36995 @item
36996 The version number, currently 4. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
36997
36998 @item
36999 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
37000
37001 @item
37002 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
37003 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
37004 to the next offset.
37005
37006 @item
37007 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
37008
37009 @item
37010 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
37011
37012 @item
37013 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
37014 @end enumerate
37015
37016 @item
37017 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
37018 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
37019 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
37020 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
37021 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
37022 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
37023 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
37024 CU indices.
37025
37026 @item
37027 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
37028 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
37029 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
37030 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
37031
37032 @item
37033 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
37034 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
37035
37036 @enumerate
37037 @item
37038 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
37039
37040 @item
37041 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
37042 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
37043
37044 @item
37045 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
37046 @end enumerate
37047
37048 @item
37049 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
37050 the hash table is always a power of 2.
37051
37052 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
37053 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
37054 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
37055 constant pool.
37056
37057 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
37058 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
37059 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
37060
37061 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
37062 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
37063 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
37064 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula
37065 @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}. The terminating @samp{\0} is not
37066 incorporated into the hash.
37067
37068 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
37069 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
37070 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
37071 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
37072 collision.
37073
37074 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
37075 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
37076 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
37077 the code.
37078
37079 @item
37080 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
37081 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
37082 strings.
37083
37084 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
37085 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
37086 Each subsequent value is the index of a CU in the CU list. This
37087 element in the hash table is used to indicate which CUs define the
37088 symbol.
37089
37090 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
37091 @end enumerate
37092
37093 @include gpl.texi
37094
37095 @node GNU Free Documentation License
37096 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
37097 @include fdl.texi
37098
37099 @node Index
37100 @unnumbered Index
37101
37102 @printindex cp
37103
37104 @tex
37105 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
37106 % meantime:
37107 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
37108 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
37109 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
37110 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
37111 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
37112 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
37113 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
37114 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
37115 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
37116 \page\colophon
37117 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
37118 @end tex
37119
37120 @bye
This page took 0.843926 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.